Pe 020000

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 302

2012

Rules
Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships

Part 2 Materials and Welding

2012

Guidance
Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel ships

Part 2 Materials and Welding


2012

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships

Part 2

Materials and Welding

RA-02-E KOREAN REGISTER OF SHIPPING


Amendments to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships
(PART 2 MATERIALS AND WELDING, 2011 Edition)

Effective Date 1 July 2012

CHAPTER 1 MATERIALS

Section 3 Rolled Steels


- 301. 1. (3) and (4) have been newly established.
- 301. 12. has been newly established.
- Table 2.1.10 of 302. has been amended.
- Table 2.1.13 of 303. has been amended.
- 303. 3. (2) and (3) have been newly established.
- Table 2.1.14 and 2.1.15 have been amended and Table 2.1.14-1 has been newly
established in 303.
- 303. 10. has been amended.
- Table 2.1.16, 2.1.17 and 2.1.18 have been amended and Table 2.1.17-1 has been
newly established in 304.
- 305. 1. (2) has newly established.
- 305. 12. has newly established.
- 306. 1. (2) has newly established.
- Table 2.1.21, 2.1.22, 2.1.23 and 2.1.24 of 306. have been amended.
- 306. 5. (2), 7. (2) and 8. (2), (3), (4) have been deleted.
- Table 2.1.33 of 308. has been amended.

Section 5 Castings
- 502. 1. (2) has been newly established.
- Table 2.1.69 and 2.1.70 of 502. have been amended.
- 502. 9. (1) has been deleted.

Section 6 Steel Forgings


- 603. 1. (2) has been newly established.
- Table 2.1.85, 2.1.86 and 2.1.87 of 603. have amended.
- 603. 8. has been deleted.

CHAPTER 2 WELDING

Section 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures


- Table 2.2.2 of 203. has been amended.

Section 4 Welding Procedure Qualification Tests


- 407. 2. (1) (e) has been amended.

Section 5 Welders and Welder Performance Qualification Tests

- i -
- Fig. 2.2.11, 2.2.16 and 2.2.17 have been amended.

- ii -
CONTENTS

CHAPTER 1 MATERIALS ·································································································1

Section 1 General ··················································································································1


101. Application ···················································································································· 1
102. Approval of manufacturing process and manufacturing control ······························· 1
103. Chemical composition ·································································································· 1
104. Testing and inspection ································································································· 2
105. Execution of testing and inspection ··········································································· 2
106. Identification of materials ···························································································· 2
107. Test certificates ············································································································ 2
108. Quality and repair of defects ······················································································ 3
109. Retest procedures ········································································································· 3
110. Marking ························································································································· 4

Section 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures ···················································5


201. General ·························································································································· 5
202. Form and dimension of test specimen ······································································· 5
203. Testing procedure ······································································································· 10

Section 3 Rolled Steels ·····································································································11


301. Rolled steels for hull structural ················································································ 11
302. Rolled steel plates for boiler ···················································································· 18
303. Rolled steel plates for pressure vessel ····································································· 20
304. Rolled steels for low temperature service ································································ 23
305. Rolled stainless steels ································································································ 27
306. Round bars for chain ································································································ 29
307. Rolled steel bars for boiler ······················································································· 32
308. high strength quenched and tempered steels for welded structures ······················· 33
309. Stainless clad steel plates ·························································································· 37
310. Additional requirements for through thickness properties ······································· 39

Section 4 Steel Tubes and Pipes ···················································································42


401. Steel tubes for boilers and heat exchangers ···························································· 42
402. Steel pipes for pressure piping ················································································· 46
403. Stainless steel pipes ··································································································· 52
404. Steel pipes for low temperature service ··································································· 55
405. Header ························································································································· 58

Section 5 Castings ··············································································································61


501. Steel castings ·············································································································· 61
502. Steel castings for chains ···························································································· 65
503. Stainless steel castings ······························································································· 67
504. Steel castings for low temperature service ······························································ 68
505. Stainless steel casting for propeller ·········································································· 69
506. Grey iron castings ······································································································ 71

- iii -
507. Spheroidal or nodular graphite iron castings ··························································· 73

Section 6 Steel Forgings ···································································································78


601. Steel forgings ············································································································· 78
602. Stainless steel forgings ······························································································ 88
603. Steel forgings for chains ··························································································· 89
604. Steel forgings for low temperature service ······························································ 91

Section 7 Copper and Copper Alloy ··············································································93


701. Copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes ······························································· 93
702. Copper alloy castings ································································································· 94

Section 8 Aluminium Alloys ······························································································98


801. Aluminium alloys ······································································································· 98

CHAPTER 2 WELDING ································································································· 103

Section 1 General ·············································································································103


101. Application ················································································································ 103
102. Matters to be approved ··························································································· 103
103. Special weldings ······································································································· 103
104. Terms and definitions ······························································································ 103

Section 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures ···············································104


201. General ······················································································································ 104
202. Selection of test specimens ····················································································· 104
203. Size and dimensions of test specimens ·································································· 104
204. Mechanical testing procedures ················································································· 108

Section 3 Welding Work and Inspection ····································································109


301. Details of joints ······································································································· 109
302. Welding Practice ······································································································ 110
303. Application of welding consumables ······································································ 110
304. Preparation for Welding ·························································································· 110
305. Welding sequence and direction of welding ·························································· 112
306. Main welding ··········································································································· 112
307. Automatic welding ··································································································· 112
308. Welding for higher strength steel ··········································································· 112
309. Quality of welds ······································································································ 113
310. Repairs ······················································································································ 113

Section 4 Welding Procedure Qualification Tests ····················································114


401. General ······················································································································ 114
402. Welding procedure specification ·············································································· 114
403. Welding procedure qualification tests(WPQT) ······················································· 115
404. Tests for butt welded joints ···················································································· 115
405. Tests for fillet welded joints ··················································································· 123
406. Retests and Procedure qualification records(PQR) ················································· 124
407. Validity of qualified welding procedure specification ··········································· 125

- iv -
SECTION 5 Welders and Welder Performance Qualification Tests ···················129
501. General ······················································································································ 129
502. Grades, and range of qualification ········································································· 129
503. Testing procedure ····································································································· 133

SECTION 6 Welding Consumables ··············································································139


601. General ······················································································································ 139
602. Electrodes for manual arc welding for normal strength steels, higher strength
steels and steels for low temperature service ························································ 141
603. Automatic welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength steels
and steels for low temperature service ·································································· 150
604. Semi-automatic welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength
steels and steels for low temperature service ························································ 160
605. Electro-slag and electro-gas welding consumables ················································ 167
606. One side welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength steels
and steels for low temperature service. ································································· 171
607. Welding consumables for stainless steel ································································ 176
608. Welding consumables for aluminium alloys ·························································· 186
609. Welding consumables for high strength quenched and tempered steels for welded
structures ··················································································································· 190

- v -
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

CHAPTER 1 MATERIALS

SECTION 1 General

101. Application
1. The requirements in this Chapter apply to the materials intended to be used for the components
specified in each Part of hull construction, equipment and machinery.
2. The materials other than those prescribed in this Chapter may be used where specially approved in
connection with the design. In such cases, the detailed data relating to the chemical compositions
and mechanical properties, etc. of the materials are to be submitted for approval.
3. Reinforced plastic materials used for construction or repair of plastic pipes, FRP ships or composite
vessel should be in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.

102. Approval of manufacturing process and manufacturing control


1. Approval of manufacturing process
(1) The materials prescribed in this Chapter, unless otherwise specially provided, are to be manufac-
tured by open-hearth, electric furnace, basic oxygen processes, or other processes at works ap-
proved by the Society. In this case, the manufacturer is to obtain the approval in accordance
with the Guidance specially specified by the Society in advance concerning the process of man-
ufacture (melting process, ingot casting, rolling, casting, forging and heat treating).
(2) The manufacturing process of semi-finished products such as ingots, slabs, blooms and billets
for the normal and higher strength hull structural steels or forgings are to be approved in ac-
cordance with the Guidance specially specified by the Society in advance
(3) The rolled steel manufacturer supplied semi-finished products from other steel works or hot coil
processor is required to obtain the approval of the manufacturing process according to the re-
quirement of proceeding (1) as appropriate.
(4) The requirements specified in Pars (1) and (2) may be applied to the non-ferrous material pre-
scribed in this Chapter.
2. Manufacturing control
(1) It is the manufacturer's responsibility to assure that effective process and production controls in
operation are adhered to within the manufacturing specifications.
(2) Where control imperfection inducing possible inferior quality of product occurs, the manufacturer
is to identify the cause and establish a countermeasure to prevent its recurrence. Also, the com-
plete investigation report is to be submitted to the Surveyor.
(3) For further use, each product affected by previous (2) is to be tested to the Surveyor's
satisfaction. The frequency of testing for subsequent products offered may be increased to gain
confidence in the quality at the discretion of the Society.
(4) When steel is not produced at the works at which it is rolled, a certificate is to be supplied to
the Surveyor at the rolling mill stating the process by which it was manufactured, the name of
the manufacturer who supplied it, the number of the cast from which it was made and the ladle
analysis. The Surveyor is to have access to the works at which the steel was produced.

103. Chemical composition


1. The chemical composition of samples taken from each ladle of each cast is to be determined by
the manufacturer in an adequately equipped and competently staffed laboratory and is to comply
with the appropriate requirements for chemical composition provided in this Chapter.
2. The Manufacturer’s declared analysis will be accepted subject to occasional checks if required by
the Surveyor.
3. Product analysis may be required where the final product chemistry is not well represented by the
analysis from the cast.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 1


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

104. Testing and inspection


1. The materials are to be tested and inspected in the presence of the Society‘s Surveyor except oth-
erwise specially provided, and are to comply with the requirements in this Chapter.
2. The materials other than those prescribed in this Chapter are to be tested and inspected according
to the specification for the testing approved in accordance with the requirements in 101. 2.
3. The Society may accept to omit the tests for materials having the appropriate certificates.
4. Where the materials are manufactured by the approval of quality assurance scheme specially speci-
fied by the Society, a part or all of test and inspection in the presence of the Society's Surveyor
may be omitted.

105. Execution of testing and inspection


1. The manufacturers shall afford the Surveyor all necessary facilities and access to all relevant parts
of the works to enable him to verify that the approved process is adhered to, for the selection of
test materials, and the witnessing of tests, as required by the Rules, and for verifying the accuracy
of the testing equipment.
2. All tests and inspections are to be carried out at the place of manufacture before dispatch. The test
specimens and procedures are to be in accordance with Sec 2 of this chapter. All the test speci-
mens are to be selected and stamped by the Surveyor and tested in his presence, unless otherwise
agreed.
3. In the case of special order, the manufacturer is to show the order specifications, special require-
ments, etc. of the materials to the Surveyor prior to the material test.
4. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are the responsibility of the steel maker. The ac-
ceptance by the Surveyor shall not absolve the steel maker from this responsibility.

106. Identification of materials


1. The manufacturer is to take a suitable measure for the identification of ingots, slabs, castings, forg-
ings, and finished pieces, etc. which will enable the material to be traced to its original heat, roll,
etc.
2. The steelmaker is to adopt a system for the identification of ingots, slabs and finished pieces
which will enable the material to be traced to its original cast. The Surveyor is to be given full
facilities for so tracing the material when required.
3. Where small products such as castings are manufactured in large numbers, modified arrangements
for identification may be specially agreed with the Society.

107. Test certificates


1. The Certificate for Materials Inspection is to be issued to the materials that have been satisfactorily
tested and inspected in accordance with the requirements in this Chapter.
2. The Certificate for Materials Inspection is to contain in addition to the dimensions and weight of
steels at least the following particulars;
(1) Purchaser‘s name or purchaser's order number and if known the hull number for which the ma-
terial is intended.
(2) Identification of the cast and rolled piece.
(3) Identification of the steelworks.
(4) Material grade mark
(5) Chemical composition (ladle analysis values of elements controlled by the requirements) and car-
bon equivalent calculated by following a formula. (if required)

         
         
  

2 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(6) Mechanical properties.


(7) Condition of heat treatment (e.g. normalized or controlled roll except for as rolled)
(8) Deoxidization procedure is to be stated. (rimmed steel only)
3. Notwithstanding the previous provisions, the accepted material may be omitted the issue of the
Certificate for Materials Inspection where the manufacturer supplies the Mill Sheets stated the re-
quirement of the previous Par 2 for each accepted steel grade to the Surveyor for his signature. In
this case, the manufacturer is to enter the following statement on the certificate to show that the
steel material has been made by an approval process and that it has withstand satisfactory the re-
quired tests. The following form of declaration will be accepted if stamped or printed on each test
certificate with the name of the steel works in English or Korean, and is to be signed by the per-
sonnel of the manufacturing shop in charge of product quality assurance or inspector.
"We hereby certify that the material has been made by an approval process and has been satisfac-
torily tested in accordance with the Rules of Korean Register of Shipping."

108. Quality and repair of defects


1. All materials are to be free from surface or internal defects which would be prejudicial to their
proper application in service. The surface finish is to be in accordance with good practice and any
specific requirements of the approved plan.
2. In the event of any material proving unsatisfactory during subsequent working or fabrication, such
material may be rejected, notwithstanding any previous satisfactory testing and/or certification where
the Surveyor considers necessary.
3. Welding or other means for the purpose of repairing defects is not permitted, unless the extent and
method of repair (including welding procedure and heat treatment) are approved by the Surveyor.
The repair of defects is to be carried out in the presence of the Surveyor, unless otherwise agreed.
4. Where repair by grinding is carried out then the remaining plate thickness below the ground area
must be within the allowable under thickness tolerance.

109. Retest procedures


1. Where a part of the results of any test except impact test does not comply with the requirements,
but the remainders are satisfactory, additional test specimens twice in number may be taken from
the same material and retests for the failed test may be carried out. In such a case, all of the test
specimens are to comply with the requirements.
2. Impact test
(1) Where the result of the impact test is unsatisfactory, additional tests may be carried out, with
the exception of the cases specified in (i) and (ii) below, by taking a set of test specimens out
of the same piece from which the above-mentioned test specimens have been taken.
(i) The absorbed energy of all test specimens is under the required average absorbed energy.
(ii) The absorbed energy of two of the test specimens is under 70 % the required average ab-
sorbed energy.
(2) In case of the previous (1), all pieces of the same lot from which the test specimens have been
taken, may be accepted, provided that the average absorbed energy of the six test specimens,
including those which have been rejected as unsatisfactory, is not less than the required average
absorbed energy, and that not more than two individual results are lower than the required aver-
age absorbed energy and of these, not more than one result is below 70 % of the required aver-
age absorbed energy.
3. If a heat treated material fails to meet the requirements in any test, retest and heat treatment may
be allowed two times(three times including the first test). In this case, however, the material is not
to be considered as having complied with the requirements, unless all tests fully comply with the
test requirements.
4. If the percentage of elongation of any tension test specimen is less than that specified and any part
of fracture is outside the one-fourth of the gauge length from the centre of gauge length, the test
is to be considered as invalid, and a retest for the material from which the first test specimen has
been taken may be allowed.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 3


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

110. Marking
1. Every material complying with the requirements is to be clearly stamped with the Society's brand
and material grade mark, and marked with the following particulars at least in one position by
the maker:
(1) Name or mark to identify the steel works.
(2) Number or mark to identify the material.
(3) Name or mark to identify the purchaser. (if required by the purchaser)
2. Materials which have been specially approved by the Society in accordance with the requirements
in 101. 2 are to have the letter "S" after the material grade mark.
3. Materials which are unsuitable for stamping may be marked with brands, seals or by other suitable
means.
4. The marking particulars, but excluding the manufacturer's name or trade mark where this is em-
bossed on finished products are to be encircled with paint or otherwise marked so as to be easily
recognisable.
5. Materials which can not be stamped and marked in accordance with the requirements in Pars 1
and 2 due to small size may be properly marked in the lump.
6. Where a number of light materials are securely fastened together in bundles the manufacturer may,
subject to the agreement of the Society, brand only the top piece of each bundle, or alternatively,
a firmly fastened durable label containing the brand may be attached to each bundle.
7. In the event of any material bearing the Society's brand failing to comply with the test require-
ments, the brand is to be unmistakably defaced by the manufacturer.

4 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures

201. General
1. Application
(1) Test specimens and mechanical testing procedures for materials are to comply with the require-
ments of this Section, unless otherwise specially provided in each Section.
(2) Where test specimens and testing procedures differing from those prescribed in this Section are
used, they are to be approved by the Society.
2. Testing machine
(1) The testing machines used for the tests relative to this Chapter are to be managed by competent
personnel on machines.
(2) Tension/compression testing machines are to be calibrated in accordance with KS B ISO 7500-1
or other recognised standard.
(3) Impact testing machines are to be calibrated in accordance with KS B ISO 148-2 or other recog-
nised standard.
(4) The accuracy of tensile test machines is to be within ±1%
3. Selection of test specimens
(1) The test specimens are to be selected according to each requirement in this Chapter.
(2) Except where otherwise specified or agreed with the Surveyor, test samples are not to be de-
tached from the material until being stamped by the Surveyor.
(3) If test samples are cut from material by flame cutting or shearing, a reasonable margin is re-
quired to enable sufficient material to be removed from the cut edges during final machining.
(4) The preparation of test specimens is to be done in such a manner that test specimens are not
subjected to any significant cold working or heating.
(5) If any test specimen shows defective machining or defects having no relation to the substantial
nature, it may be discarded and substituted by another test specimen.

202. Form and dimension of test specimen


1. Tensile test specimen
(1) Tensile test specimens are classified as standard test specimen and proportional test specimen as
shown in Table 2.1.1 depend on the shape and dimension of test specimen.

Table 2.1.1 Kinds of tensile test specimen


Kind Flat Round Pipe
Proportional R14B R14A R14B, R14C
Standard R1A, R1B, R5, R13B R4, R8C, R10 -

(2) Tensile test specimens are to be of the forms and sizes given in Fig 2.1.1
(3) The gauge length may be rounded off the nearest 5 mm, provided that the difference between
this length and  is less than 10 % of  .

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 5


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Shapes Kind Type Forms of specimen(1) Size of specimen(2) Materials to be applied

 = 
Rolled steels 3 mm thick
 = 25 mm
or more,
Proportional R 14B  = 
 (4) Aluminium alloy 12.5mm
 ≅    thick or less
 = 25 mm
 = 
Rolled steel plates for
 = 40 mm
boiler,
R 1A  = 200 mm
Rolled steel plates for
 ≅ 220 mm
pressure vessel
 = 25 mm
 = 
 = 25 mm
Rolled steels 3 mm thick
Flat(3) R 1B  = 200 mm
or more,
 ≅ 212.5 mm
 = 25 mm
Standard
 = 
 = 25 mm
Rolled steel plates for
R5  = 50 mm
pressure vessel
 ≅ 60 mm
 = 15 mm
 = 
 = 12.5 mm
Rolled steels less than 3
R 13B  = 50 mm
mm thick
 ≅ 60 mm
 = 25 mm
Rolled steels, Castings,
(5) Forgings, Spheroidal or
 = 5
nodular graphite iron
Proportional R 14A  ≅   
castings, Copper alloy
 = 10 mm(6)
Aluminium alloy 12.5mm
thick or more
 = 14 mm
 = 50 mm Rolled steel plates for
R4
 ≅ 60 mm pressure vessel
 = 15 mm
Round
 = 12.5 mm
 = 50 mm Rolled steel plates for
R 10
Standard  ≅ 60 mm boiler
 = 15 mm

 = 20 mm
R 8C Grey iron castings
 = 25 mm

Fig 2.1.1 Types and forms of tensile test specimens (unit : mm)

6 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Shapes Kind Type Forms of specimen Size of specimen Materials to be applied

 = t
 ≥ 12 mm
R 14B  = 

 ≅  + 2
 = 25 mm Steel tubes, copper and
Pipe Proportional copper alloy pipes and
tubes
 = 

 ≅  + 
R 14C
 is the distance
between the grips

NOTES:
(1) The notations used are defined as follows.
 : Diameter,  : Cross section,  : Thickness,  : Transition radius,  : Width
 : External tube diameter,  : Gauge length,  : Plate thickness,  : Parallel test length
(2) The both ends of the test specimens may be machined to such shapes as to fit the holder of the testing
machine.
(3) When the capacity of the available testing machine is insufficient to allow the use of test specimen of full
thickness, this may be reduced by machining one of the rolled surfaces.
(4) Gauge length  should preferably be greater than 20 mm.
(5) d ≥ 10 mm to 20 mm, preferably 14 mm
(6) For nodular cast iron and materials with a specified elongation less than 10%, R ≥ 1,5

Fig 2.1.1 Types and forms of tensile test specimens (unit : mm)

(4) The manufacturers may use the test specimens approved by the Society, besides those specified
in (2). In this case, the elongation measured at the tensile tests is to be corrected by the fol-
lowing formula:


  ․ ․  


where:
 = equivalent elongation for the proportional test specimens specified in (1) (%).
 = actual measured elongation of test specimen (%).
 = actual cross-sectional area of test specimen ( mm  ).
 = actual gauge length of test specimen (mm).
 ,  = constants given in bellow in accordance with the kind of materials.

Constant  
Material
Material 1 2.0 0.40
Material 2 2.6 0.55
NOTES:
1. Material 1 : For carbon and low alloy steels with a tensile strength not exceeding 590
Nmm  in the hot rolled, annealed, normalized or normalized and tempered conditions.
2. Material 2 : For carbon and low alloy steels in the quenched and tempered condition.
3. The values of a and b for other kinds of materials than Material 1 and Material 2 are
to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 7


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(5) The machine-finished parallel part of test specimens is to be uniform throughout the entire
length and the permissible variation (difference between the maximum and minimum values) is
to be as specified in Table 2.1.2.

Table 2.1.2 Permissible Variation (unit : mm)


Round Flat specimen with thickness equal to or
Flat specimen with thickness less than 6 mm
specimen greater than 6 mm
Nominal Nominal Nominal Nominal Nominal
Permissible permissible permissible permissible permissible
diameter Thickness width Thickness width
variation variation variation variation variation
(d) (t) (w) (t) (w)
10≤d<12 0.025 6≤t<12 0.02 25≤w<40 0.05 0.6≤t<1.2 0.002 12.5≤w<25 0.02
12≤d<16 0.03 12≤t<20 0.04 40≤w 0.10 1.2≤t<2.5 0.004 25≤w 0.04
16≤d 0.04 20≤t 0.05 2.5≤t<6 0.01

2. Bend test specimen


Bend test specimens are to be of size and dimensions given in Fig 2.1.2 according to the kind of
materials.

3. Impact test specimen


(1) Impact test specimens are to be provided in a set of three specimens, and the test specimens
are to be machine finished to the forms and dimensions given in Fig 2.1.3 and Table 2.1.3

8 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

unless the section thickness of the product is less than 12 mm


(2) The notch is to be cut in a face of the test specimen which was originally perpendicular to the
rolled surface, casting surface and forging surface according to the kind of materials. The posi-
tion of the notch is not to be nearer than 25 mm to a flame cut or sheared edge.

Fig 2.1.3 Impact test specimen

Table 2.1.3 Dimensions of impact Test Specimens

Kinds Charpy V-notch test specimen


Dimensions
Length (mm)  55 ± 0.6

Width (mm)  10 ± 0.11

Thickness (mm)  10 ± 0.06

Angle of notch (mm)  45 ± 2

Depth below notch (mm)  8 ± 0.06

Root radius of notch (mm)  0.25 ± 0.025


Distance of notch from end of test
 27.5 ± 0.42
specimen (mm)
Angle between plane of symmetry of notch
- 90 ± 2
and longitudinal axis of test specimen (deg)

(3) Where the impact test specimens, having the size specified in (1) above for rolled steels, tubes
and pipes cannot be taken, the width W may be the sub-size values given in Table 2.1.4. In
this case, the average absorbed energy of rolled steels, tubes and pipes is not to be less than
the value(by counting fractions of 0.05 and over as 0.1 and disregarding the rest) multiplying
the absorbed energy by values given in Table 2.1.4 in accordance with the width of the test
specimens.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 9


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.4 Multiplier to Absorbed Energy

Multiplier for absorbed energy


Thickness and width of sub-size
specimen t×W (mm) Average absorbed energy of 3 test specimens

10 × 5 ± 0.06 2/3

10 × 7.5 ± 0.11 5/6

(4) Where the thickness of a test specimen is less than 6 mm, and where impact test specimen hav-
ing the sub-size specified in Table 2.1.4 cannot be taken in welded parts of tubes and pipes,
the impact test may be omitted.
(5) In all cases, the largest size charpy specimens possible for the material thickness shall be
machined.
4. Confirmation for test specimen

The size and dimensions of test specimens are to be carefully inspected and verified by suitable
means before testing.

203. Testing procedure


1. Tensile test
(1) When well-defined yield phenomena exists, the value of yield strength(yield stress) is to be
measured at the first peak obtained during yielding. When no well defined yield phenomenon
exists, the 0.2 % proof stress (Rp 0.2) is to be determined. For austenitic and duplex stainless
steel products, the 1 % proof stress (Rp 1) may be determined in addition to Rp 0.2 as approved
by the Society.
(2) Where the value of yield point or yield stress is measured at tensile test, the rate of loading
shall be as following.

Modulus of Elasticity of the Rate of stressing (Nmm sec)


material (E)
(Nmm  ) Min. Max.

<150,000 2 20
≥150,000 6 60

(3) After reaching the yield or proof load, for ductile material the machine speed during the tensile
test is not to exceed that corresponding to a strain rate of 0.008s-1. For brittle materials, such
as cast iron, the elastic stress rate is not to exceed 10 Nmm sec
2. Impact test

The impact test is to be conducted on a Charpy impact testing machine having a capacity not less
than 150 J and a striking velocity between 4.5 and 6 m/sec, with the test specimens at temperature
controlled within +2℃ of the specified temperature.

10 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 3 Rolled Steels

301. Rolled steels for hull structural


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to hull structural rolled steels (hereinafter referred to as "steels")
not exceeding 100 mm in thickness.
(2) Any requirement regarding steels over the thickness specified in Table 2.1.5 is to be left to the
discretion of the Society.
(3) YP47 rolled steels with minimum yield strength of 460 Nmm  and over for hull structural
member are to be in accordance with the approved specifications by the Society.
(4) Corrosion resistance steels for cargo oil tanks of crude oil tanker are to be deemed appropriate
by the Society.
(5) Where improved through thickness properties are specified for plates and wide flats with thick-
ness of 15 mm and over, the tensile test of through thickness property specified in 310. is to
be carried out in addition to the requirements of 301.
(6) Steels other than those specified in 301. are to be in accordance with the requirements of 101.
2.
2. Kinds
Steels are classified as specified in Table 2.1.5.

Table 2.1.5 Grades of Rolled Steels for hull

Kinds Grade Thickness  (mm)


Plates(3)  ≤ 100
(1)
Normal strength steel A, B, D, E
Sections and bars  ≤ 50

AH 32, DH 32, EH 32, FH 32


Plates(3) AH 36, DH 36, EH 36, FH 36  ≤ 100
AH 40, DH 40, EH 40, FH 40
Higher strength steels(2)
AH 32, DH 32, EH 32, FH 32
Sections and bars AH 36, DH 36, EH 36, FH 36  ≤ 50
AH 40, DH 40, EH 40, FH 40

NOTE:
(1) Provision is made for four grades of normal strength steels based on the impact test requirements.
(2) For higher strength steels, provision is made for three strength levels(315, 355 and 390 Nmm  )
each subdivided into four grades(ex. : AH 32, DH 32, EH 32 and FH 32) based on the impact test
temperature.
(3) Steel plates include flat bars not less than 600 mm in width.

3. Manufacturing process
(1) Where steel plates are manufactured from the continuous casting slabs, the maximum thickness
for approval is to be determined, as a rule, with the roll ratio of 6 as standard. However, upon
consideration of the manufacturing process, the roll ratio may be reduced to 4 (3 for steel plate
thickness in excess of 50 mm).
(2) The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of each grade are to comply with the re-
quirements given in Table 2.1.6. For steel plates and wide flats over 50mm thick and When
thermo-mechanical controlled processing (hereinafter referred to as "TMCP") is used as heat
treatment, slight deviations in the chemical composition may be allowed as approved by the
Society.
4. Heat treatment
The heat treatment of each grade is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.8 and
Table 2.1.9.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 11


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.6 Deoxidation Practice and Chemical Composition


(5)
Chemical Composition (  )
Thickness, Deoxidation
Kinds Grade
 (mm) Practice C Si Mn P S Cu Cr Ni Mo Al(8) Nb V Ti N

Killed and 0.21 2.5×C


 ≤50
Semi-killed max. 0.50 min.
(1)
A
(3)(4) max. (4)
 >50 Killed -
Killed and 0.21 0.8
 ≤50 0.35
B Semi-killed max. min.
Normal max. (4)(6) 0.035 0.035
(4)
strength  >50 Killed - - - - - - - -
max. max.
steels  ≤25 Killed 0.21 0.6 0.015
0.35
D Fine grain max. min. min.
 >25 (4) max. (4) (2)(9)
treated(2)
Killed and 0.18 0.7 0.015
0.35
E  ≤100 Fine grain max. min. min.
(4) max. (4) (9)
treated
AH 32
DH 32
EH 32
 ≤100
AH 36 0.90~
0.18 0.035 0.035 0.40
DH 36 1.60 -
Higher max. (7) max. max. max.
Killed and 0.015 0.02~ 0.05~ 0.02
strength EH 36 0.50 0.35 0.20 0.08
Fine grain min. 0.05 0.10 max.
steels AH 40 max. max. max. max. (10) (10)(11) (10)(11) (11)
(13) treated
DH 40
EH 40
 ≤50
FH 32 0.009
0.16 0.90~ 0.025 0.025 0.80
FH 36 max.
max. 1.60 max. max. max. (12)
FH 40

NOTES:
(1) For sections up to 12.5 mm in thickness inclusive, subject to a special approval by the Society, rimmed steel
may be accepted.
(2) For steels above 25 mm in thickness, aluminium treatment is to be used as a fully killed, fine grain practice.
However, killed steel up to 50 mm in thickness may be accepted at the discretion of the Society.
(3) For steel sections, maximum carbon content may be increased to 0.23 %.
(4) The value of C + Mn/6 is not to exceed 0.40 %.
(5) Where additions of any other element have been made as part of the steelmaking practice, the content is to be
indicated on the test certificate.
(6) When an impact test as killed steels is conducted, the minimum manganese content may be reduced to 0.60 %.
(7) For steels up to 12.5 mm in thickness inclusive, the minimum manganese content may be reduced to 0.70 %.
(8) Aluminium content is to be represented by the acid soluble aluminium content, but may be determined by the
total aluminium content. In such a case, the total aluminium content is not to be less than 0.020 %.
(9) Upon the approval by the Society, grain refining elements other than aluminium may be used.
(10) The steel is to contain aluminium, niobium, vanadium or other suitable grain refining elements, either singly or
in any combination. When used singly, the steel is to contain the specified minimum content of the grain refin-
ing element. When used in combination, the specified minimum content of each element is not applicable.
(11) The total niobium, vanadium and titanium content is to be less than 0.12 %.
(12) If Aluminium is present, the maximum content of nitrogen may be increased to 0.012 %.
(13) For TMCP steels, carbon equivalent values(Ceq) and/or cold cracking susceptibility(Pcm) of each steel is to be
left to the discretion of the Society.

12 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.7 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test Impact test


(1)
Average absorbed energy (J)
(6)
Grade Yield Tensile Elongation test Thickness,  (mm)
strength strength (   
) temp
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (%) (℃)  ≤ 50 50 <  ≤ 70 70 <  ≤ 100
(2) (2) (2) (2)
L T L T L (2) T (2)
(4) (4) (4) (4)
A +20 - -
B 0(5)
235 min. 400~520(3) 22 min.
D -20 27 min. 20 min. 34 min. 24 min. 41 min. 27 min.
E -40
AH 32 0
DH 32 -20
315 min. 440~570 22 min. 31 min. 22 min. 38 min. 26 min. 46 min. 31 min.
EH 32 -40
FH 32 -60
AH 36 0
DH 36 -20
355 min. 490~630 21 min. 34 min. 24 min. 41 min. 27 min. 50 min. 34 min.
EH 36 -40

FH 36 -60

AH 40 0
DH 40 -20
390 min. 510~660 20 min. 39 min. 26 min. 46 min. 31 min. 55 min. 37 min.
EH 40 -40

FH 40 -60

NOTE:
(1) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in value
than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is less
in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to be failed.
(2) L (or T) denotes that the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is arranged parallel (or transverse) to the
final direction of rolling.
(3) For all thickness of Grade A section, the upper limit of the specified tensile strength, may be exceeded.
(4) For Grade A steel over 50 mm in thickness with ARS or CRS heat treatment, impact tests are required. In
this case, the average absorbed energy is to comply with the requirements of Grade B steel.
(5) For Grade B steels up to 25 mm in thickness, generally no impact testing is required.
(6) The minimum elongation for R 1B test specimen (L=200mm) is to be in compliance with the requirement
given in the Table below.

Thickness 
(mm) 3≤ ≤5 5<≤10 10<≤15 15<≤20 20<≤25 25<≤30 30<≤40 40<≤100
Grade
A, B, D, E,
AH 32, DH 32, EH 32, 14 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
FH 32
AH 36, DH 36, EH 36,
13 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
FH 36
AH 40, DH 40, EH40,
12 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
FH 40

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 13


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.8 Heat Treatment and Size of lot for Impact Test specimen for Normal Strength Steels

Heat treatment and Size of Lot for Impact Test Specimen(1)(2)(3)(4)


Deoxidation Thickness(mm)
Grade Products(5)
practice 0 12.5 25 35 50 100

Rimmed(6) Sections AR<->

Semi-killed All AR<->


A
N<-> TM CP<-> CRS<50>(6)
Plates AR<->
ARS<50>(6)
Killed
Sections and bars AR<->

Semi-killed All

N<50> TM CP<50> CRS<25>


B Plates AR<-> AR<50>
Killed ARS<25>

Sections and bars

TM CP <50> N <50>
Killed All AR <50>
CR <50>

TM CP <50> N <50>
D Plates TM CP<50> N<50> CRS<25>
Fine grain
CR <50>
AR <50>
treated
TM CP <50> N <50>
Sections and bars
CR <50> ARS <50>

Killed and Plates TM CP<P> N<P>


E Fine grain
treated Sections and bars TM CP <50> N <50> CRS <50> ARS <50>

NOTES:
(1) Indication symbols used in heat treatment are as follows(the same holds henceforth in this Section):
AR : As Rolled CR : Controlled Rolling Condition N : Normalized Condition
TM CP : Thermo-Mechanical Controlled Processing
ARS : As Rolled Condition subject to special approval of the Society
CRS : Controlled Rolled Condition subject to special approval of the Society.
(2) In the Table, "marks" put at the end of each symbol for heat treatment stand for the volume of each lot.
For examples, <50>, <25> and <15> each indicate that steels not greater than 50, 25 and 15 tonnes in
weight (belonging to the same charge in the same manufacturing process) are to be taken as one lot; <P>,
Piece, indicates that steel material rolled directly from one slab, billet or steel ingot is to be taken as one
lot; and <-> indicates that no impact test is required. The term "piece" is understood to mean the rolled
product from a single slab, billet or ingot if this is rolled directly into plates, sections or bars.
(3) TM CP , N or CR may be applied to instead of being left in a state of AR. In this case, steels are to be
treated equivalent to those left in a state of AR with regard to the fundamental unit of lot.
(4) Steel plates include flat bars not less than 600 mm in width.
(5) For sections up to 12.5 mm in thickness, subject to a special approval by the Society, rimmed steel may be
accepted.
(6) See Note (4) of Table 2.1.7

14 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.9 Heat Treatment and Size of Lot for Impact Test Specimen for Higher Strength Steels

Heat treatment and Size of Lot for Impact Test Specimen(1)(2)(3)(4)

Grade Deoxidation practice Products(5) Thickness (mm)


0 12.5 20 25 35 50 100

Plates TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CR<25>


Nb and/or
(5) AR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50>
V Sections and bars
ARS<25>
AH 32 ARS<50>
AH 36 Plates TM CP<50> N<50>
Al alone TM CP<50> N<50> CR<25>
AR<50> CR<50>
or with Ti
TM CP<50> N<50>
Sections and bars
CR<50> ARS<25>
Plates TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CR<25>
Nb and/or
AR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50>
V(5) Sections and bars
ARS<25>
ARS
DH32
<25>
DH36 Plates
Al alone TM CP<50> N<50>
AR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CRS<25>
or with Ti CR<50>
Killed and TM CP<50> N<50>
Fine grain Sections and bars
CR<50> ARS<25>
treated Plates TM CP<P> N<P>
EH 32
EH 36 Sections and bars TM CP<25> N<25> CR<15> ARS<15>

FH 32 Plates TM CP<P> N<P> QT<P>


FH 36 Sections and bars TM CP<25> N<25> QT<25> ARS<15>
Any grain
AH Plates AR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> QT<P>
refining
40 treated Sections and bars AR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50>
DH elements Plates TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50> TM CP<50> N<50> QT<P>
40 Sections and bars TM CP<50> N<50> CR<50>
Plates TM CP<P> N<P> QT<P>
EH 40
Sections and bars TM CP<25> N<25> QT<25>
Plates TM CP<P> N<P> QT<P>
FH 40
Sections and bars TM CP<25> N<25> QT<25>

NOTES:
(1) Indication symbols used in heat treatment are as follows (the same holds henceforth in this Section);
AR : As rolled CR : Controlled Rolling Condition N : Normalized Condition
TM CP : Thermo-Mechanical Controlled Processing Q T : Quenched and Tempered Condition
ARS : As Rolled Condition subject to special approval of the Society
CRS : Controlled Rolled Condition subject to special approval of the Society.
(2) In the Table, "marks" put at the end of each symbol for heat treatment stand for the volume of each lot. For ex-
amples, <50>, <25> and <15> each indicate that steels not greater than 50, 25 and 15 tonnes in weight (belonging
to the same charge in the same manufacturing process) are to be taken as one lot; <P>, Piece, indicates that steel
material rolled directly from one slab, billet or steel ingot is to be taken as one lot; and <-> indicates that no im-
pact test is required. The term "piece" is understood to mean the rolled product from a single slab, billet or ingot
if this is rolled directly into plates, sections or bars.
(3) TM CP , N or CR may be applied to instead of being left in a state of A R . In this case, steels are to be treated
equivalent to those left in a state of A R with regard to the fundamental unit of lot.
(4) Steel plates include flat bars not less than 600 mm in width.
(5) Niobium treatment stands for the addition of N b either singly or in any combination, regardless of the Nb content,
for grain refining. (Refer to Note (10) of Table 2.1.6)

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 15


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steels are to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.7.
6. Selection of test samples
(1) All material in a batch presented for acceptance tests is to be of the same product form e.g.
plates, flats, sections, etc. from the same cast and in the same condition of supply. The test
samples are to be fully representative of the material and, where appropriate, are not to be cut
from the material until heat treatment has been completed.
(2) For the samples of steel from which tensile test specimens are cut, except where specially ap-
proved by the Society, steels not greater than 50 tonnes in mass (where the amount of scatter
is to be less than 10 mm in thickness or diameter even when they belong to the same cast in
the same manufacturing process) are to be treated as one lot, and the largest one in thickness
or diameter is to be selected from each lot.
(3) For the samples of steel from which impact test specimens are cut, unless otherwise specially
provided or except where specially approved by the Society, the thickest test sample is to be
selected from each lot specified in Table 2.1.8 and Table 2.1.9, according to the substance of
deoxidation practices, type of products and kind of heat treatments
(4) The test samples are to be taken from the following portions according to the requirements (a)
to (c) below and Fig 2.1.4, unless otherwise specified:
(a) Plates and flat bars wider than 600 mm :
One end at a portion approximately 1/4 of the width from the flange end of the plates or
flat bars.
(b) Sections and flat bars not exceeding 600 mm in width:
One end at a portion approximately 1/3 of the width from the flange end. In case of
channels, bulb plates and H-section, the test samples may be taken from the portion approx-
imately 1/4 of the depth from the centre line of the web.
(c) Bars:
The test samples are to be taken so that the axis of each test specimen may lie as near as
possible to the portion specified in (i) and (ii) below. This rule, however, does not apply
when, because dimensions of cross section are insufficient for standard test specimens, a
piece cut in a proper length from the product having the largest diameter of a certain lot is
used as it is for a tensile test.
(i) For non-circular sections, at approximately 1/6 of the largest distance from the outside.
(ii) For circular section, at approximately 1/6 of the diameter from the outside.

7. Selection of test specimens


(1) Test specimens are not to be heat treated separately from the product.
(2) Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to (a) to (c) below.
(a) One test specimen is to be taken from one test sample.
(b) The test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis normal to the final direction
of rolling. For sections, bars and flat bars not exceeding 600 mm in width or when spe-
cially approved by the Society, however, they are to be taken with their longitudinal axis
parallel to the final direction of rolling.

16 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(c) Flat test specimens of full product thickness are, generally, to be used. Round test specimen
may be used when the plates and shapes(except bars) thickness exceeds 40 mm or for bars.
When tensile test specimens of bar type are taken from plates and shapes except bars, they
are to be taken at a portion approximately 1/4 of the thickness from the surface.
(3) Impact test specimens are to be taken according to (a) to (c) below.
(a) A set of test specimens is to be taken from one test sample.
(b) The test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis parallel (L direction) to the
final direction of rolling. When deemed necessary by the Society, however, they are to be
taken with their longitudinal axis normal (T direction) to the final direction of rolling.
(c) When the product thickness does not exceed 40 mm, the test specimens are to be cut with
their edge within 2 mm from the "as rolled" surface. When the product thickness exceeds 40
mm, the test specimen is to be taken at a portion where the axis of the test specimen cor-
responds to approximately 1/4 of the thickness (1/6 of the diameter of bars) from the
surface.
8. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions
(1) The maximum permissible under thickness tolerance for plates and wide flats is -0.3 mm.
Tolerances for over thickness may be taken from KS or proprietary specification which give
reasonable equivalence. But the thickness tolerances for plates with thickness less than 5 mm
may be specially agreed by the Society.
(2) Tolerances for rolled steel other than plates and wide flats may be specially agreed.
(3) Tolerances for length, width and flatness should be in accordance with a recognized national or
international standard which specially agreed by the Society.
(4) The thickness is to be measured at random locations whose distance from longitudinal edge is
to be at least 10 mm.
9. Quality and repair of defects
(1) The quality of finished steel is to be in accordance with the requirements specified in 101. 1.
and 2. The steel is to be reasonably free from segregations and non-metallic inclusions.
(2) If plates and wide flats are ordered with ultrasonic inspection or required by the Society, the
test procedure and acceptance criteria are to be made in accordance with an accepted standard
at the discretion of the Society. However, the probe frequency is to be of 4MHz in general.
(3) The surface defects may be removed by local grinding. However, the procedure of removal of
defect and repair is to be in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by
the Society.
10. Retest Procedures
(1) Where the tensile test fails to meet the requirements, two further tensile tests may be made
from the same piece. If both of these additional tests meet all of the requirements, the piece
and the remaining pieces from the same lot may be accepted.
(2) If one or both of the additional tests referred to above are unsatisfactory, the piece from which
the above-mentioned test pieces have been taken is to be rejected. However, the remaining ma-
terial from the same lot may be accepted, provided that two of the remaining pieces in the lot,
selected in the same way, are tested with satisfactory results.
(3) (a) Where the result of the impact test is unsatisfactory, additional tests may be carried out,
with the exception of the cases specified in (i) and (ii) below, by taking a set of test speci-
mens out of the same piece from which the above-mentioned test specimens have been taken.
(i) The absorbed energy of all test specimens is under the required average absorbed
energy.
(ii) The absorbed energy of two of the test specimens is under 70 % the required average
absorbed energy.
(b) In case of the previous (a), all pieces of the same lot from which the test specimens have
been taken, may be accepted, provided that the average absorbed energy of the six test
specimens, including those which have been rejected as unsatisfactory, is not less than the
required average absorbed energy, and that not more than two individual results are lower
than the required average absorbed energy and of these, not more than one result is below
70 % of the required average absorbed energy.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 17


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(4) When the initial piece, representing a lot, gives unsatisfactory results from the additional Charpy
V-notch impact tests referred to the preceding (3), this piece is to be rejected but the remaining
material in the lot may be accepted provided that two of the remaining pieces in the lot are
tested with satisfactory results. If unsatisfactory results are obtained from either of these two
pieces, then the lot of material is to be rejected. The pieces selected for these additional tests
are to be the thickest remaining in the batch.
(5) If any test specimen fails because of faulty preparation, visible defects or (in the case of tensile
test) because of fracturing outside the range permitted for the appropriate gauge length, the de-
fective test piece may, at the Surveyors discretion, be disregarded and replayed by an additional
test piece of the same type.
(6) Where the test pieces fail in the retests specified above, the piece from which the test pieces
have been taken is to be rejected, However, at the consultation of the manufacturer and the or-
derer, the remaining pieces in the lot may be resubmitted individually for test and those pieces
which give satisfactory results may be accepted.
(7) At the consultation of the manufacturer and the order, the rejected piece may be resubmitted af-
ter heat treatment of re-heat treatment, or may be resubmitted as any other grade of steel and
then, may be accepted, provided that the required tests are satisfactory.
11. Marking
Steels which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the identi-
fication mark in accordance with the requirements in 110. and material supplied in the thermo-me-
chanical controlled processing condition is to have the letters TM added after the material grade
mark. (e.g. EH 40TM )
12. Forming
The cold deformation limit of hull structural rolled steels is to be in accordance with the Guidance
specially specified by the Society.

302. Rolled steel plates for boiler


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the steel plates (hereinafter referred to as "steel plates") for
boilers and pressure vessels to be used at high temperatures.
(2) Steel plates other than those specified in 302. are to comply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds The steel plates are classified as specified in Table 2.1.10.

Table 2.1.10 Grades of Steel Plates

Grade Thickness (mm)


RSP 42
RSP 46 6∼200
RSP 49

RSP 46A
6∼150
RSP 49A

3. Heat treatment
(1) For steel plates of the "RSP 42, RSP 46 and RSP 49" grade with 50 mm or less and of the "RSP
46A and RSP 49A " grade with 38 mm or less in thickness, they are to be as rolled. They, how-
ever, may be heat treated(normalized or annealed for stress relieving) as deemed necessary by
the manufacturer.
(2) For steel plates of the "RSP 42, RSP 46 and RSP 49" grade more than 50 mm and of the "RSP
46A and RSP 49A " grade more than 38 mm in thickness, they are to be either normalized to ob-

18 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

tain the normal grain size or heated uniformly to such a temperature at the time of hot forming
that an effect equivalent to normalizing can be achieved. In case of normalizing, it is, in prin-
ciple, to be performed by the manufacturer.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of steel plates is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.11.

Table 2.1.11 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Grade Thickness
C Si Mn P S Mo
t (mm)
t ≤ 25 0.24 max.
RSP 42 25 < t ≤ 50 0.27 max.
50 < t ≤ 200 0.30 max. 0.90
t ≤ 25 0.28 max. max.
RSP 46 25 < t ≤ 50 0.31 max. -
50 < t ≤ 200 0.33 max.
t ≤ 25 0.31 max.
1.20
RSP 49 25 < t ≤ 50 0.33 max.
max. 0.030 0.030
50 < t ≤ 200 0.35 max. 0.15∼0.40
max. max.
t ≤ 25 0.18 max.
25 < t ≤ 50 0.21 max.
RSP 46A
50 < t ≤ 100 0.23 max.
100 < t ≤ 150 0.25 max. 0.90
0.45~0.60
t ≤ 25 0.20 max. max.
25 < t ≤ 50 0.23 max.
RSP 49A
50 < t ≤ 100 0.25 max.
100 < t ≤ 150 0.27 max.
NOTES:
1. For RSP 46 with 25 mm and over in thickness, carbon and manganese content may be 0.30 % or less
and 1.00 % or less, respectively.

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steel plates are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.12.
6. Selection and heat treatment of test samples
(1) For the steel plates which are not to be heat treated, one test sample is to be taken from each
plate as rolled directly from one slab or ingot
(2) For the steel plates which are to be heat treated, one test sample is to be taken from every
similarly heat treated plate as rolled directly from one slab or ingot.
(3) For steel plates to which stress relieving is required after welding or stress relieving is applied
by the purchaser one or several times repeatedly during their working process, instruction of
that effect is to be given at the time when they are placed for an order. In case where the
procedure of stress relieving is not specified by the purchaser, a heat treatment is to be applied
for the test samples by heating them slowly and uniformly to the temperature of 600℃ to 65
0℃, holding at that temperature for a period of over one hour per 25 mm of thickness, and
then, to be cooled to 300℃ in the furnace before exposure in a still atmosphere.
(4) The test samples are to be taken from the portion approximately 1/4 of the width from the side
end of the plates.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 19


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.12 Mechanical Properties

Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation (%)


Grade
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) R 1A R 10
RSP 42 225 min. 410 ~ 550 21 min. 25 min.
RSP 46 245 min. 450 ~ 590 19 min. 23 min.
RSP 49 265 min. 480 ~ 620 17 min. 21 min.

RSP 46A 255 min. 450 ~ 590 19 min. 23 min.


RSP 49A 275 min. 480 ~ 620 17 min. 21 min.
NOTE:
(1) R1A tensile test specimen is to be used for steel plate up to 50mm in thickness and R10 test specimen for
steel plate more than 50 mm in thickness. However R10 test specimen can be used for steel plate more
than 40 mm in thickness.
(2) For material under 8 mm in thickness, a deduction from the specified percentage of elongation of 1 % is to
be made for each decrease of 1 mm of the specified thickness.
(3) For the plates over 90 mm in thickness, the elongation may be reduced from that mentioned in the
above Table by 0.5 % for each increment of 12.5 mm or fraction thereof exceeding 90 mm in thickness.
Such reduction, however, is limited to 3 %.
(4) In case where the elongation of RSP46A with thickness between 6mm and 20 mm exclusive and RSP49A
steel plate is insufficient within 3 % of the specified value, It will be able to regard as satisfactory if the
elongation of the gauge length 50 mm which includes a rupture part is of 25 % or more.

7. Selection of test specimens


Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to (1) to (3) below.
(1) One test specimen is to be taken from one test sample.
(2) The test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis normal to the final direction of
rolling.
(3) The test specimens of bar type are to be taken from the portion approximately 1/4 of the thick-
ness from the surface.
8. Tolerance for thickness
Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are to be in accordance with the requirements in
301. 8. The minus tolerance for the nominal thickness of plates is to be 0.25 mm.
9. Retest procedure
Where the tensile tests from the first test specimens selected fail to meet the requirements, addi-
tional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109.
10. Marking
(1) Steel plates which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark relating to heat treatment in addition to the requirements in 110.
(2) The marks relating to heat treatment are to be as specified in the following:
(a) Where the plates are normalized : N (e.g. : RSP 46N)
(b) Where the test specimens are normalized : TN (e.g. : RSP 46TN)
(c) Where the test specimens are heat treated corresponding to the stress relieving to be applied
: SR (e.g. : RSP 46N-SR, RSP 46TN-SR)

303. Rolled steel plates for pressure vessel


1. Application
(1) These requirements are mainly to apply to the steel plates for pressure vessels to be used at at-
mospheric temperature (hereinafter referred to as "steel plates")
(2) The steel plates having characteristics differing from those specified in 303. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.

20 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

2. Kinds
The steel plates are classified as specified in Table 2.1.13.

Table 2.1.13 Grades of Steel Plates

Grade Thickness (mm)


RPV 24 6∼200
RPV 32, RPV 36, RPV 42,
6∼150
RPV 46, RPV 50

3. Heat treatment
(1) RPV 24 plate is to be as rolled. The plates, however, may be normalized as deemed necessary
by the Society.
(2) RPV 32 and RPV 36 plates are to be as rolled. The plates, however, may be normalized as
deemed necessary by the Society. But, they may be TM CP or quenched and tempered under the
approval by the Society.
(3) RPV 42 plate is to be TM CP . The plate, however, may be normalized or quenched and tem-
pered under the approval by the Society.
(4) RPV 46 and RPV 50 plates are to be quenched and tempered. But, they may be TM CP under
the approval by the Society.
4. Chemical composition
(1) The chemical composition of steel plates is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.14.
(2) Carbon equivalent(Ceq) and weld cold cracking susceptibility(Pcm) value of steel plates are to
comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.14-1.

Table 2.1.14 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition () Carbon equivalent ()


Grade
C Si Mn P S  ≤ 50(mm) 50 <  ≤ 75(mm)

 ≤100 mm 0.18 max.


RPV 24 0.35 max. 1.40 max. - -
 > 100 mm 0.20 max.

RPV 32 0.18 max. - -


0.55 max. 0.030 0.030
RPV 36 0.20 max. max. max. - -

RPV 42 1.60 max.


0.44 max. 0.46 max.
RPV 46 0.18 max. 0.75 max.
RPV 50 0.45 max. 0.47 max.
NOTE:
(1) Where deemed necessary, other elements than specified in Table 2.1.14 may be added. In that case, such
elements are to be stated in the test sheets.
(2) For RPV46 and RPV50 steel plates which not to be quenched and tempered, slight deviations in the chemical
composition may be allowed as approved by the Society.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 21


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.14-1 Carbon equivalent(Ceq) and Pcm value


Carbon equivalent (%) Pcm value (%)
Heat 50 <  75 <  100 <  125 <  50 <  75 <  100 < 
Grade ≤ 50 ≤ 50
treatment ≤ 75 ≤ 100 ≤125 ≤ 150 ≤ 75 ≤ 100 ≤ 150
(mm) (mm)
(mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm)
0.39 0.24 0.28
RPV 32 0.41 max. 0.43 max. 0.26 max.
max. max. max.
(1) 0.40 0.26 0.29
RPV 36 TMCP 0.42 max. 0.44 max. 0.27 max.
max. max. max.
0.43 0.27 0.28 0.29
RPV 42 0.45 max. - -
max. max. max. max.
0.44 0.46 0.49 0.52 0.54
RPV 46 Quenching max. max. max. max. max. 0.28
and 0.30 max.
(2) 0.45 0.47 0.50 0.53 0.55 max.
RPV 50 Tempering
max. max. max. max. max.
(Note)
(1) Carbon equivalent and Pcm value of RPV 32, RPV 36 and RPV 42 plates quenched and tempered are to be
as deemed appropriate by the Society.
(2) Carbon equivalent and Pcm value of RPV 46 and RPV 50 plates, which not to be quenched and tempered,
are to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steel plates are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.15.

Table 2.1.15 Mechanical Properties


Tensile test Impact test
 Absorbed
Yield strength (Nmm ) Tensile Elongation() Test Average
Grade energy of
Thickness of plate t (mm) strength Thickness of plate t (mm) temp. absorbed
 (5) individual test
 ≤ 50 50<≤100 100<≤200 (Nmm ) ≤16(2) 16<≤40(2) 40< (3) (℃) energy(J)
specimen(J)
RPV 24 235 min. 215 min. 195 min. 400∼510 17 min. 21 min. 24 min.
(1)
RPV 32 315 min. 290 min. 275 min. 490∼610 16 min. 20 min. 23 min. 0
(1)
RPV 36 355 min. 335 min. 315 min. 520∼640 14 min. 18 min. 21 min.
(1)
47 min. 27 min.
RPV 42 410 min. 390 min. 370 min. 550∼670 12 min. 16 min. 18 min.
(1) (4) (4)
RPV 46 450 min. 430 min. 410 min. 570∼700 19 min. 26 min. 20 min. -10
(1) (4) (4)
RPV 50 490 min. 470 min. 450 min. 610∼740 18 min. 25 min. 19 min.
NOTE:
(1) To be applied for the plates 150 mm or less in thickness
(2) To be tested with R1A test specimen.
(3) To be tested with R1A test specimen. When the capacity of the available testing machine does not permit test-
ing the full thickness specimen, R4 test specimen may be used.
(4) To be tested with R5 test specimen.
(5) Test temperature of RPV 32, RPV 36 and RPV 42 plates manufactured by TM CP is to be -20℃.

6. Selection of test samples


(1) For the steel plates which are not to be heat treated, one test sample is to be taken from each
plate as rolled directly from one slab or ingot.
(2) For the steel plates which are to be heat treated, one test sample is to be taken from every
similarly heat treated plate as rolled directly from one slab or ingot.

22 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(3) For steel plates to which stress relieving is required after welding or stress relieving is applied
by the purchaser, test samples are to be heat treated in accordance with the requirements in
302. 6 (3)
(4) The test samples are to be taken from the portion approximately 1/4 of the width from the side
end of the plate.
7. Selection of test specimen
(1) Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to (a) to (c) below.
(a) One test specimen is to be taken from one test sample.
(b) The test specimens are to be taken with thier longitudinal axis normal to the final direction
of rolling .
(c) The test specimens of bar type are to be taken from the portion approximately 1/4 of the
thickness from the surface.
(2) Impact test specimens is to be taken according to (a) to (c) below.
(a) A set of test specimens are to be taken from one test sample.
(b) The test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis parallel (L direction) to the
final direction of rolling. Where deemed necessary by the Society, however, they are to be
taken with their longitudinal axis normal (T direction) to the final direction of rolling.
(c) The test specimens are to be taken at a portion where the axis of the test specimen corre-
sponds to approximately 1/4 of the thickness from the surface.
8. Tolerance for thickness

Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are to be in accordance with the requirements in
301. 8. The minus tolerance for the nominal thickness of plates is to be 0.25 mm.
9. Retest procedures

Where the tensile test and impact tests from the first test specimen selected fails to meet the re-
quirements, additional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109.
10. Marking
(1) Steel plates which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark relating to heat treatment in addition to the requirements in 110.
(2) The marks relating to heat treatment in (1) are to be as specified in the following:
(a) Where the plates are normalized : N (e.g. : RPV 32N )
(b) Where the plates are quenched and tempered : QT (e.g. : RPV 46QT )
(c) Where the plates are heat treated in TM CP condition : TM (e.g. : RPV 36TM )
(d) Where only test specimens are normalized in the steel plate as rolled) : TN (e.g. : RPV
32TN )
(e) Where the test specimens are heat treated corresponding to the stress relieving to be applied
in the steel plate normalized : NSR (e.g. : RPV 32NSR )
11. Steel plates equivalent to standard
(1) The mild steel plates of grade RD and RE, the high tensile steels of rolled steels for hull speci-
fied in 301. are taken as equivalent to the plates specified in 303., in case where the test
specimens are taken as required in Pars 6 and 7 and test results comply with the requirements
in 301. In this case, "PV " is to be suffixed to the markings to indicate the kind of plates
specified in 301.
(2) Any requirements regarding heat treatment of steel plates specified in (1) is left to the dis-
cretion of the Society.

304. Rolled steels for low temperature service


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the rolled steels not exceeding 40 mm in thickness intended
for tanks and ship's hull structures adjacent to tanks of liquefied gas carriers, and other parts
such a hull structures of refrigerated cargo carrier which are exposed to low temperature

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 23


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(hereinafter referred to as "steels").


(2) Any requirement regarding the steels over 40 mm in thickness is left to the discretion of the
Society.
(3) The requirements other than those specified in 304. are applicable to the requirements in 301.
(4) The steels other than those specified in 304. are to comply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
Steels are classified as specified in Table 2.1.16.
Table 2.1.16 Grades and Chemical Composition
Chemical composition (%)
Grade Deoxidation
C Si Mn P S Ni
RL 235A
0.15 max. 0.15~0.30 0.70~1.50
RL 235B
RL 325A 0.035 max. 0.035 max. 0.8 max.
0.16 max. 0.15~0.50 0.80~1.60
RL 325B
RL 360 0.16 max. 0.15~0.50 0.80~1.60
Fully killed
RL 2N255 Aluminium 0.17 max. 2.10~2.50
RL 3N255 treated fine 0.15 max.
grain 0.70 max.
RL 3N275 0.17 max. 3.25~3.75
RL 3N440 0.15 max. 0.30 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max.
RL 5N590 0.13 max. 1.50 max. 4.75~6.00
RL 9N520 0.12 max.
0.90 max. 8.50~9.50
RL 9N590 0.12 max.

3. Heat treatment
The heat treatment of steels is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.17.
Table 2.1.17 Heat Treatment
grade Heat treatment
RL 235A

RL 235B Normalized or TM CP

RL 325A

RL 325B
Quenched and Tempered or TM CP
RL 360
RL 2N255
(1)
RL 3N255 Normalized or Quenched and Tempered
RL 3N275
RL 3N440
Quenched and Tempered(1)
RL 5N590
RL 9N520 Double normalized and tempered(1)
RL 9N590 Quenched and tempered(1)
NOTE:
(1) Heat treatment may be conducted according to TM CP, subject to the special approval by the Society.

24 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

4. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition


(1) The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of each grade are to comply with the re-
quirements given in Table 2.1.16. When deemed necessary, chemical elements other than
those given in the table may be added.
(2) When heat treatment has been conducted according to TM CP, the chemical composition of steels
specified in Table 2.1.16 may be modified subject to the approval by the Society.
5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steels are to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.17-1.
Where deemed necessary by the Society. other tests on notch toughness may be required
additionally.

Table 2.1.17-1 Mechanical properties


(5)(6)
Tensile test Impact

Yield Tensile Elongation() Average absorbed


grade Test
strength strength Thickness of plate  (mm) temp.(7) energy(J)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) 6<≤16
(2)
16<≤40(2) 40< (3)(4)
(℃)
 
RL 235A -40
235 min.(1) 400∼510 18 min. 22 min. 24 min.
RL 235B
-50
RL 325A
325 min. 440∼560 22 min. 30 min. 22 min.
RL 325B
-60
RL 360 360 min. 490∼610 20 min. 28 min. 20 min.
RL 2N255 -70
255 min. 450∼590 24 min. 29 min. 24 min. 41min. 27min.
RL 3N255
-101
RL 3N275 275 min. 480∼620 22 min. 26 min. 22 min.
RL 3N440 440 min. 540∼690 -110
RL 5N590 590 min. -130
21 min. 25 min. 21 min.
RL 9N520 520 min. 690∼830
-196
RL 9N590 590 min.
NOTES:
(1) Same or above 215 Nmm  when the thickness of plate is above 40 mm.
(2) To be tested with R5 test specimen. To be tested with R1A test specimen For RL 235A and RL 235B.
(3) To be tested with R4 test specimen.
(4) Above 20mm for Ni alloys.
(3) L (or T) indicates that the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is arranged parallel (or transverse) to the
final direction of rolling.
(4) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in value
than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is less
in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.
(5) Impact test temperature for steels specified in Pt 7, Ch 5 is to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.1.18.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 25


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.18 Impact Test Temperature of Steels Specified in Pt 7, Ch 5.

Grade Thickness  (mm) Test temp (℃)(1)


(2)
RL 235A  ≤ 25 -20 or (Td-5)
RL 235B 25 <  ≤ 30 -20 or (Td-10)
(2)

RL 325A (2)
RL 325B 30 <  ≤ 35 -20 or (Td-15)
RL 360 35 <  ≤ 40 (Td-20)
≤ 25 -70
(2)
25 <  ≤ 30 -70 or (Td-10)
RL 2N255 (2)
30 <  ≤ 35 -70 or (Td-15)
(2)
35 <  ≤ 40 -70 or (Td-20)
 ≤ 25 -95
(2)
RL 3N255 25 <  ≤ 30 -95 or (Td-10)
RL 3N275 30 <  ≤ 35 -95 or (Td-15)
(2)

(2)
35 < ≤ 40 -95 or (Td-20)
≤ 25 -110
(2)
RL 3N440 25 <  ≤ 30 -110 or (Td-10)
RL 5N590 30 <  ≤ 35 -110 or (Td-15) (2)

(2)
35 <  ≤ 40 -110 or (Td-20)
RL 9N520
≤ 40 -196
RL 9N590
NOTES:
(1) Td is the design temperature (℃).
(2) The test temperature is to be the lower of those specified above.

6. Selection of test sample


(1) For steel plates, one test sample is to be taken from each plate as rolled directly from one slab
or ingot.
(2) For test samples used in other steels than steel plates, steels not greater than 10 tonnes in mass
(having the same cross-sectional dimensions and being from the same cast manufactured by the
same process) are to be treated as one lot, and one test sample is to be taken from each lot.
(3) The requirements specified in 301. 6 (4) are to be applied to the selection of the test samples.
7. Selection of test specimens
(1) Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in 301. 7 (2).
(2) Impact test specimens are to be taken according to the following (a) and (b):
(a) The requirements specified in 301. 7 (3) are to apply.
(b) For steel plates, the test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis normal (T
direction) to the final direction of rolling; for other steels than steel plates, they are to be
taken with their longitudinal axis parallel (L direction) to the final direction of rolling.
8. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions
Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are to be in accordance with the requirements in
301. 8. The minus tolerance for the nominal thickness of plates is to be 0.25 mm.
9. Retest procedures
Where the tensile test and impact tests from the first test specimen selected fails to meet the re-
quirements, additional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109.

26 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

10. Marking
Steels which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the identi-
fication mark in accordance with the requirements in 110. For steels to which the requirements
given in Notes (1) of Table 2.1.17 and Notes (7) of Table 2.1.17-1 have been applied, "TM "
and impact test temperature "T " are to be suffixed to the markings. (e.g. RL 33TM - 50T )

305. Rolled stainless steels


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the rolled stainless steels (hereinafter referred to as "steels")
for tanks in low temperature service or corrosion-resisting service.
(2) Austenitic-ferritic stainless steel (hereinafter referred to as "duplex stainless steels") not exceeding
75 mm in thickness are to be as in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified
by the Society.
(3) The requirements other than those specified in 305. are applicable to the requirements in 301.
(4) Steels other than those specified in 305. are to comply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
Steels are classified as specified in Table 2.1.19.

Table 2.1.19 Grades and Chemical Composition of Stainless Steels

Chemical composition ()


Grade
C Si Mn P S Ni Cr Mo N O thers

RSTS 304 0.08 8.00~


max. 10.50
2.00 -
max.
RSTS 304L 0.030 9.00~ -
max. 13.00 18.00~
20.00
RSTS 304N1 7.00~ 0.10~0.25
0.08 1.00 2.50 10.50
max. max. max. 7.50~
RSTS 304N2 10.50 - 0.15~0.30 Nb≤0.15

RSTS 304LN 0.030 8.50~ 17.00~ 0.12~0.22


max. 11.50 19.00

RSTS 309S 12.00~ 22.00~


15.00 24.00
0.08 1.50 19.00~ 24.00~
RSTS 310S max. max. 22.00 26.00
-
RSTS 316 0.040 0.030 10.00~
max. max. 14.00

RSTS 316L 0.030 12.00~ 16.00~


max. 15.00 18.00 -
2.00 2.00~3.00
RSTS 316N 0.08 10.00~ 0.10~0.22
max. max. 14.00

RSTS 316LN 0.030 10.50~ 16.50~ 0.12~0.22


max. 1.00 14.50 18.50
max.
RSTS 317 0.08
max. -
11.00~ 18.00~ 3.00~4.00
RSTS 317L 15.00 20.00
0.030
RSTS 317LN max. 0.10~0.20
RSTS 321 Ti≥5×C
0.08 9.00~ 17.00~ - -
max. 13.00 19.00
RSTS 347 Nb≥10×C

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 27


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

3. Heat treatment
The steels are generally to receive a solid solution treatment.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of steels is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.19.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steels are to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.20.

Table 2.1.20 Mechanical Properties of Stainless Steels

Tensile Hardness test


Grade Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation() Brinell Rock well Vickers
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
) HB HRB HV

RSTS 304 205 min. 520 min.


40 min. 187 max. 90 max. 200 max.
RSTS 304L 175 min. 480 min.
RSTS 304N1 275 min. 550 min. 217 max. 95 max. 220 max.
35 min.
RSTS 304N2 345 min. 690 min. 248 max. 100 max. 260 max.

RSTS 304LN 245 min. 550 min. 217 max. 95 max. 220 max.
RSTS 309S

RSTS 310S 205 min. 520 min. 40 min.


187 max. 90 max. 200 max.
RSTS 316
RSTS 316L 175 min. 480 min.

RSTS 316N 275 min. 35 min.


550 min. 217 max. 95 max. 220 max.
RSTS 316LN 245 min.

RSTS 317 205 min. 520 min.


187 max. 90 max. 200 max.
RSTS 317L 175 min. 480 min.
40 min.
RSTS 317LN 245 min. 550 min. 217 max. 95 max. 220 max.

RSTS 321
205 min. 520 min. 187 max. 90 max. 200 max.
RSTS 347

(2) The results of hardness test, according to the test method, are to comply with the requirements
given in Table 2.1.20.
(3) Other tests on notch toughness or corrosion resistance may be required, where deemed necessary
by the Society.
6. Selection of test samples
(1) One test sample is to be taken from every similarly heat treated plate as rolled directly from
one slab or ingot.
(2) The requirements provided in 301. 6 (4) are to be applied to the selection of the test samples.
7. Selection of test specimens
(1) Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in 301. 7 (2).
(2) The hardness test specimen may be a portion of tensile test specimen.
8. Tolerance for thickness
Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are to be in accordance with the requirements in
301. 8. The minus tolerance for the nominal thickness of plates is to be 0.25 mm.

28 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

9. Marking
Steels which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with identi-
fication mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.
10. Forming
The cold deformation limit of the rolled stainless steels is to be in accordance with the Guidance
specially specified by the Society.

306. Round bars for chain


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the rolled round bars (hereinafter referred to as "Chain
bars") for chain specified in Pt 4, Ch 8, Sec 4.
(2) Chain bars for manufacture of offshore mooring chain are to be in accordance with the
Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(3) The requirements other than those specified in 306. are applicable to the requirements in 301.
(4) Chain bars having characteristics differing from those specified in 306. are to comply with the
requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The chain bars are classified as specified in Table 2.1.21.

Table 2.1.21 Grades of Chain Bars

Grade Application used for


Un-studded chain
Grade 1 chain bar RSBC 31
Grade 1 chain
Ship's stud link anchor
Grade 2 chain bar RSBC 50 Grade 2 chain chain cables and accessories

Grade 3 chain bar RSBC 70 Grade 3 chain

3. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition


The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of each grade are to comply with the require-
ments given in Table 2.1.22. Elements other than specified in Table 2.1.22 may be added sub-
ject to a special approval by the Society.

Table 2.1.22 Deoxidation Practice and Chemical Composition (  )

Grade Deoxidation C Si Mn P S Al (1)


RSBC 31 Killed 0.20 max. 0.15~0.35 0.40 min. 0.040 max. 0.040 max. -
(2)
RSBC 50 Fine-grained 0.24 max. 0.15~0.55 1.60 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. 0.020 min.
RSBC 70 (2) killed 0.36 max. 0.15~0.55 1.00~1.90 0.035 max. 0.035 max. 0.020 min.
NOTE:
(1) Al content is to be represented by the total Al content and may be replaced partly by other fine grain-
ing elements.
(2) If the Society agrees, additional alloying elements may be added.

4. Heat treatment
Chain bars are to be as rolled condition.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 29


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of chain bars are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.23.

Table 2.1.23 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test Impact test(1)(2)

Grade Tensile Average


Yield strength Elongation(%) Reduction of area Test temp
strength absorbed
(Nmm  )(3) (   ) (%) (℃)
(Nmm  )(3) energy (J)
RSBC 31 - 370~490(6) 25 min. - - -
RSBC 50 295 min. 490~690 22 min. - 0 27 min.(2)
RSBC 70 410 min. 690 min. 17 min. 40 min. 0(4) 60 min.(4)
NOTES:
(1) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in val-
ue than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is
less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.
(2) For RSBC 50 which will be heat treated according to Pt 4, Ch 8, 405., no impact testing is required.
(3) Impact test of RSBC 70 may be carried out at the temperature of -20℃ where approved by the Society.
In this case, minimum mean absorbed energy is to be not less than 35 J.
(4) Lower limit of tensile strength of RSBC 31 may be 300 Nmm  with the approval of the Society.

6. Selection of test sample


(1) Chain bars not greater than 50 tonnes in weight (from the same cast manufactured by the same
process) are to be treated as one lot, and one test sample largest in diameter is to be taken
from each lot.
(2) Test sample mentioned in above (1), prior to sampling, must be subjected to the heat treatment
provided for the finished chain cable. Details of the heat treatment must be indicated by the
chain cable manufacturer. In case of no indication, heat treatment of the test sample is to com-
ply with the requirements given in Pt.4, Sec.8 406. for each grade.
7. Selection of test specimens
(1) Test specimens are to be taken in accordance with the Table 2.1.24

Table 2.1.24 Number of test specimens


Grade Number of tensile test specimens Number of impact test specimens
RSBC 31 1 piece -
RSBC 50 1 piece 1 set (3 piece)(1)
RSBC 70 1 piece 1 set (3 piece)
NOTES:
(1) In case where note (2) of Table 2.1.23 is applied, no impact test specimen need to be taken.

(2) The test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis parallel to the final direction of
rolling.
(3) The tensile and impact test specimens are to be taken from the test sample in the longitudinal
direction at a depth of 1/6 diameter from the surface or as close as possible to this position.
(See Fig 2.1.5)

30 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Fig 2.1.5 Selection of test specimens

(4) The longitudinal axis of the notch is to correspond approximately to the radial direction of each
test specimen.
8. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions
(1) Surface inspection for all grades is to be carried out and it is to be confimed that there are no
harmful defects.
(2) The diameter and roundness of all grades of chain bars are to be within the tolerances specified
in Table 2.1.25.

Table 2.1.25 Dimensional tolerance

(1)
Tolerance on roundness
Nominal Diameter (mm) Tolerance on diameter (mm) (d  - d  ) (mm) (2)
less than 25 -0, +1.0 0.6 max.
25 ~ 35 -0, +1.2 0.8 max.
36 ~ 50 -0, +1.6 1.1 max.
51 ~ 80 -0, +2.0 1.50 max.
81 ~ 100 -0, +2.6 1.95 max.
101 ~ 120 -0, +3.0 2.25 max.
121 ~ 160 -0, +4.0 3.00 max.
NOTES:
(1) For nominal diameter of bar materials which have more than 161 mm, dimensional tolerances are to be
as deemed appropriate by the Society.
(2) d  and d  mean the maximum and minimum diameter of a round bar.

9. Retest procedures
(1) Where the tensile test and impact tests from the first test specimen selected fails to meet the
requirements, additional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109.
(2) If failure to pass the tensile test or impact test is definitely attributable to improper heat treat-
ment of the test sample, a new test sample may be taken from the same piece and reheat
treated. The complete test (both tensile and impact test) is to be repeated; and the original re-
sults obtained may be disregarded.
10. Marking
Chain bars which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with identi-
fication marks in accordance with the requirements in 110.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 31


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

307. Rolled steel bars for boiler


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to hot rolled steel bars intended to be used for the stay bolts
for boilers (hereinafter referred to as "steel bars").
(2) The steel bars having characteristics differing from those specified in 307. are to comply with
the requirements of 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The steel bars are classified as specified in Table 2.1.26.

Table 2.1.26 Grades and Chemical Composition

Chemical composition ()


Grade
C S P
RSB 42 0.30 max.
0.04 max. 0.05 max.
RSB 46 0.33 max.

3. Heat treatment
The heat treatment of steel bars is to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of steel bars is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.26.
5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steel bars are to comply with the following requirements.
(1) The tensile test of steel bars is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.27.
(2) The bend test specimen is to stand being bent cold through 180 degrees without cracking on
the outside of the bent portion to an inside redius given in Table 2.1.28.

Table 2.1.27 Mechanical Properties Table 2.1.28 Bend Test

Yield Tensile Ratio of inside radius of bend to


Elongation()
Grade strength strength Dia. of bar
(   ) diameter of test specimen
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (mm)
RSB 42 225 min. 410~490 24 min. RSB 42 RSB 46


RSB 46 245 min. 450~540 22 min. ≤25  1
NOTE:
25< ≤50 1 
The required value of yield strength for the 
steel bars exceeding 100 mm in diameter 
50< ≤75
may be taken as 205 Nmm  for RSB 42 

and 225 Nmm  for RSB 46, regardless of  
75<  
the above requirements. 

6. Selection of test samples


For the test samples of steel bars, steel bars which belong to the same cast manufactured by the
same process and where the amount of scatter is to be less than 10 mm in diameter, are to be
treated as one lot, and test samples are to be taken from each lot accord ing to the mass of the
lot and to the requirements provided in Table 2.1.29.

32 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

7. Selection of test specimens


(1) Each one piece of tensile and bend test specimen is to be taken from one test sample.
(2) Test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis parallel to the final direction of
rolling.
(3) Tensile test specimens are to be taken from the sample in the longitudinal direction at a depth
of 1/6 diameter from the surface or as close as possible to this position. (See Fig 2.1.5)
8. Tolerance for diameter
The tolerance for diameter of the steel bars is to comply with the requirements in Table 2.1.30.
9. Marking
Steel bars which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

Table 2.1.29 Number of Test Samples Table 2.1.30 Tolerance for Diameter

Weight of group (ton) Number of test samples


Diameter of bar (mm) Tolerance
25 and under 1 each
 < 16 ± 0.4 mm
Over 25 up to 30 2 each

2 each plus 1 each for each 16 ≤  < 28 ± 0.5 mm


Over 30 10 tons of excess or fraction
thereof 28 ≤  ± 1.8 

308. High Strength Quenched and Tempered Steels for Welded Structures
1. Application
(1) The requirements given in 308. are to apply to weldable high strength quenched and tempered
steel plates and wide flats not exceeding 70 mm in thickness intended for mobile offshore units,
tanks of liquefied gas carriers and process pressure vessels (hereinafter referred to as "steels")
(2) Any requirements regarding the steels over 70 mm in thickness are left to the discretion of the
Society.
(3) Product forms other than plates and wide flats, such as section and tubulars, may be provided
to the requirements given in 308. when specially agreed to by the Society.
(4) Steels for hull structures should be in accordance with the Guidance specified by the Society.
(5) The requirements other than those specified in 308. are applicable to the requirements in 301.
(6) Steels having characteristics differing from those specified in 308. are to comply with the re-
quirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
Steels are classified as specified in Table 2.1.31.
3. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
(1) The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of steels are to comply with the require-
ments given in Table 2.1.32. Where deemed necessary, other elements than specified in Table
2.1.32 may be added.
(2) Where heat treatment has been conducted according to TMCP, the requirements given in Table
2.1.32 may be modified subject to the special approval by the Society.
(3) The cold cracking susceptibility(Pcm) for evaluating weldability should be in accordance with
the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society. The maximum Pcm to be achieved
is to be agreed with the Society and included in the approved specification.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 33


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.31 Grade of Steels

Kind Grade

AH 43, DH 43, EH 43, FH 43

AH 47, DH 47, EH 47, FH 47

Weldable high strength AH 51, DH 51, EH 51, FH 51


quenched and tempered steel AH 56, DH 56, EH 56, FH 56

AH 63, DH 63, EH 63, FH 63

AH 70, DH 70, EH 70, FH 70

4. Heat treatment
The steels shall be in the quenched and tempered condition. Special consideration may be given to
the supply of those steels in thicknesses up to 50 mm in the TMCP condition subject to approval
of the Society.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steels are to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.33.
(2) In the case of other product forms where longitudinal tests are agreed, the elongation values are
to be 2 percentage units above those listed in Table 2.1.33.
(3) Where deemed necessary by the Society, other test on notch-toughness and weldability may be
required in addition to the tests specified in Table 2.1.33.
6. Selection of test samples
(1) One test sample is to be taken from every similarly heat treated plate as rolled directly from
one slab or ingot.
(2) The requirements specified in 301. 6 (4) are to be applied to the selection of the test samples.
7. Selection of test specimens
(1) Tensile test specimens are to comply with the requirements shown in (a) to (c) below:
(a) Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in 301. 7 (2).
(b) Normally flat tensile test specimens are to be prepared in such a manner as to maintain the
rolling scale at least at one side.
(c) Where the thickness exceeds 40 mm, full thickness specimens may be prepared but when in-
stead a machined round tensile test specimen is used then the axis must be located at a po-
sition lying at a distance of t/4 from the surface or as near as possible to this position.
(2) Impact test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in 304. 7 (2).
8. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions
(1) Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are the responsibility of the steel manufacturer
and the minus tolerance in the nominal thickness of plates is to be 0.25 mm. For steels except
steel plates, any requirement regarding the minus tolerance is left to the discretion of the
Society.
(2) If required by the Society the manufacturer is to perform ultrasonic examinations in accordance
with an approved standard.
(3) If required by the Society, through thickness tensile tests are to be performed in accordance
with requirements specified in 310.
9. Retest procedures
(1) Where the tensile test from the first test specimen selected fails to meet the requirements, addi-
tional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109. 1.
(2) Regarding the impact tests, additional tests are to be carried out according to the requirements
given in 109. 2.
(3) For other product forms the impact tests are to be in the longitudinal direction, the results of
the tests are to comply with the appropriate requirements of Table 2.1.33
(4) Normally sub-surface test specimens will be taken, however, for material with a thickness in

34 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

excess of 40mm, impact tests should be taken at the quarter thickness (t/4) location.
10. Marking
Steels which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the identi-
fication mark in accordance with the requirements in 110. For steels to which the requirements
given in Note (4) of Table 2.1.33 have been applied, the "impact test temperature T" are to be
suffixed to the marking. (e.g. DH 63-25T)

Table 2.1.32 Deoxidation Practice and Chemical Composition (%)

De-
Grade oxidation C Si Mn P S Cu Cr Mo V B N
practice

AH 43 0.21 max. 1.70 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max.

DH 43 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

EH 43 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

FH 43 0.18 max. 1.60 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max.

AH 47 0.21 max. 1.70 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max.

DH 47 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

EH 47 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

FH 47 0.18 max. 1.60 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max.


- - - - -
AH 51 0.21 max. 1.70 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max.

DH 51 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

EH 51 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.


Fully
FH 51 killed 0.18 max. 0.55 1.60 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max. 0.020
AH 56 fine 0.21 max. max. 1.70 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. max.
grain
DH 56 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

EH 56 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

FH 56 0.18 max. 1.60 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max.

AH 63 0.21 max. 1.70 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max.


1.00
DH 63 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.
max.
EH 63 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

FH 63 0.18 max. 1.60 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max. 0.50 0.60 0.10 0.006
AH 70 0.21 max. 1.70 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. max. max. max. max.

1.20
DH 70 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.
max.
EH 70 0.20 max. 1.70 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max.

FH 70 0.18 max. 1.60 max. 0.025 max. 0.025 max.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 35


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.33 Heat Treatment and Mechanical Properties


(2)(3)
Tensile test Impact test
Heat Yield Tensile (5) (4) Average absorbed
Grade Elongation () Test temp.
treatment strength strength energy(J)

(    ) (℃)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) L T
AH 43 0
DH 43 -20
420 min. 530~680 18 min. 42 min. 28 min.
EH 43 -40
FH 43 -60
AH 47 0
DH 47 -20
460 min. 570~720 17 min. 46 min. 31 min.
EH 47 -40
FH 47 -60
AH 51 0
DH 51 -20
500 min. 610~770 16 min. 50 min. 33 min.
EH 51 -40
FH 51 Quenched -60
and
AH 56 tempered(1) 0
DH 56 -20
550 min. 670~830 16 min. 55 min. 37 min.
EH 56 -40
FH 56 -60
AH 63 0
DH 63 -20
620 min. 720~890 15 min. 62 min. 41 min.
EH 63 -40
FH 63 -60
AH 70 0
DH 70 -20
690 min. 770~940 14 min. 69 min. 46 min.
EH 70 -40
FH 70 -60
NOTES:
(1) Heat treatment may be conducted according to TMCP, instead of quenching and tempering, subject to
the special approval by the Society.
(2) L (or T) denotes that the longitudinal axis of each test specimen is parallel (or normal) to the final di-
rection of rolling.
(3) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in val-
ue than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is
less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.
(4) Impact test temperature for steels specified in Pt 7, Ch 5 are given in Table 2.1.34.
(5) The minimum elongation for R1B test specimen (L=200mm) is to be in compliance with the require-
ments given in the Table below.

Thickness (mm)
Grade
≤10 10<≤15 15<≤20 20<≤25 25<≤40 40<≤50 50<≤70
AH 43, DH 43, EH 43, FH 43 11 13 14 15 16 17 18
AH 47, DH 47, EH 47, FH 47 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
AH 51, DH 51, EH 51, FH 51 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
AH 56, DH 56, EH 56, FH 56 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
AH 63, DH 63, EH 63, FH 63 9 11 12 12 13 14 15
AH 70, DH 70, EH 70, EH 70 9 10 11 11 12 13 14

36 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.34 Impact Test Temperature for Steels specified in Pt 7, Ch 5


Impact test
Thickness 
Grade Average absorbed energy (  )
(mm) Test temp (℃)
L T
 ≤ 20 0
AH 43, DH 43, AH 47, DH 47 20 <  ≤ 40 -20 41 27
AH 51, DH 51, AH 56, DH 56
AH 63, DH 63, AH 70, DH 70 40 < ≤ 50 -30
(1)
50 < 
NOTE: (1) Temperature is to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.

309. Stainless clad steel plates


1. Application
(1) The requirements in 309. are to apply to the stainless clad steels not exceeding 50 mm in
thickness intended for tanks of ships carrying dangerous chemicals in bulk, tank circumference
hull construction units and corrosion-resisting tanks (hereinafter referred to as "steel plates").
(2) The requirements other than those specified in 309. are to be in accordance with the require-
ments in 301.
(3) Steel plates over 50 mm in thickness and having characteristics differing from those specified in
309. are to comply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Process of manufacture
(1) Manufacture of steel plates is to comply with the processes shown in (a) to (e) below:
(a) Rolling
(b) Explosive pressing
(c) Overlay rolling
(d) Cast rolling
(e) Explosive rolling
(2) Application of any other process of manufacture than those specified in (1) is left to the dis-
cretion of the Society.
3. Structural metals
(1) Base and clad materials for steel plates are to be mild steel plates of rolled steels for hull
specified in 301. and steel plates of rolled stainless steels specified in 305., respectively. In
case of overlay rolling or cast rolling, clad materials are to comply with the specified chemical
composition of welding materials or stainless steel casting applied as a clad.
(2) The material grade marks are to be signified by a combination of base metal and clad material.
(ex. A + RSTS 316)
4. Heat treatment
The steel plates are to comply with the requirements for heat treatment of the base metal.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel plates are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.35.
(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society according to the use of steel plates, tests on corrosion
resistance may be required.
6. Selection of test samples
(1) One test sample is to be taken from each steel plate, being from the same manufacturing proc-
ess, which belong to the plate as rolled from a slab or ingot of a certain base metal. In case
of overlay rolling, a separate test sample which is applied the same condition of manufacturing
process can be made.
(2) The requirements specified in 301. 6 (4) are to be applied to the selection of the test samples.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 37


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.35 Mechanical Properties


(1)
Tensile test Shearing strength test(3)
Grade Yield strength Tensile strength Shearing strength Impact test
Elongation ()
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
A
To be complied To be complied
B (2)
235 min.  min. with requirement 200 min. with requirement
D
for base metal for base metal
E
NOTES:
(1) The tensile test specimen is to be R1B test specimen (L=200mm)
(2)  is to be obtained from the following formula:

  
  
  

where:
σ  = Tensile strength of steel plates (Nmm  )
σ  = Specified minimum tensile strength of base metal (Nmm  )
σ  = Specified minimum tensile strength of clad material (Nmm  )
t  = Thickness of base metal (mm)
t  = Thickness of clad material (mm)
(3) Any requirement for the procedure of shear strength test is left to the discretion of the Society. In
case of overlay rolling, shear strength test may be omitted.

7. Selection of test specimens


(1) Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in 301. 7 (2).
(2) Impact test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in 301. 7 (3).
In this case, the thickness of the test specimens is to agree with that of the base metal from
which the clad material has been removed.

(3) Shearing strength test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements specified in the
following (a) to (b):
(a) One test specimen is to be taken from one test sample.
(b) The size and dimensions of the test specimens, are to be determined according to Fig
2.1.6.

Fig 2.1.6 Size and Dimensions of Shearing Test Specimens (unit: mm)

38 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

8. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions


The minus tolerance for the nominal thickness of plates is left to the discretion of the Society.
9 Quality and repair of defects
(1) Each steel plate is to be subjected to ultrasonic testing. Any requirement for the test procedure
is left to the discretion of the Society.
(2) Each cladding defects does not exceed 50 mm in length and 20 ㎠ in area. All defect areas do
not exceed 1.5 % of the total surface in question.
(3) Any cladding defects over the length and area of (2) may be repaired by welding in accordance
with the requirements given in 301. 9 (3)
10. Marking
(1) The test certificates are to comply with the requirements given in 107. and are to contain the
particulars as to the process of manufacture of steel plates and the thickness of the clad
material.
(2) Steel plates which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be suffixed with
the following marks relating to the process of manufacture of the steel plates, in addition to the
marks showing the kinds of the base and clad materials. (e.g. A + RSTS 316 - R )

Rolling : [-R ]
Cast rolling : [-ER ]
Explosive pressing : [-B ]
Explosive rolling : [-BR ]
Overlay rolling : [-W R ]

310. Additional requirements for through thickness properties


1. Application
(1) The requirements in 310. are to apply to hull structural rolled steels and weldable high strength
quenched and tempered steel plates and wide flats with thickness of 15 mm and over which is
required improved through thickness properties to minimise the possibility of lamellar tearing
during fabrication.
(2) The requirements are applicable to the other steels than the material specified in (2) above,
where deemed appropriate by the Society.
2. Through thickness properties
The through thickness properties of steels are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.36 as the result of tensile tests whose specimens are taken in the through thickness direction of
the product.

Table 2.1.36 Through thickness properties

Reduction of area acceptance values(1)


Grade Application
Minimum average(%) Minimum individual(%)
Z25 normal use 25 15
Z35 severe service condition 35 25
Note
(1) The minimum average value for the reduction of area of at least 3 tensile test specimens taken
in the through thickness direction must be that shown for the appropriate grade given in Table.
Only one individual value may be below the minimum average but not less than minimum in-
dividual value shown for the appropriate grade.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 39


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

3. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition


In addition to the requirements of the appropriate steel specification given in 301. or 308., the
maximum sulphur content is to be 0.008% determined by the ladle analysis.
4. Selection of test specimens
(1) For steel, of same thickness, belonging to the same charge and same heat treatment condition,
one test sample is to be taken from each lot specified in Table 2.1.37.

Table 2.1.37 Batch size dependent on product and sulphur content

Product S>0.005% S≤0.005%


Plates <P> <50>
Wide flats of normal thickness ≤25mm <10> <50>
Wide flats of normal thickness >25mm <20> <50>
Note
(1) In the Table, <50>, <20> and <10> each indicate that steels not greater than 50, 20 and 10 tones are
to be taken as one lot; <P> indicates that steel rolled directly from one slab or steel ingot is to be
taken as one lot. The term "piece" is understood to mean the rolled product from a single slab or
ingot if this is rolled directly into plates, sections or bars.

(2) The test samples are to be taken from one end (top of ingot when applicable) of the portion
corresponding to the middle of the plates or flat bars as shown in Fig 2.1.7.

Fig 2.1.7 Selection of Test Samples

5. Selection of test specimens


(1) Three round tensile test specimens are to be taken from one test sample in the through thick-
ness direction.
(2) The test specimens are to be taken according to the requirements for dimensions provided in
Table 2.1.38.

Table 2.1.38 Dimensions of Specimen


Product thickness Diameter of test specimen Parallel length
 (mm)  (mm)  (mm)
15 ≤  ≤ 25  = 6  ≥ 2
 > 25  = 10  ≥ 2

40 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(3) Where the product thickness does not allow to prepare specimens of sufficient length suitable
for the gripping jaws of the testing machine, the ends of the specimens may be built up by
suitable welding methods. The welding is not to impair the portion of the specimen within the
parallel length.
6. Retest procedure
(1) Acceptance, rejection and retest criteria for the through thickness properties of steels are to
comply with the requirements given in Fig 2.1.8

Fig 2.1.8 Acceptance, rejection and retest criteria for the


through thickness properties of steels

(2) Fig 2.1.8 shows the three cases where a retest situation is permitted. In these instances three
more tensile tests are to be taken from the remaining test sample or remaining steel plates of
same piece. The average of all 6 tensile tests is to be greater than the required minimum aver-
age with no greater than two results below the minimum average.
(3) In the case of failure after retest, either the lot represented by the piece is rejected or each
piece within the lot is required to be tested.
(4) The test is considered invalid and further replacement test is required if the fracture occurs in
the weld or heat affected zone.
7. Ultrasonic tests
(1) Ultrasonic testing should be carried out on each piece in the final supply condition.
(2) Any requirement for the test procedure and acceptance criteria are left to the discretion of the Society.
However, the probe frequency is to be of 4MHz in general.

8. Marking

Steels which have satisfactorily complied with the requirements specified in 310. are to have the
notation Z25 or Z35 after the material grade mark. (e.g. EH 36 Z 25, EH 36 Z 35 )

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 41


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 4 Steel Tubes and Pipes

401. Steel tubes for boilers and heat exchangers


1. Application
(1) The requirements are mainly to apply to steel tubes intended for heat transfer at inside or out-
side of the tubes; for example, smoke tubes, water tubes, stay tubes, superheater tubes of boil-
ers, other tubes for high temperature heat exchangers, etc. (hereinafter referred to as "steel
tubes").
(2) Steel tubes other than those specified in (1) are to comply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds

The steel tubes are classified as specified in Table 2.1.39.

Table 2.1.39 Kinds


Description Grade
Carbon steel tubes for RSTH 35 RSTH 42
boilers and heat exchangers RSTH 52
Alloy steel tubes for RSTH 12 RSTH 22
boilers and heat exchangers RSTH 23 RSTH 24

3. Heat treatment

The heat treatment of steel tubes is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.40.

Table 2.1.40 Heat treatment

Seamless steel tube Electric-resistance welded steel tube


Grade
Hot working Cold working As weld Hot working Cold working
RSTH 35 Low temperature an- As drawn
As drawn nealed, Normalized or Normalized Low temperature an- (1)
RSTH 42 full annealed Normalized
nealed

RSTH 52 Normalized
Low temperature annealed, Isothermal annealed, Full annealed,
RSTH 12
Normalized or Normalized and tempered(2)
Low temperature annealed , Isothermal annealed,
RSTH 22
Full annealed or Normalized and tempered(2)
Isothermal annealed, Full annealed or
RSTH 23
Normalized and tempered at 650℃ -
RSTH 24
and over
NOTES
(1) Steel tubes which are normalized prior to cold working may be finished by annealing
(2) Low temperature annealing is not to be applied to electric resistance welded steel tube

4. Chemical composition

The chemical composition of steel tubes is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.41.

42 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.41 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C Si Mn P S Cr Mo
RSTH 35 0.18 max. 0.30~0.60
RSTH 42 0.32 max. 0.10~0.35 0.30~0.80 -
-
RSTH 52 0.25 max. 1.00~1.50 0.035 max. 0.035 max.
RSTH 12 0.10~0.20 0.10~0.50 0.30~0.80
RSTH 22 0.50 max. 0.80~1.25 0.45~0.65
RSTH 23 0.15 max. 0.50~1.00 0.30~0.60 1.00~1.50
0.030 max. 0.030 max.
RSTH 24 0.50 max. 1.90~2.60 0.87~1.13
NOTE:
In case where approved by the Society, RSTH 35 and RSTH 42 may be the killed steel of below
0.10 % Si.

5. Mechanical properties

The mechanical properties of steel tubes are to comply with the following requirements.
(1) Tensile test : The tensile test of steel tubes is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.42.

Table 2.1.42 Mechanical Properties


Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation ( %)
Grade
( N/mm 2) ( N/mm 2) ( L=5.65 A)
RSTH 35 175 min. 340 min. 26 (22) min.
RSTH 42 255 min. 410 min.
RSTH 52 295 min. 510 min.
RSTH 12 380 min. 21 (17) min.
RSTH 22 205 min.
RSTH 23 410 min.
RSTH 24
NOTES:
1. The values of elongation in parenthesis are applicable to the test specimens taken transversely.
In this case, the sampling material is to be heated 600℃ to 650℃ after flattened and annealed
in order to make it free from strain.
2. In case where test specimen of non-tubular section is taken from an electric-resistance welded
steel tube, the test specimen is to be taken from the parts that do not include the welded line.

(2) Flattening test : A tubular section which is taken from the end of the steel tube is to stand be-
ing flattened cold between parallel plates, without cracking or showing flaw, until the distance
between the plates becomes less than the value of H calculated by the following formula. In
this case, the length L of steel tube is to be not less than 50 mm, however, not more than 100
mm. For electric-resistance welded steel tubes, however, the welded line is to be placed at
right angle to the direction of the applied force as shown in Fig 2.1.9 (a) For tubes, however,
of 15 % of outside diameter and over in thickness, C-type test specimen may be used, having a
part of its circumference discarded as shown in Fig 2.1.9 (b)

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 43


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

   
 



where:
 = Distance between flattening plates (mm).
 = Thickness of steel tube (mm).
 = Outside diameter of steel tube (mm).
 = Constant given in Table 2.1.43 which varies according to the grade of steel tubes.

Fig 2.1.9 Flattening test

Table 2.1.43 Value of 

Grade Value of 
RSTH 35 0.09
RSTH 42, RSTH 12, RSTH 22, RSTH 23, RSTH 24 0.08
RSTH 52 0.07

(3) Flaring test : A section of steel tube which is taken from its end is to stand being flared cold
with a tool having an included angle of 60 degrees, until the steel tube at the mouth of the
flare is expanded without cracking or showing flaw to the diameter shown in Table 2.1.44.
The rate of penetration of the mandrel shall not exceed 50 mm/min. In this case, the length of
test specimen is to be 1.5 D , however, not less than 50 mm.

Table 2.1.44 Outside Diameter of Steel Tube End after Flaring

Grade Outside diameter of steel tube end


RSTH 35, RSTH 42, RSTH 52 1.2 times the outside diameter of steel tube
RSTH 12, RSTH 22, RSTH 23, RSTH 24 1.14 times the outside diameter of steel tube

(4) Reverse flattening test : A section of steel tube of 100 mm in length which is taken from the
steel tube is to be slotted longitudinally on the opposite side of the welded line, opened and
flattened without cracking or showing flaw on the inside of the welded line. There is also to
be no misalignment, lack of penetration and overlap. But, this test is applied for electric-resist-
ance welded steel tubes only.
(5) Hydraulic test :
(a) Steel tubes are to be hydraulically tested to a satisfactory result by 2 times and over the
maximum working pressure at the mill. But the minimum test pressure is to be 7 M Pa .
(b) The test pressure prescribed in (a) need not exceed the pressure calculated by the following
formula:

44 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1


   

where:
 = Thickness of steel tube (mm)
 = Outside diameter of steel tube (mm)
 = 60  of the prescribed minimum yield strength ( Nmm  )
(c) Where each steel tube is hydraulically tested as a regular procedure during the process of
manufacturing at the mill, which makes a number of steel tubes continually, and the results
are forwarded to the Surveyor, the test in the presence of the Surveyor may be dispensed
with.
(d) A non-destructive inspection deemed appropriate by the Society may be substituted for the
hydraulic test specified in (a).
6. Selection of test specimen
The test specimens are to be taken in accordance with the following requirements, from each grade
and each size which has been heat treated at the same time in the same heating furnace for
heat-treated tubes and from each grade and each size for non-heat-treated steel tubes respectively.
(1) Seamless steel tubes
One sampling steel tube is to be selected from each lot of 50 tubes or fraction thereof and
each one specimen for tensile test, flattening test and flaring test is to be taken from each sam-
pling steel tube.
(2) Electric-resistance welded steel tubes
For electric-resistance welded steel tubes, in addition to the requirements in (1), one sampling
steel tube is to be selected from each lot of 100 tubes or fraction thereof, and one reverse flat-
tening test specimen is to be taken from each of the sampling steel tubes.
7. Tolerance for dimensions
The tolerances for the outside diameter and thickness are to comply with the requirements in Table
2.1.45. and Table 2.1.46. respectively.

Table 2.1.45 Tolerance for Outside Diameter of steel Tubes


Tolerance for Outside Diameter (mm)
Outside diameter
of steel tube  Seamless steel tube Electric-resistance welded steel tube
(mm)
Hot finished Cold working Other than cold working Cold working
 <25 ± 0.10 ± 0.15 ± 0.10
25≤  <40 ± 0.15 ± 0.20 ± 0.15
40≤  <50 ± 0.20 ± 0.25 ± 0.20
+ 0.4
50≤  <60 - 0.8 ± 0.25 ± 0.30 ± 0.25
60≤  <80 ± 0.30 ± 0.40 ± 0.30
+ 0.40
80≤  <100 ± 0.40 ± 0.40
- 0.60
+ 0.40 + 0.40 + 0.40
100≤  <120
+ 0.4 - 0.60 - 0.80 - 0.60
- 1.2 + 0.40 + 0.40 + 0.40
120≤  <160
- 0.80 - 1.00 - 0.80
+ 0.4 + 0.40 + 0.40 + 0.40
160≤  <200
- 1.6 - 1.20 - 1.20 - 1.20
+ 0.4 + 0.40 + 0.40 + 0.40
200≤ 
- 1.8 - 1.60 - 1.60 - 1.60

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 45


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.46 Tolerance for thickness


Thickness t (mm)
Kind <2 2≤ <2.4 2.4≤ <3.8 3.8≤ <4.6 4.6≤ 
Outside
diameter D (mm)
+40 %
Hot finished seamless  < 100 +35 % +33 % +28 %
- 0%
steel tube 0% 0% 0%
 ≥ 100 -
Cold drawn seamless +0.4mm +22 %
 < 40
steel tube and 0 mm 0%
Electric-resistance welded
steel tube of cold  ≥ 40 +22 %, 0%
working
Electric-resistance welded +0.3mm +18 %
 < 40
steel tube of other than 0 mm 0%
cold working  ≥ 40 +18 %, 0%
NOTE:
For hot finished seamless steel tubes. the tolerance for deviation in wall thickness is to be 22.8 % and under
of the thickness of the steel tube. But, for steel tubes of less than 5.6 mm in thickness, this note is not
applied.

8. Quality
(1) Each steel tubes are hydraulically or non-destructively tested as a regular procedure during the
process of manufacturing at the mill and are free from leakages or harmful defects.
(2) The steel tubes are to be of uniform quality. For electric-resistance welded steel tubes, deposit
metal projected on outside of tubes is to be removed and finished smooth and that projected on
inside of tubes is to be removed to have a height not more than 0.25 mm.
9. Retest procedures
Where the tensile test, flattening test, flaring test or reverse flattening test fails to meet the require-
ments, additional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109.
10. Marking
(1) The name or brand of the manufacturer, grade of tubes, size and symbol of the method of the
manufacture relating to (2) below are to be legibly stamped or stenciled before shipment on
each length steel tube in case of 30 mm and above in outside diameter and on each bundle or
container of steel tubes in case of less than 30 mm in outside diameter. The Society"s brand
indicating compliance with the requirements is to be stamped in the vicinity of the foregoing
marks.
(2) The symbols indicating the method of manufacture are to be as specified in the following:
Hot finished seamless steel tube ············································································ -S-H
Cold drawn seamless steel tube ············································································· -S-C
Electric-resistance welded steel tube of other than hot and cold working ······ -E-G
Electric-resistance welded steel tube of hot working ········································· -E-H
Electric-resistance welded steel tube of cold working ········································· -E-C

402. Steel pipes for pressure piping


1. Application
(1) These requirements are mainly to apply to seamless steel pipes and electric-resistance welded
steel pipes intended for use in piping which is prescribed in Pt 5, Ch 6 (hereinafter referred to
as "steel pipes").
(2) Steel pipes for general purpose specified in 102. 2 (4) of Pt 5, Ch 6 are to comply with the
requirements of KS D 3507(SPP) or equivalent thereto. However, tests in the presence of the
Surveyor are not required.
(3) The steel pipes having characteristics differing from those specified in 402. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.

46 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

2. Kinds
The steel pipes are classified as specified in Table 2.1.47.

Table 2.1.47 Grades of Steel Pipes

Kind Grade Schedule applied


Grade 1 RST 138
Sch.10~Sch.80
Carbon steel pipe for pressure service RST 142
RST 238
Grade 2
RST 242 Sch.40~Sch.160
Carbon steel pipe for high pressure service
RST 249
RST 338
Grade 3
RST 342
Carbon steel pipe for high temperature service
RST 349
RST 412 Sch.10~Sch.160
Grade 4 RST 422
Alloy steel pipe RST 423
RST 424

3. Heat treatment
The heat treatment of steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.48.

Table 2.1.48 Heat treatment

Seamless steel pipe Electric-resistance welded steel pipe


Grade Hot
Hot finished Cold drawn As drawn Cold finished
finished
RST 138
Grade1 Annealed As drawn As drawn Annealed
RST 142
As drawn
RST 238 Low temperature
Grade2 RST 242 annealed or -

RST 249 Normalized

Low temper- Low temperature


RST 338 Low temperature ature annealed As drawn annealed or
Grade3 RST 342 As drawn annealed or or Normalized Normalized
Normalized
RST 349
Low temperature annealed
Isothermal annealed, Full annealed,
RST 412
Normalized or
Normalized and tempered
Low temperature annealed , -
Grade4
RST 422 Isothermal annealed, Full annealed
or Normalized and tempered
Isothermal annealed, Full annealed
RST 423
or Normalized and tempered at
RST 424
650℃ and over

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 47


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.49.
Table 2.1.49 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition ()


Grade
C Si Mn P S Cr Mo
RST 138 0.25 max. 0.30~0.90 0.040 0.040
Grade 1 0.35 max.
RST 142 0.30 max. 0.30~1.00 max. max.

RST 238 0.25 max. 0.30~1.10

Grade 2 RST 242 0.30 max. 0.30~1.40


-
RST 249 0.33 max. 0.30~1.50 -
0.10~0.35
RST 338 0.25 max. 0.30~0.90 0.035 0.035
max. max.
Grade 3 RST 342 0.30 max.
0.30~1.00
RST 349 0.33 max.
RST 412 0.10~0.20 0.10~0.50 0.30~0.80
RST 422 0.50 max. 0.80~1.25 0.45~0.65
Grade 4
RST 423 0.15 max. 0.50~1.00 0.30~0.60 0.030 0.030 1.00~1.50
RST 424 0.50 max. max. max. 1.90~2.60 0.87~1.13

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steel pipes are to comply with the following requirements.
(1) Tensile test : The tensile test of steel pipes are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.50.
Table 2.1.50 Mechanical Properties

Yield strength Tensile strength


Grade Elongation ()(   
)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
Grade 1 RST 138
Grade 2 RST 238 215 min. 370 min. 24 (20) min.
Grade 3 RST 338
Grade 1 RST 142
Grade 2 RST 242 245 min. 410 min. 21 (17) min.
Grade 3 RST 342
Grade 2 RST 249
275 min. 480 min. 19 (15) min.
Grade 3 RST 349
Grade 4 RST 412 380 min.
RST 422 205 min. 21(17) min.
Grade 4 RST 423 410 min.
RST 424
NOTES:
1. The requirements for elongation given in parentheses in the Table are applied for the case where
test specimens are taken transversely. In this case, the test sample is to be stress relieved at the
temperature of 600℃ to 650℃ after flattened.
2. In case where test specimen of non-tubular section is taken from electric-resistance welded steel
pipes, the test specimen is to be taken from the part that does not include a welded line.

48 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) Flattening test


(a) Pipes other than Grade 1 of electric-resistance welded steel pipe: A tubular section of steel
pipe which is taken from the end of the steel pipe, is to stand being flattened between par-
allel plates, without cracking or showing flaw, until the distance between the plates becomes
less than the value of H calculated by the following formula. In this case, the length of
test specimen is to comply with the requirements in 401.5 (2). For steel pipes, however, of
15 % of outside diameter and above in thickness, C-type test specimen may be used, having
a part of its circumference discarded as shown in Fig 2.1.9 (b)

   
 



where:
 = Distance between flattening plates (mm).
 = Thickness of steel pipe (mm).
 = Outside diameter of steel pipe (mm).
 = Constant given in Table 2.1.51 which varies according to the grade of steel
tubes.

Table 2.1.51 value of 

RST 142, RST 242, RST 249, RST 138, RST 238, RST 338, RST 412
Grade
RST 342 RST 349 RST 422, RST 423, RST 424

 0.07 0.08

(b) Electric-resistance welded steel pipes Grade 1 :


   for welded line,


    for elsewhere.

In case of electric-resistance welded steel pipes, the welded line is to be placed at right an-
gle to the direction of the applied force, as in Fig 2.1.10.

Fig 2.1.10 Flattening test of electric-resistance welded steel pipes Grade 1

(3) Bend test : For steel pipes of 50 mm and under in outside diameter, the specimen for flattening
test may be substituted for that for bend test. In this case, a test specimen of tubular section
which is taken from the end of the steel pipe and has sufficient length is to stand being bent
cold, up to the specified value in Table 2.1.52, without cracking or showing flaw on the wall.
But, for Grade 4, this test need not be carried out.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 49


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.52 Bend Test

Grade Angle of bending Inside bend radius


1, 2 and 3 90° 6 times the outside diameter of steel pipe
NOTE:
Electric-resistance welded steel pipes are to be so bent as the welded line is placed widest.

(4) Hydraulic test


(a) Grade 1 steel pipes are to be hydraulically tested with the pressure specified in Table
2.1.53.
(b) In case where the test pressure higher than prescribed in (a) is specified by the purchaser
for Grade 2 through 4 steel pipes, the test is to be carried out with the specified pressure.
In this case, test pressure need not exceed the pressure calculated by the following formula:


   Mpa

where :
 = Hydraulic test pressure ( MPa ).
 = Outside diameter of steel pipe (mm).
 = Thickness of steel pipe (mm).
 = 60  of the prescribed minimum yield strength ( Nmm  ).
(c) When each steel pipe is hydraulically tested as a regular procedure during the process of
manufacturing at the mill which makes a number of steel tubes continually, and the results
are forwarded to the Surveyor, the test in the presence of the Surveyor may be dispensed
with.
(d) A non-destructive inspection deemed appropriate by the Society may be substituted for the
hydraulic inspection specified in (a).
6. Selection of test specimen
(1) Grade 1 : Sampling steel pipes are to be selected as following requirements in connection with
the nominal diameter of steel pipes specified in Table 2.1.53 and each one specimen for ten-
sile test, flattening test or bend test is to be taken from each sampling steel pipe.
(a) For steel pipes less than 65A in nominal diameter : One sampling steel pipe is to be se-
lected from each lot of 1000 pipes or fraction thereof.
(b) For steel pipes which a nominal diameter is 65A or above and less than 150A : One sam-
pling steel pipe is to be selected from each lot of 500 pipes or fraction thereof.
(c) For steel pipes which a nominal diameter is 150A or above and less than 350A : One
sampling steel pipe is to be selected from each lot of 250 pipes or fraction thereof.
(d) For steel pipes more than 350A in nominal diameter : One sampling steel pipe is to be se-
lected from each lot of 150 pipes or fraction thereof.
(2) Grade 2 : One sampling steel pipe is to be selected from each lot of 50 pipes or fraction
thereof, and each one specimen for tensile test and flattening test or bend test is to be taken
from each sampling steel pipe.
(3) Grade 3
Selection of test specimen is to comply with the requirements in (2).
(4) Grade 4 : One sampling steel pipe is to be selected from each lot of 50 pipes or fraction
thereof, and each one specimen for tensile test and flattening test or bend test is to be taken
from each sampling steel pipe.

50 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.53 Schedule and Hydraulic Test Pressure

Nominal thickness (mm)


Nominal Outside
diameter diameter
(A) (mm) Sch.10 Sch.20
Sch.30 Sch.40 Sch.60 Sch.80 Sch.100 Sch.120 Sch.140 Sch.160
(10S) (20S)

6 10.5 (1.2) (1.5) - 1.7 2.2 2.4 - - - -


8 13.8 (1.65) (2.0) - 2.2 2.4 3.0 - - - -
10 17.3 (1.65) (2.0) - 2.3 2.8 3.2 - - - -
15 21.7 (2.1) (2.5) - 2.8 3.2 3.7 - - - 4.7
20 27.2 (2.1) (2.5) - 2.9 3.4 3.9 - - - 5.5
25 34.0 (2.8) (3.0) - 3.4 3.9 4.5 - - - 6.4
32 42.7 (2.8) (3.0) - 3.6 4.5 4.9 - - - 6.4
40 48.6 (2.8) (3.0) - 3.7 4.5 5.1 - - - 7.1
50 60.5 (2.8) 3.2(3.5) - 3.9 4.9 5.5 - - - 8.7
65 76.3 (3.0) 4.5(3.5) - 5.2 6.0 7.0 - - - 9.5
80 89.1 (3.0) 4.5(4.0) - 5.5 6.6 7.6 - - - 11.1
90 101.6 (3.0) 4.5(4.0) - 5.7 7.0 8.1 - - - 12.7
100 114.3 (3.0) 4.9(4.0) - 6.0 7.1 8.6 - 11.1 - 13.5
125 139.8 (3.4) 5.1(5.0) - 6.6 8.1 9.5 - 12.7 - 15.9
150 165.2 (3.4) 5.5(5.0) - 7.1 9.3 11.0 - 14.3 - 18.2
200 216.3 (4.0) 6.4(6.5) 7.0 8.2 10.3 12.7 15.1 18.2 20.6 23.0
250 267.5 (4.0) 6.4(6.5) 7.8 9.3 12.7 15.1 18.1 21.4 25.4 28.6
300 318.5 (4.5) 6.4(6.5) 8.4 10.3 14.3 17.4 21.4 25.4 28.6 33.3
350 355.6 6.4 7.9 9.5 11.1 15.1 19.0 23.8 27.8 31.8 35.7
400 406.4 6.4 7.9 9.5 12.7 16.7 21.4 26.2 30.9 36.5 40.5
450 457.2 6.4 7.9 11.1 14.3 19.0 23.8 29.4 34.9 39.7 45.2
500 508.0 6.4 9.5 12.7 15.1 20.6 26.2 32.5 38.1 44.4 50.0
550 558.8 6.4 9.5 12.7 15.9 22.2 28.6 34.9 41.3 47.6 54.0
600 609.4 6.4 9.5 14.3 17.5 24.6 31.0 38.9 46.0 52.4 59.5
650 660.4 7.9 12.7 - 18.9 26.4 34.0 41.6 49.1 56.6 64.2
Grade 1 2.0 3.5 5.0 6.0 9.0 12.0 - - - -
Hydraulic
Grade 2 - - - 6.0 9.0 12.0 15.0 18.0 20.0 20.0
test
pressure Grade 3
(M Pa ) and 2.0 3.5 5.0 6.0 9.0 12.0 15.0 18.0 20.0 20.0
Grade 4
NOTE:
The values of nominal thickness in parentheses are applicable to stainless steel pipes.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 51


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

7. Tolerance for dimensions


Tolerances for the outside diameter and the thickness are to comply with the requirements in Table
2.1.54.

Table 2.1.54 Tolerance for Dimensions

Outside Tolerance for wall thickness


Tolerance
diameter of
Kind for outside
steel pipe D Grade 1 Grade 2, 3 and 4
diameter
(mm)
Thickness of Thickness of
+ 0.6 mm
D < 50 ± 0.5 mm steel pipe: Less steel pipe: Less ± 0.5 mm
- 0.5 mm
Hot finished seam- than 4 mm than 4 m m
less steel pipe Thickness of Thickness of
+ 15 %
D ≥ 50 ±1% steel pipe: steel pipe: ± 12.5 %
- 12.5 %
4 mm and over 4 m m and over

Thickness of Thickness of
Cold drawn seam- D < 40 ± 0.3 mm steel pipe: Less ± 0.3 mm steel pipe: Less ± 0.2 mm
less steel pipe and than 3 mm than 2 m m
electric-resistance Thickness of Thickness of
welded steel pipe D ≥ 40 ± 0.80 mm steel pipe: ± 10 % steel pipe: ± 10 %
3 mm and over 2 mm and over

NOTE:
For hot finished seamless steel pipes Grades 2, 3 and 4, the tolerance for deviation in wall thick-
ness is to be 20 % and under of the thickness of the pipes. But, for steel pipes less than 5.6
m m in thickness, this note is not applied.

8. Quality
(1) Each steel pipes are hydraulically or non-destructively tested and are free from leakages or
harmful defects.
(2) The steel pipes are to be of uniform quality and free from harmful defects.
9. Retest procedures
Where the tensile test, flattening test or bend test fails to meet the requirements, additional tests
may be conducted according to the requirements given in 109.
10. Marking
(1) The name or brand of the manufacturer, grade of steel tubes, size and symbol of the method of
the manufacture relating to (2) below are to be legibly stamped or stenciled before shipment on
each length steel tube in case of 60 mm and above in outside diameter and on each bundle or
container of steel tubes in case of less than 60 mm in outside diameter. The Society's brand
indicating compliance with the requirements is to be in the vicinity of the foregoing marks.
(2) The symbols indicating the method of manufacture are to comply with the requirement in 401.
10 (2).

403. Stainless steel pipes


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the stainless steel pipes for low temperature service or corro-
sion-resistance service (hereinafter referred to as "stainless steel pipes").
(2) Stainless steel pipes having characteristics differing from those specified in 403. are to comply
with the requirements in 101. 2.

52 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

2. Kinds
The stainless steel pipes are classified as specified in Table 2.1.55.

Table 2.1.55 Grades and Chemical Composition

solid solution Chemical Composition (  )


Grade
treatment(℃)
C Si Mn P S Ni Cr Mo O thers
RSTS 1010 and over, 0.080
8.00~11.00
304TP quenching max.
18.00~20.00
RSTS 1010 and over, 0.030 1.00
9.00~13.00
304LTP quenching max. max.
-
RSTS 1030 and over, 12.00~15.00 22.00~24.00
309STP quenching

RSTS 1030 and over, 0.080 1.50


19.00~22.00 24.00~26.00
310STP quenching max. max.
-
RSTS 1010 and over, 10.00~14.00
316TP quenching 2.00 0.040 0.030
16.00~18.00 2.00~3.00
RSTS 0.030 max. max. max.
1010 and over, 12.00~16.00
316LTP quenching max.

RSTS 1010 and over, 0.080


317TP quenching max. 1.00
11.00~15.00 18.00~20.00 3.00~4.00
RSTS 0.030 max.
1010 and over,
317LTP quenching max.

RSTS 920 and over, Ti≥5×C


321TP quenching 0.080
9.00~13.00 17.00~19.00 -
RSTS max.
980 and over, Nb≥10×C
347TP quenching

3. Heat treatment
The stainless steel pipes are generally to receive a solid solution treatment. For RSTS 321TP and
RSTS 347TP, stabilizing treatment may be required. In this case, heat treatment temperature is to
be of 850~930℃.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of stainless steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.1.55.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of stainless steel pipes are to comply with the following requirements.
(a) Tensile test
The tensile test of stainless steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.56.
(b) Flattening test
Flattening tests are to be carried out in accordance with the requirements in 402. 5 (2).
However, where the requirements are applied, the value of e is to be taken as 0.09.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 53


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.56 Tensile Test

Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation ()(   


)
Grade
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) L T
RSTS 304TP 205 min. 520 min.
RSTS 304LTP 175 min. 480 min.
RSTS 309STP
RSTS 310STP 205 min. 520 min.
RSTS 316TP
26 min. 22 min.
RSTS 316LTP 175 min. 480 min.
RSTS 317TP 205 min. 520 min.
RSTS 317LTP 175 min. 480 min.
RSTS 321TP
205 min. 520 min.
RSTS 347TP
NOTES:
1. L (or T) denotes that the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is arranged parallel (or normal) to
the final direction of rolling.
2. Where the nominal diameter of stainless steel pipes is 200 mm and over, tensile test specimens may
be taken transversely.
3. Where test specimens of non-tubular section are taken from welded pipes, the test specimens are to
be taken from the part that does not include the welded line.

(c) Hydraulic test


(i) Stainless steel pipes are to be hydraulically tested with the pressure specified in Table
2.1.57.

Table 2.1.57 Hydraulic Test Pressure

Schedule No. Sch.10S Sch.20S Sch.40 Sch.80 Sch.120 Sch.160

Test pressure (M Pa ) 2.0 3.5 6.0 12.0 18.0 20.0

(ii) In case where the test pressure higher than prescribed in (a) is specified by the pur-
chaser, the test is to be carried out with the specified pressure. In this case, the test
pressure need not exceed the pressure calculated by the following formula:

 
   Mpa

where:
 = Hydraulic test pressure ( MPa ).
 = Thickness of stainless steel pipe (mm).
 = Outside diameter of stainless steel pipe (mm).
 = 60 % of the prescribed minimum yield strength ( Nmm  ).
(iii) When each pipe is hydraulically tested as a regular during the process of manufacturing
at the mill which makes a number of tubes continually, and the results are forwarded to
the Surveyor, the test in the presence of the Surveyor may be dispensed with.
(iv) A non-destructive inspection deemed appropriate by the Society may be substituted for
the hydraulic test specified in (i).

54 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) The Society may require the impact test or corrosion resistance test according to purposes of
stainless steel pipes.
6. Selection of test specimens
One sampling pipe is to be selected from each lot of 50 pipes or fraction thereof which are of the
same charge, size and kind and are simultaneously heat treated, and each one specimen for tensile
test and flattening test is to be taken from each sample pipe.
7. Tolerance for dimensions
Tolerances for the outside diameter and the thickness are to comply with the requirements in Table
2.1.58.

Table 2.1.58 Tolerance for Dimensions

Outside diameter of
Kind Tolerance for wall thickness
stainless steel pipe
Thickness of pipe:
Less than 50 ± 0.5 mm ± 0.5 mm
Hot-finished seamless Less than 4 m m
stainless steel pipe Thickness of pipe: 4
50 and over ±1% ± 12.5 
mm and over
Cold drawn seamless Thickness of pipe:
Less than 30 ± 0.3 mm ± 0.2 mm
stainless pipe, automatic Less than 2 m m
arc welded stainless steel
pipe and electric-resistance Thickness of pipe:
30m m and over ±1 ± 10 
welded stainless steel pipe 2 m m and over

NOTE:
For hot finished seamless stainless steel pipes, the tolerance for deviation in wall thickness is to be
20  and under of the thickness of the pipes. But, for stainless steel pipes less than 5.6 mm in
thickness, this note is not applied.

8. Quality
(1) Each steel pipes are hydraulically or non-destructively tested and are free from leakages or harm-
ful defects.
(2) The stainless steel pipes are to be of uniform quality and free from harmful defects.
9. Retest procedures
Where the tensile test or flattening test fails to meet the requirements, additional tests may be con-
ducted according to the requirements given in 109.
10. Marking
Stainless steel pipes which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked
with identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 402. 10. However, the symbols in-
dicating the manufacturing method of automatic arc welded steel pipes are to be as specified in the
following:
Automatic arc welded steel pipe : -A
Automatic arc welded and cold finished steel pipe : -A-C
Automatic arc welded and machined steel pipe : -A-B

404. Steel pipes for low temperature service


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the seamless steel pipes and electric resistance welded steel
pipes not exceeding 25 mm in thickness, intended to be used at the design temperature lower
than 0℃ in liquefied gas carriers (hereinafter referred to as "steel pipes").

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 55


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) Any requirement regarding the steel pipes over 25 mm in thickness is left to the discretion of
the Society.
(3) Steel pipes having characteristics differing from those specified in 404. are to comply with the
requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The steel pipes are classified as given in Table 2.1.59.
3. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of each grade are to comply with the require-
ments given in Table 2.1.59.

Table 2.1.59 Grades and Chemical Composition ()

Grade Deoxidation C Si Mn P S Ni
RLPA 0.23 max. 0.35 max. 1.60 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. -
RLPB 0.18 max. 0.35 max. 1.60 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. -
RLPC Fully killed 0.18 max. 0.35 max. 1.60 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. -
RLP 2 fine grain 0.19 max. 0.10~0.35 0.90 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. 2.00~2.60
RLP 3 0.16 max. 0.10~0.35 0.90 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max. 3.20~3.80
RLP 9 0.10 max. 0.10~0.35 0.90 max. 0.030 max. 0.030 max. 8.40~9.50

4. Heat treatment
The heat treatment of steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.60.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel pipes are to comply with the following (a) to (d).
(a) Tensile test
The tensile test of steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.60.
(b) Impact test
The impact test of steel pipes is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.60.
(c) Flattening test
Flattening test is to be carried out in accordance with the requirements given in 402. 5 (2).
Where this requirement is applied, the value of e is to be taken as 0.08. For steel pipes of
50 mm and under in outside diameter, the specimen for flattening test may be substituted
for that for bend test. In this case, a test specimen of tubular section which is taken from
the end of the steel pipe and has sufficient length is to stand being bent cold, up to the
specified value in Table 2.1.60, without flaw and cracking on the outside of bent portion.
Electric resistance welded steel pipes are to be bent at the place where the welded line is
on the outside of bent portion.
(d) Hydraulic test
All steel pipes are to be subjected to hydraulic test in accordance with the requirements
given in 402. 5 (4).
(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, other tests may be required in addition to the tests
specified in (1)
6. Selection of test specimens
(1) One sampling pipe is to be selected from each lot of 50 pipes or fraction thereof which are of
the same charge, size and kind and are simultaneously heat treated. Each one specimen for
tensile test and flattening test is to be taken from each sample pipe.

56 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) One set of three specimens for impact test is to be taken from each sample pipe in accordance
with Fig 2.1.11. Moreover, for electric resistance welded steel pipes, another set of three
specimens is to be taken from the welded zone in accordance with Fig 2.1.12.

Table 2.1.60 Heat Treatment and Mechanical Properties


(1)(2)(3)
Tensile test Bend test Impact test
Elongation (%) Average
Yield Tensile Angle of Test
Grade Heat treatment (   
) Inside radius absorbed
strength strength bend temp.
of bend energy
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) L T (°) (℃)
(J)(4)
RLPA -40(5)
RLPB Normalized, 205 min. 380 min. 26 min. 19 min. -50(5) 27 min.
Normalized and (5)
RLPC tempered or -60
RLP 2 Quenched and 6 times the -70
tempered 245 min. 450 min. 20 min. 14 min. outside 34 min.
RLP 3 90 -95
diameter of
Double steel pipe
normalized and
RLP 9 tempered or 520 min. 690 min. 15 min. 11 min. -196 41 min.
Quenched and
tempered

NOTES:
(1) L (or T) denotes that the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is arranged parallel (or normal) to the final
direction of rolling.
(2) Where the nominal diameter of steel pipes is 200 mm and over, the tensile test specimen may be taken
transversely.
(3) Where test specimen of non-tubular section is taken from electric resistance welded pipes, the test speci-
men is to be taken from the portion that does not include the welded line.
(4) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in value
than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is less
in value than 70% of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.
(5) Impact test temperature for steel pipes specified in Pt 7, Ch 5 is to be 5℃ below the design temperature
or -20℃, whichever is the lower.

7. Tolerance for dimensions


The tolerances for outside diameter and wall thickness of steel pipes are to be in accordance with
the requirements given in Table 2.1.61.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 57


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.61 Tolerance for Outside Diameter and Wall Thickness

Kind Tolerance for outside diameter Tolerance for wall thickness


D<50 : ± 0.5 mm
50≤D<250 : ± 1 % t<4 : ± 0.5 mm
Hot-finished seamless steel pipe
(maximum value 2.0 mm) t≥4 : ± 12.5 %
250≤D : ± 0.8 %
Cold-drawn seamless steel pipe and ± 0.8 % t<2 : ± 0.2 mm
Electric-resistance welded steel pipe (max. value 0.3 mm) t≥2 : ± 10 %
NOTE:
For hot-finished seamless steel pipes, the tolerance for deviation in wall thickness is to be 20 % or
less of wall thickness, but it shall not be applied to the pipes less than 5.6 mm in wall thickness.

8. Quality
The steel pipes are to be of uniform quality and free from harmful defects.
9. Retest procedures
(1) Where other mechanical tests than impact tests fail to meet the requirements, additional tests
may be carried out according to the requirements given in 109.
(2) Regarding the impact tests, additional tests are to be carried out according to the requirements
given in 301. 10 (3).
10. Marking
Marking for steel pipes is generally to comply with the requirements given in 402. 10. and in
case the requirement in Note (5) of Table 2.1.60 has been applied, "impact test temperature T" is
to be suffixed to the marking. (e.g. RLPA -25T )

405. Header
1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the headers to be used for boilers.
(2) The headers having characteristics differing from those specified in 405. are to comply with the
requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The headers are classified as specified in Table 2.1.62.

Table 2.1.62 Grades of Headers

Grade 1 Grade 2 Grade 3 Grade 4 Grade 5 Grade 6


Grade
RBH 1 RBH 2 RBH 3 RBH 4 RBH 5 RBH 6

3. Heat treatment
Headers are to be heat treated by annealing or normalizing.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of headers is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.63.

58 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.63 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C Si Mn P S Cr Mo
RBH 1 0.25 max. 0.040
0.10~0.35 0.040 -
RBH 2 0.30 max. 0.30~0.80 max. -
max.
RBH 3 0.45~0.65
0.10~0.20
RBH 4 0.030 0.20~0.45
0.10~0.50 0.030 0.80~1.20
RBH 5 0.30~0.60 max. 0.45~0.65
0.15 max. max.
RBH 6 2.00~2.50 0.90~1.10

5. Mechanical properties
(1) Tensile test: The tensile test of headers is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.64.

Table 2.1.64 Mechanical Properties

Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation(%) Reduction of area


Grade
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
) (%)

RBH 1 205 min. 410 min. 24 min. 38 min.


RBH 2 225 min. 450 min. 23 min.
RBH 3 380 min. 22 min.
RBH 4 40 min.
205 min.
RBH 5 410 min. 21 min.
RBH 6
NOTE:
When test specimens are taken crosswise to the rolled direction, the values of yield strength
and tensile strength are to be as given in this Table and the elongation is to take the value
reduced by 5 % from the percentage given in this Table. The value of reduction of area may
be only remained on records for reference.

(2) Bend test: The test specimen is to stand being bent cold through 180" without flaw and crack-
ing on the outside of bent portion to an inside radius of 12 mm. Where the test specimen of
20 mm in thickness can not be taken, the test specimen may be as original in thickness, in
which case, however, the width of test specimen is not to be less than 1.5 times the thickness
and the inside radius of bend is to be equal to the thickness.
6. Selection of test specimens
(1) Tensile test specimens are to be taken lengthwise or crosswise to the rolled direction and bend
test specimens to be taken crosswise to the rolled direction each from the open ends of headers.
(2) For the headers of the same size made from the same melt and subjected to the heat treatment
simultaneously in the same furnace, tensile and bend test specimens are to be selected in ac-
cordance with the requirements given in Table 2.1.65.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 59


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.65 Number of Test Specimens

Grade Length of test specimens l (mm) Number of test specimens


3000 ≤ l 1 set for each one length
RBH 1
2000 ≤ l < 3000 1 set for each three lengths
RBH 2
2000 > l 1 set for each five lengths

RBH 3 RBH 4 3000 ≤ l 1 set from each end for each one lengths
RBH 5 RBH 6 3000 > l 1 set for each one length

(3) Where the both ends of header are closed by reforging, the test samples of proper size may be
cut from the open ends before reforging.
(4) Where test samples cut from circular headers, etc. are necessary to be flattened, the test samples
are to be taken from the body before being subjected to the heat treatment and after flattening
the test samples are to be heat treated simultaneously with the body in the same furnace, or the
test samples are to be cut from the structures after being subjected to the heat treatment and
after flattened cold, they are to be heated to the temperature of 600℃ to 650℃ for the pur-
pose of removing the distortion due to the flattening, and the required test specimens are to be
cut from the test samples.
7. Tolerance for thickness
The tolerance for thickness is to be +12.5 %. The tolerance, however, may not apply to the closed
portions of circular or square headers, the side corners of square headers and the corrugated
headers.
8. Quality
Headers are to be of uniform quality and free from harmful defects.
9. Marking
Headers which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the iden-
tification mark in accordance with the requirements in 401. 10.

60 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 5 Castings

501. Steel castings


1. Application
(1) The requirements in 501. are to apply to the steel castings intended to be used for the compo-
nents specified in the relevant Parts of hull construction equipments and machinery, except that
defined in 502., 503. and 504.
(2) Steel castings having characteristics differing from those specified in 501. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The steel castings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.66.

Table 2.1.66 Grades and Mechanical Properties

Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation (%)


Kind Grade Reduction of area (%)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
)
RSC 410 205 min. 410 min. 24 min. 38 min.
RSC 450 225 min. 450 min. 22 min. 29 min.

Carbon steel RSC 480 245 min. 480 min. 20 min. 27 min.
castings RSC 520 265 min. 520 min. 18 min. 25 min.
RSC 560 305 min. 560 min. 15 min. 20 min.
RSC 600 325 min. 600 min. 13 min. 20 min.
RSC 440A 245 min. 440 min. 22 min. 40 min.
Low alloy
RSC 480A 275 min. 480 min. 17 min. 35 min.
steel castings
RSC 550A 345 min. 550 min. 16 min. 35 min.
NOTES:
1. For intermediate values of the tensile strength, the minimum values for yield strength, elongation and
reduction of area may be obtained by interpolation and the value at the first decimal place is to be
subjected to the method of counting fractions over 1/2 as one and disregarding the rest.
2. The upper limit of the tensile strength is to be within 150 Nmm  from minimum tensile strength of
each grade.

3. Manufacture
(1) All flame cutting, scarfing or arc-air gouging to remove the risers and surplus metal is to be
undertaken in accordance with recognized good practice and is to be carried out before the final
heat treatment. Preheating is to be employed when necessitated by the chemical composition or
thickness of the castings. If necessary, the affected areas are to be either machined or ground
smooth.
(2) Where the surface of steel castings is hardened by induction hardening, nitriding, cold rolling or
other methods, the proposed methods of manufacture are to be approved by the Society.
(3) When two or more castings are joined by welding to form a composite component, the pro-
posed welding procedure is to be submitted for approval to the Society. If necessary, welding
procedure qualification tests may be required.
4. Chemical composition
(1) All castings are to be made from killed steel and the chemical composition is to comply with
the overall limits given in Table 2.1.67.
(2) The chemical composition of each heat is to be determined by the manufacturer on a sample
taken preferably during the pouring of the heat. When multiple heats are tapped into a common
ladle, the ladle analysis shall apply.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 61


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.67 Chemical Composition (%)

Chemical composition (%)


Steel
Application Residual elements Total
Type C Si Mn S P
Cu Cr Ni Mo W residuals

Casting for
0.40 0.60 0.50- 0.040 0.040 0.30 0.30 0.40 0.15 0.80
non-welded -
Carbon max. max. 1.60 max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
construction
steel
casting Casting for
0.23 0.60 1.60 0.040 0.040 0.30 0.30 0.40 0.15 0.80
welded (1) -
max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
construction
Low alloy steel 0.25 0.60 0.50 - 0.030 0.030 0.50 1.50 0.50 1.20 0.10 1.00
casting max. max. 0.80 max. max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
NOTES :
(1) The carbon content may be, subject to approval by the Society, increased above this level provided that
the carbon equivalent (Ceq) is not more than 0.41 %

(3) Unless otherwise required suitable grain refining elements such as aluminium may be used at
the discretion of the manufacturer. The content of such elements is to be reported in the ladle
analysis.
5. Heat treatment
(1) Steel castings are to be annealed, normalized, normalized and tempered, or quenched and
tempered. No annealed casting is to be removed from the furnace until the temperature of the
entire furnace charge has fallen to or below a temperature of 455°C. The tempering temperature
is to be not less than 550℃.
(2) Steel castings which are locally heated or subjected to any cold work after heat treatment, are
to be stress-relieved.
(3) Castings for components such as crankshafts and engine bedplates, where dimensional stability
and freedom from internal stresses are important, are to be given a stress relief heat treatment.
This is to be carried out at a temperature of not less than 550℃ followed by furnace cooling
to 300℃ or lower.
(4) Heat treatment is to be carried out in properly constructed furnaces which are efficiently main-
tained and have adequate means for control and recording of temperature. The furnace di-
mensions are to be such as to allow the whole casting to be uniformly heated to the necessary
temperature In the case of very large castings alternative methods for heat treatment will be
specially considered by the Society.
Sufficient thermocouples are to be connected to the furnace charge to measure and record that
its temperature is adequately uniform unless the temperature uniformity of the furnace is verified
at regular intervals.
(5) The foundry is to maintain records of heat treatment identifying the furnace used, furnace
charge, date, temperature and time at temperature. The records are to be presented to the
Surveyor on request.
6. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of the steel castings are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.1.66.
(2) Impact tests should be required on carbon steel castings intended for welded construction such
as cast sternframes, rudder horns and shoepieces. The results of impact test is to be in accord-
ance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
7. Selection of test specimens
(1) At least one test sample is to be provided for each casting. Unless otherwise agreed these test
samples are to be either integrally cast or gated to the castings and are to have a thickness of
not less than 30 mm. Test material, sufficient for the required tests and for possible retest pur-
poses is to be provided for each casting or batch of castings. One tensile test specimen is to be
taken from each test sample.

62 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) The test samples are to be heat treated together with the castings which they represent and are
not to be detached from the casting until the specified heat treatment has been completed and
they have been properly identified.
(3) For castings where the method of manufacture has been specially approved by the Society in
accordance with 3 (2), the number and position of test samples is to be agreed with the
Society having regard to the method of manufacture employed.
(4) Number of test specimens is to comply with the requirements of Table 2.1.68.

Table 2.1.68 Number of Test Specimens

Condition of casting Number of test specimens


Where the weight of one steel casting is between 1 ton and 10 tons (1)
1 for each casting
inclusive
Where the casting is of complex design or where the finished weight
2 for each casting(1)
exceeds 10 tons
Where large castings are made from two or more casts which are not Two or more corresponding to
mixed in a ladle prior to pouring. the number of casts involved(1)
Where a number of small castings with a weight of 1 ton or less
(2)
which are to be of similar type and dimensions, made from one cast 1 for each batch of castings
and heat-treated in the same furnace charge.
NOTES:
(1) These test samples are to be integrally cast at locations as widely separated as possible.
(2) Test sample are to be separately casted and are to have suitable dimensions.

8. Surface and dimension inspections


(1) When heat treatment and machining are finished and, if necessary, at a proper time during ma-
chining, surface inspection is to be carried out. Where applicable, this is to include the exami-
nation of internal surfaces. Testing methods and acceptance criteria are to be in accordance with
the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(2) All castings are to be cleaned and adequately prepared for examination; suitable methods include
pickling, caustic cleaning, wire brushing, local grinding, shot or sand blasting. The surfaces are
not to be hammered, peened or treated in any way which may obscure defects.
(3) The dimension inspection of the steel castings is to be conducted under the responsibility of the
manufacturer, unless otherwise specified.
9. Quality
(1) All castings are to be free from surface or internal defects, which would be prejudicial to their
proper application in service.
(2) In the event of any casting proving to be defective during subsequent machining or testing it is
to be rejected notwithstanding any previous certification.
10. Non-destructive inspection
(1) The steel castings intended for stern frame, rudder post and other important structural members
or the steel castings specified in Pt 5, Ch 2, 201. 1 are to be subjected to ultrasonic tests at
an appropriate stage of the manufacturing process and the test reports are to be showed or sub-
mitted to the Surveyor. Testing methods and acceptance criteria are to be in accordance with
the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(2) The important parts of the following steel castings are to be subjected to magnetic particle tests
at an appropriate stage of the manufacturing process. But, machining surfaces may be subjected
to liquid penetrant tests. Testing methods and acceptance criteria are to be in accordance with
the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(a) Steel castings intended for stern frame, rudder post and other important structural members.
(b) Steel castings specified in Pt 5, Ch 2, 201. 1.
(c) Propellers.
(d) Turbine castings.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 63


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(3) When required by the relevant construction Rules, castings are to be pressure tested before final
acceptance. These tests are to be carried out in the presence of the Surveyor and are to be to
their satisfaction.
(4) In place of the test methods specified in (1) and (2), the Society may accept the application of
other non-destructive inspections considered adequate by the Society.
(5) The Society may require non-destructive inspections by radiographic test, ultrasonic test, mag-
netic particle test or penetrant test not only for the steel casting specified in (1) and (2) but al-
so for the steel casting deemed necessary by the Society.
(6) The welding parts of steel castings used to welded construction are to be subjected to non-de-
structive inspections considered adequate by the Society.
11. Repair of defects
(1) General
(i) The approval of the Society is to be obtained where steel castings from which defects were
removed are to be used with or without weld repair.
(ii) Procedure of removal of defect and weld repair is to be in accordance with the Guidance
relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(iii) Where the defective area is to be repaired by welding, the excavations are to be suitably
shaped to allow good access for welding. The resulting grooves are to be subsequently
ground smooth and complete elimination of the defective material is to be verified by mag-
netic particle test or liquid penetrant test.
(iv) Shallow grooves or depressions resulting from the removal of defects may be accepted pro-
vided that they will cause no appreciable reduction in the strength of the casting. The re-
sulting grooves or depressions are to be subsequently ground smooth and complete elimi-
nation of the defective material is to be verified by magnetic particle test or liquid penetrant
test.
(v) The manufacturer is to maintain full records detailing the extent and location of repairs
made to each casting and details of weld procedures and heat treatments applied for repairs.
These records are to be available to the Surveyor and copies provided on request.
(2) Weld repairs
When a casting can be repaired by welding, the following requirements apply:
(i) Before welding is started, full details of the extent and location of the repair, the proposed
welding procedure, heat treatement and subsequent inspection procedures are to be submitted
for approval.
(ii) All castings in low alloy steels and all castings for crankshafts are to be suitably pre-heated
prior to welding. Castings in carbon steel may also require to be pre-heated depending on
their chemical composition, the dimensions and position of the weld repairs.
(iii) Welding is to be done under cover in positions free from draughts and adverse weather
conditions by qualified welders with adequate supervision. As far as possible, all welding is
to be carried out in the downhand (flat) position.
(iv) The welding consumables used are to be of an appropriate composition, giving a weld de-
posit with mechanical properties similar and in no way inferior to those of the parent
castings.
Welding procedure tests are to be carried out by the manufacturer to demonstrate that sat-
isfactory mechanical properties can be obtained after heat treatment as detailed in 5.
(v) After welding has been completed the castings are to be given either a suitable heat treat-
ment in accordance with the requirements of previous 5 (1) or a stress relieving heat treat-
ment at a temperature of not less than 550℃. The type of heat treatment employed will be
dependent on the chemical composition of the casting and the dimensions, positions and na-
ture of the repairs .
(vi) Subject to the prior agreement of the Society, special consideration may be given to the
omission of postweld heat treatment or to the acceptance of local stress-relieving heat treat-
ment where the repaired area is small and machining of the casting has reached an ad-
vanced stage.
(vii) On completion of heat treatment the weld repairs and adjacent material are to be ground
smooth and examined by magnetic particle or liquid penetrant testing. Supplementary exami-
nation by ultrasonics or radiography may also be required depending on the dimensions and
nature of the original defect. Satisfactory results are to be obtained from all forms of
non-destructive testing used.

64 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

12. Retest procedure


(1) Where the tensile test fails to meet the requirements, additional test may be carried out in ac-
cordance with the requirements of 109.
(2) The additional tests are to be taken, preferably from the same, but alternatively from another,
test sample representative of the casting or batch of castings.
(3) At the option of the manufacturer, when a casting or batch of castings has failed to meet the
test requirements, it may be reheat treated and re-submitted for acceptance tests.
13. Marking
(1) The grade of material and the manufacturer"s name or trade mark are to be cast or stamped on
all steel castings. In addition, the cast number is to be stamped on all steel castings not less
than 250 kg in mass. The Society's brand indicating satisfactory compliance with the require-
ments is to be stamped in the vicinity of the foregoing marks.
(2) For steel castings to which the requirements given in note 1 of the Table 2.1.66, the material
symbols are specified as RSC - (or RSC - A ) and the required tensile strength is to be filled
in symbol " - ". (e.g. For carbon steel castings which the required tensile strength is 420
2
N /m m , RSC 420)
(3) Where carbon steel castings are intended for welded hull construction specified in Table 2.1.67,
"W" is to be suffixed to the marking. (e.g, RSC 420-W )
14. Additional requirements for crank throw
(1) In case where semi-built-up crank throw for diesel engines is made of steel casting, the manu-
facturing procedure is to be approved by the Society.
(2) Where special manufacturing methods are adopted to reduce the size of crank throw according
to the requirements in Pt 5, Ch 2, 208, the preliminary test instructed by the Society are to be
carried out.

502. Steel castings for chains


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the steel castings used for anchor chain cables and accesso-
ries specified in Pt 4, Ch 8 (hereinafter referred to as "steel castings").
(2) Steel castings for manufacture of offshore mooring chain accessories are to be in accordance
with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(3) Steel castings having characteristics differing from those specified in 502. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The steel castings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.69

Table 2.1.69 Grade of Steel Casting

Grade Application
RSCC 50 Grade 2 chain
RSCC 70 Grade 3 chain

3. Heat treatment
(1) Steel castings are to be normalized, normalized and tempered, quenched and tempered or heat
treated by the process approved by the Society.
(2) Steel castings which are locally heated or subjected to any cold work after heat treatment, are
to be stress-relieved by the approved methods.
(3) Flame cutting or scarfing to remove risers and surplus metals is to be completed before final
heat treatment of the steel castings.
4. Chemical composition
Chemical composition of steel castings is to be subjected to the special approval by the Society.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 65


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of steel castings are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.70.

Table 2.1.70 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test Impact test(1)

Grade Average
Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation (%) Reduction of Testing
absorbed
(Nmm  ) (2) (Nmm  ) (2) (   ) area (%) temp. (℃)
energy (J)
RSCC 50 295 min. 490~690 22 min. - - -
RSCC 70 410 min. 690 min. 17 min. 40 min. 0 60 min.
NOTE:
(1) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in
value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test speci-
men is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to
have failed.

6. Selection of test specimens


(1) One test sample is to be taken from castings of similar dimensions originating from the same
heat treatment charge and the same cast of steel. In this case, the test sample may be the test
assembly cast with the body of casting and similar area. The tensile and impact test specimens
are to be taken from the test sample in the longitudinal direction at a depth of 1/6 diameter
from the surface specified in Fig 2.1.5.
(2) For RSCC 50, one tensile test specimen, and for other grades of chain castings, one tensile test
specimen and one set (3 pieces) of impact test specimens are to be taken from the test sample.
7. Surface inspection
Steel castings are to be subjected to the surface inspection after completion of the final heat
treatment.
8. Quality
Steel castings are to be of uniform quality and free from harmful defects.
9. Non-destructive inspection
A suitable non-destructive inspection, such as an ultrasonic test, may be required where deemed
necessary by the Society.
10. Repair of defects
The repair of defects for steel castings is generally to be carried out in accordance with the re-
quirements in 501. 11.
11. Retest procedure
Where the tensile test or impact test on the selected first test specimens fails to meet the require-
ments, additional tests may be conducted according to the requirements given in 306. 7.
12. Marking
Steel castings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 501. 13 (1).

66 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

503. Stainless steel castings


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the stainless steel castings for valves and pipe fittings in pip-
ing systems used at low temperature (-165℃ and over in design temperature) service or corro-
sion-resisting service (hereinafter referred to as "steel castings").
(2) Steel castings having characteristics differing from those specified in 503. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The steel castings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.71.
3. Heat treatment
Steel castings are generally to receive a solid solution treatment.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of steel castings is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.71.

Table 2.1.71 Grades and Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C Si Mn P S Ni Cr Mo O ther
2.00
RSSC 13 0.08 8.00~11.00 18.00~21.00 ─ ─
max.
max.
RSSC 14 10.00~14.00 ─
1.50
0.030 17.00~22.00 2.00~3.00
RSSC 16 max. 12.00~16.00 ─
max.
2.00 0.040 0.030
RSSC 17 0.08 12.00~15.00 22.00~26.0 ─ ─
max. max. max.
RSSC 18 max. 19.00~22.00 23.00~27.0 ─ ─
0.030 2.00
RSSC 19 max. 8.00~12.00 17.00~21.0 ─ ─
max.
0.08
RSSC 21 9.00~12.00 18.00~21.0 1.35≥Nb+Ta≥10×C
max.

5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel castings are to comply with the requirements give in Table
2.1.72.
(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, impact test or corrosion-resistance test may be required
in addition to the specified tests.
6. Selection of test specimens
(1) Where a stainless steel casting is 500 kg and over in weight, one tensile test specimen and one
hardness test specimen are to be taken from each casting.
(2) Where a number of stainless steel castings of similar form and size, each of which weight less
than 500 kg, are cast from the same charge, two tensile test specimens and two hardness test
specimens are to be taken from each group of castings simultaneously heat treated in the same
furnace.
(3) Hardness test specimen may be a portion of tensile test specimen.
7. Marking
Steel castings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 67


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.72 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test Hardness test


Grade Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation()
Brinell HB
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
)
RSSC 13
185 min. 440 min. 26 min.
RSSC 14
RSSC 16 175 min. 390 min. 31 min.
RSSC 17 205 min. 183 max.
440 min. 26 min.
RSSC 18
185 min.
RSSC 19 390 min. 31 min.
RSSC 21 205 min. 440 min. 26 min.

504. Steel castings for low temperature service


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the steel castings for valves and pipe fittings in piping sys-
tems intended to be used at the design temperature lower than 0℃ in liquefied gas carriers
(hereinafter referred to as "steel castings").
(2) Steel castings other than specified in 504. or those used in other parts than specified in (1) are
to comply with the requirements given in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The steel castings are classified as given in Table 2.1.73.

Table 2.1.73 Grades and Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Grade Deoxidation
C Si Mn P S Ni Mo
RLCA 0.30 max. 1.00 max. 0.035 0.035 -
-
RLCB 0.25 max. max. max. 0.45~0.65
Fully killed
0.60 max.
RLC 2 fine grain 0.25 max. 0.50~0.80 2.00~3.00
0.030 0.030
-
RLC 3 0.15 max. max. max. 3.00~4.00

3. Heat treatment
Steel castings are to be normalized or normalized and tempered.
4. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of steel castings are to comply with the require-
ments given in Table 2.1.73.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel castings are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.74.
(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, other tests may be required in addition to the tests
specified in (1).

68 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.74 Mechanical Properties


(2)
Tensile test Impact test

Grade Yield
Tensile strength Elongation (%) Reduction of Test temp. Average absorbed
strength
(Nmm  ) (   ) area (%) (℃) energy (J )
(Nmm  )
(1)
RLCA -40
245 min. 27 min.
RLCB -50(1)
450 min. 21 min. 35 min.
RLC 2 -70
275 min. 34 min.
RLC 3 -95
NOTES:
(1) Impact test temperature for castings specified in Pt 7, Ch 5 is to be 5℃ below the design temperature
or -20℃, whichever is the lower.
(2) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in val-
ue than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is
less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.

6. Selection of test specimens


(1) Where a steel casting is 500 kg and over in weight, one tensile test specimen and one set of
three impact test specimens are to be taken from each casting.
(2) Where a number of steel castings of similar form and size, each of which less than 500 kg in
weight, are cast from the same charge, two tensile test specimens and two sets of six impact
test specimens are to be taken from each group of castings simultaneously heat treated in the
same furnace.
7. Retest procedures
(1) Where the tensile tests fail to meet the requirements, additional tests may be carried out accord-
ing to the requirements given in 109.
(2) Regarding the impact tests, additional tests are to be carried out according to the requirements
given in 304. 9 (2).
8. Marking
Steel castings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 501. 13 (1) and in case the requirement
in Note (1) of Table 2.1.74 has been applied, "impact test temperature T" is to be suffixed to the
marking. (e.g. RLCA - 25T )

505. Stainless steel casting for propeller


1. Application
(1) These requirements are applicable to the manufacture of stainless steel casting(hereinafter referred
to as "steel propeller casting") for propellers, blades and bosses. These requirements may al-
so be used for the repair of propellers damaged in service, subject to prior agreement with the
Society.
(2) Steel propeller castings having characteristics differing from those specified in 505. are to com-
ply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
Steel propeller castings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.75.
3. Chemical composition
Chemical composition is classified as specified in Table 2.1.75.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 69


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.75 Kinds and Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Alloy type
C Mn Cr M o (1) Ni
12Cr 1Ni 0.15 Max. 2.0 Max. 11.5 - 17.0 0.5 Max. 2.0 Max.
13Cr 4Ni Martensitic 0.06 Max. 2.0 Max. 11.5 - 17.0 1.0 Max. 3.5 - 5.0
16Cr 5Ni 0.06 Max. 2.0 Max. 15.0 - 17.5 1.5 Max. 3.5 - 6.0
19Cr 11Ni Austenitic 0.12 Max. 1.6 Max. 16.0 - 21.0 4.0 Max. 8.0 - 13.0
NOTE :
(1) Minimum values may be in accordance with recognised national or international standards, subject to pri-
or agreement with the Society.

4. Heat treatment
Martensitic castings are to be austenitized(quenching) and tempered. Austenitic castings should be
solution treated.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties are to meet the requirements in Table 2.1.76 These values refer to
the test specimens machined from integrally cast test bars attached to the hub or on the blade.

Table 2.1.76 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test Impact test

(1)
Types Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation Reduction area Average absorbed
  (3)
(Nmm ) (Nmm ) (%) (%) energy (J)

12Cr 1Ni 440 Min. 590 Min. 15 Min. 30 Min. 20 Min.

13Cr 4Ni 550 Min. 750 Min. 15 Min. 35 Min. 30 Min.

16Cr 5Ni 540 Min. 760 Min. 15 Min. 35 Min. 30 Min.


(2)
19Cr 11Ni 180 Min. 440 Min. 30 Min. 40 Min. -

NOTES
(1) 0.2 % yield strength
(2) 1.0 % yield strength is min. 205 Nmm  .
(3) Not required for general service and the lowest Ice class notation(Grade ID). For other Ice class no-
tations, tests are to be made -10℃.

6. Selection of test samples and specimens


(1) Where possible, the test samples attached on blades are to be located in an area between 0.5 to
0.6 R , where R is the radius of the propeller.
(2) The test samples are not to be detached from the casting until the final heat treatment has been
carried out. Removal is to be by non-thermal procedures.
(3) Separately cast test samples may be used subject to prior approval of the Society. The test sam-
ples are to be cast from the same heat as the castings represented and heat treated with the
castings represented.
(4) At least one set of mechanical tests is to be made on material representing each casting.
However, where a number of small propellers of about the same size, and less than 1 m in di-
ameter, are made from one cast and heat treated in the same furnace charge, a batch testing
procedure may be adopted using separately cast test samples of suitable dimensions. At least

70 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

one set of mechanical tests is to be provided for each multiple of five castings in the batch.
7. Surface and dimension inspection
(1) Steel propeller castings are to be subjected to the surface inspection by the Society at the final
process and other proper processing stages if necessary. The surveyor may require areas to be
etched for the purpose of investigating weld repairs.
(2) Steel propeller castings are to be free from cracks, hot tears or other imperfections which, due
to their nature, degree or extent, will interfere with the use of the castings.
(3) The dimensions are the responsibility of the manufacturer and the report on the dimensional in-
spection is to be handed over to the Surveyor, who may require checks to be made in his
presence.
8. Non-destructive inspection
(1) The important parts of steel propeller casting are to be subjected to the liquid penetrant test in
accordance with the Guidance relating to Rules specified by the Society.
(2) The division of severity zones of steel propeller casting is to be in accordance with the
Guidance relating to Rules specified by the Society.
(3) Where serious doubt exists that the castings are not free from internal defects, further non-de-
structive inspections are to be carried out upon request of the Surveyor, e.g. radiographic and/or
ultrasonic tests. The acceptance criteria are then to be agreed between the manufacturer and the
Society.
(4) The foundry is to maintain records of inspections traceable to each propeller casting. These re-
cords are to be reviewed by the Surveyor. The foundry is also to provide the Surveyor with a
statement confirming that non-destructive tests have been carried out with satisfactory results.
9. Repair of defects
(1) In general the repairs are to be carried out by mechanical means, e.g. by grinding or milling.
Where the steel propeller castings from which defects where removed are used in that condition,
the steel propeller castings are to be approved by the Surveyor.
(2) The resulting grooves are to be blended into the surrounding surface so as to avoid any sharp
contours. Complete elimination of the defective material is to be verified by liquid penetrant
testing.
(3) Weld repairs are to be undertaken only when they are considered to be necessary and have pri-
2
or approval of the Surveyor. Welds having an area less than 5 cm are to be avoided.
(4) The repair welding procedures are to have prior approval of the Surveyor in accordance with
the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(5) All weld repairs are to be documented by means of sketches or photographs showing the loca-
tion and major dimensions of the grooves prepared for welding. The documentation is to be
presented to the Surveyor prior to repair welding.
10. Retest procedure
Where the results of tensile tests fail to meet the requirements, additional test may be carried out
in accordance with the requirements of 109.
11. Marking
Steel propeller castings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked
with the identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

506. Grey iron castings


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the grey iron castings (hereinafter referred to as "iron cast-
ings") intended to be used for propeller or important parts of machinery.
(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, KS or equivalent thereto may be applied.
(3) Where small castings are produced in large quantities, the manufacturer may adopt alternative
procedures for testing and inspection subject to the approval of the Society.
2. Manufacture
(1) The manufacturer has the necessary manufacturing and testing facilities and the manufacturing
processes are to be approved by the Society.
(2) Suitable mechanical methods are to be employed for the removal of surplus material from

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 71


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

castings. Thermal cutting processes are not acceptable, except as a preliminary operation to me-
chanical methods.
(3) Where castings of the same type are regularly produced in quantity, the manufacturer, subject to
the approval of the Society, is to make any tests necessary to prove the quality of the proto-
type castings and is also to make periodical examinations to verify the continued efficiency of
the manufacturing technique. The Surveyor is to be given the opportunity to witness these tests.
3. Grade and mechanical properties
Grey iron castings are to comply with the KS D 4301. However, the minimum tensile strength is
to be not less than 200 Nmm 
4. Chemical composition
(1) The chemical composition of the iron used is left to the discretion of the manufacturer, who is
to ensure that it is suitable to obtain the mechanical properties specified for the castings.
(2) When required by the Societies the chemical composition of ladle samples is to be reported.
5. Heat treatment
(1) Except as required by (2) castings may be supplied in either the as cast or heat treated
condition.
(2) For some applications, such as high temperature service or where dimensional stability is im-
portant, castings may require to be given a suitable tempering or stress relieving heat treatment
6. Selection of test samples and specimens
(1) Test material sufficient for the required tests and for possible re-tests is to be provided for each
casting or batch of castings.
(2) Separately cast test samples are to be used in principle and are to be cast from the same ladle
as the castings in moulds of the same type of material as the moulds for the castings
(3) Test samples are to be in the form of bars 30 mm in diameter and of a suitable length.
(4) When two or more test samples are cast simultaneously in a single mould, the bars are to be
at least 50 mm apart as given in Fig 2.1.13.

Fig 2.1.13 Sample distance

(5) Cast test samples are not to be stripped from the moulds until the metal temperature is below
500°C.
(6) Integrally cast samples may be used when a casting is more than 20 mm thick and its mass ex-
ceeds 200 Kg, subject to agreement between the manufacturer and the purchaser. The type and
location of the sample are to be selected to provide approximately the same cooling conditions
as for the casting it represents and also subject to agreement.
(7) The numbers of test specimen are as below:
(a) With the exception of (d) below, at least one test sample is to be cast with each batch.
(b) With the exception of (c) below, a batch consists of the castings poured from a single ladle
of metal, provided that they are all of similar type and dimensions. A batch should not nor-
mally exceed two tonnes of fettled castings and a single casting will constitute a batch is
its mass is 2 tonnes or more.
(c) For continuous melting of the same grade of cast iron in large tonnages the mass of a

72 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

batch may be increased to the output of 2 hours of pouring.


(d) If one grade of cast iron is melted in large quantities and if production is carefully moni-
tored by systematic checking of the melting process, such as chill testing, chemical analysis
or thermal analysis, test samples may be taken at longer intervals.
(8) All test samples are to be suitably marked to identify them with the castings which they
represent.
(9) Where castings are supplied in the heat treated condition, the test samples are to be heat treated
together with the castings which they represent. For cast-on-test samples the sample shall not be
cut off from the casting until after the heat treatment.
(10) One tensile test specimen is to be prepared from each test sample. Where test samples of oth-
er dimensions are specially required the tensile test specimens are to be machined to agreed
dimensions.
(11) All tensile tests are to be carried out using test procedures in accordance with the require-
ments specified in 203. 1.
7. Test and inspection
(1) All castings are to be cleaned and adequately prepared for examination. The surfaces are not to
be hammered, peened or treated in any way which may obscure defects.
(2) For grey iron castings, testing and inspection may not require the presence of the Society's sur-
veyors, except where specially specified in connection with the design.
(3) For the steel propeller castings and spheroidal iron castings, testing and inspection may require
the presence of the Society"s surveyor.
(4) When required by the relevant construction Rules, castings are to be pressure tested before final
acceptance.
(5) Unless otherwise agreed, the verification of dimensions is the responsibility of the manufacturer.
(6) Supplementary examination of castings by suitable nondestructive testing procedures is generally
not required except in circumstances where there is reason to suspect the soundness of the
casting.
8. Rectification of defective casting
(1) At the discretion of the Surveyor, small surface blemishes may be removed by local grinding.
(2) Subject to the prior approval of the Surveyor, castings containing local porosity may be rectified
by impregnation with a suitable plastic filler, provided that the extent of the porosity is such
that it does not adversely affect the strength of the casting.
(3) Repairs by welding are generally not permitted.
9. Retest procedure Where the tensile test fails to meet the requirements, additional test may be
carried out in accordance with the requirements of 109.
10. Marking Grey iron castings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be
marked with the identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

507. Spheroidal or nodular graphite iron castings


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the Spheroidal or nodular graphite iron castings (hereinafter
referred to as "iron castings") intended to be used for propeller or important parts of machinery.
(2) These requirements are applicable only to castings where the design and acceptance tests are re-
lated to mechanical properties at ambient temperature. For other applications additional require-
ments may be necessary, especially when the castings are intended for service at low or ele-
vated temperatures.
(3) Where deemed necessary by the Society, KS or equivalent thereto may be applied.
(4) Where small castings are produced in large quantities, the manufacturer may adopt alternative
procedures for testing and inspection subject to the approval of the Society.
2. Manufacture
(1) The manufacturer has the necessary manufacturing and testing facilities and the manufacturing
processes are to be approved by the Society.
(2) Suitable mechanical methods are to be employed for the removal of surplus material from
castings. Thermal cutting processes are not acceptable, except as a preliminary operation to me-

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 73


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

chanical methods.
(3) Where castings of the same type are regularly produced in quantity, the manufacturer, subject to
the approval of the Society, is to make any tests necessary to prove the quality of the proto-
type castings and is also to make periodical examinations to verify the continued efficiency of
the manufacturing technique. The Surveyor is to be given the opportunity to witness these tests.
3. Grade and mechanical properties Grade and mechanical properties of castings are to be as
specified in Table 2.1.77. However, Brinell hardness values are intended for information purposes
only.

Table 2.1.77 Grade and mechanical properties

Specified min. 0.2% proof Elongation Brinell Impact energy Typical


tensile strength stress (%) hardness Test kV (2) structure
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) 
 values temp.(℃) (J) min of matrix

370 min. 230 min. 17 min. 120-180 - - Ferrite


400 min. 250 min. 12 min. 140-200 - - Ferrite
Ordinary 500 min. 320 min. 7 min. 170-240 - - Ferrite/Perlite
qualities 600 min. 370 min. 3 min. 190-270 - - Ferrite/Perlite
700 min. 420 min. 2 min. 230-300 - - Perlite
800 min. 480 min. 2 min. 250-350 - - Perlite or Tempered
(3)
Special 350 min. 220 min. 22 min. 110-170 +20 17(14) Ferrite
qualities 400 min. 250 min. 18 min.(3) 140-200 +20 14(11) Ferrite

NOTE
1. For intermediate values of specified minimum tensile strength, the minimum values for 0,2 % proof
and elongation may be obtained by interpolation.
2. The average value measured on 3 Charpy V-notch specimens. One result may be below the average
value but not less than the minimum shown in brackets.
3. In the case of integrally cast samples, the elongation may be 2 percentage points less.

4. Chemical composition
(1) The chemical composition of the iron used is left to the discretion of the manufacturer, who is
to ensure that it is suitable to obtain the mechanical properties specified for the castings.
(2) When required by the Societies the chemical composition of ladle samples is to be reported.
5. Heat treatment
(1) Except as required by (2) castings may be supplied in either the as cast or heat treated
condition.
(2) For some applications, such as high temperature service or where dimensional stability is im-
portant, castings may require to be given a suitable tempering or stress relieving heat treatment
(3) Heat treatment is to be carried out after any refining heat treatment and before machining. The
special qualities with 350 Nmm  and 400 Nmm  nominal tensile strength and impact test shall
undergo a ferritizing heat treatment.
(4) Where it is proposed to locally harden the surfaces of a spheroidal iron castings full details of
the proposed procedure and specification are to be submitted for approval by the Society.
6. Selection of test samples and specimens
(1) Test material sufficient for the required tests and for possible re-tests is to be provided for each
casting or batch of castings.
(2) The test samples are generally to be one of the standard types detailed in Figs 2.1.14, 2.1.15
and 2.1.16 with a thickness of 25 mm. Test samples of other dimensions, as detailed in Figs
2.1.14 or 2.1.16 may, however, be specially required for some components.
(3) At least one test sample is to be provided for each casting and unless otherwise required may
be either gated to the casting or separately cast. Alternatively test material of other suitable di-
mensions may be provided integral with the casting.
(4) Where separately cast test samples are used, they are to be cast in moulds made from the same

74 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

type of material as used for the castings and are to be taken towards the end of pouring of the
castings.
(5) The samples are not to be stripped from the moulds until the temperature is below 500°C.
(6) For large castings where more than one ladle of treated metal is used, additional test samples
are to be provided so as to be representative of each ladle used.
(7) As an alternative to (3) above, a batch testing procedure may be adopted for castings with a
fettled mass of 1 tonne or less. All castings in a batch are to be of similar type and di-
mensions, cast from the same ladle of treated metal. One separately cast test sample is to be
provided for each multiple of 2,0 tonnes of fettled castings in the batch.
(8) All test samples are to be suitably marked to identify them with the castings which they
represent.
(9) Where castings are supplied in the heat treated condition, the test samples are to be heat treated
together with the castings which they represent.
(10) One tensile test specimen is to be prepared from each test sample.
(11) All tensile tests are to be carried out using test procedures in accordance with the require-
ments specified in 203. 1. Unless otherwise agreed all tests are to be carried out in the pres-
ence of the Surveyors.
(12) Impact tests may additionally be required and in such cases a set of three test specimens of
agreed type is to be prepared from each sample. Where Charpy V-notch test specimens are
used, the dimensions and testing procedures are to be in accordance with the requirements
specified in 202. 3 and 203. 2.

Standard Alternative sample when specially required


sample Case 1 Case 2 Case 3
u(mm) 25 12 50 75
v(mm) 55 41 90 125
x(mm) 40 30 60 65
y(mm) 100 80 150 165
z To suit testing machine

Fig 2.1.14 U-type test sample

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 75


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Fig 2.1.15 Double U-type test sample

Standard Alternative sample when specially required


sample Case 1 Case 2 Case 3
u(mm) 25 12 50 75
v(mm) 55 40 100 125
x(mm) 40 25 50 65
y(mm) 140 135 150 175
z To suit testing machine

Fig 2.1.16 Y-type test sample

7. Test and inspection


(1) All castings are to be cleaned and adequately prepared for examination. The surfaces are not to
be hammered, peened or treated in any way which may obscure defects.
(2) Before acceptance, all castings are to be visually examined including, where applicable, the ex-
amination of internal surfaces. Unless otherwise agreed the verification of dimensions is the re-
sponsibility of the manufacturer.
(3) When required by the relevant construction Rules, castings are to be pressure tested before final
acceptance.
(4) Supplementary examination of castings by suitable nondestructive testing procedures is generally
not required except in circumstances where there is reason to suspect the soundness of the
casting. However, cast crankshaft are to be subjected to a magnetic particle inspection. Crack
like indications are not allowed.

76 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(5) For crankshafts the metallographic examination is to be carried out as followings;


(a) When required, a representative sample from each ladle of treated metal is to be prepared
for metallographic examination. These samples may conveniently be taken from the tensile
test specimens but alternative arrangements for the provision of the samples may be adopted
provided that they are taken from the ladle towards the end of the casting period.
(b) Examination of the samples is to show that at least 90 % of the graphite is in a dispersed
spheroidal or nodular form. Details of typical matrix structures are given in Table 2.1.77
and are intended for information purposes only.
8. Rectification of defective casting
(1) At the discretion of the Surveyor, small surface blemishes may be removed by local grinding.
(2) Subject to the prior approval of the Surveyor, castings containing local porosity may be rectified
by impregnation with a suitable plastic filler, provided that the extent of the porosity is such
that it does not adversely affect the strength of the casting.
(3) Repairs by welding are generally not permitted.
9. Retest procedure Where the tensile test fails to meet the requirements, additional test may be
carried out in accordance with the requirements of 109.

10. Marking Spheroidal iron castings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are
to be marked with the identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 77


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 6 Steel Forgings

601. Steel forgings


1. Application
(1) The requirements in 601. are to apply to the steel forgings(except those specified in 602., 603.
and 604.) intended to be used for the components of hull construction, equipments, and machi-
nery specified in each Part, and where relevant, these requirements are also applicable to materi-
al for forging stock and to rolled bars intended to be machined into components of simple
shape (hereinafter referred to as the "steel forgings").
(2) Steel forgings having characteristics differing from those specified in 601. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds The steel forgings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.81 and 2.1.82.
3. Manufacturing process
(1) Steel forgings are to be manufactured from the killed steel.
(2) Adequate discards are to be made from the top and bottom of each ingot to ensure freedom
from piping and harmful segregation in the finished forgings.
(3) Steel forgings are to be hot worked by press or hammer from ingots, blooms forged or rolled
from ingots or blooms made from ingots by a combination of rolling and forging.
(4) Steel forgings are to be gradually and uniformly hot worked and are to be brought as nearly as
possible to the finished shape and size. Where practicable, they are to be worked so as to
cause metal flow in the most favourable direction having regard to the mode of stressing in
service.
(5) The reduction ratio is to comply with the following;
(a) For components where the fibre deformation is mainly longitudinal; the total reduction ratio
is to be not less than those shown in Table 2.1.78.

Table 2.1.78 Reduction Ratio

Method of manufacture Description(1) Total reduction(2)(3)


Made directly from ingots or from L>D 3 : 1
forged blooms or billets L≤D 1.5 : 1
L>D 4 : 1
Made from rolled products
L≤D 2 : 1
NOTES:
(1) L and D are the length and diameter respectively of the part of the forging under
consideration.
(2) The reduction ratio is to be calculated with reference to the average cross-sectional
area of the ingot. Where an ingot is initially upset, this reference area may be tak-
en as the average cross-sectional area after this operation.
(3) For rolled bars used as a substitute for forgings the reduction ratio is to be not less
than 6:1.

(b) Disc type forgings such as gear wheels are made by upsetting
(i) The thickness of any part of the disc is to be not more than one half of the length of
the billet from which it was formed provided that this billet has received an initial
forging reduction of not less than 1.5:1.
(ii) Where the piece used has been cut directly from an ingot or where the billet has re-
ceived an initial reduction of less than 1.5:1, the thickness of any part of the disc is to
be not more than one third of the length of the original piece.
(6) The shaping of forgings or rolled slabs and billets by flame cutting, scarfing or arc-air gouging
is to be undertaken in accordance with recognized good practice and, unless otherwise approved,
is to be carried out before the final heat treatment. Preheating is to be employed when neces-
sitated by the composition and thickness of the steel. For certain components, subsequent ma-
chining of all flame cut surfaces may be required.

78 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(7) When two or more forgings are joined by welding to form a composite component, the pro-
posed welding procedure specification is to be submitted for approval to the Society. Welding
procedure qualification tests may be required.
4. Heat treatment
(1) Except as provided in (5), after completion of all hot working operations, forgings are to be
supplied in one of the conditions given in Table 2.1.79. to refine the grain structure and to
obtain the required mechanical properties. No annealed forging is to be removed from the fur-
nace until the temperature of the entire furnace charge has fallen to or below a temperature of
455°C. The tempering temperature is to be not less than 550℃.

Table 2.1.79 Heat Treatment

Kind Heat treatment

Annealed
Normalized
Carbon steels
Normalized and tempered
Quenched and tempered

Alloy steels Quenched and tempered

(2) Alternatively, alloy steel forgings may be supplied in the normalized and tempered condition, in
which case the specified mechanical properties are to be agreed with the Society.
(3) Steel forgings which are subjected to any hot work after heat treatment, are to be heat treated
again.
(4) If a forging is locally reheated or any straightening operation is performed after the final heat
treatment, consideration is to be given to a subsequent stress relieving heat treatment.
(5) Where induction hardening or nitriding is to be carried out, forgings are to be heat treated at
an appropriate stage to a condition suitable for this subsequent surface hardening.
(6) Where carburizing is to be carried out, forgings are to be heat treated at an appropriate stage
(generally either by full annealing or by normalizing and tempering) to a condition suitable for
subsequent machining and carburizing.
(7) Where it is intended to surface harden forgings, full details of the proposed procedure and spec-
ification are to be submitted for the approval of the Society. For the purposes of this approval,
the manufacture may be required to demonstrate by test that the proposed procedure gives a
uniform surface layer of the required hardness and depth and that it does not impair the sound-
ness and properties of the steel.
(8) Heat treatment is to be carried out in properly constructed furnaces which are efficiently main-
tained and have adequate means for control and recording of temperature. The furnace di-
mensions are to be such as to allow the whole furnace charge to be uniformly heated to the
necessary temperature. In the case of very large forgings alternative methods of heat treatment
will be specially considered by the Society.
Sufficient thermocouples are to be connected to the furnace charge to measure and record that
its temperature is adequately uniform unless the temperature uniformity of the furnace is verified
at regular intervals.
(9) The forge is to maintain records of heat treatment identifying the furnace used, furnace charge,
date, temperature and time at temperature. The records are to be presented to the surveyor on
request.
5. Chemical composition
(1) The chemical composition of steel forgings is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.80.
(2) The chemical composition of each heat is to be determined by the manufacturer on a sample
taken preferably during the pouring of the heat. When multi heats are tapped into a common
ladle, the ladle analysis shall apply.
(3) At the option of the manufacturer, suitable grain refining elements such as aluminium, niobium
or vanadium may be added. The content of such elements is to be reported in the ladle
analysis.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 79


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.80 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Steel type (3) Total
C Si Mn P S Cr Mo Ni Cu
residual
Hull and Carbon 0.23(1)(2) 0.45 0.30- 0.035 0.035 0.30(3) 0.15(3) 0.40(3) 0.30 0.85
General steel max. max. 1.50 max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
purpose
steel Low alloy (4) 0.45 (4) 0.035 0.035 (4) (4) (4) 0.30
(5)
-
forging steel max. max. max. max.
(1)
Carbon 0.65 0.45 0.30- 0.035 0.035 0.30(3) 0.15(3) 0.40(3) 0.30 0.85
Machinery steel max. max. 1.50 max. max. max. max. max. max. max.
steel
forging Low alloy 0.45 0.45 0.30- 0.035 0.035 0.40(7) 0.15(7) 0.40(7) 0.30
(6) -
steel max. max. 1.00 max. max. min. min. min. max.
NOTES :
(1) The carbon content of carbon steel forgings intended for welded construction is to be 0.23 % maximum. The
carbon content may be increased above this level provided that the carbon equivalent (Ceq) is not more than
0.41 %.
(2) The carbon content of carbon steel forgings not intended for welded construction may be 0.65 % maximum.
(3) Elements are considered as residual elements.
(4) Specification is to be submitted for approval.
(5) Rudder stocks and pintles should be of weldable quality.
(6) Where alloy steel forgings are intended for welded constructions, the proposed chemical composition is subject
to approval by the Society.
(7) One or more of the elements is to comply with the minimum content.

6. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel forgings are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.81. and 2.1.82.
(2) At the discretion of this Societies hardness tests may be required on the following: The results
of hardness tests are to be reported and, for information purposes, typical Brinell hardness val-
ues are given in Table 2.1.82.
(i) Gear forgings after completion of heat treatment and prior to machining the gear teeth. The
hardness is to be determined at four positions equally spaced around the circumference of
the surface where teeth will subsequently be cut. Where the finished diameter of the toothed
portion exceeds 2.5 m, the above number of test positions is to be increased to eight. Where
the width of a gear wheel rim forging exceeds 1.25 m, the hardness is to be determined at
eight positions at each end of the forging.
(ii) Small crankshaft and gear forgings which have been batch tested.
In such cases at least one hardness test is to be carried out on each forging.
(3) Hardness tests may also be required on forgings which have been induction hardened, nitrided
or carburized. For gear forgings these tests are to be carried out on the teeth after, where appli-
cable, they have been ground to the finished profile. The results of such tests are to comply
with the approved specifications.
7. Selection of test specimens
(1) Except as provided in (10) and (11), the test specimens for steel forgings are, after final heat
treatment, to be taken lengthwise from prolongations or through bolt holes having a sectional
area not less than that of the body of forging. Where batch testing is permitted according to
(10), the test material may alternatively be a production part or separately forged. Separately
forged test material is to have a reduction ratio similar to that used for the forgings represented.
(2) "One set of test specimens" is to consist of one tensile test specimen and when required, three
charpy-V notch impact test specimen.

80 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.81 Kinds and Mechanical Properties for Hull Steel Forgings

Tensile test

Elongation(%)
Reduction of area(%)
Steel type grades Tensile strength Yield strength (   
)
(minimum)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (minimum)

L T L T

RSF 400H 400 min. 200 min. 26 19 50 35

RSF 440H 440 min. 220 min. 24 18 50 35

Carbon steel RSF 480H 480 min. 240 min. 22 16 45 30


forgings RSF 520H 520 min. 260 min. 21 15 45 30

RSF 560H 560 min. 280 min. 20 14 40 27

RSF 600H 600 min. 300 min. 18 13 40 27

RSF 550AH 550 min. 350 min. 20 14 50 35


Low alloy steel
RSF 600AH 600 min. 400 min. 18 13 50 35
forgings
RSF 650AH 650 min. 450 min. 17 12 50 35

Notes ;
(1) Where it is proposed to use a steel with a specified minimum tensile strength intermediate to those given,
corresponding minimum values for the other properties may be obtained by interpolation and the value at
the first decimal place is to be subjected to the method of counting fractions over 1/2 as one and dis-
regarding the rest.
(2) For the upper limit of tensile strength, the following ranges for tensile strength may be additionally speci-
fied:

Specified minimum tensile strength (Nmm  ) Range of upper limit(Nmm  )


< 600 120
≥ 600 150

(3) In the case of large forgings requiring two tension tests, the range of tensile strength is not to exceed 70
Nmm 
(4) L (or T) denotes that the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is arranged parallel (or tangential) to the
direction of forging.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 81


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.82 Kinds and mechanical properties for machinery steel forgings

Tensile test Hardness test


Elongation() Reduction of
Tensile Yield
Steel type Grades (   
) area() Hardness
strength strength (minimum) (minimum) (HB)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
L T L T
RSF 400M 400 min. 200 min. 26 19 50 35 110 - 150
RSF 440M 440 min. 220 min. 24 18 50 35 125 - 160
RSF 480M 480 min. 240 min. 22 16 45 30 135 - 175
RSF 520M 520 min. 260 min. 21 15 45 30 150 - 185
Carbon RSF 560M 560 min. 280 min. 20 14 40 27 160 - 200
steel
forgings RSF 600M 600 min. 300 min. 18 13 40 27 175 - 215
RSF 640M 640 min. 320 min. 17 12 35 27 185 - 230
RSF 680M 680 min. 340 min. 16 12 35 24 200 - 240
RSF 720M 720 min. 360 min. 15 11 35 24 210 - 250
RSF 760M 760 min. 380 min. 14 10 35 24 225 - 265
RSF 600AM 600 min. 360 min. 18 14 50 35 175 - 215
RSF 700AM 700 min. 420 min. 16 12 45 30 205 - 245
Low alloy RSF 800AM 800 min. 480 min. 14 10 40 27 235 - 275
steel
forgings RSF 900AM 900 min. 630 min. 13 9 40 27 260 - 320
RSF 1000AM 1000 min. 700 min. 12 8 35 24 290 - 365
RSF 1100AM 1100 min. 770 min. 11 7 35 24 320 - 385
NOTES :
(1) Where it is proposed to use a steel with a specified minimum tensile strength intermediate to those giv-
en, corresponding minimum values for the other properties may be obtained by interpolation and the val-
ue at the first decimal place is to be subjected to the method of counting fractions over 1/2 as one
and disregarding the rest.
(2) For the upper limit of tensile strength, the following ranges for tensile strength may be additionally
specified:

Specified minimum tensile strength (Nmm  ) Range of upper limit (Nmm  )


< 900 150
≥ 900 200
(3) L (or T) denotes that the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is arranged parallel (or tangential) to
the direction of forging.
(4) For propeller shafts intended for ships with ice class notation except the lowest one(Grade ID), Charpy
V-notch impact testing is to be carried out for all steel types at -10℃ and the average energy value is
to be minimum 27 J (longitudinal test). One individual value may be less than the required average val-
ue provided that it is not less than 70 % of this average value. and, The impact test for important
components for machinery is to be in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by
the Society.
(5) The hardness values are typical and are given for information purposes only.

82 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(3) Test specimens are normally to be cut with their axes either mainly parallel (longitudinal test)
or mainly tangential (tangential test) to the principal axial direction of each product.
(4) Unless otherwise agreed, the longitudinal axis of test specimens is to be positioned as follows.
However the axis of transverse specimens may be located close to the surface of the forgings
(a) for thickness or diameter up to maximum 50 mm, the axis of test specimens is to be at the
mid-thickness or the center of the cross section.
(b) for thickness or diameter greater than 50 mm, the axis is to be at one quarter thickness
(mid-radius) or 80 mm, whichever is less, below any heat treated surface.
(5) Except as provided in (10), the number and direction of tests is to be as given in (a) through
(h) of the following requirements:
(a) Hull components such as rudder stocks, pintles etc. General machinery components such as
shafting, connecting rods, etc. : One set of tests is to be taken from the end of each forg-
ing in a longitudinal direction except that, at the discretion of the manufacture, the alter-
native directions or positions as shown in Fig 2.1.17., Fig 2.1.18. and Fig 2.1.19 may be
used. Where a forging exceeds both 4 tonnes in mass and 3 m in length, one set of tests is
to be taken from each end.

Fig 2.1.17 Plain shaft

Fig 2.1.18 Flanged shaft

Fig 2.1.19 Flanged shaft with collar

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 83


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(b) Pinions : Where the finished machined diameter of the toothed portion exceeds 200 mm one
set of tests is to be taken from each forging in a tangential direction adjacent to the tooth-
ed portion (test position B in Fig 2.1.20) Where the dimensions preclude the preparation of
tests from this position, tests in a tangential direction are to be taken from the end of the
journal (test position C in Fig 2.1.20). If however, the journal diameter is 200 mm or less
the tests are to be taken in a longitudinal direction (test position A in Fig 2.1.20). Where
the finished length of the toothed portion exceed 1.25 m, one set of tests is to be taken
from each end.

Fig 2.1.20 Pinion

(c) Small pinions : Where the finished diameter of the toothed portion is 200 mm or less one
set of tests is to be taken in a longitudinal direction (test position A in Fig 2.1.20).
(d) Gear wheels : One set of tests is to be taken from each forging in a tangential direction
(test position A or B in Fig 2.1.21).

Fig 2.1.21 Gear wheel

(e) Rims intended for reduction gears and for cam shaft driving gears of diesel engine (see Pt
5, Ch 2 201.1) are to comply with the following requirements.
(i) Where the finished diameter exceeds 2.5 m or the mass (as heat treated excluding test
material) exceeds 3 tonnes, two sets of tests are to be taken from diametrically opposite
positions (test positions A and B in Fig 2.1.22). The mechanical properties for longi-
tudinal test are to be applied.

Fig 2.1.22 Gear rim (made by expanding)

84 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(ii) Where the weight and finished diameter are different from those given in (a), one set
of test specimens may be taken from one end of the rim.
(f) Pinion sleeves : One set of tests is to be taken from each forging in a tangential direction
(test position A or B in Fig 2.1.23). Where the finished length exceeds 1.25 m one set of
tests is to be taken from each end.

Fig 2.1.23 Pinion sleeve

(g) Crankwebs : One set of tests is to be taken from each forging in a tangential direction.
(h) Solid open die forged crankshafts : One set of tests is to be taken in a longitudinal direc-
tion from the driving shaft end of each forging (test position A in Fig 2.1.24). Where the
mass (as heat treated but excluding test material) exceeds 3 tonnes tests in a longitudinal
direction are to be taken from each end (test positions A and B in Fig 2.1.24). Where,
however, the crankthrows are formed by machining or flame cutting, the second set of tests
is to be taken in a tangential direction from material removed from the crankthrow at the
end opposite the driving shaft end (test position C in Fig 2.1.24).

Fig 2.1.24 Solid forged crankshaft

(6) For closed die crankshaft forgings and crankshaft forgings where the method of manufacture has
been approved by the Society, the number and position of test specimens is to be agreed with
the Society having regard to the method of manufacture employed.
(7) When a forging is subsequently divided into a number of components, all of which are heat
treated together in the same furnace charge, for test purposes this may be regarded as one forg-
ing and the number of tests required is to be related to the total length and mass of the origi-
nal multiple forging.
(8) The test specimens are not to be separated from the body before the final heat treatment has
been completed. In the case of stamp forging or other case of forging requiring the surface
hardening process, the test specimens may be prepared at a proper stage before the final heat
treatment providing that such is approved by the Surveyor.
(9) When forgings are to be carburized, sufficient test material is to be provided for both prelimi-
nary tests at the forge and for final tests after completion of carburizing. For this purpose du-
plicate sets of test material are to be taken from positions as detailed in (5) except that irre-
spective of the dimensions or mass of the forging, tests are required from one position only
and, in the case of forgings with integral journals, are to be cut in a longitudinal direction.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 85


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

This test material is to be machined to a diameter of D/4 or 60 mm, whichever is less, where
D is the finished diameter of the toothed portion. For preliminary tests at the forge one set of
test material is to be given a blank carburizing and heat treatment cycle simulating that which
subsequently will be applied to the forging. For final acceptance tests, the second set of test
material is to be blank carburized and heat treated along with the forgings which they represent.
At the discretion of the forgemaster or gear manufacture test samples of larger cross section
may be either carburized or blank carburized, but these are to be machined to the required di-
ameter prior to the final quenching and tempering heat treatment. Alternative procedures for test-
ing of forgings which are to be carburized may be specially agreed with the Society.
(10) Normalized forgings with mass up to 1000 kg each and quenched and tempered forgings with
mass up to 500 kg each may be batch tested. A batch is to consist of forgings of similar shape
and dimensions, made from the same heat of steel, heat treated in the same furnace charge and
with a total mass not exceeding 6 tonnes for normalized forgings and 3 tonnes for quenched
and tempered forgings, respectively.
(11) A batch testing procedure may also be used for hot rolled bars. A batch is to consist of ei-
ther:
(i) material from the same rolled ingot or bloom provided that where this is cut into individual
lengths, these are all heat treated in the same furnace charge, or
(ii) bars of the same diameter and heat, heat treated in the same furnace charge and with a to-
tal mass not exceeding 2.5 tonnes.
8. Surface inspection
(1) When heat treatment and final machining are completed and, if necessary, at a proper time dur-
ing machining, surface inspection is to be carried out. Where applicable, this is to include the
examination of internal surfaces and bores. Testing methods and acceptance criteria are to be in
accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(2) Dimension inspection of the steel forgings is to be conducted under the responsibility of the
manufacturer, unless otherwise specified.
9. Quality
(1) Steel forgings are to be free from surface or internal defects which would be prejudicial to their
proper application in service.
(2) When required by the conditions of approval for surface hardened forgings referred in 4 (7), ad-
ditional test samples are to be processed at the same time as the forgings which they represent.
These test samples are subsequently to be sectioned in order to determine the hardness, shape
and depth of the locally hardened zone and which are to comply with the requirements of the
approved specification.
(3) In the event of any forging proving defective during subsequent machining or testing, it is to
be rejected notwithstanding any previous certification.
10. Non-destructive inspection
(1) The following steel forgings are to be subjected to ultrasonic test at an appropriate stage of the
manufacturing process and the test reports are to be showed or submitted to the Surveyor.
Testing methods and acceptance criteria are to be in accordance with the Guidance relating to
the Rules specified by the Society.
(a) Rudder stock and pintle.
(b) Steel forgings given in Pt 5, Ch 2, 201.1.
(c) Thrust shafts, intermediate shafts and propeller shafts.
(d) Reduction gears and reduction gear shafts.
(e) Turbine rotors, turbine discs and turbine blades.
(2) The important parts of the following steel forgings are to be subjected to magnetic particle or
liquid penetrant test at an appropriate stage of the manufacturing process. Testing methods and
acceptance criteria are to be in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by
the Society.
(a) Steel forgings given in Pt 5, Ch 2, 201.1.
(b) Propeller shafts.
(c) Reduction gears.
(d) Turbine rotors, turbine discs and turbine blades.
(3) The Society may require sulphur print test for the portion of gear teeth.

86 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(4) In place of the test methods given above, the Society may accept the application of other
non-destructive inspections considered adequate by the Society.
(5) The Society may require non-destructive inspection or the steel other than those specified in (1)
and (2) when such is deemed necessary by the Society.
(6) The welded parts of steel forgings used for welded construction are to be subjected to the
non-destructive inspections considered adequate by the Society.
11. Repair of defects
(1) Defects may be removed by grinding or chipping and grinding provided the component di-
mensions are acceptable.
(2) After removing the defects, adequate non-destructive inspections are to be carried out to ensure
that all defects have been completely removed.
(3) The resulting grooves are to have a bottom radius of approximately three times the groove
depth and are to be blended into the surrounding surface so as to avoid any sharp contours.
Where the forgings from which defects where removed are used in that condition, the forgings
are to be approved by the Surveyor.
(4) Repair welding of forgings except crankshaft forgings may be permitted subject to prior appro-
val of the Society. In such cases, full details of the extent and location of the repair, the pro-
posed welding procedure, heat treatment and subsequent inspection procedures are to be sub-
mitted for the approval.
(5) The manufacturer is to maintain full records detailing the extent and location of repairs made to
each forging and details of weld procedures and heat treatments applied for repairs. These re-
cords are to be available to the Surveyor and copies provided on request.
12. Retest procedures
(1) Where the tensile test or hardness test fails to meet the requirements, additional test may be
carried out in accordance with the requirements of 109.
(2) Regarding the impact tests, additional tests are to be carried out according to the requirements
given in 301. 10 (3).
(3) The additional tests are to be taken, preferably from material adjacent to the original tests, but
alternatively from another test position or sample representative of the forging or batch of
forgings.
(4) At the option of the manufacturer, when a forging or a batch of forgings has failed to meet the
test requirements, it may be reheat treated and re-submitted for acceptance tests.
13. Marking
(1) Steel forgings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with
the identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.
(2) For steel forgings to which the requirements given in note 1. of the Table 2.1.81 and Table
2.1.82 applied, the material symbols are specified as RSF - (or RSF - A ) and the specified ten-
sile strength is to be filled in symbol " - ". (e.g. For Hull and General purpose steel forging
which the specified tensile strength is 420 Nmm  : RSF 420H)
(3) Where carbon steel forgings are intended for welded construction specified in Note (1) of Table
2.1.80, "W" is to be suffixed to the marking. (e.g. RSF 440H-W, RSF 440M-W)
(4) The grade of Steel bars is to be indicated by suffixing a letter "B" to the symbol "RSF ". (e.g.
For Machinery steel forging which the specified tensile strength is 440 Nmm  : RSFB 440M)
14. Additional requirements for crank shafts
(1) Where solid crank shafts of 250 mm and over in finished diameter are manufactured by free
forging, the heat treatment is normally to be carried out after crank parts are machined as near-
ly as possible to the finished shape.
(2) Where solid crank shafts, semibuilt-up crank throws and full built up crank arms are manufac-
tured by special manufacturing processes, the preliminary tests instructed by the Society are to
be carried out, in connection with the manufacturing processes and the selection of test
specimens.
(3) Where special manufacturing processes are adopted to reduce the size of crank shaft (refer to
the requirements in Pt 5, Ch, 208. the preliminary tests instructed by the Society are to be
carried out.
15. Additional requirements for turbine rotors
(1) The test specimens for turbine rotors are to be taken in accordance with the following require-
ments:

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 87


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(a) Where the turbine rotor is greater than 3 tons in weight, one set of longitudinal test speci-
mens is to be taken from each end of the shaft portion and one set of transverse test speci-
mens from the body portion respectively. (See Fig 2.1.25)
(b) Where the turbine rotor is not exceeding 3 tons in weight, one set of longitudinal test
specimens is to be taken from one end of the shaft portion and one set of transverse test
specimens from the body portion respectively.
(2) For each turbine disc, one set of transverse test specimens is to be taken from the boss portion.
(See Fig 2.1.26)

Fig 2.1.25 Selection of test specimen for turbine rotor

Note: One set of test specimens may


be taken from one location
given in the Figure.

Fig 2.1.26 Selection of test specimen for turbine disc

(3) Solid forged turbine rotors intended for main propulsion service where the inlet steam temper-
ature exceeds 400℃ are to be subjected to stability tests at least once at a suitable time after
rough machining or heat treatment. This requirement is also applicable to rotors fabricated by
welding. The method of stability test is to be approved by the Society prior to the test.
16. Additional requirements for turbine blades Turbine blades are to be tested in accordance
with the approved test specification.

602. Stainless steel forgings


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the stainless steel forgings for valves and pipe fittings in pip-
ing systems used at low temperature (-165℃ and over in design temperature) service or corro-
sion-resisting service (hereinafter referred to as "steel forgings").
(2) Steel forgings having characteristics differing from those specified in 602. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds Steel forgings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.83.
3. Heat treatment
Steel forgings are generally to receive a solid solution treatment.
4. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of steel forgings is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.83.

88 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.83 Grade and Chemical Composition


Chemical composition (%)
Grade
C Si Mn P S Cr Ni Others

RSSF 304 0.08 max.


18.00~20.00 8.00~12.00
RSSF 304L 0.030 max.
-
RSSF 309S 22.00~24.00 12.00~15.00
RSSF 310S 0.08 max. 24.00~26.00 19.00~22.00
1.00 2.00 0.040 0.030
RSSF 316 Mo 2.00~3.00
max. max. max. max. 16.00~18.00 10.00~14.00
RSSF 316L 0.030 max. Mo 2.00~3.00
RSSF 317 18.00~20.00 10.00~15.00 Mo 3.00~4.00
RSSF 321 0.08 max. 9.00~12.00 Ti≥5×C
17.00~19.00
RSSF 347 9.00~13.00 Nb+Ta≥10×C

5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel forgings are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.84.
(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, impact test or corrosion resistance test may be re-
quired in addition to the specified tests.

Table 2.1.84 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test
Grade Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation() Reduction of area
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
) ()

RSSF 304L, RSSF 316L 175 min. 450 min. 37 min. 50 min.

Other forgings 205 min. 520 min. 37 min. 50 min.

6. Selection of the specimens


(1) The number of tensile test specimens is to be in accordance with the requirements in 601. 7.
(2) Tensile test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axes parallel to the direction of
forging, unless otherwise specially provided by the Society.
(3) Where tests are made in accordance with the requirements in 601. 7 (5), (c) and (d), the
Surveyor may require hardness test for each forging.
7. Marking
Steel forgings which have satisfactorily complied with the required test are to be marked with the
identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

603. Steel forgings for chains


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the steel forgings used for anchor chain cables and accesso-
ries specified in Pt 4, Ch 8 (hereinafter referred to as "steel forgings").
(2) Steel forgings for manufacture of offshore mooring chain accessories are to be in accordance
with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
(3) Steel forgings having characteristics differing from those specified in (1) are to comply with the
requirements in 101. 2.
(4) In addition to the requirements given in 603., general requirements may be considered by the
Society.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 89


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

2. Kinds
The steel forgings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.85.

Table 2.1.85 Grades of Steel Forgings


Grade Application
Steel forging for Grade 2 chain RSFC 50 Grade 2 chain
Steel forging for Grade 3 chain RSFC 70 Grade 3 chain

3. Heat treatment
The steel forgings are to be normalized, normalized and tempered, quenched and tempered or heat
treated by the process approved by the Society.
4. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of each grade are to comply with the require-
ments given in Table 2.1.86. Elements other than specified in Table 2.1.86 may be added sub-
ject to a special approval by the Society.

Table 2.1.86 Deoxidation Practice and Chemical Composition (%)

(1)
Grade Deoxidation C Si Mn P S Al

RSFC 50 Fine-grained 0.24 max. 0.15~0.55 1.60 max. 0.035 max. 0.035 max. 0.020 min.
RSFC 70 killed 0.36 max. 0.15~0.55 1.00~1.90 0.035 max. 0.035 max. 0.020 min.
NOTE:
(1) Al content is to be represented by the total Al content and may be replaced partly by other fine grain-
ing elements.

5. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of each grade are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.87.

Table 2.1.87 Mechanical Properties


(1)
Tensile test Impact test

Grade Tensile Elongation Average


Yield strength Reduction of Test temp.
strength (%) abs-orbed
(Nmm  ) (2) area (%) (℃)
(Nmm  ) (2)
(   ) energy(J)

RSFC 50 295 min. 490~690 22 min. - - -


RSFC 70 410 min. 690 min. 17 min. 40 min. 0 60 min.
NOTE:
(1) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in val-
ue than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is
less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.

6. Selection of test specimens


(1) One test sample is to be selected from each lot of every 25 steel forgings or fraction thereof,
which belong to the same heat. In case of steel forgings having small diameter, the number of
test samples may be reduced subject to approval of the Society. Where specially approved by

90 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

the Society, the test sample may be taken from the representative part of the steel forging at a
proper time during manufacturing, or a separate sample forged to the forge ratio equivalent to
that of the steel forgings. In this case, the test sample is to be heat treated simultaneously
with the steel forgings.
(2) For Grade 1 and Grade 2 chain bars, one tensile test specimen is to be taken from the test
sample; for Grade 3 chain bars, one tensile test specimen and one set (3 pieces) of impact test
specimens are to be taken from the test sample.
(3) The tensile and impact test specimens are to be taken from the test sample in the direction of
forging at a depth of 1/6 diameter from the surface or as close as possible to this position.
(see Fig 2.1.5)
7. Surface inspection
Surface inspection for all grades is to be carried out and it is to be confirmed that there are no
harmful defects.
8. Retest procedure
Where the tensile test or impact test on the selected first test specimens fails to meet the require-
ments, additional tests may be carried out according to the requirements given in 306. 9.
9. Marking
Steel forgings which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests are to be marked with the
identification mark in accordance with the requirement in 110.

604. Steel forgings for low temperature service


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the steel forgings for valves and pipe fittings in piping sys-
tems intended to be used at the design temperature lower than 0℃ in liquefied gas carriers
(hereinafter referred to as "steel forgings").
(2) Steel forgings other than those specified in 604. are to comply with the requirements given in
101. 2.
2. Kinds The steel forgings are classified as given in Table 2.1.88.
3. Heat treatment
The steel forgings are to be normalized, normalized and tempered, quenched and tempered or dou-
ble normalized and tempered.
4. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
The deoxidation practice and chemical composition of each grade are to comply with the require-
ments given in Table 2.1.88.

Table 2.1.88 Grades and Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Grade Deoxidation
C Si Mn P S Ni Cr Cu Al
RLFA 0.23 max. 0.15~0.35 1.10 max.
- - - -
RLFB 0.20 max. 0.15~0.35 1.60 max.
Fully killed 0.030 0.030
RLFC 0.12 max. 0.10~0.35 0.55~1.00 0.50~0.95 0.50~0.95 0.40~0.75 0.04~0.30
fine grain max. max.
RLF 3 0.20 max. 0.15~0.35 0.90 max. 3.25~3.75
- - -
RLF 9 0.10 max. 0.10~0.35 0.90 max. 8.50~9.60

5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of steel forgings are to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.89.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 91


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, other tests may be required in addition to the tests
specified in (1).

Table 2.1.89 Mechanical Properties


(2)
Tensile test Impact test

Grade Tensile Average


Yield strength Elongation (%) Reduction of Test temp.
strength absorbed energy
(Nmm  ) (   
) area (%) (℃)
(Nmm  ) (J)

RLFA 205 min. 410 min. 23 min. -40(1)


RLFB 275 min. 490 min. 20 min. 40 min. -50(1) 27 min.
(1)
RLFC 205 min. 410 min. 23 min. -60
RLF 3 275 min. 490 min. 23 min. 50 min. -95 34 min.
RLF 9 520 min. 680 min. 19 min. 45 min. -196 41 min.
NOTES:
(1) Impact test temperature for steel forgings specified in Pt 7, Ch 5 is to be 5℃ below the design
temperature or -20℃, Whichever is the lower.
(2) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less
in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test
specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is consid-
ered to have failed.

6. Selection of tests specimens


(1) The number of test specimens is to be in accordance with the requirements specified in 601. 7.
(2) The test specimens for tensile and impact tests are to be cut with their longitudinal axes paral-
lel to the direction of forging except where otherwise specially specified.
(3) Where tests are made in accordance with the requirements in 601. 7 (5), (c) and (d), the
Surveyor may require a hardness test for each forging.
7. Retest procedures
(1) Where the tensile tests fail to meet the requirements, additional tests may be carried out accord-
ing to the requirements given in 109.
(2) Regarding the impact tests, additional tests are to be carried out according to the requirements
given in 304. 9.
8. Marking
Marking for steel castings is to comply with the requirements given in 601. 13. (1) and in case
the requirement in Note (1) of Table 2.1.89. has been applied, "impact test temperature T" is to
be suffixed to the marking (e.g. RLFA - 25T )

92 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 7 Copper and Copper Alloy

701. Copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes


1. Application
(1) The requirements are to apply to the copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes.
(2) Copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes are to comply with the requirements in KS D 5301 or
equivalent thereto.
(3) Copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes having characteristics differing from those specified in
701. are to comply with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
Copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes are classified as specified in Table 2.1.90.

Table 2.1.90 Kinds and Grades

Kinds Grades

Copper pipes Phosphorus deoxidized copper seamless pipes and


C 1201, C 1220
and tubes. tubes

Brass seamless pipes and tubes C 2600, C 2700, C 2800


Copper alloy
Brass seamless pipes and tubes for condenser C 4430, C 6870, C 6871, C 6872
pipes and tubes
Cupro-nickel seamless pipes and tubes for condenser C 7060, C 7100, C 7150

3. Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes are to comply with the re-
quirements given in Table 2.1.91.

Table 2.1.91 Mechanical Properties

Tensile test(1)
Kinds Grade
Tensile strength (Nmm  ) Elongation ()

Phosphorus deoxidized copper C 1201,


206 min. 40 min.
seamless pipes and tubes. C 1220
C 2600 275 min. 45 min.
Brass seamless pipes and tubes C 2700 294 min. 40 min.
C 2800 314 min. 35 min.
C 4430 314 min. 30 min.
Brass seamless pipes and tubes C 6870, 373 min.
(2)
40 min.
for condenser C 6871, (3)
C 6872 353 min. 40 min.

C 7060 275 min. 30 min.


Cupro-nickel seamless pipes and
C 7100 314 min. 30 min.
tubes for condenser
C 7150 363 min. 30 min.
NOTES :
(1) These properties are a measure of the mechanical quality of the metal in annealed condition.
(2) It is applicable to those having 5 mm and up to 50 mm in outside diameter.
(3) It is applicable to those having over 50 mm up to 200 mm in outside diameter.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 93


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

4. Testing and inspection


Testing and inspection of pipes and tubes are to com ply with the requirements specified in KS D
5301. Those subjected to the maximum working pressure not exceeding 1 M Pa may not require
the presence of the Society"s Surveyor.
5. Marking
Copper and copper alloy pipes and tubes which have satisfactorily complied with the required tests
are to be marked with the identification mark in accordance with the requirements in 110.

702. Copper alloy castings


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the copper alloy castings to be used for propellers and pro-
peller blades (hereinafter referred to as "propeller castings"). Also, upon special consideration of
the Society, these requirements may also be applied for the repair and inspection of propellers
becoming damaged during service.
(2) Copper alloy castings to be used for important parts differing from those specified in 702. are
to comply with the requirements of KS or equivalent thereto. The tests and inspections need in
general to be made in the presence of the Surveyor where special requirements are given in
connection with the design.
(3) Copper alloy castings characteristics differing from those specified in 702. are to comply with
the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds Propeller castings are classified as specified in Table 2.1.92.

Table 2.1.92 Kinds and Grades

Kinds Grade
High strength brass casting, Grade 1 CU 1
High strength brass casting, Grade 2 CU 2
Aluminium bronze casting, Grade 3 CU 3
Aluminium bronze casting, Grade 4 CU 4

3. Moulding and casting


(1) The pouring must be carried out into dried moulds using degassed liquid metal.
(2) The pouring is to be controlled as to avoid turbulences of flow. Special devices and/or proce-
dures must prevent slag flowing into the mould.
(3) Subsequent stress relieving heat treatment may be performed to reduce the residual stresses. For
this purpose, the manufacturer shall submit a specification containing the details of the heat
treatment to the Society for approval. The stress relieving temperatures and holding times should
be in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
4. Chemical composition
(1) The chemical composition of propeller castings is to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.1.93.

Table 2.1.93 Chemical Composition ()

Grade Cu Al Mn Zn Fe Sn Ni Pb
CU 1 52~62 0.5~3.0 0.5~4.0 35~40 0.5~2.5 0.1~1.5 1.0 max. 0.5 max.
CU 2 50~57 0.5~2.0 1.0~4.0 33~38 0.5~2.5 0.15 max. 3.0~8.0 0.5 max.
CU 3 77~82 7.0~11.0 0.5~4.0 1.0 max. 2.0~6.0 0.1 max. 3.0~6.0 0.03 max.
CU 4 70~80 6.5~9.0 8.0~20.0 6.0 max. 2.0~5.0 1.0 max. 1.5~3.0 0.05 max.

94 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) For CU 1 and CU 2, it is also to comply with the followings:


(a) The zinc equivalent as specified below is not to exceed 45 %

 ×  
Zinc equivalent =   
  

Where A : Sn + 5Al - 0.5M n - 0.1Fe - 2.3Ni (%)


(b) Each tensile test specimen is to be examined metalographically, and the proportion of al-
pha-phase determined from an average of five counts is not to be less than 25 %.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties of copper propeller casting are to comply with the requirements given
in Table 2.1.94.
However, the requirements specified in this Table apply to specimens cut from separately cast
samples, where specimens cut from propeller casting itself, the requirements are to be deemed
appropriate by the Society

Table 2.1.94 Mechanical Properties


(1)
Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation (%)
Grade
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   )

CU 1 175 min. 440 min. 20 min.


CU 2 175 min. 440 min. 20 min.
CU 3 245 min. 590 min. 16 min.
CU 4 275 min. 630 min. 18 min.
NOTE:
(1) Yield strength is measured as 0.2 % proof stress and is applicable to the case which is spe-
cially required considering the design by the Society.
(2) As for the materials of the propellers which used for the ship strengthened for navigation in
ice, the elongation of the materials used is not to be less than 19 % for R14A test specimen
specified in Pt 2, Ch 1 and absorbed energy for the Charpy V notch impact test is not to be
less than 21 J at -10°C

6. Selection of Test Samples and Specimens


(1) Generally, the specimens shall be taken from separately cast sample pieces. The test samples
shall be cast in moulds made of the same material as the mould for the propeller and they
must be cooled down under the same conditions as the propeller. If propellers are subjected to
a heat treatment, the test samples are to be heat treated together with them.
(2) The shapes and dimensions of the test samples are to comply with those given in Fig 2.1.27
The shape given by the dotted lines shown in the figure, however, may be acceptable.

Fig 2.1.27 shapes and dimensions of the Test Samples

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 95


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(3) One tensile test specimen is to be taken from each casting when integral test samples are pro-
vided and one tensile test specimen is to be taken from each ladle when separately-cast test
samples are provided.
(4) For determining the proportion of alpha phase of alloy types CU 1 and CU 2. at least one
specimen shall be taken from each heat. However tensile test specimen can be substitute for.
(5) When integral test samples are provided, the test samples shall be located on the blades in an
area lying between 0,5 to 0,6 R (where R is the radius of the propeller). The test sample mate-
rial must be removed from the casting by non thermal procedures.
7. Surface and dimension Inspection
(1) Propeller casting is to be subjected to a comprehensive visual inspection by the Surveyor at fi-
nal process and other proper processing stages if necessary.
(2) The dimensions are to be checked by the manufacturer and the report on the dimensional in-
spection is to be handed over to the Surveyor, who may require checks to be made in his
presence. Where straightening of a bent blade is carried out, the procedure for the straightening
is to be in accordance with the Guidance relating to Rules specified by the Society.
(3) The Surveyor may be require areas to be etched (e.g. by iron chloride) for the purpose of in-
vestigating weld repairs.
8. Quality
All castings must have a workman like finish and must be free from defects liable to impair their
use. Minor casting defects which may still be visible after machining such as small sand and slag
inclusions, small cold shuts and scabs shall be trimmed off by the manufacturer.
9. Non-destructive inspection
(1) The important parts of propeller castings are to be subjected to the liquid penetrant test in ac-
cordance with the Guidance relating to Rules specified by the Society.
(2) The division of severity zones of propeller casting is to be in accordance with the Guidance re-
lating to Rules specified by the Society.
(3) Where serious doubts exist that the castings are not free from internal defects, further non-
destructive inspections are to be carried out upon request of the Surveyor, e.g. radiographic
and/or ultrasonic tests. For this purpose, the acceptance criteria are to be agreed between the
manufacturer and the Society in accordance with a recognized standard.
(4) All defects requiring welding repair on the propeller castings are to be documented preferably
on drawings or special sketches showing their dimensions and locations. Furthermore, the in-
spection procedure is to be reported. The documentation is to be presented to the Surveyor prior
to any repair weldings will be carried out.
10. Repair of defects
(1) In the event of finding defects in the propeller castings, the defects may be removed by grind-
ing, etc. After removing the defects, liquid penetrant tests are to be carried out to ensure that
all defects have been completely removed.
(2) Where the propeller castings from which defects where removed are used in that condition or
after repaired by welding, the propeller castings are to be approved by the Surveyor.
(3) After weld repairs, the portions repaired by welding are to be subjected to the stress-relieving
treatments.
(4) It is to be confirmed that the portions repaired by welding are free from harmful defects by the
non-destructive inspections such as liquid penetrant test, etc.
(5) The repair welding procedures are to have prior approval of the Surveyor in accordance with
the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the Society.
11. Retest procedure
Where the results of tensile tests fail to meet the requirements, additional test may be carried out
in accordance with the requirements of 109.
12. Marking
(1) Prior to final inspection by the Surveyor each casting shall be marked by the manufacturer at
least with the following symbols:
(a) Grade of cast material or corresponding abbreviated designation
(b) Manufacturer’s mark

96 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(c) Heat number, casting number or another mark enabling the manufacturing process to be
traced back
(d) Specimen number
(e) Date of final inspection
(f) Number of the Society’s test certificate
(g) Ice class symbol, where applicable
(h) Skew angle for high skew propellers.
(i) Manufacturer's certificate
(2) For each propeller the manufacturer must supply to the Surveyor a certificate containing the fol-
lowing details:
(a) Purchaser and order number
(b) Shipbuilding project number, if known
(c) Description of the casting with drawing number
(d) Diameter, number of blades, pitch, direction of turning
(e) Grade of alloy and chemical composition of each heat
(f) Heat or casting number
(g) Final weight
(h) Results of non-destructive tests and details of test procedure where applicable
(i) Portion of alpha-structure for CU 1 and CU 2 alloys
(j) Results of the mechanical tests
(k) Casting identification No.
(l) Skew angle for high skew propellers

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 97


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 8 Aluminium Alloys

801. Aluminium alloys


1. Application
(1) These requirements are to apply to the aluminium alloy plates and extruded shapes(hereinafter
referred to as "aluminium alloys") intended to be used in the construction of hulls, super-
structures, other marine structures and tanks of liquefied gas carriers.
(2) Where aluminium alloys exceeding the maximum value of plate thickness or size specified in
Table 2.1.96 and Table 2.1.97. are manufactured, a new approval test is required by the
Society.
(3) Aluminium alloys having characteristics differing from those specified in 801. are to comply
with the requirements in 101. 2.
2. Kinds
The aluminium alloys are classified as specified in Table 2.1.95.

Table 2.1.95 Kinds

Product Grades Temper condition

Rolled 5000 series 5083P , 5086P , 5383P, 5059P , 5754P, 5456P O, H 112, H 116, H 321

Extruded 5000 series 5083S, 5383S, 5059S, 5086S O, H 111, H 112


Shapes 6000 series 6005AS(1), 6061S (1), 6082S T 5, T 6
NOTE :
(1) These alloy should not be used in direct contact with sea water unless protected by anodes and/or paint
system.

3. Chemical composition
The chemical composition of aluminium alloys is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.1.96.

Table 2.1.96 Chemical Composition


Chemical composition (  )
(1)
Grades Others
Si Fe Cu Mn Mg Cr Zn Ti Al
Each Total
5083P 0.40max. 0.40max. 0.10max. 0.40~1.0 4.0~4.9 0.05~0.25 0.25max. 0.15max. 0.05max. 0.15max.
5083S
5383P 0.05(4)
0.25max. 0.25max. 0.20max. 0.70~1.0 4.0~5.2 0.25max. 0.40max. 0.15max. max. 0.15(4)
5383S max.
5059P 0.05(5) 0.15
0.45max. 0.50max. 0.25max. 0.60~1.2 5.0~6.0 0.25max. 0.4~0.90 0.20max. max. max.(5)
5059S
5086P 0.40max. 0.50max. 0.10max. 0.20~0.7 3.5~4.5 0.05~0.25 0.25max. 0.15max. 0.05 0.15max. Remainder
5086S max.
(2)
5754P 0.40max. 0.40max. 0.10max. 0.50max. 2.6~3.6 0.30max. 0.20max. 0.15max. 0.05max. 0.15max.
5456P 0.25max. 0.40max. 0.10max. 0.50~1.0 4.7~5.5 0.05~0.2 0.25max. 0.20max. 0.05max. 0.15max.
(3)
6005AS 0.5~0.9 0.35max. 0.30max. 0.50max. 0.40~0.7 0.30max. 0.20max. 0.10max. 0.05max. 0.15max.
6061S 0.4~0.8 0.7max. 0.15~0.40 0.15max. 0.8~1.2 0.04~0.35 0.25max. 0.15max. 0.05max. 0.15max.
6082S 0.7~1.3 0.50max. 0.10max. 0.40~1.0 0.6~1.2 0.25max. 0.20max. 0.10max. 0.05max. 0.15max.
NOTES :
(1) Includes Ni, Ga, V and listed elements for which no specific limit is shown. When the existence of the other el-
ements is presumed in the course of routine analysis, further analysis thereof is to be conducted.
(2) 0.10 ≤ M n + Cr ≤ 0.60
(3) 0.12 ≤ M n + Cr ≤ 0.50
(4) Zr: maximum 0.20. The total for other elements does not include Zirconium.
(5) Zr: 0.05-0.25. The total for other elements does not include Zirconium.

98 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

4. Heat treatment
The heat treatment(hereinafter referred to as "temper condition") of the aluminium alloys is to com-
ply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.97 and Table 2.1.98.
5. Mechanical properties
(1) The mechanical properties in tension tests are to comply with the requirements given in Tables
2.1.97. and 2.1.98.

Table 2.1.97 Mechanical Properties for Rolled Products(1)


Tensile test
Temper Thickness,  Yield Tensile Elongation(%)
Grades (2)
condition (mm) strength strength
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
) (   )

O 3≤ ≤50 125 min. 275∼350 16 min. 14 min.

H112 3≤ ≤50 125 min. 275 min. 12 min. 10 min.


5083P
H116 3≤ ≤50 215 min. 305 min. 10 min. 10 min.

H321 3≤ ≤50 215∼295 305∼385 12 min. 10 min.


O 3≤ ≤50 145 min. 290 min. - 17 min.
5383P H116 or
3≤ ≤50 220 min. 305 min. 10 min. 10 min.
H321
O 3≤ ≤50 160 min. 330 min. - 24 min.
5059P H116 or 3≤ ≤20 270 min. 370 min. 10 min. 10 min.
H321 20< ≤50 260 min. 360 min. 10 min. 10 min.
O 3≤ ≤50 95 min. 305 min. 16 min. 14 min.
3≤ ≤12.5 125 min. 250 min. 8 min. -
5086P H112
12.5<≤50 105 min. 240 min. - 9 min.
(3)
H116 3≤ ≤50 195 min. 275 min. 10 min. 9 min.

5754P O 3≤ ≤50 80 min. 190∼240 18 min. 17 min.

3≤ ≤6.3 130-205 290-365 16 min. -


O
6.3< ≤50 125-205 285-360 16 min. 14 min.
3≤ ≤30 230 min. 315 min. 10 min. 10 min.
H116 30< ≤40 215 min. 305 min. - 10 min.
5456P
40< ≤50 200 min. 285 min. - 10 min.
3≤ ≤12.5 230-315 315-405 12 min. -
H321 12.5< ≤40 215-305 305-385 - 10 min.
40< ≤50 200-295 285-370 - 10 min.
NOTES :
(1) Aluminium alloy may be subject to any other standards in lieu of the requirements given in this Table
where they are approved by the Society.
(2) Symbols used in temper condition are as follows :
O : Annealing
H112 : Work hardened
H116 : Stabilizing treatment after work hardened
H321 : Stabilizing treatment after work hardened
(3) 8 % for thicknesses up to and including 6.3 mm.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 99


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.98 Mechanical Properties for Extruded Shapes(1)


Tensile test
Temper Thickness,  Elongation(%)(3)
Grades (2) Yield strength Tensile strength
condition (mm)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
) (   )

O 3≤ ≤50 110 min. 270 ∼ 350 14 min. 12 min.


5083S H111 3≤ ≤50 165 min. 275 min. 12 min. 10 min.
H112 3≤ ≤50 110 min. 270 min. 12 min. 10 min.
O/H111 3≤ ≤50 145 min. 290 min. 17 min. 17 min.
5383S
H112 3≤ ≤50 190 min. 310 min. - 13 min.
5059S H112 3≤ ≤50 200 min. 330 min. - 10 min.
O 3≤ ≤50 95 min. 240 ∼ 315 14 min. 12 min.
5086S H111 3≤ ≤50 145 min. 250 min. 12 min. 10 min.
H112 3≤ ≤50 95 min. 240 min. 12 min. 10 min.
T5 3≤ ≤50 215 min. 260 min. 9 min. 8 min.
6005AS 3≤ ≤10 215 min. 260 min. 8 min. 6 min.
T6
10<≤50 200 min. 250 min. 8 min. 6 min.
6061S T6 3≤ ≤50 240 min. 260 min. 10 min. 8 min.
T5 3≤ ≤50 230 min. 270 min. 8 min. 6 min.
6082S 3≤ ≤5 250 min. 290 min. 6 min. -
T6
5<≤50 260 min. 310 min. 10 min. 8 min.
NOTES :
(1) Aluminium alloy may be subject to any other standards in lieu of the requirements given in this
Table where they are approved by the Society.
(2) Symbols used in temper condition are as follows :
O : Annealing
H111 : Work hardened
H112 : Work hardened
T5 : Artificial age hardening treatment after elevated temperature working and succeeding cool-
ing
T6 : Artificial age hardening treatment after solution treatment
(3) The values are applicable for longitudinal and transverse tensile test specimens as well.

(2) Where deemed necessary by the Society, other tests may be required in addition to the specified
tests.
6. Selection of test samples
(1) For test samples for rolled products, if the weight of one lot exceeds 2 tonnes, one extra test
specimen is to be taken from every 2 tonnes of the product or fraction thereof, in each lot ex-
cept where specially approved by the Society.
One lot is made up of rolled products of the same alloy and from the same cast, of the same
thickness, manufactured by the same process and having been submitted simultaneously to the
same temper condition. For single plate or coil weighting more than 2 tonnes each, one lot is
made up of a single plate or coil.
(2) For test samples for extruded shapes with a nominal weight of less than 1 kg/m, except where
specially approved by the Society, one test specimen is to be taken from each 1 tonne, or frac-
tion thereof, in each lot. For nominal weights between 1 and 5 kg/m, one test specimen is to
be taken from each 2 tonnes or fraction hereof, in each lot. If the nominal weight exceeds 5
kg/m, one test specimen is to be taken for each 3 tonnes of the product or fraction thereof, in
each lot.
One lot is made up of rolled products of the same alloy and from the same cast, of the same
dimension, manufactured by the same process and having been submitted simultaneously to the
same temper condition.

100 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(3) Test samples are to be taken out of the place at one third of the width from a longitudinal
edge of rolled products, or in the range 1/3 to 1/2 of the distance from the edge to the centre
of the thickest part of extruded products.
(4) After removal of test samples, each test specimen is to be marked in order that its original
identity, location and orientation is maintained.
7. Selection of test specimens
Tensile test specimens are to be taken according to (1) to (4) below.
(1) One test specimen is to be taken out of each test sample.
(2) For rolled products, the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is to be taken transversely to the
rolling direction. If the width is insufficient to obtain transverse test specimen or in the case of
strain hardening alloys, however, the longitudinal direction may be taken parallel to the rolling
direction.
(3) For extruded shapes, the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is to be taken parallel to the ex-
truding direction.
(4) For thickness of test sample up to and including 40 mm, the longitudinal axis of the test speci-
men is to be located at a distance from the surface equal to half of the thickness. For thickness
of test sample over 40 mm, the longitudinal axis of the test specimen is to be located at a dis-
tance from one of the surfaces equal to one quarter of the thickness.
8. Corrosion testing
(1) For aluminium alloys specified in Tables 2.1.97. in the H 116 and H 321 tempers intended for
use in marine hull construction or in marine applications where frequent direct contact with sea-
water is expected are to be corrosion tested with respect to exfoliation and intergranular corro-
sion resistance.
(2) For corrosion resistance test sample, one test sample is to be taken from each lot specified in
801. 6 (1). Test samples are to be selected from mid width at one end of a coil or random
sheet or plate.
(3) Testing method and acceptance criteria is to be in accordance with the Guidance relating to the
Rules specified by the Society.
9. Surface inspection and dimensional tolerance
(1) Surface inspection and verification of dimensions are left to the responsibility of the
manufacturer.
(2) The under-thickness tolerances of rolled products are to comply with the requirements given in
2.1.99.

Table 2.1.99 Under-thickness Tolerance for Rolled Products

Nominal width  (mm)


Nominal thickness, 
 ≤ 1500 1500 <  ≤ 2000 2000 <  ≤ 3500
(mm)
Under-thickness tolerance (mm)
3 ≤  < 4 0.10 0.15 0.15
4 ≤  < 8 0.20 0.20 0.25
8 ≤  < 12 0.25 0.25 0.25
12 ≤  < 20 0.35 0.40 0.50
20 ≤  < 50 0.45 0.50 0.65

(3) Dimensional tolerance except those specified in (2) above is left to the discretion of the
Society.
10. Quality
(1) Aluminium alloys are to be of uniform quality and free from internal and surface harmful de-
fects prejudicial to the use of the concerned material for the intended application.
(2) Slight surface imperfections may be removed by smooth grinding or machining as long as the
thickness of the materials remains within the tolerances given in Table 2.1.99.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 101


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

11. Retest procedures


(1) When the tensile test from the first piece selected fails to meet the requirements given in Table
2.1.97 and 2.1.98, two further tensile tests may be made from the same piece. If both of
these additional tests meet all of the requirements, the piece and the remaining pieces from the
same lot may be accepted.
(2) If one or both of the additional tests referred to above (1) are unsatisfactory, the piece is to be
rejected. However, the remaining materials from the same lot may be accepted provided that
two of the remaining pieces in the lot selected in the same way, are tested with satisfactory
results.
12. Marking
(1) Aluminium alloys which have satisfied with the required tests are to be marked with the identi-
fication mark in accordance with the requirements in 110. 1. In this case, the mark of temper
conditions is to be put subsequent to the mark of material grade. (ex : 5083 H 321)
(2) For aluminium alloy, which have satisfied with the corrosion resistance tests specified in 801.8,
the mark of [M] is to be put subsequent to the mark of the temper condition (ex : 5083 H 321
M)

102 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

CHAPTER 2 WELDING

SECTION 1 General

101. Application
1. Welding to be used in hull construction and important equipment is to be in accordance with the
requirements in this Chapter unless otherwise specified.
2. The welding in boiler, pressure vessel, main engine, auxiliary engine and pipe arrangement is to be
in accordance with the requirements in Pt 5, Chs 2, 5 and 6 except where prescribed in this
Chapter.

102. Matters to be approved


1. The welding is to be carried out in accordance with the procedures previously approved, with the
electrodes, the wire and flux (hereinafter referred to as "welding consumables") or equivalent
materials and by the welders qualified by the Society.
2. Where deemed appropriate by the Society, National Standards, internationally recognized Codes or
Standards considered as equivalent for those may be applied instead of requirements of this
Chapter.

103. Special weldings


Where special welding and material not complied with the requirements in this Chapter is used, the
welding procedures and the welding consumables are to be specially approved by the Society.

104. Terms and definitions


1. The term manual welding is used to describe processes in which the weld is made manually by a
welder using a manually fed electrode such as shield metal arc welding, etc.
2. The term semi-automatic is used to describe processes in which the weld is made manually by a
welder holding a gun through which the electrode wire is continuously fed such as metal arc weld-
ing or flux-cored arc welding, etc.
3. The term automatic welding is used to describe processes in which the weld is made automatically
by a welder using a continuously fed electrode wire such as submerged arc welding or electro-slag
welding, etc.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 103


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures

201. General
1. Test specimens and mechanical testing procedures specified in this Chapter for welding procedure
qualification tests, welders and qualification tests, approval test and periodical inspection of welding
consumables are to comply with the requirements in this Section.
2. Where specimens and mechanical testing procedures differing from those prescribed in this Section
are used, they are to be approved by the Society.

202. Selection of test specimens


1. Test specimens are to be selected according to respective requirements in each Section.
2. Except where otherwise specified or agreed with the Surveyor, test specimens are not to be de-
tached from the test assembly until having been stamped by the Surveyor.
3. If test specimens are cut from test assemblies by flame cutting or shearing, a reasonable margine is
required to enable sufficient material to be removed from the cut edges during final machining.
4. The preparation of test specimens is to be done in such a manner that test specimens are not sub-
jected to any significant cold straining or heating.
5. If any test specimen shows defective machining or defects having no relation to the substantial na-
ture, it may be discarded and substituted by another test specimen.

203. Size and dimensions of test specimens


1. Tensile test specimens
(1) Tensile test specimens are to be of size and dimensions given in Table 2.2.1, and the both
ends of the test specimen may be machined to such a shape as to fit the holder of the testing
machine.
(2) The upper and lower surfaces of weld are to be filed, ground or machined flush with the sur-
face of plate.
(3) When the capacity of the available testing machine does not permit testing the full thickness
specimen, two or more thinner than full thickness specimens may be prepared by cutting the
full thickness specimens into section, each of which is to meet the requirements.
2. Bend test specimens
(1) Bend test specimens are to be of size and dimensions given in Table 2.2.2 according to the
kind of test assemblies.
(2) Where the thickness of test assemblies is greater than the thickness of the bend test specimen
prescribed in Table 2.2.2, the face bend or root bend specimen may be machined on its com-
pression side.
(3) Reinforcements and back straps are to be machined flush with base metal.
3. Impact test specimens
Impact test specimens are to be charphy V-notch impact test specimens specified in Ch 1, 202. 3
and to be of size and dimensions given in Fig 2.1.3, Tables 2.1.3 and 2.1.4.
4. Confirmation for test specimens
The size and dimensions of test specimens are to be carefully inspected and verified by suitable
means before testing

104 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.1 Size and Dimensions of Tensile Test Specimens (Unit : mm)

Type Size of specimen Dimensions Intended for

 = 10
 = 50
 = 55 Deposited metal
 ≥ 10 tensile test
R 14A
Alternatively. Longitudinal
 = 5 tensile test
 ≅   
 = 12

 = 12
 = 6.0
 = 24
 = 32
 ≅ 6
Deposited metal tensile
R 10 test(Welding consumables
for stainless steel)
 = 19~25
 = 12.5
 = 50
 = 60
 ≅ 15

 = 
 = 12 ( ≤ 2)
Butt weld tensile test for
R 2A  = 25 ( > 2)
plate
 = B + 60
 > 25

 = 
 = 38 ( ≤ 25)
Butt weld tensile test for
R 2B  = 25 ( > 25)
pipe
 =  + 12
 ≥ 50

NOTE: L : Gauge length


The notations used are defined as follows: P : Parallel test length
d : Diameter B : Width of weld
a : Thickness R : Transition radius
b : Width t : Thickness of material

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 105


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.2 Size and Dimensions of Bend Test Specimens (Unit : mm)

Used for Type Size of specimen Dimensions(1) Intended for

<12
Butt weld bend test
Face and  = 
for plate
root bend RB 1  = 30
Longitudinal bend
specimen  ≥ 200
test for plate(2)
 = 1 ~ 2
Welding procedure qualification tests

12≤ 
 =  (3)
Side bend Butt weld bend test
RB 2  = 10
specimen for plate or pipe
 ≥ 200
 = 1 ~ 2

① 0< <9
 = 
 =  + D/10
 ≒ 250
Face and
 ≤ a/6 Butt weld bend test
root bend RB 3
② 9≤ ≤12 for pipe
specimen
 = 9
 = 40
 ≒ 250
 ≤ 1.5
Approval test and periodical inspection for welding consumables

 = 
 = 30
 ≥ 200
 ≤ 1.5
Where the thickness of
Face and
test assemblies exceeds
root bend RB 4 Butt weld bend test
25 mm, the thickness of
specimen
test specimen may be
reduced to 25 mm with
its surface machined on
one side only(com-
pression side)

 =  Butt weld bend test


 = 10 (welding materials
RB 5
 ≥ 200 for electro-slag and
 ≤ 1.5 electro-gas)
Side bend
specimen Butt weld bend test
 = 
(MIG double side,
 = 9
RB 6 one layer each, butt
 ≥ 200
welding for alumi-
 ≤ 1.5
nium alloy)

 < 12
Welder's

Face and  = 
Butt weld bend test
root bend RB 7  = 40
for pipe
specimen  ≒ 150
 ≤ 1.5

106 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.2 Size and Dimensions of Bend Test Specimens (Continued) (Unit : mm)

Used for Type Size of specimen Dimensions(1) Intended for

12≤ 
 =  (3)
Side bend Butt weld bend
RB8  = 9
specimen test for plate
 ≒ 150
 ≤ 1.5

 ≤ 9.5
 = 
 ≒ 150
RB9  ≤ 1.5
 = 40
(  >100)
or 25(  ≤100)

Face and
Welder's qualification test

root bend
specimen  > 9.5
 = 10
 ≒ 150
RB10  ≤ 1.5
 = 40
(  >100)
or 25(  ≤100)

Butt weld bend


test for pipe

12≤ 
 =  (3)
Side bend
RB11  = 9
specimen
 ≒ 150
 ≤ 1.5

NOTES:
(1) The following designations are used.
 : Thickness
 : Width
 : Edge radius
 : External pipe diameter
 : Thickness of test assembly
 : Length
(2) The specimen also applies to longitudinal bend test for welding consumables for 9 % Ni steel. The width of
Specimen, b, is to be B+12 where breath of weld, B, is 26 mm and over.
(3) For plates over 40 mm thick, the side bend specimen may be subdivided, each part being at least 20 mm wide
and each part may be tested.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 107


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

204. Mechanical testing procedures


1. Tensile test and impact test
Tensile tests and impact tests are to be carried out in accordance with the procedures prescribed in
Ch 1, 203.
2. Bend test
(1) Except where guided bend tests are required, bend test is roller bend test carried out by the jig
of which the plunger has a bending radius specified in each Section with supporting rollers ad-
justable for their spans.
(2) Guided bend test jigs are to be as shown in Figs 2.2.1 and 2.2.2.
(3) Roller bend test jigs are to be as shown in Fig 2.2.3.

108 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 3 Welding Work and Inspection

301. Details of joints


1. Application

The details of joints for manual welding are to be in accordance with the following Paragraphs.
For other welding procedures such as automatic welding and in case where the specified details of
joint are deemed unpracticable, full details of joint are to be submitted for approval.
2. Butt joints
(1) In general, edge preparations of butt welds are to be as shown in Fig 2.2.4.
(2) Butt welded joints of plates having difference over 4 mm in thickness are to be properly ta-
pered at the end of thicker plate.
3. Butt joints of thick materials

The groove of thick materials, such as cast steel, is in general to be prepared as shown in Fig
2.2.5.

Fig 2.2.4 Edge preparation Fig 2.2.5 Butt Joint of Thick Material

4. Lap joints
(1) The breadth of overlap for lap joints which may be subjected to bending is not to be less than
obtained from the following formula, but need not exceed 50 mm.

 = 2  + 25 (mm)

where:
 = Thickness of the thinner plate (mm)
(2) Where plates are joggled, the breadth of overlap for joints which may be subjected to bending
is not to be less than obtained from the following formula, but need not exceed 40 mm.

 =  + 25 (mm)

where:
 = Thickness of the thinner plate (mm).

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 109


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

302. Welding Practice


1. Welding Practice, which is the detailed statement of the general welding works for hull structure, is
to contain welding process, standard of welding and its quality control, application of welding con-
sumables, welding procedures specification(WPS) and welding sequence of main hull structure and
be submitted to the Society.
2. The welding procedure specification(WPS) specified above is to be those satisfactorily complying
with the welding procedure qualification tests specified in Sec 4.

303. Application of welding consumables


Welding consumables used for welded joints of hull structure are to be of the grades as specified
in the relevant Articles of Sec 6 according to the following requirements:
(1) Application of welding consumables for welded joints of various grades of steel is to be as
specified in Table 2.2.3.
(2) Welding consumables for lower toughness of steel may be used for welded joints of different
toughness of steel of the same specified strength.
(3) In case of welding of steels of different specified strength, the welding consumables required for
the steel of lower specified strength may be used, provided that adequate means for preventing
cracks are considered.
(4) It is recommended that controlled low hydrogen type consumables are to be used when joining
higher strength structural steel to the same or lower strength level, except that other con-
sumables may be used at the discretion of the Society when the carbon equivalent is below or
equal to 0.41 %. When other than controlled low hydrogen type electrodes are used, appropriate
procedure tests for hydrogen cracking may be conducted at the discretion of the Society.

304. Preparation for Welding


1. Edge preparation
(1) The edge preparations are to be in accordance with the plans, and are to be free from moisture,
grease, rust and paint which may cause injurious defects in welded joints.
(2) The edges to be welded shall be smooth, uniform and free from notches, laminations, cracks
and other discontinuities which would adversely affect the quality or strength of the weld.
(3) Any injurious defects on the edges are to be removed. When weld repairs are required, con-
trolled low hydrogen type welding consumables are to be used as far as practicable and grind-
ing the complete weld smooth and flush with the adjacent surface.
2. Tack welding
(1) Tack welding is to be carried out by the welders qualified by the Society.
(2) Tack welding is to be removed before the main welding for joints of strength deck plating,
sheer strakes, shell plating, and other important structural members or is to be carried out by
the same procedure as the main welding without injurious defect in welded joints and made
with the same or higher grade of welding consumables as intended to use for main welding.
(3) The minimum length and pitch of tack welds should be in accordance with the Guidance in re-
lating to Rules.
(4) Injurious defects or any deviations from groove design due to tack welding to obstruct proceed-
ings of main welding are to be completely removed.
(5) In case of tack welding higher strength steels, high strength quenched and tempered steels or
joining under high restraint, preheating is to be taken as necessary prior to tack welding.
3. Fixtures
(1) Setting appliances to be used for welding fabrications are to be so arranged as to give restraint
without cracks and other defects in welded joints.
(2) Tack welding for temporary fittings is not to leave any defect on base metal after the tack
welds have been removed.

110 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.3 Selection of welding consumables(rolled steel plates)


(1)
Kind and grade of steel to be welded Grade of applicable welding consumables
A 1, 2, 3, 1Y , 2Y , 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , 2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 1, L 2, L 3
Mild
B, D 2, 3, 1Y , 2Y , 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , 2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 1, L 2, L 3
steel
E 3, 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 1, L 2, L 3
1Y (2), 2Y , 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , 2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 2(3), L 3, 2Y 42, 3Y 42,
AH32, AH36
Rolled 4Y 42, 5Y 42
steels DH32, DH36 2Y , 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , 2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 2(3), L 3, 3Y 42, 4Y 42, 5Y 42
Higher
for
hull
strength EH32, EH36 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 2(3), L 3, 4Y 42, 5Y 42
low
FH32, FH36 4Y , 5Y , 4Y 40, 5Y 40, L 2(3), L 3, 4Y 42, 5Y 42
alloy
steel AH40, DH40 2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, 3Y 42, 4Y 42, 5Y 42, 2Y 46, 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46
EH40 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40, 3Y 42, 4Y 42, 5Y 42, 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46
FH40 4Y 40, 5Y 40, 4Y 42, 5Y 42, 4Y 46, 5Y 46
RL24A 4Y , 4Y 40, L 1, L 2, L 3
(4)
Rolled steels for low RL24B, RL27, RL33 5Y 42, L 2, L 3
temperature services RL37 5Y 42, L 3
RL9N53, RL9N60 L 91, L 92
2Y 42, 3Y 42, 4Y 42, 5Y 42, 2Y 46, 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46, 2Y 50, 3Y 50, 4Y 50,
AH43
5Y 50
DH43 3Y 42, 4Y 42, 5Y 42, 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46, 3Y 50, 4Y 50, 5Y 50
EH43 4Y 42, 5Y 42, 4Y 46, 5Y 46, 4Y 50, 5Y 50
FH43 5Y 42, 5Y 46, 5Y 50
AH47 2Y 46, 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46, 2Y 50, 3Y 50, 4Y 50, 5Y 50
DH47 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46, 3Y 50, 4Y 50, 5Y 50
EH47 4Y 46, 5Y 46, 4Y 50, 5Y 50
FH47 5Y 46, 5Y 50
AH51 2Y 50, 3Y 50, 4Y 50, 5Y 50, 2Y 55, 3Y 55, 4Y 55, 5Y 55
DH51 3Y 50, 4Y 50, 5Y 50, 3Y 55, 4Y 55, 5Y 55
High strength EH51 4Y 50, 5Y 50, 4Y 55, 5Y 55
quenched and FH51 5Y 50, 5Y 55
tempered steels for
AH56 2Y 55, 3Y 55, 4Y 55, 5Y 55, 2Y 62, 3Y 62, 4Y 62, 5Y 62
welded structures
DH56 3Y 55, 4Y 55, 5Y 55, 3Y 62, 4Y 62, 5Y 62
EH56 4Y 55, 5Y 55, 4Y 62, 5Y 62
FH56 5Y 55, 5Y 62
AH63 2Y 62, 3Y 62, 4Y 62, 5Y 62, 2Y 69, 3Y 69, 4Y 69, 5Y 69
DH63 3Y 62, 4Y 62, 5Y 62, 3Y 69, 4Y 69, 5Y 69
EH63 4Y 62, 5Y 62, 4Y 69, 5Y 69
FH63 5Y 62, 5Y 69
AH70 2Y 69, 3Y 69, 4Y 69, 5Y 69
DH70 3Y 69, 4Y 69, 5Y 69
EH70 4Y 69, 5Y 69
FH70 5Y 69
NOTES :
(1) The symbol of welding consumables listed above show the materials which are specified in Table 2.2.16,
Table 2.2.25, Table 2.2.33, Table 2.2.39, and Table 2.2.67.
(2) When joining higher strength steels using Grade 1Y welding consumables, the material thicknesses should not
exceed 25 mm.
(3) Welding consumables of "L2" is applicable to steel grade of AH32, DH32, EH32 or FH32.
(4) Welding consumables of "L3" is applicable to steel grade of RL33.
Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 111
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

305. Welding sequence and direction of welding


1. Welding sequence and direction of welding are to be so determined as to prevent defects in welded
joints and to minimize deformations caused by welding.
2. The joints which may cause excessive contraction by welding are to be welded as far as practi-
cable prior to the joints which cause smaller contraction by welding.
3. Welding is to be proceeded to free ends of the joints as far as practicable and welding with direc-
tion of vertical-downward is not to be carried out, except the special approval of the Society.

306. Main welding


1. Welding is to be carried out so that no injurious defects may exist in the joints.
2. Welding is to be carried out under conditions of protection against the deleterious effect of mois-
ture, rain, wind and snow, and is to be preheated in cold weather if found necessary.
3. The ends of important welded joints are to be fitted with run-off tabs or are to have proper ex-
tensions, which are to be cut off after finished welding.
4. Butt welded joints are to be back chipped to remove the defects in root of welds before applying
the closing bead, except in case of one side welding or other approved procedures.
5. In case of welding under excessive restraint or welding for thick steel plate, cast steel or forged
steel, special precaution is to be taken as necessary, such as preheating of the material, use of low
hydrogen electrodes, etc. so as to prevent cracks.
6. In the parts subject to excessive stress concentration, the fillet welding is to be carried around the
ends of member, but in other parts, the fillet welding may not be carried out around the ends, pro-
vided that the craters at the ends of welds are filled up.
7. Excessive gaps in butt joint are to be either deposited with welding on grooves, fitted with backing
strips to the joints or partly replaced, and are not to be spanned with welding nor filled by
slugging.
8. Where the gap between the members in fillet joints is not greater than 2 mm, the welding may be
done with the given size of fillet. Where the gap is not less than 2 mm nor more than 5 mm, the
welding is to be done with an increased size of fillet corresponding to the amount of gap. Where
the gap exceeds 5 mm, the welding is to be done inserting a liner of suitable size or with a chill
strip, or plates to be welded are to be partly renewed.
9. Preheating, intermediate temperature and post heat treatment are to be carried out in accordance
with the welding procedure approved beforehand or the special approval of the Society.

307. Automatic welding


1. The grooves for automatic welding are to be finished in specially accurate dimensions.
2. Automatic welding is to be carried out within the inclination approved in the welding procedure
qualification test.
3. In the cross but joints of 16 mm or over in thickness, one joint is to be welded after the auto-
matic welding of the other joint has been completed on both sides.
4. Special precaution is to be taken as necessary for the automatic welding of rimmed steel to prevent
cracks.

308. Welding for higher strength steel


1. Arc strikes are to be avoided as far as practicable.
2. Short bead, min. length of repair welds and line heating temperature, etc. are to be in accordance
with the Shipbuilding Quality Standard recognized by the Society.

112 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

309. Quality of welds


1. The weld is to have a regular and uniform surface and it to be reasonably free from excessive re-
inforcements, injurious defects, such as undercuts, overlaps, etc.
2. Welded structures are to be reasonably free from welding deformation.
3. Non-destructive inspection is to be carried out for welded joints as the Guidance relating to the
Rules specified elsewhere.
4. The welding defects found in an appropriate non-destructive inspection including the visual in-
spection or watertight test are to be removed and corrected by rewelding.

310. Repairs
1. The removal of weld defects shall be done by gouging, grinding, chipping, etc. with such a manner
that the remaining weld metal or base metal is not damaged, however oxygen gouging is not to be
used in high strength quenched and tempered steels.
2. The removed weld defects parts are to be so machined as not to affect repair welding and repair
welding shall be carried out with low hydrogen type welding consumables and an electrode pref-
erably smaller than that used for making the original weld.
3. Members distorted by welding may be straightened by mechanical means or localized heat treat-
ment, however in case of localized heat treatment, the temperature of heated areas is to be so lim-
ited as not to affect the mechanical properties of base metal.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 113


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 4 Welding Procedure Qualification Tests


401. General
1. Application
(1) The welding procedures to be applied to hull construction specified in this Chapter as well as
cargo tank, secondary barriers and piping arrangements in ships carrying liquefied gases in bulk,
are to be those satisfactorily complying with the welding procedure qualification tests specified
in this Section.
(2) The welding procedures qualification test for areas other than those specified in (1) is to be in
accordance with the Guidance in relating to Rules.
2. Definitions
(1) Welding procedure specification(WPS)
A specification of materials, detailed methods, welding parameters etc. to be applied in the
welding of a particular joint.
(2) Welding procedure qualification tests(WPQT)
A test carried out in order to demonstrate that a weld made according to a specific welding
procedure specification meets the given requirements.
(3) Welding procedure qualification record(PQR)
The record of the actual parameters employed during welding of the qualification test piece ac-
cording to the requirement of (2), and results from the non-destructive inspection and mechan-
ical testing.
3. General requirements of WPQT
(1) The manufacturers are to obtain the approval of the welding procedure qualifications before the
welding works in the following case specified in (a) through (b)
(a) Where the welding procedure is first adopted for welding works specified in 1.
(b) Where the welding variables specified in 402. 2 (1) through (11) are changed beyond the
extent of those described in the approved welding procedure specifications.
(2) For the approval of welding procedure qualification, the preliminary welding procedure specifica-
tion specified in 402. is to be reviewed by the Society and the welding procedure qualification
test is to be carried out with satisfactory results. Welding procedure specifications are to refer
to the test conditions and test results achieved during welding procedure qualification testing.

402. Welding procedure specification


1. A welding procedure specification (WPS) is to be prepared by the shipyard or manufacturer which
intends to perform the welding procedure qualification test. This document is also referred to as a
preliminary welding procedure specification (pWPS). The shipyard or manufacturer is to submit to
the Society a pWPS for review prior to the tests.
2. The pWPS can be modified and amended during procedure tests as deemed necessary however it is
to define, at least, the following welding variables.
(1) Kind of base metal
(2) Nominal thickness or diameter range(dimensions)
(3) Welding process
(4) Joint or groove designs with tolerances
(5) Welding position(s) and direction of progression
(6) Welding consumables(grade, shielded gas, backing, flux, etc.)
(7) Electrical characteristics(amperage, voltage and pole nature etc.)
(8) Travel speed and heat input ranges
(9) Preheat and maximum interpass temperature
(10) Post weld heat temperature (if any)
(11) Other conditions necessary for the welding procedure (ex. : welding speed, heat input etc.)
3. Welding consumables used in welding procedure qualification tests should be approved in accord-
ance with the requirements specified in Sec 6 of the Rules.
4. In case that the test pieces welded according to the pWPS show unacceptable results the pWPS is
to be adjusted by the shipyard or manufacturer. The new pWPS is to be prepared and the test
pieces welded in accordance with the new pWPS.
5. The WPS is to be used as a basis for the production welds, and upon satisfactory completion of
the tests based on the pWPS, the Society may approve it as a WPS. In case that a WPS is ap-
proved by the Society the approval range is to be in compliance with the requirements in 407.

114 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

403. Welding procedure qualification tests(WPQT)


1. Where procedure qualification test is required, the test assembly is to be welded in the same or
similar environment and the qualification tests are to be carried out under the welding conditions
given in the pWPS.
2. Welding of the test assemblies and testing of test specimens are to be witnessed by the Surveyor.
3. If tack welds and/or start and stop points are a condition of the weld process they are to be fused
into the joint and are to be included in the test assemblies.
4. For qualification tests for stainless clad steels, the requirements specified in 404. and 405. are to
be complied with. However the impact test may be dispensed with where other welding procedure
qualification on the stainless clad steel base metal under the same welding condition has been
approved.
5. Where materials other than those specified in this Section are used, the qualification tests are to be
carried out in accordance with the testing standard approved by the Society.
6. Tests or test conditions other than those specified in this Section for the welding procedure qual-
ification may be required, where deemed necessary by the Society.

404. Tests for butt welded joints


1. Application
The requirements stated hereunder apply to the butt joints welded by manual welding, semi-auto-
matic welding or automatic welding.
2. Kinds of test
According to the materials to be tested, kinds of test and number of test specimens are to be giv-
en in Table 2.2.4. Additional test may be required where found necessary by the Society.
3. Test assemblies
(1) Test assemblies are to be prepared with the same or equivalent meterial used in the actual
work.
(2) The dimensions and types of test assembly are to be as indicated in Fig 2.2.6.

(Note)
The test assembly is to be of a size with the
minimum dimensions:
(1) manual or semi-automatic welding:
Width(W) : min. 300mm
Length(L) : min. 350mm
(2) automatic welding
Width(W) : min. 400mm
Length(L) : min. 1,000mm

(A) Test assembly fot Hull Structural Steels, High Strength Quenching and Tempered Steels,
Stainless Steels or Aluminium Alloys
Fig 2.2.6 Welding procedure test assembly (Unit : mm) (cont'd)

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 115


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(B) Test assembly for pipes up to 20mm in thickness

(C) Test assembly for pipes over 20mm in thickness

Fig 2.2.6 Welding procedure test assembly (Unit : mm)

116 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.4 Kinds of Test for Butt Welded Joints

Kinds and number of specimens for test(1)

Grades and material symbols of test specimens Macro- Non-


Visual Tensile Bend Impact Hard.
structure destructive
insp. test test test test
insp. insp.(3)
Normal
strength A, B, D, E -
Rolled
steel
steels for (2)
4
hull Higher A H 32, D H 32, E H 32, F H 32, A H 36, D H
structural strength 36, 2 1(11)
steel E H 36, F H 36, A H 40, D H 40, E H 40, F H 40

Rolled steels for R L 24A , RL 24B , RL 27, RL 33, RL 37


low temperature R L 2N 30, RL 3N 32, RL 5N 43 2 (3)

service R L 9N 53, R L 9N 60 4(5) -


Steel pipes for low
R LP A , R LP B , R LP C , R LP 2, R LP 3, R LP 9
temperature service
AH 43, D H 43, E H 43, F H 43, A H 47, D H 47,
Weldable high EH 47, F H 47, A H 51, D H 51, E H 51, F H 51,
strength quenched AH 56, D H 56, E H 56, F H 56, A H 63, D H 1(11)
and tempered steel 63, (2)
EH 63, F H 63, A H 70, D H 70, E H 70, F H 70 Welding 4
Welding
positions
R SC 410, R SC 450, R SC 480, R SC 520, positions
of 1
Casting for welded R SC 560, R SC 600, R SC 440A , R SC 480A , of whole
whole
construction and R SC 550A , R SF 410H , R SF 450H , R SF 480H , length
(3)(10) length
Hull steel forging R SF 520H , R SF 560H , R SF 600H ,
R SF 550A H , R SF 600A H , R SF 650A H

R STS 304, RSTS 304L, RSTS 304N 1, 2


RSTS 304N 2, RSTS 304LN , RSTS 309S,
Rolled stainless
RSTS 310S, RSTS 316, RSTS 316L , RSTS 2
steels
316N , RSTS 316LN , RSTS 317, RSTS 317L ,
RSTS 317LN , RSTS 321, RSTS 347 (6) -

R STS 304TP , R STS 304LTP , R STS 309STP ,


Stainless steel R STS 310STP , R STS 316TP , R STS 316LTP ,
4
pipes R STS 317TP , R STS 317LTP , R STS 321TP ,
R STS 347TP
5000 5083P , 5383P , 5059P , 5086P , 5754P ,
Aluminium series 5083S, 5383S, 5059S, 5086S (8)
4(2) -
alloys(7) 6000 (9)
6005AS, 6061S, 6082S
series

NOTES:
(1) Where found necessary by the Society, microscopic test, hardness test and tests other than these may be required.
(2) Two root and two face bend specimens are to be tested. For thickness 12 mm and over, four side bend specimens
may alternatively be tested.
(3) No. of test sets and position of notch are as shown in Fig 2.2.7.
(4) Internal inspections by radiographic examination or ultrasonic examination and surface inspections by magnetic particle
examination or liquid penetrant examination are to be carried out.
(5) Two specimens are to be taken longitudinally and transversely respectively (See. Fig 2.2.6)
(6) Where found necessary by the Society, impact tests up to steels specially used for may be required.
(7) Material symbols of aluminium alloys include the symbols of which is the temper condition.
(8) Rolled products which have the same grade and temp condition may be used.
(9) Other rolled aluminium alloys of 6000 series with minimum tensile strength 260 Nmm  may be used.
(10) Where impact test is required.
(11) Hardness test(  10) is required for weldable high strength quenched and tempered steel and hull structural steel with
specified minimum yield strength of  ≥ 355 Nmm 

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 117


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(3) Test assemblies are to be welded in the same welding positions as the actual work.
(4) Test assemblies for the pipes over 500 mm in diameter at the actual work may be those for the
plates.
(5) For butt welded joints of rolled steel plates, the direction of welding according to rolling direc-
tion is to be as follows.
(a) When steel plates impact tested in longitudinal direction are used for test assemblies, the di-
rection of welding of test assembly is perpendicular to the rolling direction of the two
plates.
(b) When steel plates impact tested in transverse direction are used for test assemblies, the di-
rection of welding of test assembly is parallel to the rolling direction of the two plates.
4. Visual inspection
Welding surface is to be regular and uniform surface and is to be free from injurious defects, such
as cracks, undercuts, overlaps, etc.
5. Tensile tests
(1) The number of tensile test specimens taken from each test assembly is to be as shown in
Table 2.2.4.
(2) Tensile tests are to be carried out with the test specimen shown in Table 2.2.1. The tensile
strength is not to be less than the minimum tensile strength specified for the base metal except
for those specified in Table 2.2.5. When butt welds are made between plates of different
grades, the tensile strength to be obtained on the welded assembly is to be in accordance with
the requirements relating to the steel grade having lower strength.

Table 2.2.5 Tensile Test Requirements for Butt Welded Joint

Grade of testing Tensile strength Yield strength


Kind of testing materials
materials (Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
(1)
590 min. 315 min.
Rolled steels for lower temperature service RL 9N53, RL 9N60 (2)
630 min. -
Steel pipes for low temperature service RLP 9 630 min. -
5754 190 min. -
5086 240 min. -
5083 275 min. -
Aluminium alloys
5383 290 min. -
5059 330 min. -
(3)
6005A, 6061, 6082 170 min. -
(Notes)
(1) For test specimen in longitudinal direction
(2) For test specimen in transverse direction
(3) See notes (9) of Table 2.2.4.

(3) In those cases where the consumables are not unavoidably approved by the Society, it is to be
required additionally to prepare a R 14A deposited metal tensile test specimen as shown in
Table 2.2.1 in entirely weld metal and the tensile properties recorded for each specimen are
not to be less than the minimum required for the approval of the appropriate grade of
consumable. Where more than one welding process or type of consumable has been used to
make the test weld, test specimens are to be taken from the area of the weld where each was
used with the exception of those processes or consumables used to make the first weld run or
root deposit.
6. Bend tests
(1) The number of bend test specimens taken from each test assembly is to be as shown in Table
2.2.4, and the position of specimen is to be as shown in Fig 2.2.6.

118 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(2) The shape and dimension of face bend specimen, root bend specimen or side bend specimen are
to be as indicated in RB1, RB2 or RB3 of Table 2.2.2. Bend test procedure and inside bend
radius are to be as indicated in Table 2.2.6. There is to be no crack nor any other defect
greater than 3 mm in length in any direction on the surface of bend specimen.

Table 2.2.6 Bend Test Requirements

Inside bend Bending


Kind of testing materials Grade of testing materials
radius (mm)(1) angle

Steel pipes for low 


RLP 9  
temperature service 
A H 56, D H 56, E H 56, F H 56,
weldable high strength 
A H 63, D H 63, E H 63, F H 63,  
quenched and tempered steel  180°
A H 70, D H 70, E H 7 0, F H 70
5754, 5086, 5083, 5383, 5059,
Aluminium alloys (3)
6005A, 6061, 6082(2)
Other materials 
NOTES :
(1)  is the thickness of the test specimen.
(2) See Notes (9) of the Table 2.2.4.
(3) The bend test specimens should be bent on a mandrel with maximum diameter as given in the
formula below.
 × 
    

where  is the maximum former diameter
 is the thickness of the bend test specimen (this includes side bends)
 is the minimum tensile elongation required by the alloy grade, temper condition
and thickness (for combination between different alloys, the lowest individual
value should be used).

(3) For butt joints in heterogeneous steel plates, face and root longitudinal bend test specimens may
be used instead of the transverse bend test specimens.
7. Impact tests
(1) Normal and higher strength hull structural steels
(a) The test specimen is to be charphy V-notch impact test specimen as shown in Table 2.1.3
and to be taken from the position in Fig 2.2.6.
(b) The number of test specimens taken from test assemblies and the position of notch for the
test specimen are as specified in Fig 2.2.7.
(c) Test specimen is to be sampled from 1 to 2 mm below the surface of the base metal, trans-
verse to the weld and on the side containing the last weld run.
(d) Test temperature and absorbed energy are to be in accordance with Table 2.2.7.
(e) When butt welds are made between different steel grades/types, the test specimens are to be
taken from the side of the joint with lower toughness of steel. Temperature and absorbed
energy results are to be in accordance with the requirements for the lower toughness steel.
(f) Where more than one welding process or consumable has been used to make the test weld,
impact test specimens are to be taken from the respective areas where each was employed.
This is not to apply to the process or consumables used solely to make the first weld run
or root deposit.
(g) Where the weld metal cross-section size or shape does not allow the charphy V-notch im-
pact test specimen to be in deposited metal, the requirements in 202. 3 of Ch 1 are to be
applied.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 119


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(2) High strength quenched and tempered steels


(a) Impact test is to be performed as described in the above (1).
(b) Test temperature and absorbed energy are to be in accordance with the requirements of base
metal
(3) Weldable C and C-Mn hull steel castings and forgings
For base metal with specified impact values test temperature and absorbed energy are to be in
accordance with the requirements of the base metal to be welded.

heat input thickness Locations of V-notch(3)

t ≤ 50 mm(1)

normal heat
input
≤ 50 

t > 50 mm

t ≤ 50 mm(2)

high heat
input
> 50 

t > 50 mm

Note:
(1) For one side single run welding over 20 mm notch location "a" is to be added on root side.
(2) For one side welding with thickness over 20 mm notch locations "a", "b" and "c" are to be added on root
side.
(3) Notch locations:
a : center of weld "WM"
b : on fusion line "FL"
c : in HAZ, 2 mm from fusion line
d : in HAZ, 5 mm from fusion line
e : in HAZ, 10 mm from fusion line in case of heat input > 200 kJ/cm

Fig 2.2.7 No. of test sets and locations of V-notch

120 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.7 Impact test requirements for butt joints (t ≤ 50 mm)(1),(2)


(4)
Value of minimum average absorbed energy (J)
Grade of Test temp. For manually or semi-automatically welded joints
steel (℃) For automatically
Downhand, Horizontal, Vertical upward, welded joints
Overhead Vertical downward
A (3) 20
(3)
B , D 0
E -20
A H 32, A H 36 20 34 min. 34 min.
D H 32, D H 36 0
E H 32, E H 36 -20 47 min.
F H 32, F H 36 -40
A H 40 20
D H 40 0
39 min. 39 min.
E H 40 -20
F H 40 -40

Note:
(1) For thickness above 50 mm impact test requirements are to be agreed by the Society.
(2) These requirements are to apply to test piece of which butt weld is perpendicular to the rolling direc-
tion of the plates.
(3) For Grade A and B steels average absorbed energy on fusion line and in heat affected zone is to be
minimum 27 J.
(4) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in val-
ue than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is
less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.

(4) Steels for low temperature Service


(a) The test specimen is to be charphy V-notch impact test specimen as shown in Table 2.1.3
and to be taken from the position in Fig 2.2.6.
(b) The number of test specimens taken from test assemblies, the position of notch for the test
specimen, test temperature and absorbed energy are as specified in Table 2.2.8.
(5) Rolled stainless steels and stainless steel pipes
(a) Where deemed necessary by the Society, impact test may be required.
(b) Test temperature and absorbed energy are to be in accordance with the requirements of base
metal
8. Macro-structure inspection
(1) The test specimens are to be prepared and etched on one side to clearly reveal the weld metal,
the fusion line and the heat affected zone. Macro examination is to include about 10 mm un-
affected base metal.
(2) The examination is to reveal a regular weld profile, through fusion between adjacent layers of
weld and base metal and the absence of defects such as cracks, lack of fusion etc.
9. Non-destructive inspection
(1) Test assemblies are to be examined for the whole length(excepting discard area of test assembly
of Fig 2.2.6) by visual and by non-destructive testing prior to the cutting of test specimen.
Non destructive examinations should be carried out after any required post weld heat treatment,
natural or artificial ageing, and prior to the cutting of the test specimens.
(2) For high strength quenched and tempered steels with specified minimum yield strength of 420
Nmm  and above the non-destructive testing is to be delayed for a minimum of 48 hrs, unless
heat treatment has been carried out.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 121


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.8 Impact Test Requirements for Butt Welded Joint (Steels for low temperature Service)

A (1) B, C, D, E (1)
Test temp.
Grade of steel Value of average Value of average absorbed energy(J )(3)
(℃)(4)
(3)
absorbed energy(J ) L (2) T (2)
RL 24A -40
RL 24B -50
RL 27 -60
RL 33 -60
RL 37 -60
41 min. 27 min.
RL 2N30 -70
RL 2N32 -95
RL 5N43 -110
27 min.
RL 9N53 -196
RL 9N60 -196
RLPA -40
RLPB -50 27 min.
RLPC -60
-
RLP 2 -70
34 min.
RLP 3 -95
RLP 9 -196 41 min.
NOTES:
(1) Position of notch as shown in Fig 2.2.7.
(2) L(or T) indicates that the direction of welding is transverse (or parallel) to the rolling direction of test
materials.
(3) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in value
than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is less
in value than 70% of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.
(4) Where requirements in Pt 7, Ch 5 apply, the impact test temperature is to be as given as follows:
(a) Impact test temperature for RL 24A through RL 5N43 is to be the lower of the temperatures given in
Table 2.1.18 specified in Pt 2, Ch 1.
(b) Impact test temperature for RLPA through RLPC is to be either 5℃ below the design temperature or
-20℃ whichever is the lower.

(3) NDT procedures are to be agreed with the Society. The results of non-destructive testing are to
show that there are no cracks or other injurious defects, and acceptance criteria is to be in ac-
cordance with the relevant requirements of the relevant Rules.
10. Hardness test
(1) For weldable high strength quenched and tempered steel and hull structural rolled steels with
specified minimum yield strength of ReH ≥ 355 Nmm  , hardness test(the vickers method Hv10)
is to be carried out in accordance with the Guidance relating to the Rules specified by the
Society.
(2) The results from the hardness test are not to exceed the following:
- Steel with a specified minimum yield strength ReH ≤ 420 Nmm  : 350 Hv10
- Steel with a specified minimum yield strength 420 Nmm  < ReH ≤ 690 Nmm  : 420 Hv10

122 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

405. Tests for fillet welded joints


1. Application
The requirements stated hereunder apply to the fillet joints welded by manual, semi-automatic or
automatic welding in any welding position.
2. Kinds of test
Fillet weld joints are to be subjected to visual inspection, surface crack detection, macro-structure
inspection, hardness test and fracture test. Additional tests may be required if found necessary by
the Society.
3. Test assemblies and welding
(1) Test assembly is to be prepared with the same or equivalent material used in the actual work.
(2) Dimensions and type of test assembly are to be as indicated Fig 2.2.8.

Fig 2.2.8 Test assembly for fillet weld joint (unit : mm)

(3) Test assembly is to be welded in the same welding positions as the actual work.
(4) The assembly is to be welded on one side only, except in case deemed necessary by the
surveyor.
(5) For single run manual and semi-automatic welding, a stop/restart is to be included in the test
length and its position is to be clearly marked for subsequent examination.
4. Visual inspection
Fillet welding is to have a regular and uniform surface, and is to be free from cracks, undercuts,
overlaps and other injurious defects.
5. Non-destructive inspection
(1) Test assemblies are to be examined by visual and by non-destructive testing prior to the cutting
of test specimen. In case that any post-weld heat treatment is required or specified non-destruc-
tive testing is to be performed after heat treatment.
(2) For weldable high strength quenched and tempered steel with specified minimum yield strength
of 420 Nmm  and above the non-destructive testing is to be delayed for a minimum of 48 hrs,
unless heat treatment has been carried out.
(3) NDT procedures are to be agreed with the Society. The results of non-destructive testing are to
show that there are no cracks or other injurious defects, and acceptance criteria is to be in ac-
cordance with the relevant requirements of the relevant Rules.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 123


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

6. Macro-structure inspection
(1) The test specimen is to be taken from the position in Fig 2.2.8. However, in case of rolled
steels for hull structural, weldable high strength quenched and tempered steel, and aluminium al-
loy, two specimens are to be taken. For manual welding and semi-automatic welding, one of
the macro etched specimens is to be from the stop/restart position, if present.
(2) The test specimens are to be prepared and etched on one side to clearly reveal the weld metal,
fusion line, root penetration and the heat affected zone. Macro examination is to include about
10 mm unaffected base metal.
(3) The examination is to reveal a regular weld profile, through fusion between adjacent layers of
weld and base metal, sufficient root penetration and the absence of defects such as cracks, lack
of fusion etc.
7. Hardness test
For weldable high strength quenched and tempered steel and hull structural rolled steels with speci-
fied minimum yield strength of ReH ≥ 355 Nmm  , hardness test(Hv 10) is to be carried out in ac-
cordance with the requirement in 404. 10.
8. Fracture tests
The remaining test assemblies after the macro-structure test specimen has been removed are to be
broken by pressing as shown in Fig 2.2.8 and there shall be no cracks, blow holes, poor pene-
trations and any other injurious defects in the fractured surface. However, where the sum of lengths
having blow holes and poor penetration, except at both ends of the test specimen, is not greater
than 10 % of the total welded length, the test may be regarded as satisfactory.

406. Retests and Procedure qualification records(PQR)


1. Retests
(1) Where visual inspection or non-destructive inspection fails to meet the requirements, the new
test specimens welded under the same welding condition, are to be subject to retest and all of
these test specimens are to pass the test. If this additional test piece does not comply with the
relevant requirements, the pWPS is to be regarded as not capable of complying with the re-
quirements without modification.
(2) Where the result of a tensile or bend test does not comply with the requirements, twice as
many test specimens as the number of specimens of failed test are to be selected from either
the first test material or test materials welded under the same welding conditions, and all of
these test specimens are to be satisfactorily tested.
(3) If there is a single hardness value above the maximum values allowed, additional hardness tests
are to be carried out (on the reverse of the specimen or after sufficient grinding of the tested
surface). None of the additional hardness values is to exceed the maximum hardness values
required.
(4) (a) Where the result of the impact test is unsatisfactory, additional tests may be carried out,
with the exception of the cases specified in (i) and (ii) below, by taking a set of test speci-
mens out of the same test material from which the above-mentioned test specimens have been
taken.
(i) The absorbed energy of all test specimens is under the required average absorbed
energy.
(ii) The absorbed energy of two of the test specimens is under 70 % the required average
absorbed energy.
(b) In case of the previous (a), the test specimens may be accepted, provided that the average
absorbed energy of the six test specimens, including those which have been rejected as un-
satisfactory, is not less than the required average absorbed energy, and that not more than
two individual results are lower than the required average absorbed energy and of these, not
more than one result is below 70 % of the required average absorbed energy.
(5) Where there is insufficient welded assembly remaining to provide additional test specimens, a
further assembly is to be welded using the same procedure to provide the additional specimens.

124 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(6) Where the retest fails to meet the requirements, the test may be made over again. In this case,
where the whole tests specified on the test assembly are carried out and are complied with re-
quirements, the tests are accepted as successful.
2. Procedure qualification records(PQR)
(1) Three copies of the procedure qualification records showing the welding conditions for test as-
semblies and test results are to be submitted to the Society for approval. Forms of welding pro-
cedure test records are to be at the discretion of the Society.
(2) A statement of the results of assessing each test piece, including repeat tests, is to be made for
each welding procedure test. The relevant items listed for the WPS of these requirements are to
be included.
(3) A statement that the test piece was made according to the particular welding procedure is to be
signed by the Surveyor witnessing the test and is to include the Society´s identification.

407. Validity of qualified welding procedure specification


1. General
(1) Welding procedures qualified at a manufacturer are valid for welding in workshops under the
same technical and quality management.
(2) Qualification of a welding procedure remains valid provided the welding variables are kept with-
in the qualified range during production welding. When one or more variables outside the quali-
fied range given in 2. occur, the welding procedure is to be respecified and requalified by
welding procedure qualification tests.
(3) Shop primers may have an influence on the quality of fillet welds and is to be considered.
Welding procedure qualification with shop primer will qualify those without but not vice versa.
(4) Validity of welding variables for the welding procedure specification of aluminium alloy is to
be in accordance with the Guidance relating to Rules.
2. Validity of variables for qualified WPS is as follows. However, it may be considered as equiv-
alent for the requirements of the standard internationally recognized(AW S , ASM E etc.) are applied.
(1) Base metal Kind of base metal and their validity are as follows. Other materials not specified
herein is to be in accordance with the requirements of the standard internationally recognized as
deemed appropriate by the Society.
(a) Normal and higher strength hull structural steels
① Normal strength steel(A , B , D and E ) or equivalent structural steels with tensile
strength 400 ~ 520 Nmm  .
② Higher strength steels(AH 32, D H 32, EH 32, FH 32, AH 36, D H 36, EH 36, FH 36,
AH 40, D H 40, EH 40 and FH 40) or equivalent structural steels with minimum
specified yield strength 315 ~ 390 Nmm  .
③ Weldable high strength quenched and tempered steels (Pt 2, Ch 1, 308. of the
Rules) or equivalent structural steels with minimum specified yield strength 420~690
Nmm  .
(i) For each strength level, welding procedures are considered applicable to the same and
lower toughness grades as that tested.
(ii) For each toughness grade of normal and higher strength hull structural steels, welding
procedures are considered applicable to the same and two lower strength levels as that
tested.
(iii) For each toughness grade of high strength quenched and tempered steels, welding proce-
dures are considered applicable to the same and one lower strength level as that tested.
(iv) For applying the above (a) and (b) to high heat input processes above 50 kJ/cm, e.g.
the two-run technique with either submerged arc or gas shielded metal arc welding,
electro slag and electro gas welding, welding procedure is applicable to that toughness
grade tested and one strength level below.
(v) For the high strength quenched and tempered steels, the approval of quenched and tem-
pered steels does not quality thermo-mechanically rolled steels (TMCP steels) and vice
versa.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 125


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(b) Weldable C and C-Mn hull steel castings The approval of quenched and tempered hull
steel castings does not quality other delivery conditions and vice versa.
(c) Weldable C and C-Mn hull and general purpose steel forgings The approval of
quenched and tempered hull steel forgings does not quality other delivery conditions and
vice versa.
(d) Rolled steels for low temperature service and Steel pipes for low temperature service
(e) Rolled stainless steels and Stainless steel pipes
(2) Thickness and outer diameter of base metal
(a) The qualification of a WPS carried out on a plate or pipe test assembly of thickness t is
valid for the thickness range given in Table 2.2.9

Table 2.2.9 Qualified thickness range for butt, T-joint and fillet welds

Range of approval (mm)


Thickness of test piece,
 (mm) (1) Butt and T-joint welds with single Butt and T-joint welds with
run or single run from both sides multi-run and fillet welds (2)
 ≤ 3 0.8 ∼ 1.1  ∼ 2
3 <  ≤ 12 0.7 ∼ 1.1 3 ∼ 2
(3)
12 <  ≤ 100 0.7 ∼ 1.1 0.5 ∼ 2 (max.150)
(3)
100 <  0.8 ∼ 1.1 0.5 ∼ 1.5
Notes ;
(1) For multi process procedures, the recorded thickness contribution of each process is to be used
as a basis for the range of approval for the individual welding process.
(2) For fillet welds, the range of approval is to be applied to both base metals.
(3) For high heat input processes over 50 kJ/cm, the upper limit of range of approval is to be 1.0
x .

(b) In addition to the requirements of Table 2.2.9, the range of approval of throat thickness
"a" for fillet welds is to be as follows:
(i) Single run ; "0.75 x a" to "1.5 x a"
(ii) Multi-run ; as for butt welds with multi-run (i.e. a=t)
(c) The qualification of a WPS carried out on a pipe test assembly is valid for the outer diam-
eter range given in Table 2.2.10.

Table 2.2.10 Qualified outer diameter range for pipe welds


Outer diameter D (mm) Qualified range
D ≤ 168.3 0.5 D ~ 2 D
D 〉 168.3 ≥ 0.5 D

(d) For the vertical-down welding, the test piece thickness "t" is always taken as the upper lim-
it of the range of application.
(e) For unequal plate thickness of butt welds the lesser thickness is ruling dimension.
(f) Notwithstanding the above, the approval of maximum thickness of base metal for any tech-
nique is to be restricted to the thickness of test assembly if three of the hardness values in
the heat affected zone are found to be within 25 Hv of the maximum permitted, as stated
404. 10 (2) and 405. 7 of the Rules.
(3) Welding positions
Approval for a test made in any position is restricted to that position (see Fig 2.2.9 and Fig
2.2.10 of the Rules). To qualify a range of positions, test assemblies are to be welded for

126 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

highest heat input position and lowest heat input position and all applicable tests are to be
made on those assemblies.
(4) Welding process
(a) The approval is only valid for the welding process(es) used in the welding procedure test. It
is not permitted to change from a multi-run to a single run.
(b) For multi-process procedures the welding procedure approval may be carried out with sepa-
rate welding procedure tests for each welding process. It is also possible to make the weld-
ing procedure test as a multi-process procedure test. The approval of such a test is only
valid for the process sequence carried out during the multi-process procedure test.
(5) Welding consumables
(a) Except high heat input processes over 50 kJ/cm, welding consumables cover other approved
welding consumables having the same grade mark including all suffixes specified in Pt 2,
Ch 2, Sec 6 of the Rules with the welding consumable tested.
(b) Change in welding consumables specified in Table 2.2.3(Application of welding con-
sumables) of Pt 2, Ch 2 of the Rules.
(c) Change in shielding gas in accordance with Pt 2, Ch 2, 603. 3 (4) of the Rules.
(6) Welding condition
(a) Change from short circuiting transfer to spray arc or pulsed arc or vice versa.
(b) Change of welding voltage, current and/or travel speed are to be at the discretion of the
Society.
(c) The minimum preheating temperature is not to be 15℃ less than that used in the
qualification. The maximum interpass temperature is not to be 56℃ higher than that used in
the qualification
(d) The heat treatment used in the qualification test is to be maintained during manufacture.
Holding time may be adjusted as a function of thickness.
(7) Heat input
(a) The upper limit of heat input approved is 25 % greater than that used in welding the test
piece or 55 kJ/cm whichever is smaller, except that the upper limit is 10 % greater than that
for high heat input processes over 50 kJ/cm.
(b) The lower limit of heat input approved is 25 % lower than that used in welding the test
piece.
(8) Type of joint
(a) Range of approval depending on type of welded joints for test assembly is to be specified
in Table 2.2.11
(b) A qualification test performed on a butt weld will also qualify for fillet welding within the
thickness ranges specified for fillet welds specified in (2) (a) above.

Table 2.2.11 Range of approval for type of welded joint


Type of welded joint for test assembly Range of approval
With backing A A, C, D
One side
Without backing B A, B, C, D
Butt welding
With gouging C C
Both side
Without gouging D C, D

(c) Change of specified type of joint which may significantly affect penetration and fusion etc,
of the weld. However decrease in the groove angle, decrease in the root opening or increase
in root face is to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.
(9) Others The Validity relating to the welding variables other than previous (1) to (8) may com-
ply with the requirements of the internationally recognized Code (AW S, ASM E, ISO , EN etc.)

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 127


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

3. For changes other than previous 2, the welding procedure qualification test may be dispensed with.
In this case, the welding procedure specification to which the related procedure qualification re-
cord(PQR) is attached is to be requalified.

128 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 5 Welders and Welder Performance Qualification Tests

501. General
1. Each welder intended to engage in the manual and semi-automatic welding work specified in this
Section is to pass the performance qualification tests required according to the applicable welding
process, welding position and kinds of materials to be welded and to have the performance qual-
ification by the Society.
2. Welders engaged in tack welding should be qualified for either butt welds or fillet welds, for the
welding process and the position corresponding to the joint to be welded. If requested, the Society
may qualify those welders engaged in tack welding works only in accordance with the Guidance in
relating to Rules.
3. Welding operators intended to engage in automatic welding work are to be those skillful for the
actual welding work in which they will engage. If requested, the Society may qualify those welding
operators engaged in automatic welding works only in accordance with the Guidance in relating to
Rules.
4. The performance qualification test of welder intended to engage in the special material and welding
work not prescribed in this Section are to be at the discretion of the Society.
5. The application of more suitable requirements instead of the requirements of this Section is left to
the discretion of the Society.

502. Grades, and range of qualification


1. A welder should be qualified in relation to the variables such as base material, welding process,
type of welded joint, plate thickness and welding position.
2. Welding processes
(1) The welding processes for welder’'s qualification are to be classified in Table 2.2.12-1.

Table 2.2.12-1 Welding processes for welder’'s qualification


Symbol Welding process in actual welding works
M Manual welding Shield Metal Arc Welding(SMAW)
(1) Flux Cored Arc Welding(FCAW)
S Semi-automatic welding
(2) Gas Metal Arc Welding(GMAW)
T TIG welding Gas Tungsten Arc Welding(GTAW)

(2) A welder intended to engage in the multi-process welding work is to pass the separate perform-
ance qualification tests for each welding process.
3. Types of welded joint
(1) The types of welded joint for welder's qualification are to be classified as shown in Table
2.2.12-2 in accordance with the qualification test.
(2) A qualification test performed using butt welds automatically qualifies fillet welding.
(3) The Society may qualify the welders who are employed to perform fillet welding only.
However, where such welders are engaged to weld fillet with groove they are to be qualified
for butt welds.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 129


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.12-2. Types of welded joint for welder's qualification


Type of welded joint used in the test assembly for the qualification test(1) Type of welded joint qualified
With backing WB WB, FW
Butt weld Single sided weld(2)
Without backing NB WB, NB, FW
Fillet weld - FW FW
NOTES:
(1) A qualification test performed using butt weld test assembly for pipes automatically qualifies butt weld test
for plates.
(2) A qualification test performed using single sided weld automatically qualifies double sided weld.

4. Base materials
(1) Base materials for qualification tests are grouped as follows;
(a) Carbon and low alloy rolled steels, tubes and pipes, castings and forgings
(b) Stainless rolled steels, tubes and pipes, castings and forgings
(c) Aluminium alloy
(d) Copper alloy castings
(2) A welder passed the qualification test with certain material in specific material group may be
accepted to weld other materials in same material group.
(3) For welding with materials in different material groups, qualification approval may be carried
out with separate qualification test for each material.
5. Thickness and outer diameter of base metal
(1) The welder qualification carried out on a plate or pipe test assembly of thickness T is valid for
the thickness range given in Table 2.2.13-1

Table 2.2.13-1 Qualified thickness range for welder qualification


Grade Thickness of test assembly, T(mm) Qualified thickness range t(mm)
1 T≤3 T≤t<2T
2 3<T≤20 3<t≤2T
(1)
3 20<T 5<t
3R 12.5<T 5<t
Note
(1) For aluminium alloy, the upper limit of qualified thickness range is to be 40mm. For aluminium alloy
with thickness over 40mm, additional tests may be carried out as deemed necessary by the Society.

(2) The welder qualification carried out on a pipe test assembly is valid for the outer diameter
range given in Table 2.2.13-2.

Table 2.2.13-2 Qualified outer diameter range for pipe welds


Grade Outer diameter D (mm) Qualified range
1 D≤25 D∼2D
2 25<D≤150 0.5D∼2D(Min. 25mm)
3 150<D ≥0.5D
3R(T, K and Y Joint) 150<D ≥100mm
Note;
(1) Test assemblies for the pipes over 500 mm in diameter may be those for the plates.

130 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

6 Positions
The positions for qualification test and positions qualified for actual welding work are to comply
with the Table 2.2.14.

Table 2.2.14 Welding Positions for Welder Qualification

Welding positions in actual welding work(2)


Grade Test Positions(1) Plates Pipes
Butt joint Fillet joint Butt joint Fillet joint
(3)
1G F F, H F F, H
Flat
1F - F - F
(3)
2G F, H F, H F, H F, H
Horizontal
2F - F, H - F, H
(3)
3G-up F, H, VU F, H, VU F, H, VU F, H, VU
For each Vertical-upward
grade of 3F-up - F, H, VU - F, H, VU
plates
3G-down F, VD F, VD - -
Vertical-downward
3F-down - F, VD - -
(3)
4G F, H, OH F, H, OH F, OH F, H, OH
Overhead
4F - F, H, OH - F, H, OH
(3)
3G-up+4G All All All All
1G-P F F F F, H
Horizontal-rolled
1F-P - F - F
2G-P F, H F, H F, H F, H
Vertical-fixed
2F-P - F, H - F, H
5G-P F, V, OH F, V, OH F, V, OH F, V, OH
For each Horizontal-fixed
grade of 5F-P - F, V, OH - F, V, OH
pipes(7) Vertical-fixed+Horizontal-fixed
All All All All
(2G-P)+(5G-P)
6G-P All All All All
Inclined-fixed
6F-P - All - All

Inclined-fixed with restriction


(4) All All All All
ring (6GR-P)

NOTES:
(1) Test positions are to comply with Fig 2.2.9 and Fig 2.2.10.
(2) F=Flat, VU=Vertical-Up, VD=Vertical-Down, H=Horizontal, OH=Overhead
(3) Only qualified for pipe over 600 mm in diameter with backing strips or back gouging.
(4) Test in the 6GR-P position qualify welding in T, K & Y connection(Grade 3R) and welds with re-
stricted access.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 131


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.9 Welding position of plates

132 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.10 Welding position of pipes

503. Testing procedure


1. General
(1) Test assemblies may be welded with either alternating current or direct current.
(2) The test assemblies are not to be changed their up-and-down or right-and-left position through-
out the welding operation.
(3) The welding is to be carried out only on one side and the back welding is not to be carried
out unless specified otherwise.
(4) In general, the test assemblies for plates are to be so restrained or prestrained that the warping
due to the welding does not exceed an angular distortion of 5 degrees.
(5) The test assemblies are not to be subjected to peening or heat treatment throughout the period
before, during and after the welding.
(6) The backing strips of the test assemblies may be used steel plates, copper plate, ceramic or
similar materials to obtain the enough penetration.
(7) Welding of the test assemblies and testing of test specimens should be witnessed by the
Surveyor.
2. Test assemblies
(1) Test assemblies for butt welds and for fillet welds are to be prepared as shown in Fig 2.2.11
to Fig 2.2.15 in each qualification test.
(2) Materials used for tests are to be those specified in 502. 4 or those which are considered

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 133


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

equivalent by the Society.

Fig 2.2.11 Dimensions and types of test Fig 2.2.12 Dimensions and types of test
assembly for butt welds assembly for butt welds(T≧12mm)

Fig 2.2.13 Dimensions and types of test assembly for fillet welds

Fig 2.2.14 Dimensions and types of test Fig 2.2.15 Dimensions and types of test assembly
assembly for pipe butt welds for pipe fillet welds

(3) The dimensions and types of welded joint are to be as indicated in Fig 2.2.16 and Fig 2.2.17
or those which are considered equivalent by the Society.

134 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Materials Mild steel and stainless steel Aluminium alloy

Grade 1

Grade 2

Grade 3

Fig 2.2.16 Dimensions and types of welded joint-plates

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 135


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Materials Mild steel and stainless steel Aluminium alloy

Grade 1

Grade 2

Grade 3

Grade 3R

Fig 2.2.17 Dimensions and types of welded joint-pipes

136 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(4) Welding consumables used in qualification tests should be type approved one or those which
are considered equivalent by the Society.
3. Examination and test
(1) Examination and test are as specified in Table 2.2.15.

Table 2.2.15. Examination and test for Welder Qualification


(3)
Kinds Examination and test
Butt welds Visual inspection, Bend test(1)

Fillet welds Visual inspection, Fracture test(2)

NOTES
(1) Radiographic test may be carried out in lieu of bend test.
(2) Two macro sections may be taken in lieu of the fracture test.
(3) Additional tests may be required, at the discretion of the Society

(2) Visual examination


(a) The welds should be visually examined prior to the cutting of the test specimen for the
bend test.
(b) The result of the examination is to show the absence of cracks or other serious
imperfections. Imperfections detected are to be assessed in accordance with quality level B
in KS B ISO 5817, except for imperfection typea such as excess weld metal, excess pene-
tration, excessive convexity and excessive throat thickness for which level C applies
(3) Bend test
(a) One face bend test and root bend test specimen are to be tested. For thickness 12 mm and
over, two side specimens may be tested as an alternative.
(b) Bend test specimens are to be of size and dimensions given in Table 2.2.2 according to
the kind of test assemblies.
(c) The mandrel diameter to thickness ratio (i.e. D/t) is to be that specified in each article of
Pt 2, Ch 2, Sec 6 of the Rules +1 except for aluminium alloy for which requirements in
Table 2.2.64 of Pt 2, Ch 2, 608 of the Rules applies
(d) The test specimens are to be bent through 180 degrees. After the test, the test specimens
should not reveal any open defects in any direction greater than 3mm. Defects appearing at
the corners of a test specimen during testing should be investigated case by case.
(4) Radiographic test
When radiographic testing is used in lieu of bend test, test procedures and acceptance criteria
are to be in accordance with the Guidance in relating to Rules.
(5) Fracture test (Fillet welds)
(a) The fracture test of fillet welds is to be carried out in accordance with the requirements
specified in Pt 2, Ch 2, 405. 8 of the Rules
(b) Evaluation should concentrate on cracks, porosity and pores, inclusions, lack of fusion and
incomplete penetration. Imperfections that are detected should be assessed in accordance with
KS B ISO5817, class B.
(6) Macro examination
When macro examination is used for fillet welds, examination procedures and acceptance criteria
are to be as follows;
(a) The macro examination of fillet welds is to be carried out in accordance with the require-
ments specified in Pt 2, Ch 2, 405. 6 of the Rules
(b) The test specimens are to be prepared and etched on one side to clearly reveal the weld
metal, fusion line, root penetration and the heat affected zone.
(c) Macro sections should include about 10mm of unaffected base metal.
(d) The examination is to reveal a regular weld profile, through fusion between adjacent layers
of weld and base metal, sufficient root penetration and the absence of defects such as
cracks, lack of fusion etc.
4. Retest
(1) When a welder fails a qualification test, the following should apply.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 137


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(a) For the welder who fails to meet the requirements in a part of the tests, the retests as to
the failed tests may be made on duplicate test specimens from the test assemblies welded
within 1 month from the date of the failure and the welder may be treated to have passed
the requirements where all test specimens fully comply with the test requirements.
(b) In cases where the welder fails to meet the requirements in all parts of the required tests or
in the retest prescribed in (a) above, the welder should undertake further training and
practice.
(2) Where any test specimen does not comply with dimensional specifications due to poor machin-
ing, a replacement test assembly should be welded and tested.
5. Certification
(1) Qualification certificates are normally issued to the applicants(shipbuilder or manufacturer) when
the welder has passed the qualification test by the Society.
(2) The following items should be specified in the certificate:
(a) Range of qualification for materials, welding processes, types of welded joint, plate thick-
nesses and welding positions;
(b) Expiry date of the validity of the qualification;
(c) Name, date of birth, identification and the photograph of the welder;
(d) Name of shipbuilder / manufacturer.
6. General requirements for qualification validity
(1) Each shipyard and manufacturer should be responsible for the employment, training, testing, con-
trol of the validity of the certificate and the range of the approval of the welders.
(2) Where welder has not engaged in a particular process and equipment for a period exceeding six
months, his qualification is automatically withdrawn. All the following conditions are fullfilled
for maintaining welder's qualification.
(a) The welder should be engaged with reasonable continuity on welding work within the cur-
rent range of approval. The welder's work should in general be in accordance with the tech-
nical conditions under which the approval test is carried out.
(b) The qualification validity of welder is to be confirmed at six-month intervals by the ship-
yards/manufacturers responsible for weld quality.
(c) The status of approvals of each individual qualification is to be demonstrated to the
Classification Society when requested.
(3) The welder failed to meet the required qualify of the Society in welding work may be sus-
pended his qualification.

138 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 6 Welding Consumables

601. General
1. Application
(1) The covered electrodes for manual welding and gravity welding, wire/flux combinations for two
run or multirun submerged arc welding, solid wire/gas combinations for arc welding, flux cored
wires with or without gas for arc welding and consumables for use in electroslag and electrogas
vertical welding specified in the Rules are to be approved by the Society in accordance with
the requirements in this Section.
(2) The welding consumables which are used in welding processes differing from those specified in
(1) or where it is considered impracticable to apply the requirements in this Section are to be
of the type approved by the Society.
(3) The approval test for welding consumables which are not covered by this Section is to be left
to the discretion of the Society.
2. Process of manufacture
The approved welding consumables are to be manufactured of uniform quality, under the manu-
facturer's responsibility, by the process approved by the Society, at works approved by the Society.
3. Test assemblies
(1) The test assemblies are to be prepared under the supervision of the Surveyor, and all tests are
to be carried out in his presence.
(2) When a welded joint is performed, the edges of the plates are to be bevelled either by mechan-
ical machining or by oxygen cutting; in the later case, a descaling of the bevelled edges is
necessary.
(3) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler mate-
rial is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.
4. Approval test
(1) The approved welding consumables are subject to the approval tests and inspections specified in
602. to 609. in this Section.
(2) Welding consumables are to be approved at each manufacturing plant and for each brand.
However, where are specified in (a) and/or (b) below, a reduced test programme at least equiv-
alent to annual tests is permitted if the manufacturer can certify that the materials used and the
fabrication process are identical with those used in the main works. However, should there be
any doubt, complete test-series may be required.
(a) Where welding consumables which have been approved are intended to manufacture at man-
ufacturing plants other than those of the manufacturers who manufacture the said welding
consumables.
(b) Where welding consumables which have been approved are intended to manufacture accord-
ing to technical licensing agreements with those parties who manufacture the said welding
consumables.
(3) Wire flux combination for submerged arc welding. If a unique powder flux is combined with
different wires coming from several factories belonging to the same firm, it may be admitted to
perform only one test-series if the different wires are conformable to the same technical specifi-
cation, after approval of the Society.
(4) Where deemed necessary by the Society, tests other than those specified in this Section may be
required.
5. Periodical inspection
The manufacturer of welding materials is to be subjected to the periodical inspection in the pres-
ence of Surveyor for each brands of the welding materials at each manufacturing plant in a period
not exceeding 12 months.
6. Alterations to approved consumables
(1) In case when the particulars of the welding materials which being mentioned in the certificate

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 139


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

of approval, such as grade, welding position, maximum diameter of welding materials or shield
gas, are changed, the manufacturer is to submit a copy of application form for change to the
Society, and necessary additional approval tests are to be carried out accordingly.
(2) When the significant changes in compositions or manufacturing process of the wire and flux or
removal of manufacturing plant is made, the manufacturer is to submit a single copy of notifi-
cation of alternation in any preferred form to the Society, and necessary confirmation survey
and test may be carried out accordingly.
(3) Upgrading and uprating of welding consumables will be considered only at manufacturer's re-
quest, preferably at the time of annual testing. Generally, for this purpose, tests from butt weld
assemblies will be required in addition to the normal annual approval tests..
7. Retests
(1) Tensile test and bend test
(a) Where the tensile test and bend test fail to meet the requirements, twice as many test speci-
mens as the number of specimens of failed test are to be selected from the first test materi-
al or from a test material welded under the same welding conditions, and if all of test
specimens pass the tests, then the tests are considered to be successful.
(b) Where insufficient original welded assembly is available, a new assembly is to be prepared
using welding consumables from the same batch.
(c) If the new assembly is made with the same procedure (particularly the number of runs) as
the original assembly, only the duplicate re-test specimens needs to be prepared and tested.
Otherwise, all test specimens should be prepared as for re-testing.
(2) Impact test
(a) Where the result of the impact test is unsatisfactory, additional tests may be carried out,
with the exception of the cases specified in (i) and (ii) below, by taking a set of test speci-
mens out of the same test material from which the above-mentioned test specimens have
been taken.
(i) The absorbed energy of all test specimens is under the required average absorbed
energy.
(ii) The absorbed energy of two of the test specimens is under 70 % the required average
absorbed energy.
(b) In case of the previous (a), the test specimens may be accepted, provided that the average
absorbed energy of the six test specimens, including those which have been rejected as un-
satisfactory, is not less than the required average absorbed energy, and that not more than
two individual results are lower than the required average absorb energy and of these, not
more than one result is below 70 % of the required average absorbed energy.
(3) Where the retest fails to meet the requirements, the test may be made over again with changed
welding conditions. In this case, if the whole tests specified for the test assembly are carried
out and are in compliance with the requirements, the test is accepted as successful.
8. Revocation of approval
In the following cases, the approval of welding consumables by the Society shall be revoked, after
notice is given to the manufacturer:
(1) When the Society has recognized that the quality is remarkably worse than that approved or is
not uniform.
(2) When the welding consumables have failed the requirements in the annual inspections.
(3) When the welding consumables are not inspected annually as required by the Rules.
9. Data
The Society may require the submission of the data with respect to the properties of welding con-
sumables if necessary.
10. Packings and markings
(1) The approved welding consumables are to be packed throughly to keep the quality during their
transportation and storage.
(2) All packages of approved welding consumables are to clearly marked with the following de-
scriptions together with the approved mark of the Society.
(a) Brand
(b) Name of manufacturer

140 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(c) Kind of gas if used


(d) Grade or mark of welding consumables
(e) Electric current and its polarity
(f) Welding positions
(g) Date and number of production
(h) Sizes (diameter of core wire, length of elect rode, grain size of flux for submerged arc
welding, etc.)
(i) Special notices on the treatment

602. Electrodes for manual arc welding for normal strength steels, higher strength
steels and steels for low temperature service
1. Application
(1) Electrodes for manual arc welding for normal strength steels, higther strength steels and steels
for low temperature service given in the following (a) and (b) (hereinafter referred to as
"electrodes") are to be subjected to the approval test and annual inspections in accordance with
the requirements in 602.
(a) Electrodes for manual welding
(i) For butt welds
(ii) For fillet welds
(iii) For both butt welds and fillet welds
(b) Electrodes used in gravity welding or similar set-ups
(i) For fillet welds
(ii) For both butt welds and fillet welds
(2) Any requirements regarding one side welding without backing are left to the discretion of the
Society.
2. Grades and marks of electrode
(1) Electrodes are classified as specified in Table 2.2.16.

Table 2.2.16 Grades and Marks

For steel for low


For normal strength steel For higher strength steel
temperature service
2Y , 3Y , 4Y , 5Y , L 1, L 2, L 3,
1, 2, 3
2Y40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40 L 91, L 92

(2) For low hydrogen electrodes which have passed the hydrogen test specified in Par 6, the suf-
fixes given in Table 2.2.22 are to be added to the grade marks of the said electrodes. (e.g. 2Y
H 5)
3. General provisions for tests
(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimension of test assemblies, diameter of electrodes used
for welding, welding positions, grades and number of test specimens to be taken from each test
assembly for electrodes given in Par 1 (1) (a) (i) and (iii) are to be as given in Table 2.2.17.
However, where deemed necessary by the Society, hot cracking tests may be required by the
Society in addition to tests specified in this Table.
(2) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimension of test assemblies, diameter of electrodes used
for welding and welding positions, together with grades and number of test specimens to be
taken from each test assembly for electrodes given in Par 1 (1) (a) (ii), are to be as given in
Table 2.2.18.
(3) Tests for electrodes given in Par 1 (1) (b) are to be in accordance with the requirements in
the following (a) and (b):
(a) For electrodes given in Par 1 (1) (b) (i), tests given in Table 2.2.18 specified in the pre-
ceding (2) are to be conducted.
(b) For electrodes given in Par 1 (1) (b) (ii), tests specified in the preceding (a) and butt weld
test given in Table 2.2.17 specified in the preceding (1) are to be conducted.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 141


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.17 Kinds of Test for Electrode

Test assembly
Kind and No. of test
Kind of No. of Dimensions
Welding Thickness specimens taken from test
test Diameter of electrode (mm) test of test
position (mm) assembly
assemblies assembly
Deposited 4 1(1) Fig Tensile test specimen : 1
Flat (1)
20
metal test max. diameter 1 2.2.18 Impact test specimen : 3
First run. 4;
Subsequent runs:5 or over; 1
Last two runs. max. dia.
Flat
First run. 4;
(2)
Second run,5 or 6; 1
Subsequent runs. max. dia.
Tensile test specimen : 1
Butt weld Horizontal First run. 4 or 5 Fig Face bend specimen : 1
(4) 1 15~20
test Subsequent runs, 5 2.2.20 Root bend specimen : 1
(5)
Vertical First run. 3.2; Impact test specimen : 3
1
upward Subsequent runs. 4 or 5
Vertical (3)
1
downward
First run. 3.2;
Overhead 1
Subsequent runs. 4 or 5
Macro structure test
Fillet
One side; max. dia. Fig specimen : 3(8)
weld Horizontal 1 20
(6) The other side; min. dia. 2.2.21 Hardness test specimen : 3(8)
test
Fracture test specimen : 2
Hydrogen (9)
(7) Flat 4 4 12 Hydrogen test specimen : 1
test
NOTES:
(1) Where the diameter of the manufactured electrodes is of one type, there is to be one test assembly.
(2) Where the tests are conducted solely in the downhand position, this test assembly has been added.
(3) Electrodes with diameters specified by the manufacturers are to be used.
(4) For electrodes which have passed butt weld tests in the downhand and vertical upward positions, test in
the horizontal position may be omitted subject to approval by the Society.
(5) Impact tests are not to conduct for overhead welds.
(6) This test is added solely for electrodes used in both butt welds and fillet welds.
(7) This test is to conduct solely for low hydrogen electrodes.
(8) Test specimens used in macro structure test and hardness tests are considered to be the same.
(9) Dimensions of test assembly are to be as specified in 602. 6.

(4) Where electrodes are intended to be used for both items specified in Par 1 (1) (a) and (b), ap-
proval tests required for each electrode are to be conducted. However, deposited metal tests
may be omitted for electrodes given in Par 1 (1) (b).
(5) Steel plates to be used in preparation of test assemblies are to be as given in Table 2.2.19 ac-
cording to the grades of electrode.
(6) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc. are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler met-
al is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.
(7) For the approval of electrodes, the tests specified in the preceding (1) to (4) are to be con-
ducted for each brand of electrodes.
(8) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment.

142 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.18 Kinds of Test for Electrode

Test assembly
Kind of Diameter of Dimensions Kind and No. of test specimens taken
test Welding No. of test Thickness from test assembly
electrode of test
position assemblies (mm)
(mm) assembly
4 1
Deposited Tensile test specimen : 1
Flat max. Fig 2.2.18 20
metal test 1 Impact test specimen : 3
diameter
Flat 1
Horizontal-
1
vertical One side;
max. dia. Macro structure test specimen : 3(1)
Fillet Vertical
The other 1 Fig 2.2.20 20 Hardness test specimen : 3(1)
weld test upward
side; min. Fracture test specimen : 2
Vertical dia.
1
downward
Overhead 1
Hydrogen (3)
Flat 4 4 12 Hydrogen test specimen : 1
test(2)
NOTES:
(1) Test specimens used in macro tests and hardness tests are considered to be the same.
(2) This test is to conduct solely for low hydrogen electrodes.
(3) Dimensions of test assembly are to be as specified in 602. 2. 6.

Table 2.2.19 Grade of Steels used for Test Assembly


Grade of electrode Grade of steels used for test assembly(1)(2)
1 A
2 A , B or D
3 A , B , D or E
2Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32 or D H 36
3Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32 or E H 36
4Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
5Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
2Y 40 A H 40 or D H 40
3Y 40 A H 40, D H 40 or E H 40
4Y 40 A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
5Y 40 A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
L1 E or R L 24A
L2 E , R L 24A , R L 24B , R L 27 or R L 33
L3 R L 27, R L 33 or R L 37
L 91 R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
L 92 R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
NOTES:
(1) Notwithstanding the requirements in this Table normal strength or higher strength steel may be used for
the deposited metal test assembly. In this case, test assemblies of grade L 91 and L 92 are to be appro-
priately buttered.
(2) The tensile strength of higher strength steels A H 32, D H 32 E H 32, and F H 32 used in butt weld test as-
semblies is to be greater than 490 Nmm  .

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 143


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(9) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.
4. Deposited metal test
(1) Welding of deposited metal test assemblies
(a) Test assembly as shown in Fig 2.2.18 is to be welded in the downhand position according
to the normal practice.
(b) The weld metal is to be deposited in single or multi-run layers according to normal prac-
tice, and the direction of each run is to alternate from each end of the plate, each run of
weld metal being not less than 2 mm but not more than 4 mm thick.
(c) After each run, the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than
250℃ but not below 100℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the
surface of seam.

(2) Chemical analysis


The chemical analysis of the deposited weld metal in each test assembly is to be supplied by
the manufacturer and is to include the content of all significant alloying element.
(3) Deposited metal tensile test
(a) The tensile test specimen, one from each test assembly, is to be machined to dimensions
R14A test specimen as shown in Table 2.2.1, care being taken that the longitudinal axis
coincides with the centre of weld and the mid-thickness of plates.
(b) The tensile test specimen may be subjected to a temperature not exceeding 250 ℃ for a pe-
riod not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior to testing.
(c) The tensile strength, yield strength and elongation of each test specimen are to comply with
the requirements given in Table 2.2.20, where the upper limit of tensile strength is ex-
ceeded, special consideration will be given to the approval of the electrode, taking into con-
sideration of the other mechanical properties shown in the test results and the chemical
composition of deposited metal.
(4) Deposited metal impact tests
(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions charphy V-notch impact test specimen as shown in Table 2.1.3. The test speci-
men is to be cut with its longitudinal axis transverse to the direction of welding, and the
test specimen is to coincide with the mid-thickness of the plate shown in Fig 2.2.19.
(b) The notch is to be positioned in the centre of weld and is to be cut in the face of test
specimens perpendicular to the surface of plate.

144 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.19 Position of Butt Weld Impact Test Specimen


(Unit : mm, t : plate thickness)

(c) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.20.

Table 2.2.20 Tensile and impact Test Requirements for Deposited Metal
Impact test
Grade of Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation
electrode (Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) () Average absorbed
Test temp. (℃)
energy(J)
1 20
2 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. 0
3 -20
2Y 0
3Y -20
490 ∼ 660 375 min. 22 min.
4Y -40 47 min.
5Y -60
2Y 40 0
3Y 40 -20
510 ∼ 690 400 min. 22 min.
4Y 40 -40
5Y 40 -60
L1 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. -40
L2 440 ∼ 610 345 min. 22 min. -60 34 min.
L3 490 ∼ 660 375 min. 21 min. -60
(1)
L 91 590 min. 375 min. 25 min. -196
(1)
27 min.
L 92 660 min. 410 min. 25 min. -196
NOTE:
(1) 0.2 % Yield strength

(d) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is
less in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a
single test specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy,
the test is considered to have failed.
5. Butt weld test
(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies
(a) Test assembly as shown in Fig 2.2.20 is to be welded in each welding position (flat, hori-
zontal-vertical, vertical-upward, vertical downward and overhead) which is recommended by
the manufacturer, according to the normal practice.
(b) Test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than 250℃ but not below
100℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the surface of seam.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 145


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.20 Butt weld Test Assembly for Electrode for Manual Arc Welding (Unit: mm)

(c) In all cases, the back sealing runs are to be made with 4 mm electrode in the welding po-
sition appropriate to each test assembly, after cutting out the root run to clean metal. For
electrodes suitable for downhand welding only, the test assemblies may be turned over to
carry out the back sealing run.
(2) Butt weld tensile tests
(a) The tensile test specimen is to be R 2A specimen shown in Table 2.2.1 and the test speci-
men is to be taken from each test assembly.
(b) The surface of weld is to be machined flush with the surface of plate.
(c) The tensile strength of test specimen is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.2.21.
(3) Butt weld bend test
(a) The face and root bend test specimens are to be RB 4 specimen shown in Table 2.2.2, and
test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly. However, for L 91 or L 92, the
face and root bend specimens are to be RB 1 specimen shown in Table 2.2.2, and test
specimens are to be taken longitudinally from each test assembly.
(b) The upper and lower surfaces of the weld are to be filed, ground or machined flush with
the Surface of the plate and the sharp corners of the specimens rounded to a radius not ex-
ceeding 2 mm.
(c) The test specimens are to be capable of withstanding, without crack exceeding 3 mm long
on the outer surface of other defects, being bent through an angle of 120 degrees over a
former having a radius of 1.5 times the thickness of test specimen. The radius and angle of
the former for L 91 and L 92, however, are to be 2 tim es the thickness of the specimen and
180 degrees respectively.

146 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.21 Tensile and impact Test Requirements for butt weld
Impact test
Grade of Tensile strength Average absorbed energy (J)
electrode (Nmm  ) Test temp.
(℃) Flat, Horizontal, Vertical upward
Overhead Vertical downward
1 20
2 400 min. 0
3 -20
2Y 0 34 min.
3Y -20
490 min.
4Y -40 47 min.
5Y -60
2Y 40 0
3Y 40 -20
510 min. 39 min.
4Y 40 -40
5Y 40 -60
L1 400 min. -40
L2 440 min. -60
L3 490 min. -60 27 min. 27 min.
L 91 630 min. -196
L 92 670 min. -196

(4) Butt weld impact tests


(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions charphy V-notch impact test specimens as shown in Table 2.1.3.
(b) The test specimens are to be prepared as shown in Fig 2.2.19 and the dimensions, form,
position and direction of notches are to be as specified in Par 4. (4)
(c) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.21, appropriate to the grades of the electrode and welding position.
(d) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is
less in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a
single test specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy,
the test is considered to have failed.
6. Hydrogen test

The hydrogen test to be carried out by the mercury method or gas chromatographic method. The
use of the glycerine method may be admitted at the Society discretion.
(1) The mercury method to be as specified in the Standard KS B ISO 3690
(2) The gas chromatographic method to be as specified in the Standard KS D0064(Method of
Measurement for Hydrogen Evolved from Steel Welds)
(3) Glycerin method
(a) Welding of test assemblies
(i) As a rule, mild and high tensile steels are to be used for the test assembly, and four
test specimens are to be prepared measuring 12 mm by 25 mm in cross section by about
125 mm in length. Before welding, the specimens are to be weighed to the nearest 0.1
gram . On the 25 mm surface of each test specimen, a single bead of welding is to be
deposited, about 100 mm in length, by a 4 mm electrode, using about 150 mm of the
electrode. The welding is to be carried out with as short an arc as possible and with a
current of about 150  .
(ii) The electrodes, prior to welding, can be submitted to the normal drying process recom-
mended by the manufacturer.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 147


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(b) After welding, each test specimen prepared to the hydrogen test specified in (a) above is to
be quenched in water at a temperature of approximately 20℃ for 30 sec, after removing the
slag within a period of 30 sec. Subsequently, the test specimens are to be cleaned and be
sealed into a hydrogen collector by means of the glycerin replacement method.
The glycerin is to be kept at a temperature of approximately 45℃ during the test. The test
time required for all the four test specimens from welding to the enclosure in the hydrogen
collector is to be within 30 min. After immersing into glycerin for 48 hours, the test
specimens are to be cleaned with water and alcohol and weighed with an accuracy of 0.1 g
after being dried to measure the weight of the deposited metal. The volume of hydrogen
gas collected is to be measured with an accuracy of 0.05 cm  and converted into that under
the conditions 20℃ and 1 atmospheric pressure (760 mm  ).
(4) Average diffusible hydrogen contents of the four specimens is to comply with the requirements
given in Table 2.2.22 according to the test procedures specified in preceding articles or the
type of suffixes to be added to the grade marks.

Table 2.2.22 Requirements for Hydrogen Contents (  )


Mark Mercury method gas chromatographic method Glycerine method
H15 15 max. 15 max. 10 max.
H10 10 max. 10 max. 5 max.
H5 5 max. 5 max. -

7. Fillet weld test


(1) Welding of fillet weld test assemblies
(a) Test assembly as shown in Fig 2.2.21 is to be welded in each welding position (flat, hori-
zon-vertical, vertical-up ward, vertical-downward and overhead) which is recommended by
the manufacturer.
(b) The first side is to be welded using the maximum size of electrode manufactured and the
second side is to be welded using the minimum size of electrode manufactured.
(c) The leg length of fillet welds may will in general be determined by the electrode size and
the welding current employed during testing.
(d) In case of fillet welds using gravity or similar contact welding method, the fillet welding is
to be carried out with electrodes of maximum length. Where approval is requested for the
welding of both normal strength and higher strength steel, the assemblies are to be prepared
using higher strength steel.

Fig 2.2.21 Fillet Weld Test Assembly (Unit : mm)

(2) Fillet weld macro-structure test


(a) For macro-structure test specimens, those with breadths of 25 mm are selected from three
places shown in Fig 2.2.21.

148 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(b) The macro-etching test is conducted on the transverse section of fillet weld joint and welded
joints are to be free from excessive difference of leg length between upper and lower,
cracks and other injurious defects.
(3) Fillet weld hardness test The hardness of weld metal, heat affected zone and base metal are to
be measured at places given in Fig 2.2.22 for each test specimen which underwent the mac-
ro-etching test specified in preceding (1) and the respective hardnesses are to be in accordance
with those deemed appropriate by the Society.

Fig 2.2.22 Hardness Test (Unit : mm)

(4) Fillet weld fracture test


(a) One of the remaining sections of the fillet weld is to have the weld on the first side goug-
ed or machined to facilitate breaking the fillet weld as shown in Fig 2.2.23, on the second
side by closing the two plates together, submitting the root of the weld to tension. On the
other remaining section the weld on the second side is to be gouged or machined and the
section fractured using the same procedure.
(b) The fractured surfaces are to be examined and there should be no evidence of incomplete
penetration, or internal cracking and they should be reasonably free from porosity.

Fig 2.2.23 Fracture Test

8. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspections, tests specified in the following (2) and (3) are to be conducted for
each brand of the approved electrodes and they are to be passed satisfactorily.
(2) The kinds of test, etc. in the annual inspections for manual arc welding electrodes are to be as
given in Table 2.2.23.
(3) The kinds of test, etc. in the annual inspections of electrodes used in gravity welding or other
welding using similar welding devices are to be as given in Table 2.2.24.
(4) The welding procedures and requirements for test assemblies of tests specified in the preceding
(2) and (3) are to be as specified in Par 4.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 149


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.23 Kind of Test for Annual Inspection

Test assembly
Kind and no. of test
Kind of test
(2) Diameter of specimens taken from test
Welding Thickness
electrode Number Dimensions assembly
position (mm)
(mm)
4(1) 1
Deposited Tensile test specimen : 1
Flat exceeding 4, Fig 2.2.18 20
metal test 1 Impact test specimen : 3
8 max.
NOTES:
(1) Where deemed necessary by the Society, butt weld tests in the downhand or vertical (either upward or
downward) welding position specified in Table 2.2.17 may be requested in place of deposited metal
tests of 4 mm diameter electrodes. In this case, impact test specimens (one set of three) are to be
selected.
(2) For low hydrogen electrodes, an hydrogen test can also be required at the discretion of the Society.

Table 2.2.24 Kind of Test for Annual Inspection

Test assembly Kind and no. of test


Kind of
Welding Diameter of Thickness specimens taken from test
test Number Dimensions
position electrode (mm) (mm) assembly

Deposited Tensile test specimen : 1


Flat 4 min. 1 Fig 2.2.18 20
metal test Impact test specimen : 3

9. Changes in grades
(1) Where changes in the grades relating to the strength or toughness of electrodes approved are to
be made, tests specified in the following (2) and (3) are to be carried out and satisfactorily
passed in accordance with the requirements in 601. 6 (3).
(2) For changes in the grades relating to strength, the butt weld tests, specified in the annual in-
spection of Par 8 and in the requirements of Par 3 (1), are to be conducted.
(3) For changes in the grades relating to toughness, the butt weld impact tests, specified in the an-
nual inspection of Par 8 and in the requirements of Par 3 (1), are to be conducted.

603. Automatic welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength steels
and steels for low temperature service
1. Application
(1) Welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength steels and steels for low tem-
perature service given in the following (a) through (c) (hereinafter referred to as "automatic
welding consumables") are to be subjected to the approval tests and annual inspections in ac-
cordance with the requirements in 603.
(a) Submerged arc automatic welding consumables (Wire flux combinations)
(b) Gas shielded arc automatic welding consumables(Flux cored wire and solid wire automatic
welding consumables with shielding gas)
(c) Self-shielded arc automatic welding consumables (flux-cored or flux-coated wires without a
shielding gas)
(2) Wire-flux combinations for multiple electrode submerged arc welding will be subject to separate
approval tests. They are to be carried out generally in accordance with the requirements in 603.
(3) At the discretion of the Society, wires or wire-gas combinations approved for semi-automatic
multirun welding may also be approved, without additional tests, for automatic multirun welding
approval. This is generally the case when automatic multirun welding is performed in the same
conditions of welding current and energy as semi automatic welding with the concerned wire-gas
combination.

150 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

2. Grades and marks


(1) The automatic welding consumables are classified as specified in Table 2.2.25.

Table 2.2.25 Grade and Marks

For steel for low


For normal strength steel For higher strength steel
temperature service
1Y , 2 Y , 3Y , 4Y , 5 Y L 1, L 2, L 3,
1, 2, 3
2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40 L 91, L 92

(2) Automatic welding materials which have passed the tests for each welding process given in
Table 2.2.28 are to be appended with the suffixes shown in Table 2.2.26 at the end of their
marks.
(3) In the preceding (2), a suffix G will be added to the grade mark for gas shielded arc automatic
welding consumables, and a suffix N will be added for self-shielded wire automatic welding
consumables Further, the type of gas used is to be as specified in Table 2.2.27, and the suffix
given in Table 2.2.27 will be added after the suffix G. (e.g. 3YTM G (M 1))

Table 2.2.26 Marks


Welding technique Mark
(1)
Multi-run technique M
(2)
Two-run technique T
Multi-run and two-run technique TM
NOTES:
(1) Multi-run technique refers to a welding process involving multiple passes.
(2) Two-run technique refers to a welding process involving a single pass on both sides.

Table 2.2.27 Kinds of Gas


Gas composition (V ol.%)
Group Type
   (1)(2)
M 11 1∼5 - 1∼5 Rest
M 12 1∼5 - - Rest
M 1
M 13 - 1∼3 - Rest
M 14 1∼5 1∼3 - Rest
M 21 6∼25 - - Rest
M 2 M 22 - 4∼10 - Rest
M 23 6∼25 1∼8 - Rest
M 31 26∼50 - - Rest
M 3 M 32 - 11∼15 - Rest
M 33 6∼50 9∼15 - Rest
C1 100 - - -
C
C2 Rest 1∼30 - -
I I1 - - - 100
E E1 Except above
NOTE:
(1) Argon may be substituted by Helium up to 95 % of the Argon content.
(2) Approval covers gas mixtures with equal or higher Helium contents only.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 151


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

3. General provisions for tests


(1) Steel plates to be used for test assemblies are to be as given in Table 2.2.28, appropriate to
the kind of automatic welding consumables.
(2) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, grades and number of test
specimens to be taken from each test assembly for automatic welding consumables are to be as
given in Table 2.2.29.
(3) For the approval of automatic welding consumables, the tests specified in the preceding (2) are
to be conducted for each brand of automatic welding consumables.
(4) For gas shielded arc automatic welding consumables, the test in the preceding (3) is to be per-
formed for each type of gas given in Table 2.2.27. When the manufacturer of the material
recommends gas types of the group of M 1, M 2, M 3 or C in Table 2.2.27 and the test is sat-
isfactorily conducted in accordance with the preceding (3) on one of the gas type, the test on
the other gas types belonging to the same group is allowed to be dispensed with at the dis-
cretion of the Society.
(5) Unless otherwise agreed by the Society, additional approval tests are required when a shielding
gas is used other than that used for the original approval tests.
(6) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc. are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler met-
al is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.

Table 2.2.28 Grades of Steel used for Test Assembly

Grade of welding consumable Grade of steel used for test assembly(1)(2)


1 A
2 A , B or D
3 A , B , D or E
1Y A H 32 or A H 36
2Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32 or D H 36
3Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32 or E H 36
4Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
5Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
2Y 40 A H 40 or D H 40
3Y 40 A H 40, D H 40 or E H 40
4Y 40 A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
5Y 40 A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
L1 E or R L 24A
L2 E , R L 24A , R L 24B , R L 27 or R L 33
L3 R L 27, R L 33 or R L 37
L 91 R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
L 92 R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
NOTES:
(1) Notwithstanding the requirements in this Table, normal strength steel or higher strength steels
may be used for deposited metal test assembly In this case, test assemblies of grade L 91 and L
92 are to be appropriately buttered.
(2) The tensile strength of higher strength steels AH 32, DH 32, EH 32 and FH 32 used in butt weld
test assemblies is to be greater than 490 Nmm 

152 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.29 Kinds of Test of Automatic Welding Consumables


Test assembly Kinds and no. of test
Welding (8) Grade of welding
Kind of test Dimen Thickness specimens taken from test
technique(7) consumables Number
-sions (mm)(3) assembly
Deposited metal Fig Tensile test specimen: 2
1, 2, 3 1 20
test 2.2.24 Impact test specimen: 3
1Y , 2Y , 3 Y , 4Y , 5Y (4)
Multi-run Tensile test specimen: 2
2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40
technique Fig Face bend test specimen: 2(4)(6)
Butt weld test L 1, L 2, L 3, 1(4) 20~25
2.2.25 Root bend test specimen: 2(4)(6)
L 91, L 92
Impact test specimen: 3
1 12~15 Tensile test specimen: 2
Longitudinal tensile test speci-
men: 1(5)
1, 1Y
1 20~25 Face bend test specimen: 1
Root bend test specimen: 1
Submerged Impact test specimen: 3
arc welding 1 20~25 Tensile test specimen: 2
Longitudinal tensile test speci-
2, 3
men: 1(5)
Butt 2Y , 3Y , 4 Y , 5Y
weld 1 30~35 Face bend test specimen: 1
2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40
test Root bend test specimen: 1
Impact test specimen: 3
Two-run Fig 12~15(1)
technique 1 2.2.26 Tensile test specimen: 2
Gas 20(2)
(1) Longitudinal tensile test speci-
shielded 1, 2, 3 20~25 (5)
men: 1
and 1Y , 2Y , 3 Y , 4Y , 5Y acceptable Face bend test specimen: 1
self-shielded 2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40 1 maximum Root bend test specimen: 1
arc welding (
thickness Impact test specimen: 3
2)

1 12~15 Tensile test specimen: 2


Longitudinal tensile test speci-
20 or men: 1(5)
L 1, L 2, L 3,
Butt weld test acceptable Face bend test specimen: 1
L 91, L 92 1
maximum Root bend test specimen: 1
thickness Impact test specimen: 3

NOTES:
(1) Thickness of test assemblies where applied maximum plate thickness is not more than 25 mm.
(2) Thickness of test assemblies where applied maximum plate thickness is more than 25 mm.
(3) Where thickness is restricted by welding process, thickness of test assemblies may be changed upon approval of
the Society. Test assemblies shall then be welded using plates of 12 to 15 mm and 20 to 25 mm irrespective of
the grade for which the approval is requested.
(4) The number of butt weld test assemblies for multi-run gas shielded and self-shielded arc welding techniques is to
be one for each welding position. However, where there is more than one welding position, the number of tensile
test specimens and bend test specimens selected from the test assemblies for each welding position may be half
of the specified number.
(5) Test specimens are to be selected from only the thicker of two test assemblies.
(6) The number of face bend and root bend test specimens selected from the butt weld test assemblies for L 91 and
L 92 is to be one each.
(7) Tests on both multi-run and two-run technique are to be conducted for multi-run and two-run welding re-
spectively, and the number, dimensions and thickness of test assemblies, along with the grades and number of test
specimens selected from each test assembly are to be according to each of the welding processes. However, the
number of tensile test specimens in the deposited metal test for the multi-pass welding technique is to be one.
(8) The hydrogen test may be applied by request of the manufacturer.
(9) Where approval is requested for welding of both normal strength and higher strength steel two assemblies are to
be prepared using higher strength steel. Two assemblies prepared using normal strength steel may also be required
at the discretion of the Society.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 153


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(7) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment.
(8) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.
4. Deposited metal test with multi-run technique
(1) Welding of deposited metal test assemblies
(a) Test assemblies as shown in Fig 2.2.24 are to be welded in the flat position by multirun
technique according to the normal practice. The direction of deposition of each run is to
alternate from each end of the plate. After completion of each run, the flux and welding
slag is to be removed.
(b) The thickness of layer is not to be less than the diameter of wire nor less than 4 mm
whichever is the greater for submerged arc automatic welding consumables. For gas shield
and self-shielded are automatic welding consumables the thickness of layer is not to be less
than 3 mm.
(b) After each run, the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than
250℃ but not below 100℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the
surface of seam.
(2) Chemical analysis
The chemical analysis of the deposited weld metal in each test assembly is to be supplied by
the manufacturer and is to include the content of all significant alloying element.

154 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(3) Deposited metal tensile test with multi-run technique


(a) The tensile test specimens, two from each test assembly, are to be machined to dimensions
R14A test specimen as shown in Table 2.2.1, care being taken that the longitudinal axis
coincides with the centre of weld and the mid-thickness of plates.
(b) The tensile strength, yield point and elongation of each test specimen are to comply with
the requirements given in Table 2.2.30, where the upper limit of tensile strength is ex-
ceeded, special consideration will be given to the approval of the electrode, taking into con-
sideration of the other mechanical properties shown in the test results and the chemical
composition of deposited metal.
(c) The tensile test specimens may be subjected to a temperature not exceeding 250 ℃ for a
period not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior to testing.
(4) Deposited metal impact test with multi-run technique
(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions R 4 test specimen as shown in Table 2.1.3. The test specimen is to be cut with
its longitudinal axis transverse to the direction of welding, and the test specimen is to co-
incide with the mid-thickness of the plate shown in Fig 2.2.19.
(b) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.30.

Table 2.2.30 Tensile and Impact Test Requirements for Deposited Metal test
Impact test
Grade of Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation
Test temp. Average absorbed
welding material (Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (%)
(℃) energy (J )
1 20
2 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. 0
3 -20
1Y 20
34 min.
2Y 0
3Y 490 ∼ 660 375 min. 22 min. -20
4Y -40
5Y -60
2Y 40 0
3Y 40 -20
510 ∼ 690 400 min. 22 min. 39 min.
4Y 40 -40
5Y 40 -60
L1 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. -40
L2 440 ∼ 610 345 min. 22 min. -60
L3 490 ∼ 660 375 min. 21 min. -60 27 min.
(1)
L 91 590 min. 375 min. 25 min. -196
(1)
L 92 660 min. 410 min. 25 min. -196
NOTE:
(1) 0.2 % yield stress

(c) The notch is to be positioned in the centre of weld and is to be cut in the face of test
specimens perpendicular to the surface of plate.
(d) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is
less in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a
single test specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy,
the test is considered to have failed.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 155


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

5. Butt weld test with multi-run technique


(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies with multi-run technique
(a) The face side of the test assemblies as shown in Fig 2.2.25 is to be multi-pass welded in
flat position, and the corresponding welding procedure is to follow the requirements of the
preceding 4. (1). However, for gas shield arc and self shielded arc wire automatic welding
consumables, the welding position is to be as specified by the manufacturer.
(b) After completing the face welding in downhand position, back welding is performed. In
this instance, back chipping may be carried out to expose sound deposited metal at the root.
(2) Butt weld tensile test with multi-run technique
(a) The tensile test specimens are to be prepared to R 2A specimen shown in Table 2.2.1 and
two test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly.
(b) The surface of weld is to be machined flush with the surface of plate.
(c) The tensile strength of test specimen is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.2.31.
(3) Butt weld bend test with multi-run technique
(a) The face bend and root bend test specimens are to be RB 4 specimen shown in Table
2.2.2, and two test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly. However, for L 91
or L 92, the face bend and root bend specimens are to be RB 1 specimen shown in Table
2.2.2, and test specimens are to be taken longitudinally from each test assembly.
(b) The test specimens are to be capable of withstanding, without crack exceeding 3 mm long
on the outer surface of other defects, being bent through an angle of 120 degrees over a
former having a radius of 1.5 tim es the thickness of test specimen. The radius and angle of
the former for L 91 and L 92, however, are to be 2 tim es the thickness of the specimen and
180 degrees respectively.

156 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.31 Tensile and Impact Test Requirements for butt weld test with multi-run technique

Grade of welding Impact test


material Tensile strength(Nmm  )
Test temp. (℃) Average absorbed energy (J )
1 20
2 400 min. 0
3 -20
1Y 20
34 min.
2Y 0

3Y 490 min. -20

4Y -40

5Y -60

2Y 40 0

3Y 40 -20
510 min. 39 min.
4Y 40 -40

5Y 40 -60

L1 400 min. -40

L2 440 min. -60

L3 490 min. -60 27 min.

L 91 630 min. -196

L 92 670 min. -196

(4) Butt weld impact test with multi-run technique


(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions R 4 test specimens as shown in Fig 2.1.3. The test specimen is to be cut with
its longitudinal axis perpendicular to the direction of welding, and the test specimen is to
coincide with the mid-thickness of the plate shown in Fig 2.2.19.
(b) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.31.
(c) The requirements in Par 4. (4), (c) and (d) are to correspondingly apply to this Paragraph.
6. Butt weld test with two-run technique
(1) Welding of Butt weld test assemblies with two-run technique
(a) Test assemblies are to be prepared as shown in Fig 2.2.26, and the diameter of wire and
edge preparation are to be as shown in Fig 2.2.27, but some deviation may be allowed
where accepted by the Society.
(b) Test assemblies are to be welded according to the normal practice in downhand position by
two-run technique where each run is to be started alternately from each end of the plate.
After completing the first run, the assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to
100℃ or below, the temperature being taken at the centre of weld on the surface of seam.
(2) Chemical analysis
The chemical analysis of the weld metal is to be supplied by the manufacturer, and is to in-
clude the content of all significant alloying elements.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 157


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

158 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(3) Butt weld tensile tests with two-run technique


(a) The tensile test specimens are to be R2A specimen shown in Table 2.2.1 and two test
specimens are to be taken from each welded assembly.
(b) The surface of weld is to be machined flush with the surface of plate.
(c) The tensile strength of test specimen is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.2.31.
(d) One longitudinal tensile test specimen of R14A shown in Table 2.2.1 is to be machined
from the thicker of the test assembly specified in Table 2.2.28 and the longitudinal direc-
tion of the test specimen is to be parallel to the weld line and the centre line of the test
specimen is to coincide with the centre of second layer.
(e) The longitudinal tensile test specimen in the preceding (4) may be subjected to a temper-
ature not exceeding 250℃ for a period not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior
to testing.
(f) The requirements of tensile test specified in the preceding (d) and (e) are to be as given in
Table 2.2.30. Where the upper limit of tensile strength is exceeded, special consideration
will be given to the approval of the welding consumables, taking into consideration of the
other mechanical properties shown in the test results and the chemical composition of de-
posited metal.
(4) Butt weld bend test with two-run technique
(a) The face and root bend test specimens are to be RB4 or RB5 specimen shown in Table
2.2.2 and test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly. However, for L91 and
L92, the face and root bend test specimens are to be RB1 test specimens and test speci-
mens shown in Table 2.2.2 are to be taken longitudinally from each test assembly.
(b) The requirements in Par 5. (3), (b) are to correspondingly apply to this Paragraph.
(5) Butt weld impact test with two-run technique
(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions charphy V-notch impact test specimens as shown in Table 2.1.3, and the longi-
tudinal direction of the test specimen is to be perpendicular to the weld line and the surface
of weld about 2 mm apart is to coincide with the surface of specimen as shown in Fig
2.2.28.

Fig 2.2.28 Position of impact Test Specimen for Butt Weld Test Assembly with Two-Run
Technique (Unit : mm, t : plate thickness)

(b) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.31.
(c) The requirements in Par 4. (4), (c) and (d) are to correspondingly apply to this Paragraph.
7. Hydrogen test
The hydrogen test is to be in accordance with 602. 6 of the Rules
8. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspection, tests specified in the following (2) are to be conducted for each brand
of the approved consumables, and they are to be passed satisfactorily.
(2) The kinds of test, etc. involved in the annual inspections are to be as given in Table 2.2.32.
(3) The welding procedures and requirements for test assemblies of tests specified in the preceding
(2) are to be as specified in Pars 4 through 6.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 159


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.32 Kinds of Test for Annual Inspection


Grade of Test assembly Kinds and no. of test
Welding
welding Kind of test Thickness specimens taken from test
technique(1) Number Dimensions
consumables (mm) assembly

Multi-run Deposited metal Tensile test specimen: 1


1 Fig 2.2.24 20
technique test Impact test specimen: 3
Tensile test specimen: 1
Longitudinal tensile test
1, 2, 3
Submerged specimen: 1
1 Y , 2Y , 3Y , 1 20
arc welding Face bend test specimen: 1
4 Y , 5Y
Root bend test specimen: 1
2Y 40, 3Y 40, Butt
Two-run Impact test specimen: 3
4Y 40, 5Y 40 weld Fig 2.2.26
L 1, L 2, L 3, technique Tensile test specimen: 1
test Gas
L 91, L 92 Longitudinal tensile test
shielded
specimen: 1
and self 1 20~25
Face bend test specimen: 1
shielded arc
Root bend test specimen: 1
welding
Impact test specimen: 3
NOTE:
(1) Tests on both multi-run and two run technique are to be conducted for multi-run and two run welding
respectively. However, longitudinal tensile test of two run technique are not required.

9. Changes in grades
(1) Where changes in the grades relating to the strength or toughness of automatic welding con-
sumables approved are to be made, tests specified in the following (2), (3) and (4) are to be
carried out and satisfactorily passed in accordance with the requirements in 601. 6 (3).
(2) Changes in grades relating to the strength or toughness of multi-run automatic welding con-
sumables are to be in accordance with the requirements in the following (a) and (b).
(a) For changes in the grades relating to strength, the butt weld tests, specified in the annual
inspection of Par 8 and in the requirements of Par 3 (1), are to be conducted.
(b) For changes in the grades relating to toughness, the butt weld impact tests, specified in the
annual inspection of Par 8 and in the requirements of Par 3 (1), are to be conducted.
(3) Changes in grades relating to the strength or toughness of two-run automatic welding con-
sumables are to be in accordance with the requirements in the following (a) and (b).
(a) For changes in the grades relating to strength, all tests specified in Par 3 (1) are to be
conducted.
(b) For changes in the grades relating to toughness, the butt weld impact tests, specified in the
annual inspections of Par 8 and in the requirements of the preceding (a), are to be
conducted.
(4) Changes in the grades relating to the strength or toughness of automatic welding consumables
for multi-run and two-run use are to be as specified in the preceding (2) and (3).

604. Semi-automatic welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength
steels and steels for low temperature service
1. Application
Welding consumables for semi-automatic welding for normal strength steels, higher strength steels
and steels for low temperature service given in the following (a) and (b) (hereinafter referred to as
"semi-automatic welding consumables") are to be subjected to the approval test and annual in-
spections in accordance with the requirements in 604.
(a) Gas shielded arc semi-automatic welding consumables(flux cored wire and solid wire semi-auto-
matic welding consumables with shielding gas)
(b) Self-shielded arc semi-automatic welding consumables(solid wire and flux cored wire semi-auto-
matic welding consumables without shielding gas).

160 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

2. Grades and marks


(1) The semi-automatic welding consumables are classified as specified in Table 2.2.33.

Table 2.2.33 Grades and Marks


For steel for low
For normal strength steel For higher strength steel
temperature service
1Y , 2Y , 3 Y , 4Y 5Y L 1, L 2, L 3,
1, 2, 3
2Y 40, 3Y 40, 4Y 40, 5Y 40 L 91, L 92

(2) A suffix "S" will be added after the grade mark to indicate approval for semi-automatic mul-
ti-run welding. For wires intended for both semi-automatic and automatic welding, the suffixes
will be added in combination.(eg. 3Y SM )
(3) A suffix G will be added to the grade marks for semi-automatic welding consumables which
use shield gas, and a suffix N will be added for semi-automatic welding consumables which do
not use shield gas. Further, the type of shield gas used is to be as specified in Table 2.2.24,
and the suffix given in Table 2.2.24 will be added after the suffix G. (e.g. 3Y S G (M 1))
(4) For low hydrogen electrodes, which have passed the hydrogen test specified in 602. 6, the suf-
fixes given in Table 2.2.22 are to be added to the end of the grade marks of the said
electrode. (e.g. 3Y S H 5)
3. General provisions for tests
(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, diameter of wire used for
welding, welding position, grades and number of test specimens to be taken from each test as-
sembly, position for semi-automatic welding consumables used in butt welds or in both butt and
fillet welds are to be as given in Table 2.2.34.
(2) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, diameter of wire used for
welding, welding position, grades and number of test specimens to be taken from each test as-
sembly for semi-automatic welding materials used in fillet welds only are to be as given in
Table 2.2.18.
(3) Steel plates to be used for test assemblies are to be as given in Table 2.2.35, appropriate to
the kind of semi-automatic welding consumables.
(4) For the approval of semi-automatic welding consumables, the test specified in the preceding (1)
and (2) are to be conducted for each brand of semi-automatic welding consumables.
(5) For semi-automatic welding consumables, the test in the preceding (4) is to be performed for
each type of gas given in Table 2.2.27. When the manufacturer of the material recommends
gas types of the group of M 1, M 2, M 3 or C in Table 2.2.27 and the test is satisfactorily
conducted in accordance with the preceding (3) on one of the gas type, the test on the other
gas types belonging to the same group is allowed to be dispensed with at the discretion of the
Society.
(6) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc. are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler met-
al is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.
(7) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment.
(8) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 161


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.34 Kinds of Test for Semi-automatic Welding Consumables


Test assembly
Kinds and no. of test
Kind of Thicknes
Welding Dimen- specimens taken from test
test(8) Wire diameter (mm) Number s
position sions assembly
(mm)

Deposited maximum diameter 1(1) Fig Tensile test specimen: 1


Flat 20
metal test minimum diameter 1(1) 2.2.18 Impact test specimen: 3

Flat 1(2)
Horizontal(5) 1
First-run: minimum Tensile test specimen: 1
Vertical
Butt weld diameter 1 Fig Face bend test specimen :1
upward 15~20
test Remaining-run: 2.2.20 Root bend test specimen: 1
Vertical maximum diameter(4) Impact test specimen: 3(3)
1
downward
Overhead 1
One side: (7)
Fillet Macro test specimen: 3
maximum diameter Fig (7)
weld Horizontal 1 20 Hardness test specimen: 3
(6) The other side: 2.2.21
test Fracture test specimen: 2
minimum diameter
NOTES:
(1) Where the core diameter to be manufactured is of single variety, the number of test assembly is to be
one.
(2) Where tests are conducted solely in the Flat position. one test assembly welded with wire of different
diameters is to be added. Where only one diameter is manufactured, only one deposited metal assembly
is to be prepared.
(3) Impact tests are not required for welding in overhead position.
(4) The butt weld assemblies in positions other than downhand, are to be welded using, for the first run,
wire of the smallest diameter to be approved, and, for the remaining runs, the largest diameter of wire
recommended by the manufacturer for the position concerned.
(5) For semi-automatic welding consumables which have passed butt weld tests in the downhand and verti-
cal upward positions, the horizontal butt weld test may be omitted. at the discretion of the Society.
(6) This test is to be added solely against welding consumables for use in both butt and fillet weld.
(7) The test specimens used in the macro-etching test and hardness test are to be the same.
(8) For low hydrogen welding consumables, an hydrogen test may be conducted by the application of the
manufacturer, and test assembly is to be as specified in 602. 6 (1).

162 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.35 Grades of Steel for Test Assembly

Grade of welding
Grade of steel for test assembly(1)(2)
consumables
1S A
2S A , B or D
3S A , B , D or E
1Y S A H 32 or A H 36
2Y S A H 32, A H 36, D H 32 or D H 36
3Y S A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32 or E H 36
4Y S A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
5Y S A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
2Y 40S A H 40 or D H 40
3Y 40S A H 40, D H 40 or E H 40
4Y 40S A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
5Y 40S A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
L 1S E or R L 24A
L 2S E , R L 24A , R L 24B , R L 27 or R L 33
L 3S R L 27, R L 33 or R L 37
L 91S R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
L 92S R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
NOTES;
(1) Notwithstanding the requirements in this Table, normal or higher strength steels may be used for
deposited metal test assembly. In this case, test assemblies of grade L 91 and L 92 are to be ap-
propriately buttered.
(2) The tensile strength of higher strength steels AH 32, DH 32, EH 32 and FH 32 used in butt weld
test assemblies is to be greater than 490 Nmm  .

4. Deposited metal test


(1) Welding of Deposited metal test assemblies
(a) Test assembly as shown in Fig 2.2.18 is to be welded in the flat position according to the
normal practice.
(b) Test assembly is to be welded in single or multi-run layers, and the direction of deposition
of each run is to alternate from each end of the plate, each run of weld metal being not
less than 2 mm but not more than 6 mm thick.
(c) After each run, the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than
250℃ but not below 100℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the
surface of seam.
(2) Chemical analysis
The chemical analysis of the deposited weld metal in each test assembly is to be supplied by
the manufacturer and is to include the content of all significant alloying element.
(3) Deposited metal tensile test
(a) The tensile test specimen, one from each test assembly, is to be machined to dimensions
R14A test specimen as shown in Table 2.2.1, care being taken that the longitudinal axis
coincides with the centre of weld and the mid-thickness of plates.
(b) The tensile test specimen may be subjected to a temperature not exceeding 250℃ for a pe-
riod not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior to testing.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 163


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(c) The tensile strength, yield strength and elongation of each test specimen are to comply with
the requirements given in Table 2.2.36, where the upper limit of tensile strength is ex-
ceeded, special consideration will be given to the approval of the electrode, taking into con-
sideration of the other mechanical properties shown in the test results and the chemical
composition of deposited metal.

Table 2.2.36 Tensile and Impact Test Requirements for Deposited Metal test

Grade of Impact test


Tensile strength Yield strength
welding Elongation () Test temp. Average absorbed
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
consumables (℃) energy (J)
1S 20
2S 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. 0
3S -20
1Y S 20

2Y S 0

3Y S 490 ∼ 660 375 min. 22 min. -20


47 min.
4Y S -40

5Y S -60

2Y 40S 0

3Y 40S -20
510 ∼ 690 400 min. 22 min.
4Y 40S -40

5Y 40S -60

L 1S 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. -40

L 2S 440 ∼ 610 345 min. 22 min. -60 34 min.

L 3S 490 ∼ 660 375 min. 21 min. -60


(1)
L 91S 590 min 375 min. 25 min. -196
27 min.
(1)
L 92S 660 min 410 min. 25 min. -196
NOTE:
(1) 0.2 % yield stress

(4) Deposited metal impact tests


(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions charphy V-notch impact test specimens as shown in Table 2.1.3. The test speci-
men is to be cut with its longitudinal axis transverse to the direction of welding, and the
test specimen is to coincide with the mid-thickness of the plate shown in Fig 2.2.21.
(b) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.36.
(c) The notch is to be positioned in the centre of weld and is to be cut in the face of test
specimens perpendicular to the surface of plate.
(d) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is
less in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a
single test specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy,
the test is considered to have failed.

164 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

5. Butt weld test


(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies
(a) Test assembly as shown in Fig 2.2.20 is to be welded in each welding position (flat, hori-
zontal-vertical, vertical-upward, vertical-downward and overhead) which is recommended by
the manufacturer.
(b) After each run, the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than
250℃ but not below 100℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the
surface of seam.
(2) Butt weld tensile tests
(a) The tensile test specimen is to be R 2A test specimen shown in Table 2.2.1 and the test
specimen is to be taken from each test assembly.
(b) The surface of weld is to be machined flush with the surface of plate.
(c) The tensile strength of test specimen is to comply with the requirements given in Table
2.2.37.

Table 2.2.37 Tensile and Impact Test Requirements for Butt weld test

Impact test
Grade of
Tensile strength Average absorbed energy (J)
welding Test temp.
(Nmm  ) Vertical upward, Vertical
consumables (℃) Flat, Horizontal Overhead
downward
1S 20
2S 400 min. 0
3S -20
1Y S 20
34 min.
2Y S 0
3Y S 490 min. -20
47 min.
4Y S -40
5Y S -60
2Y 40S 0
3Y 40S -20
510 min. 39 min.
4Y 40S -40
5Y 40S -60
L 1S 400 min. -40
L 2S 440 min. -60
L 3S 490 min. -60 27 min. 27 min.
L 91S 630 min. -196
L 92S 670 min. -196

(3) Butt weld bend test


(a) The face and root bend test specimens are to be RB4 specimen shown in Table 2.2.2, and
test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly. However, for L 91 or L 92, the
face and root bend specimens are to be RB1 specimen shown in Table 2.2.2, and test
specimens are to be taken longitudinally from each test assembly.
(b) The test specimens are to be capable of withstanding, without crack exceeding 3 mm long
on the outer surface of other defects, being bent through an angle of 120 degrees over a
former having a radius of 1.5 times the thickness of test specimen. The radius and angle
of the former for L 91 and L 92, however, are to be 2 times the thickness of the specimen
and 180 degrees respectively.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 165


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(4) Butt weld Impact test


(a) One set of three impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions charphy V-notch impact test specimens as shown in Table 2.1.3. The test speci-
men is to be cut with its longitudinal axis transverse to the direction of welding, and the
test specimen is to coincide with the mid-thickness of the plate shown in Fig 2.2.19.
(b) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.37.
(c) The requirements in Par 4 (4), (c) and (d) are to correspondingly apply to this Paragraph.
6. Fillet weld test assemblies
(1) Welding of fillet weld test assemblies The test assemblies are to be in accordance with the re-
quirements in 602. 7 (1).
(2) Fillet weld macro-structure test The macro-structure test is to be correspondingly in accord-
ance with the requirements in 602. 7 (2).
(3) Fillet weld hardness test The hardness test is to be correspondingly in accordance with the re-
quirements in 602. 7 (3).
(4) Fillet weld fracture test The fracture test is to be correspondingly in accordance with the re-
quirements in 602. 7 (4).
7. Hydrogen test
Flux-cored or flux-coated wires which have satisfied the requirements for Grades 2S, 2YS, 2Y40S,
3S, 3YS, 3Y40S, 4YS or 4Y40S may, at manufacturer's option, be submitted to the hydrogen test as
detailed in 602. 6. using the manufacturer's recommended welding conditions and adjusting the
deposition rate to give a weight of weld deposit per sample similar to that deposited when using
manual electrodes.
8. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspections, tests specified in the following (2) are to be conducted for each
brand of the approved consumables, and they are to be passed satisfactorily.
(2) The kinds of test, etc. in the annual inspection are to be as given in Table 2.2.38.

Table 2.2.38 Kind of Test for Annual Inspection

Test assembly Kind and no. of test


Kind of test Welding Diameter of wire Num Thickness specimens taken from test
Dimension assembly
position (mm) ber (mm)

Deposited (1) Tensile test specimen : 1


Flat 1 Fig 2.2.18 20
metal test Impact test specimen : 3

NOTE:
(1) The diameters of the wire are to be within the range specified by the manufacturers.

(3) The welding procedures and requirements for test assemblies of tests specified in the preceding
(2) are to be as specified in Par 4.
9. Changes in grades
(1) Where changes in the grades relating to the strength or toughness of welding consumables ap-
proved are to be made, tests specified in the following (2) and (3) are to be carried out and
satisfactorily passed in accordance with the requirements in 601. 6 (3).
(2) For changes in the grades relating to strength, the butt weld tests, specified in the annual in-
spection of Par 8 and in the requirements of Par 3 (1), are to be conducted.
(3) For changes in the grades relating to toughness, the butt weld impact tests, specified in the an-
nual inspection of Par 8 and in the requirements of Par 3 (1), are to be conducted.

166 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

605. Electro-slag and electro-gas welding consumables


1. Application
Electro-slag and electro-gas welding consumables for normal strength and higher strength steels
(hereinafter referred to as "welding consumables") are to be in accordance with the requirements in
605.
2. Grades and marks
Welding consumables are classified as specified in Table 2.2.39.

Table 2.2.39 Grades and Marks

For normal strength steel For higher strength steel


1Y V , 2Y V , 3Y V , 4Y V , 5Y V
1V , 2V , 3V
2Y 40V , 3Y 40V , 4Y 40V , 5Y 40V

3. General provisions for tests


(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, grades and number of test
specimens to be taken from each test assembly for welding consumables are to be as given in
Table 2.2.40.

Table 2.2.40 Kinds of Test for Electro-Slag and Electro-Gas Welding Consumables

Test assembly(1) Kinds and no. of test specimens taken


Kind of test
Number Dimensions Thickness (mm) (2) from test assembly

1 20 ~ 25 Tensile test specimen: 2


Longitudinal tensile test specimen: 2
Butt weld test Fig 2.2.29 Side bend test specimen: 2
1 35 ~ 40 Impact test specimen: 6
Macro structure test specimen: 2
NOTE:
(1) Where approval is requested for welding of both normal strength and higher strength steel two assem-
blies are to be prepared using higher strength steel. Two assemblies prepared using normal strength steel
may also be required at the discretion of each Classification Society.
(2) Where thickness is restricted by welding process, thickness of test assemblies may be changed upon
approval of the Society. In this case, the maximum test thickness is to be taken as the maximum
applicable thickness.

(2) Steel plates to be used for test assemblies are to be as given in Table 2.2.41, appropriate to
the kind of welding consumables.
(3) For the approval of welding consumables, the tests specified in the preceding (1) are to be con-
ducted for each brand of welding consumables.
(4) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc. are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler met-
al is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.
(5) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment.
(6) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 167


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.41 Grades of Steel used for Test Assembly


Grade of welding (1)(2)
Grade of steel used for test assembly
material
1V A
2V A , B or D
3V A , B , D or E
1Y V A H 32 or A H 36
2Y V A H 32, A H 36, D H 32 or D H 36
3Y V A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32 or E H 36
4Y V A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
5Y V A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36
2Y 40V A H 40 or D H 40
3Y 40V A H 40, D H 40 or E H 40
4Y 40V A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
5Y 40V A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
NOTE:
(1) The tensile strength of higher strength steels of AH 32, DH 32, EH 32 and FH 32 used in the test
assemblies is to be greater than 490 Nmm  .
(2) This is in respect of the content of grain refining elements, and if general approval is required, a
niobium treated steel is to be used for the approval tests.

4. Butt weld test


(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies
(a) Test assemblies as shown in Fig 2.2.29 are to be welded upward in vertical position in
one Pass.

168 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(b) The welding conditions and edge preparation are to be within the range recommended by
the manufacturer.
(2) Tensile test
(a) Two tensile test specimens to be R2A specimen and two longitudinal tensile test specimens
to be R14A specimen as shown in Table 2.2.1 are to be taken from each test assembly.
The longitudinal axis of test specimen coincides with the centre of weld and the mid-thick-
ness of plates.
(b) The longitudinal tensile test specimens may be subjected to the heat treatment not exceeding
250℃ for a period not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior to testing.
(c) Tensile strength of each test specimen R2A and tensile strength, yield strength and elonga-
tion of each longitudinal test specimen R14A are to comply with the requirements in Table
2.2.42. Where the upper limit of tensile strength is exceeded, special consideration will be
given to the approval of the welding consumables, taking into consideration of the other
mechanical properties shown in the test results and chemical composition of deposited metal.

Table 2.2.42 Tensile and Impact Test Requirements for Butt weld test

Longitudinal Tensile Test Impact test


Grade of
Tensile strength Test Average
welding Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation
(Nmm  ) temp. absorbed energy
consumables (Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) ()
(℃) (J)
1V 20
2V 400 min. 400 ∼ 560 305 min. 22 min. 0
3V -20
1YV 20
34 min.
2YV 0
3YV 490 min. 490 ∼ 660 375 min. 22 min. -20
4YV -40
5YV -60
2Y 40V 0
3Y 40V -20
510 min. 510 ∼ 690 400 min. 22 min. 39 min.
4Y 40V -40
5Y 40V -60

(3) Bend test


(a) Bend test specimens are to be RB 6 specimens shown in Table 2.2.2 and two side bend
test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly.
(b) The test specimens are to be capable of withstanding, without crack exceeding 3 mm long
on the outer surface of other defects, being bent through an angle of 180 degrees over a
former having a radius of two times the thickness of test specimen.
(4) Impact test
(a) Two sets of six impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions charphy V-notch impact test specimens as shown in Table 2.1.3 and the longi-
tudinal direction of the test specimen is to be perpendicular to the weld line and the surface
of weld about 2 mm apart is to coincide with the surface of specimen as shown in Fig
2.2.30.
(b) The position of the notch is to be in accordance with Fig 2.2.30 (a) and (b) respectively,
and its longitudinal direction is to be perpendicular to the surface of the test assembly.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 169


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.30 Position of Impact Specimen (Unit : mm, t = Plate thickness)

(c) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.42.
(d) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is
less in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a
single test specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy,
the test is considered to have failed.
(5) Macro-structure test
(a) Two macro-structure test specimens are to be taken from the position shown in Fig 2.2.29.
As for the surface to be tested, one is to be normal to the assembly surface and the other
parallel to the assembly surface.
(b) Both the welded parts and the weld boundaries are to show complete fusion, penetration and
sound metallurgical structure.
5. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspection, tests specified in the following (2) are to be conducted for each brand
of the approved materials, and they are to be passed satisfactorily.
(2) The kinds of test, etc. in the annual inspections are to be as given in Table 2.2.43.
(3) The welding procedures and requirements for test assemblies of tests specified in the preceding
(2) are to be as specified in Par 4.

Table 2.2.43 Kind of Test for Annual Inspection

Test assembly Kinds and no. of test specimens taken


Kind of test
Number Dimensions Thickness (mm) (1) from test assembly

Tensile test specimen: 1


Longitudinal Tensile test specimen: 1
Butt weld test 1 Fig 2.2.29 20 ~ 25
Side bend test specimen: 2
Impact test specimen: 6(1)
NOTE:
(1) One set of three impact test specimens may be taken from the centre of welded part. where approved
by the Society.

6. Changes in grades
Where changes in the grades relating to the strength or toughness of welding consumables approved
are to be made, tests specified in Par 3 (1) are to be conducted and satisfactorily passed in ac-
cordance with the requirements in 601. 6 (3).

170 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

606. One side welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength steels
and steels for low temperature service.
1. Application
(1) Welding consumables for normal strength steels, higher strength steels and steels for low tem-
perature service given in the following (a) through (c) (hereinafter referred to as "one side auto-
matic welding consumables") are to be subjected to the approval tests and annual inspections in
accordance with the requirements in 606.
(a) Submerged arc one side automatic welding consumables
(b) Gas shielded arc one side automatic welding consumables (solid wire or flux cored wire
with shielding gas)
(c) Self-shielded arc one side automatic welding consumables (flux cored wire or flux coated
wire without shielding gas)
(2) Approval tests and annual inspections of one side covered electrodes for normal strength steels,
higher strength steels and steels for low temperature service, and one side semi-automatic weld-
ing consumables are to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.
(3) Approval tests and annual inspections for one side automatic welding consumables of muitiple
electrodes are to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.
2. Grades and marks
(1) One side automatic welding consumables are classified as specified in 603. 2. Further, one
side automatic welding consumables which have passed the tests for each welding procedure
given in Table 2.2.45 are to be appended with the suffixes given in Table 2.2.44 at the end
of their marks.
(2) In the preceding (1), a suffix G will be added to the grade mark for gas shielded arc one side
automatic welding consumables, and a suffix N will be added for self-shielded wire one side
automatic welding consumables. Further, the type of gas used is to be as specified in Table
2.2.27 and the suffix given in Table 2.2.27 will be added after the suffix G. (e.g. 3Y SM R
G (M 1))

Table 2.2.44 Marks


Welding technique(1) Marks
One-run technique SR
Multi-run technique MR
One-run and multi-run technique SM R
NOTE:
(1) One-run or multi-run technique refers to a welding process which performed in one pass or multiple
passes respectively regardless of the number of electrodes.

3. General provisions for tests


(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, grades and number of test
specimens to be taken from each test assembly for one side automatic welding consumables are
to be as given in Table 2.2.45.
(2) Steel plates to be used for test assemblies are to be as given in Table 2.2.46.
(3) For the approval of one side automatic welding consumables, the tests specified in the preceding
(1) are to be conducted for each brand of one side automatic welding consumables.
(4) For gas shield arc one side automatic welding consumables, the test in the preceding (3) is to
be performed for each type of gas given in Table 2.2.27. When the manufacturer of the ma-
terial recommends gas types of the group of M 1, M 2, M 3 or C in Table 2.2.27 and the test is
satisfactorily conducted in accordance with the preceding (3) on one of the gas type, the test on
the other gas types belonging to the same group is allowed to be dispensed with at the dis-
cretion of the Society.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 171


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.45 Kinds of Test for One-side Automatic Welding Consumables

Test assembly
Grade of
Welding Kind of Kind and number of test specimens
welding
technique test(4) Thickness taken from test assembly
consumables Number Dimension
(mm)(1)

1 12 ~ 15
Tensile test specimen: 2
Longitudinal tensile test specimen: 1
One-run Face bend specimen: 1
technique Maximum Root bend specimen: 1
1 Impact test specimen: 6
thickness
Macro-structure test specimen: 1

1, 2, 3, 1 15 ~ 25
Tensile test specimen: 2
1Y , 2Y ,
Longitudinal tensile test specimen: 1
3Y , 4Y , 5Y , Butt
Multi-run Face bend specimen :1
2Y 40, 3Y 40, weld Fig 2.2.31
technique Root bend Specimen: 1
4Y 40, 5Y 40, test 1 35 Impact test specimen: 6
L 1, L 2, L 3,
Macro-structure test specimen: 1
L 91, L 92

Maximum Tensile test specimen: 2


1
One-run thickness(2) Longitudinal tensile test specimen: 1
and Face bend specimen: 1
Multi-run Root bend specimen: 1
technique Impact test specimen: 6
1 35(3) Macro-structure test specimen: 1

NOTES:
(1) Where thickness is restricted by welding process, thickness of test assemblies may be changed upon ap-
proval of the Society. In this case, the maximum test thickness is to be taken as the maximum appli-
cable thickness.
(2) Thickness of test assembly for one run technique.
(3) Thickness of test assembly for multi-run technique.
(4) The hydrogen test may be carried out according to the manufacturer's request.

172 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.46 Grades of Steel used for Test Assembly

Grade of welding
Grade of steel used for test assembly(1)
consumables
1 A
2 A , B or D
3 A , B , D or E
1Y A H 32 or A H 36
2Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32 or D H 36
3Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32 or E H 36

4Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36

5Y A H 32, A H 36, D H 32, D H 36, E H 32, E H 36, F H 32 or F H 36

2Y 40 A H 40 or D H 40
3Y 40 A H 40, D H 40 or E H 40
4Y 40 A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
5Y 40 A H 40, D H 40, E H 40 or F H 40
L1 E or R L 24A
L2 E , R L 24A , R L 24B , R L 27 or R L 33
L3 R L 27, R L 33 or R L 37
L 91 R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
L 92 R L 9N 53 or R L 9N 60
NOTE:
(1) The tensile strength of higher strength steels AH 32, DH 32, EH 32 and FH 32 used in the test as-
semblies is to be greater than 490 N/mm 2

(5) The combination of one side automatic welding materials are classified as given in Table
2.2.47, appropriate to the welding procedure.

Table 2.2.47 Combinations of One Side Automatic Welding Consumables

Welding technique Combinations of welding consumables


Submerged one side automatic welding Wire + Flux + Iron powder + Backing
Gas shielded arc one side automatic welding Wire + Gas + Iron powder + Backing
Self-shielded arc one side automatic welding Wire + Iron powder + Backing
NOTE: Where iron powder is not used, iron powder is excluded in this Table.

(6) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc. are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler met-
al is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.
(7) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment.
(8) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 173


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

4. Butt weld test assemblies with one-run and multi-run technique


(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies with one-run and multi-run technique
(a) Test assemblies are to be prepared as shown in Fig 2.2.31, and the diameter of wire, root
gap and edge preparation are to be within the range specified by the manufacturer.

(b) Test assemblies are to be welded in downhand position by one-run technique or multi-run
technique according to the procedures specified by the manufacturer. However, for gas
shield and self-shielded arc one side automatic welding consumables, the welding position is
to be specified by the manufacturer.
(c) After completing each run the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to
less than 250℃ but not below 100℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of weld on
the surface of seam.
(2) Butt weld tensile test with one-run and multi-run technique
(a) Tow tensile test specimens to be R 2A specimen and one longitudinal tensile test specimen
to be R 14A specimen as shown in Table 2.2.1 are to be taken from each test assembly.
The longitudinal axis of test specimen coincides with the centre of weld and the mid-thick-

174 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

ness of plate.
(b) The longitudinal tensile test specimen may be subjected to a temperature not exceeding 25
0℃ for a period not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior to testing.
(c) Tensile strength of each test specimen R 2A is to comply with the requirements in Table
2.2.31. Tensile strength, yield strength and elongation of longitudinal tensile test specimens
R 14 are to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.2.30. Where the upper limit
of tensile strength is exceeded, special consideration will be given to the approval of the
welding consumables, taking into consideration of the other mechanical properties shown in
the test results and chemical composition of deposited metal.
(3) Butt weld bend test with one-run and multi-run technique The bend tests are to comply with
the requirements in 603. 6. (4).
(4) Butt weld impact test with one-run and multi-run technique
(a) Two sets of impact test specimens, from each test assembly, are to be machined to di-
mensions R 4 test specimen as shown in Table 2.1.3. Longitudinal direction of the test
specimen is to be perpendicular to the weld line as shown in Fig 2.2.32.
(b) Test temperature and average absorbed energy are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.31.

(c) The notch is to be positioned in the centre of weld and is to be cut in the face of test
specimens perpendicular to the surface of plate.
(d) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens
is less in value than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of
a single test specimen is less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy,
the test is considered to have failed.
(5) Butt weld macro-structure test with one-run and multirun technique
(a) Macro-structure test specimens are to be taken from the position shown in Fig 2.2.31. The
surface to be tested is to be perpendicular to the surface of the test assembly.
(b) Both the welded parts and the weld boundaries are to show complete fusion, penetration and
sound metallurgical structure.
5. Hydrogen test
The hydrogen test is to be in accordance with 602. 6 of the Rules
6. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspection, tests specified in the following (2) are to be conducted for each brand
of the approved consumables, and they are to be passed satisfactorily.
(2) The kinds of test, etc. in the annual inspection are to be as given in Table 2.2.48.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 175


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.48 Kinds of Test for Annual Inspection

Grade of Test assembly Kind and number of test


Welding Kind of
welding Num Thickness specimens taken from test
technique test Dimension
consumables ber (mm)(1) assembly

Tensile test specimen: 1


Longitudinal tensile test
One-run specimen: 1
1 20
technique Face bend specimen: 1
Root bend specimen: 1
Impact test specimen: 3(3)
1, 2, 3, Tensile test specimen: 1
1Y , 2Y , Longitudinal tensile test
3Y , 4Y , 5Y , Multi-run specimen: 1
Butt weld 1 20~25
2Y 40, 3Y 40, technique Fig 2.2.31 Face bend specimen: 1
test(2)
4Y 40, 5Y 40, Root bend specimen: 1
L 1, L 2, L 3, Impact test specimen: 3(3)
L 91, L 92
Tensile test specimen: 1
Longitudinal tensile test
One-run
specimen: 1
and
1 20~25 Face bend specimen: 1
Multi-run
Root bend specimen: 1
technique
Impact test Specimen: 3(3)

NOTES:
(1) Where the thickness of test assemblies is changed according to Note (1) of Table 2.2.45, the maximum
test thickness for approval test is to be applied.
(2) The butt weld tests for one-run and multi-run technique are to be carried out by one-run technique.
(3) The positions of notch and selection of impact test specimens are to be as given in Fig2.2.32 (b).

(3) The welding procedures and requirements of test assemblies for tests in the preceding (2) are to
be as specified in Par 4.
7. Changes in grades
Where changes in the grades relating to the strength or toughness of one side automatic welding
consumables approved are to be made, all the tests specified in Par 3 (1) are to be carried out
and satisfactorily passed in accordance with the requirements in 601. 6 (3).

607. Welding consumables for stainless steel


1. Application
Welding consumables for stainless steels specified in Ch 1, Sec 3 (hereinafter referred to as
"welding consumables") are to be subjected to the approval tests and annual inspections in accord-
ance with the requirements in 607.
2. Grades and marks
(1) Welding consumables are classified as specified in Table 2.2.49.
(2) Submerged arc welding consumables which have passed the tests for each welding process given
in Table 2.2.51 are to be appended with the suffixes shown in Table 2.2.50 at the end of
their marks.
(3) For flux cored wire semi-automatic welding consumables in the preceding (1), a suffix G will
be added to the grade mark for welding consumables which use shield gas, and a suffix N will
be added to the grade markes for welding consumables which do not used shield gas. Further,
the type of shield gas used is to be as specified in Table 2.2.27 and the suffix given in
Table 2.2.27 will be added after the suffix G. (e.g. RW 308G (C))

176 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.49 Grades and Marks of Welding Consumables

Electrode for manual Material for TIG and Flux cored wire Consumables for
arc welding MIG welding semi-automatic welding submerged welding
RD 308 RY 308 RW 308 RU 308
RD 308L RY 308L RW 308L RU 308L
RD 309 RY 309 RW 309 RU 309
RD 309L RY 309L RW 309L -
RD 309M o RY 309M o RW 309M o RU 309M o
RD 309M oL - RW 309M oL -
RD 310 RY 310 RW 310 RU 310
- RY 310S - -
RD 310M o - - -
RD 316 RY 316 RW 316 RU 316
RD 316L RY 316L RW 316L RU 316L
RD 317 RY 317 RW 317 RU 317
RD 317L RY 317L RW 317L RU 317L
- RY 321 - -
RD 347 RY 347 RW 347 RU 347

Table 2.2.50 Marks

Welding technique Marks


Multi-run technique M
Two-run technique T
Multi-run and Two-run technique TM

3. General provisions for tests


(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, diameter of wire used for
welding, grades and number of test specimens to be taken from each test assembly in each
welding position for welding consumables are to be as given in Table 2.2.51. However, addi-
tional tests appropriate to steels, such as test on corrosion-resistance test, impact test, macro
etching test, etc., except the test given in Table 2.2.51 may be required where deemed neces-
sary by the Society.
(2) Steel plates to be used for test assemblies are to be as given in Table 2.2.52 according to the
grades of welding consumables.
(3) For the approval of welding consumables, the tests specified in the preceding (1) are to be con-
ducted for each brand of welding consumables.
(4) For flux cored wire semi-automatic welding materials, which use shield gas, the test in the pre-
ceding (3) is to be performed for each type of gas given in Table 2.2.27. When the manu-
facturer of the consumables recommends gas types of the group of M 1, M 2, M 3 or C in
Table 2.2.27 and the test is satisfactorily conducted in accordance with the preceding (3) on
one of the gas type, the test on the other gas types belonging to the same group is allowed to
be dispensed with at the discretion of the Society.
(5) The welding conditions used such as amperage, voltage, travel speed, etc. are to be within the
range recommended by the manufacturer for normal good welding practice. Where a filler met-
al is stated to be suitable for both alternating current (AC) and direct current (DC), AC is to
be used for the preparation of the test assemblies.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 177


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.51 Kinds of Test of Welding Consumables for Stainless Steel


Test assembly
Dia. of Kind and number of test
Kind of welding Kind of Thick-
electrode Dimen- specimens taken from
consumables test ness No. Welding position
or wire sion test assembly
(mm) (1)
(mm)
Deposited 12 1 3.2 Fig
Flat Tensile test specimen: 1
metal test 19 1 4.0 2.2.33
Electrode for 1 Flat
manual arc 1 Horizontal Tensile test specimen: 1
Butt weld 3.2 or Fig
welding 9~12 1 Vertical upward Face bend Specimen: 1
test 4.0 2.2.34
1 Vertical downward Root bend specimen: 1
1 Overhead
Deposited 12 1 2.4 Fig
Flat Tensile test specimen: 1
metal test 19 1 3.2 2.2.33
1 Flat
Consumables for
1 Horizontal Tensile test specimen: 1
TIG welding Butt weld Fig
9~12 1 Vertical upward 2.0~3.2 Face bend specimen: 1
test 2.2.34
1 Vertical downward Root bend specimen: 1
1 Overhead
Deposited 12 1 1.2 Fig
Flat Tensile test specimen: 1
metal test 19 1 1.6 2.2.33
Flat
Consumables for
Horizontal Tensile test specimen: 1
MIG welding Butt weld Fig
9~12 1 Vertical upward 1.2~2.0 Face bend specimen: 1
test 2.2.34
Vertical downward Root bend specimen: 1
Overhead
12 1 1.2~2.4
Deposited Fig
Flat 3.2 or Tensile test specimen: 1
metal test 19 1 2.2.33
Flux cored wire max. dia
for Flat
semi-automatic Horizontal Tensile test specimen: 1
Butt weld Fig
welding 9~12 1 Vertical upward 1.2~3.2 Face bend specimen: 1
test 2.2.34
Vertical downward Root bend specimen: 1
Overhead
Deposited Fig
19~25 1 Flat 1.2~4.0 Tensile test specimen: 1
metal test 2.2.33
Multi-run
Fig Tensile test specimen: 1
Consum- technique Butt weld
19 1 Flat 1.2~4.0 2.2.35 Face bend specimen: 1
ables test
(a) Root bend specimen: 1
for
Tensile test specimen: 1
sub-
12 1 Flat 1.2~2.4 Face bend specimen: 1
merged
Root bend specimen: 1
arc Fig
Two-run Butt weld Tensile test specimen: 1
welding 2.2.35
(2) technique test Longitudinal tensile test
(b)
19 1 Flat 4.0 specimen: 1
Face bend specimen: 1
Root bend specimen: 1
NOTES:
(1) Where approved by the Society, the diameter of electrodes or wires may be changed.
(2) Tests on both multi-run and two run technique are to be conducted for multi-run and two run welding re-
spectively and the number, dimensions and thickness of test assemblies, along with the grades and number
of test specimens selected from each test assembly are to be according to each of the welding processes.
However, longitudinal tensile test of two run technique are not required.

178 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.52 Grades of Steel for Test Assembly

Grade of welding consumables Grade of steel for test assembly(1)


RD 308, RY 308, RW 308, RU 308 RSTS 304
RD 308L, RY 308L, RW 308L, RU 308L RSTS 304L
RD 309, RY 309, RW 309, RU 309
RD 309L, RY 309L, RW 309L
RSTS 309S
RD 309M o, RY 309M o, RW 309M o, RU 309M o
RD 309M oL, RW 309M oL
RD 310, RY 310, RW 310, RU 310
RY 310S RSTS 310S
RD 310M o
RD 316, RY 316, RW 316, RU 316 RSTS 316
RD 316L, RY 316L, RW 316L, RU 316L RSTS 316L
RD 317, RY 317, RW 317, RU 317 RSTS 317
RD 317L, RY 317L, RW 317L, RU 317L RSTS 317, RSTS 317L
RY 321 RSTS 321
RD 347, RY 347, RW 347, RU 347 RSTS 321, RSTS 347
NOTE:
(1) Notwithstanding the requirements in this table, mild steel or higher strength steel may be
used for deposited metal test assembly. In this case, test assemblies are to be appropriately
buttered.

(6) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment.
(7) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.
4. Deposited metal test
(1) Welding of deposited metal test assemblies
(a) Test assemblies as shown in Fig 2.2.33 are to be welded in the flat position according to
the welding procedure recommended by the manufacturer.
(b) After each run, the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than
150℃ but not below 15℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the
surface of seam.
(2) Chemical composition
(a) Deposited metals of electrodes for manual arc welding and of welding consumables for flux
cored wire semi-automatic welding and submerged arc welding are to have the chemical
composition given in Tables 2.2.53, 2.2.55 and 2.2.56 respectively.
(b) TIG and MIG welding consumables are to have the chemical composition of ladle analysis
value complied with the requirements as given in Table 2.2.54.
(3) Deposited metal tensile test
(a) One tensile test specimens to be R10 shown in Table 2.2.1 is to be taken from each test
assembly. Further, where approved by the Society, one R14A tensile test specimen may be
taken, the longitudinal axis of test specimen coincides with the centre of weld and the
mid-thickness of plate.
(b) The tensile test specimens may be subjected to a temperature not exceeding 250℃ for a pe-
riod not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen removal prior to testing.
(c) Deposited metal tensile tests are to comply with the requirements in Table 2.2.57.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 179


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.53 Chemical Composition of Deposited Metal for Electrodes

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C(max.) Si(max.) Mn(max.) P(max.) S(max.) Ni Cr Mo Others
RD 308 0.08 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 - -
RD 308L 0.04 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 12.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 - -
RD 309 0.15 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RD 309L 0.04 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 16.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RD 309M o 0.12 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RD 309M oL 0.04 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RD 310 0.20 0.75 2.50 0.03 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.0 25.0 ~ 28.0 - -
RD 310M o 0.12 0.75 2.50 0.03 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.0 25.0 ~ 28.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RD 316 0.08 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 17.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 2.75 -
RD 316L 0.04 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 16.0 17.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 2.75 -
RD 317 0.08 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
RD 317L 0.04 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 16.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
Nb8×C
RD 347 0.08 0.90 2.50 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 -
(%)~1.0

180 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.54 Chemical Composition of Deposited Metal for TIG Electrodes or MIG Wires

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C(max.) Si(max.) Mn P(max.) S(max.) Ni Cr Mo Others
RY 308 0.08 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 19.0 ~ 22.0 - -
RY 308L 0.03 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 19.0 ~ 22.0 - -
RY 309 0.12 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 23.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RY 309L 0.03 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 23.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RY 309M o 0.12 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 23.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RY 310 0.15 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.5 25.0 ~ 28.0 - -
RY 310S 0.08 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.5 25.0 ~ 28.0 - -
RY 316 0.08 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RY 316L 0.03 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RY 317 0.08 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 13.0 ~ 15.0 18.5 ~ 20.5 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
RY 317L 0.03 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 13.0 ~ 15.0 18.5 ~ 20.5 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
Ti9×C
RY 321 0.08 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 9.0 ~ 10.5 18.5 ~ 20.5 -
(%) ~ 1.0
Nb10×C
RY 347 0.08 0.65 1.0 ~ 2.5 0.03 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 19.0 ~ 21.5 -
(%) ~ 1.0

Table 2.2.55 Chemical Composition of Deposited Metal for Flux Cored Wire Semi-automatic Welding

(a) With Gas

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C(max.) Si(max.) Mn P(max.) S(max.) Ni Cr Mo Others
RW 308 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 - -
RW 308L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 12.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 - -
RW 309 0.10 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RW 309L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RW 309M o 0.12 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RW 309M oL 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RW 310 0.20 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.0 25.0 ~ 28.0 - -
RW 316 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 17.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RW 316L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 17.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RW 317 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
RW 317L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 16.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
Nb8×C
RW 347 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 -
(%) ~ 1.0

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 181


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.55 Chemical Composition of Deposited Metal for Flux Cored Wire Semi-automatic Welding

(b) Without Gas

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C(max.) Si(max.) Mn P(max.) S(max.) Ni Cr Mo Others

RW 308 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 19.5 ~ 22.0 - -

RW 308L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 12.0 19.5 ~ 22.0 - -

RW 309 0.10 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 23.0 ~ 25.5 - -

RW 309L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 23.0 ~ 25.5 - -

RW 309M o 0.12 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -

RW 309M oL 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -

RW 310 0.20 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.0 25.0 ~ 28.0 - -

RW 316 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 20.5 2.0 ~ 3.0 -

RW 316L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 20.5 2.0 ~ 3.0 -

RW 317 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 13.0 ~ 15.0 18.5 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -

RW 317L 0.04 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 13.0 ~ 15.0 18.5 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -

Nb8×C
RW 347 0.08 1.0 0.5 ~ 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 19.0 ~ 21.5 -
(%) ~ 1.0

Table 2.2.56 Chemical Composition of Deposited Metal for Submerged Arc Welding

Chemical composition (%)


Grade
C(max.) Si(max.) Mn(max.) P(max.) S(max.) Ni Cr Mo Others

RU 308 0.08 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 - -
RU 308L 0.04 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 12.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 - -
RU 309 0.15 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 - -
RU 309M o 0.12 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 22.0 ~ 25.0 2.0 ~ 3.0 -
RU 310 0.20 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 20.0 ~ 22.0 25.0 ~ 28.0 - -
RU 316 0.08 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 14.0 17.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 2.75 -
RU 316L 0.04 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 11.0 ~ 16.0 17.0 ~ 20.0 2.0 ~ 2.75 -
RU 317 0.08 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 14.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
RU 317L 0.04 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 12.0 ~ 16.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 3.0 ~ 4.0 -
Nb8×C
RU 347 0.08 1.0 2.5 0.04 0.03 9.0 ~ 11.0 18.0 ~ 21.0 -
(%) ~ 1.0

182 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.57 Tensile Test Requirements for Deposited Metal

Electrode for Consumables for Flux cored wire for Consumables Tensile Yield
Elongation
manual arc TIG and MIG semi-automatic for submerged strength strength
(%)
welding welding welding arc welding (Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
RD 308 RY 308 RW 308 RU 308 550 min. 225 min. 35 min.
RD 308L RY 308L RW 308L RU 308L 510 min. 205 min. 35 min.
RD 309 RY 309 RW 309 RU 309 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 309L RY 309L RW 309L - 510 min. 205 min. 30 min.
RD 309M o RY 309M o RW 309M o RU 309M o 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 309M oL - RW 309M oL - 510 min. 205 min. 30 min.(1)
RD 310 RY 310 RW 310 RU 310 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
- RY 310S - - 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 310M o - - - 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 316 RY 316 RW 316 RU 316 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 316L RY 316L RW 316L RU 316L 510 min. 205 min. 35 min.
RD 317 RY 317 RW 317 RU 317 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 317L RY 317L RW 317L RU 317L 510 min. 205 min. 30 min.
- RY 321 - - 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
RD 347 RY 347 RW 347 RU 347 550 min. 225 min. 30 min.
NOTE:
(1) Elongation of RW 309M oL is to be not less than 20 (%).

5. Butt weld test


(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies
(a) Test assemblies as shown in Figs 2.2.34 and 2.2.35 are to be welded in each welding po-
sition (flat, horizontal, vertical upward, vertical downward and overhead) which is recom-
mended by the manufacturer.
(b) After each run, the test assembly is to be left in still air until it has cooled to less than
150℃ but not below 15℃, the temperature being taken at the centre of the weld on the
surface of seam.
(2) Butt weld tensile test
(a) One tensile test specimens to be R2A shown in Table 2.2.1 is to be taken from each test
assembly.
(b) The tensile strength of each test specimen is to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.2.58.
(c) Submerged arc welding materials used only in the two-run technique are to be selected as
one R14A tensile test specimen of Table 2.2.1, such that the longitudinal centre line of the
test specimen coincides with the weld centre line of the test assemblies and centre of
thickness.
(d) The longitudinal tensile test specimens specified in the preceding (3) may be subjected to
the heat treatment not exceeding 250℃ for a period not exceeding 16 hours for hydrogen
removal prior to testing.
(e) The tensile strength, yield point and elongation of the test specimens specified in the pre-
ceding (c) and (d) are to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.2.57.
(3) Butt weld bend test
(a) The face and root bend test specimens are to be RB4 specimen shown in Table 2.2.2, and
test specimens are to be taken from each test assembly.
(b) The test specimens are to be capable of withstanding, without crack exceeding 3 mm long
on the outer surface of the specimen or other defects, being bent through an angle of 120
degrees over a former having a radius of 1.5 times the thickness of test specimen.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 183


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

184 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.58 Tensile Test Requirements for Butt Weld

Electrode for manual Consumables for TIG Flux cored wire for Consumables for Tensile strength
arc welding and MIG welding semi-automatic welding submerged arc welding (Nmm  )
RD 308 RY 308 RW 308 RU 308 520 min.
RD 308L RY 308L RW 308L RU 308L 480 min.
RD 309 RY 309 RW 309 RU 309 520 min.
RD 309L RY 309L RW 309L - 520 min.
RD 309M o RY 309M o RW 309M o RU 309M o 520 min.
RD 309M oL - RW 309M oL - 520 min.
RD 310 RY 310 RW 310 RU 310 520 min.
- RY 310S - - 520 min.
RD 310M o - - - 520 min.
RD 316 RY 316 RW 316 RU 316 520 min.
RD 316L RY 316L RW 316L RU 316L 480 min.
RD 317 RY 317 RW 317 RU 317 520 min.(1)
RD 317L RY 317L RW 317L RU 317L 520 min.(1)
- RY 321 - - 520 min.
RD 347 RY 347 RW 347 RU 347 520 min.
NOTE:
(1) Where the test assembly is made of RSTS 317L, the tensile strength is not to be less than 480 Nmm  .

6. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspections, tests specified in the following (2) are to be conducted for each
brand of approved consumables, and they are to be passed satisfactorily.
(2) The kinds of test, etc. in the annual inspections are to be as given in Table 2.2.59.
(3) The welding procedures and requirements of test assemblies for tests in the preceding (2) are to
be as specified in Pars 4 through 5.
Table 2.2.59 Kinds of Test at Annual Inspection
Welding procedure for test assembly
Kind and number of
Kind of welding Kind of Dia. of
Welding Thickness test specimens taken
consumables test electrode or Number Dimension
position (mm) from test assembly
wire (mm)
Electrode for manual
3.2 ~ 4.0
arc welding
Consumables for TIG
2.4 ~ 3.2
welding
Deposited Flat 1 Fig 2.2.33 12 ~ 19 Tensile test specimen: 1
Consumables for MIG metal test 1.2 ~ 1.6
welding
Flux cored wire for
1.2 ~ 3.2
semi-automatic welding
Multi-run Deposited
Flat 1.2 ~ 4.0 1 Fig 2.2.33 19 ~ 25 Tensile test specimen: 1
Consumables technique metal test
for Tensile test specimen: 1
submerged Longitudinal tensile test
arc welding Two-run Butt weld Fig
Flat 2.4 ~ 4.0 1 12 ~ 19 specimen: 1
(1) technique test 2.2.35(b)
Face bend specimen: 1
Root bend specimen: 1
NOTE:
(1) Tests on both multi-run and two run technique are to be conducted for multi-run and two run welding
respectively and the number, dimensions and thickness of test assemblies, along with the grades and num-
ber of test specimens selected from each test assembly are to be according to each of the welding
processes. However, longitudinal tensile test of two run technique are not required.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 185


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

608. Welding consumables for aluminium alloys


1. Application
(1) Welding consumables used for aluminium alloys mentioned in the following (a) and
(b)(hereinafter referred to as "welding consumables") are to be subjected to the approval tests
and annual inspections in accordance with these requirements.
(a) Rod-gas combinations for tungsten inert gas arc welding (TIG welding) or plasma arc weld-
ing
(b) Wire electrode and wire-gas combinations for metal arc inert gas welding (MIG welding),
tungsten inert gas arc welding(TIG welding) or plasma arc welding
(2) Where no special requirements are given herein, e.g. for the approval procedure or for the
welding of test assemblies and testing, those as specified in 601. through 605. apply in analo-
gous manner.
2. Grades and marks of welding consumables
(1) Grades and marks of welding consumables are classified as given in Table 2.2.60.

Table 2.2.60 Grades and Marks

Kind of welding consumables Grade and Mark


Electrode RA, RB, RC, RD
Wire W A, W B, W C, W D

(2) Approval of a wire or a rod will be granted in conjunction with a specific shielding gas ac-
cording to Table 2.2.58 with suffixed mark “G”(e.g. RBG (I-3)). or defined in terms of composi-
tion and purity of “special” gas to be designated with group sign “S”(eg. RBS ( CO 2 100%). The
composition of the shielding gas is to be reported. The approval of a wire or rod with any par-
ticular gas can be applied or transferred to any combination of the same wire or rod and any
gas in the same numbered group as defined in Table 2.2.61, subject to the agreement of the
Society.

Table 2.2.61 Kind of Gas

Gas composition(%)
Group Kinds
He Ar
I-1 - 100
I-2 100 -
I I-3 > 0 - 33 Rest
I-4 > 33 - 66 Rest
I-5 > 66 - 95 Rest
S Others

3. General provisions of tests


(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness and dimensions of test assemblies, kind and number of test
specimen taken from each test assembly for welding consumables are to be as given in Table
2.2.62.
(2) The aluminium alloys used in preparation for test assembly corresponding to welding con-
sumables are to be as given in Table 2.2.63.
(3) For the approval of welding consumables, the tests specified in (1) are to be successfully con-
ducted for each brand of welding consumables.
(4) For welding consumables using a shielding gas, the tests specified in (1) are to be conducted
for each kind of gas designated among Table 2.2.61 by the manufacturer. However, where the
manufacturer designates several kinds of gas which are classified into the group l in Table
2.2.61 and the tests specified in (1) are to be conducted for any one kind of gas, the tests for
the other kind of gas may be dispensed with subject to the approval of the Society.

186 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.62 Kinds of Test for Welding Consumables

Test assembly Kinds and number of


Kinds of test Thickness test specimens taken from
Welding position Number Dimension test assembly
(mm)
Deposited metal test
(Chemical Flat 1 Fig 2.2.36 - -
composition test)
Flat 1
Tensile test specimen : 2
Horizontal 1(1) Face bend test specimen : 2
Fig 2.2.37 10 ∼12
Vertical upward 1 Root bend test specimen : 2
Macro structure test specimen : 1
Butt weld test Overhead 1
Tensile test specimen : 2
Face bend test specimen : 2
Flat 1 Fig 2.2.38 20 ~ 25
Root bend test specimen : 2
Macro structure test specimen : 1
Note
(1) Welding consumables satisfying the requirements for flat and vertical upward positions may be dispensed
with the tests for horizontal position subject to the approval of the Society.

Table 2.2.63 Grade of Aluminium Alloys used for Test Assembly

Grade of welding Grade of aluminium alloys used for test assembly


consumables
RA, W A 5754

RB, W B 5000 series 5086

RC, W C 5083, 5383, 5456, 5059

RD, W D 6000 series 6005A, 6061, 6082


Note:
Approval on higher strength AlM g base materials(5000 series) covers also the lower
strength AlM g grades and their combination with AlSi grades

(5) When the manufacturer designated the gas classified into the group "S " in the tests specified in
(4), the composition of the shielding gas is to be reported to the Society.
(6) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment or peening.
(7) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.
4. Deposited metal test
(1) Welding of deposited metal test assembly
(a) The test assemblies as shown in Fig 2.2.36 are to be welded in flat position in accordance
with the welding process designated by the manufacturer.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 187


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(b) The size of test assembly corresponding to the welding consumables and welding process is
to be taken a sufficient amount of pure weld metal for chemical analysis.
(2) Chemical composition The chemical composition of the welding consumables is to be de-
termined by the analysis of the deposited weld metal specified in Fig 2.2.36 and the results of
the analysis are to comply with the limit value specified by the manufacturer.
5. Butt weld test
(1) Welding of butt weld test assemblies
(a) The test assemblies as shown in Fig 2.2.37 are to be welded in each welding position des-
ignated by the manufacturer (downhand, horizontal, vertical-upward and overhead). The test
assembly as shown by Fig 2.2.38 is to be welded in the downhand position.
(b) On completion of each run, the test assemblies are to be allowed to cool naturally in air
until the temperature measured at the surface of the centre of the welding joint is ambient
temperature. However, the test assemblies for RD and W D are to be allowed to naturally
ageing for a minimum period of 72 hours from the completion of welding before testing.
(2) Butt weld tensile test
(a) The tensile test specimens are to be R 2A specimen shown in Table 2.2.1 and two test
specimens are to be taken from each test assembly.
(b) The tensile strength is to comply with the requirements as given in Table 2.2.64.

Table 2.2.64 Requirements for the transverse tensile and bend tests

Bend test
Grade of welding Base material Tensile strength
consumables used for the test (Nmm  ) Former diameter Bending
(mm) angle
(1)
R A /W A 5754 190 min. 3t
R B /W B 5086 240 min.

5083 275 min.


180°
(1)
R C /W C 5383, 5456 290 min. 6t
5059 330 min.

R D /W D 6061, 6005A, 6082 170 min.


Note
(1) t : Thickness of the test specimen

(3) Butt Weld Bend Test


(a) The face bend and root bend test specimens are to be RB 4 specimen shown in Table 2.2.2
and two test specimens are to be taken from each assembly.
(b) The test specimens are to sustain the face and root bend tests over 180" using a former
having a diameter in accordance with Table 2.2.64, without cracks exceeding 3 m m in
length and other any defects on the outer surface.
(4) Butt weld macro structure test
(a) One macro structure test specimen as shown in Fig 2.2.37 and Fig 2.2.38 is to be taken
from the butt weld test assembly.
(b) The macro structure test specimen is to be examined that there are not any imperfections
such as lack of fusion, poor penetration or cracks.
6. Annual inspections
(1) In the annual inspections, every approved welding consumables are to be subjected to the tests
provided in (2) and are to be successfully examined.
(2) Kinds of tests in the annual inspections are to be as given in Table 2.2.65.
(3) The welding procedure and requirements for test assemblies specified in (2) are to be in ac-
cordance with the requirements in 4. to 5.

188 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 189


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.65 Kinds of Tests in Annual Inspections

Test assembly Kind and number of test


Kinds of test Welding Thickness specimens taken from test
Number Dimensions assembly
position (mm)
Deposited weld metal
test(Chemical Flat 1 Fig 2.2.36 - -
composition Analysis)
Tensile test specimen : 2
Face bend test specimen : 2
Butt weld test Flat 1 Fig 2.2.37 10 - 12
Root bend test specimen : 2
Macro structure test specimen : 1

609. Welding consumables for high strength quenched and tempered steels
1. Application
Welding consumables for high strength quenched and tempered steels, which are given in following
(1) through (3) (hereinafter referred to as "welding consumables" in 609.) the approval test and an-
nual inspections are to be in accordance with the requirements specified in 609.
(1) Electrodes for manual arc welding(specified in 602. 1 (1) and (2))
(2) Automatic welding consumables(specified in 603. 1 (1) and (2). However, in this case, used on-
ly for multi-run technique in principle.)
(3) Semi-automatic welding consumables
2. Grade and marks of welding consumables
(1) Grades and marks of welding consumables are classified as given in Table 2.2.67.
(2) Where the welding consumables have passed the test specified in 3 (1) below, the suffixes are
to be added to the grade marks with the same methods as specified in 603. 2 (2) and (3) or
604. 2 (2) and (3) according to the grade of welding consumables.
(3) For low hydrogen electrodes which have passed the hydrogen test specified in 6. the suffixes
given in Table 2.2.70 are to be added to the grade marks (eg. 3Y 46S H 5).
3. General provisions for tests
(1) Kinds of test, number, thickness, and dimensions of test assembles, diameters of electrodes or
wires used for welding and welding positions, together with kinds and number of test specimens
taken from each test assembly for welding consumables are to be in accordance with the re-
quirements specified in 602. 3., 603. 3. or 604. 3. However, note (4) of Table 2.2.17 and
note (5) of Table 2.2.34 are not to be required. Provisions for automatic welding consumables
are to be the requirements specified in multi run technique.
(2) The grades of steels used for tests are to be those given in Table 2.2.66 corresponding to the
grades of welding consumables, or those which are considered equivalent by the Society.

Table 2.2.66 Grade of Steels for Test Assembly

Grade of welding consumables Grade of steel for assembly


2Y 42, 2Y 46, 2Y50, 2Y 55, 2Y 62, 2Y 69 A H 43∼A H 70
3Y 42, 3Y 46, 3Y50, 3Y 55, 3Y 62, 3Y 69 A H 43∼A H 70, D H 43∼D H 70
4Y 42, 4Y 46, 4Y50, 4Y 55, 4Y 62, 4Y 69 A H 43∼A H 70, D H 43∼D H 70, E H 43∼E H 70
A H 43∼A H 70, D H 43∼D H 70,
5Y 42, 5Y 46, 5Y50, 5Y 55, 5Y 62, 5Y 69
E H 43∼E H 70, F H 43∼F H 70
NOTES:
Notwithstanding the requirements in this table, normal and higher strength steels may be used for de-
posited metal test assembly. In this case, appropriate buttering is to be carried out.

190 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(3) For the approval of welding consumables, the tests specified in 602., 603. or 604. are to be
conducted for each brand of welding consumables.
(4) After welding, the test assemblies are not to be subjected to any heat treatment or peening.
(5) It is recommended that the welded assemblies be subjected to a radiographic examination to as-
certain that there are any defects in the weld prior to the preparation of test specimens.
4. Deposited metal test
(1) Welding of deposited metal test assembly
Welding sequence of test assemblies are to be in accordance with the requirements specified in
602. 4 (1), 603. 4 (1) or 604. 4 (1) appropriate to the grade of the welding consumables.
(2) Chemical composition
(a) The chemical composition of the deposited weld metal shall be determined by the manu-
facturer and reported the results of the analysis to the Society. The report is also to include
the main alloy elements.
(b) The results of the analysis shall not exceed the limit values specified in the standards or by
the manufacturer, the narrower tolerances being applicable in each case.
(3) Deposited metal tensile test
(a) Kinds, numbers and selection methods of the deposited metal tensile test specimens being
taken from each test assembly are to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 4 (3),
603. 4 (3) or 604. 4 (3) according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(b) The tensile strength, yield strength and elongation of each test specimen are to comply with
the requirements specified in Table 2.2.67 according to the grade of the welding
consumables.
(c) The provisions specified in the preceding 602. 4 (3) (b) may be applied to the tensile test
specimens.
(4) Deposited metal impact test
(a) Kinds, numbers and selection methods of the deposited metal impact test specimens being
taken from each test assembly are to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 4 (4),
603. 4 (4) or 604. 4 (4) according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(b) The test temperature and minimum mean absorbed energy are to comply with the require-
ments specified given in Table 2.2.67 according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(c) The requirements specified in the preceding 602. 4 (4), (b) and (d) are to be applied to
this test.
5. Butt weld test
(1) Welding of butt weld test assembly
Welding sequence of test assemblies are to be in accordance with the requirements specified in
602. 5 (1), 603. 5 (1) or 604. 5 (1) appropriate to the grade of the welding consumables.
(2) Butt weld tensile test
(a) Kinds and numbers of the butt weld tensile test specimens being taken from each test as-
sembly are to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 5 (2), 603. 5 (2) or 604. 5
(2) according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(b) The tensile strength of each test specimen is to meet the requirements given in Table
2.2.68 according to the grade of the welding consumables.

Table 2.2.68 Tensile Test Requirements for butt weld test

Grade of welding consumables Tensile strength (Nmm  )


2Y 42, 3Y 42, 4Y 42, 5Y 42 530 min.

2Y 46, 3Y 46, 4Y 46, 5Y 46 570 min.

2Y 50, 3Y 50, 4Y 50, 5Y 50 610 min.

2Y 55, 3Y 55, 4Y 55, 5Y 55 670 min.

2Y 62, 3Y 62, 4Y 62, 5Y 62 720 min.

2Y 69, 3Y 69, 4Y 69, 5Y 69 770 min.

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 191


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.67 Test Requirements for Deposited Metal

Grade of Tensile test Impact test


welding Tensile strength Yield strength Elongation Test temp Minimum mean
consumables (Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
(1)
(%) (℃) absorbed energy(J)
2Y 42 0
3Y 42 -20
530 ∼ 680 420 min. 20 min.
4Y 42 -40
5Y 42 -60
47 min.
2Y 46 0
3Y 46 -20
570 ∼ 720 460 min. 20 min.
4Y 46 -40
5Y 46 -60
2Y 50 0
3Y 50 -20
610 ∼ 770 500 min. 18 min. 50 min.
4Y 50 -40
5Y 50 -60
2Y 55 0
3Y 55 -20
670 ∼ 830 550 min. 18 min. 55 min.
4Y 55 -40
5Y 55 -60
2Y 62 0
3Y 62 -20
720 ∼ 890 620 min. 18 min. 62 min.
4Y 62 -40
5Y 62 -60
2Y 69 0
3Y 69 -20
770 ∼ 940 690 min. 17 min. 69 min.
4Y 69 -40
5Y 69 -60
Note
Tensile strength specified in the table may be alerted where deemed appropriate by the Society.

(3) Butt weld bend test


(a) Kinds and numbers of the butt weld face bend and root bend test specimens being taken
hom each test assembly are to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 5 (3), 603.
5 (3) or 604. 5 (3) according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(b) The test specimens are to be subjected to face bend and root bend tests by using former
having a radius given in Table 2.2.69. Outer surface of the specimens is to be free from
any cracks exceeding 3 mm long or other defects when they are bent to the angle of 120
degrees.

Table 2.2.69 Bend Radius for Butt Weld Bend Test

Grade of welding consumable Radius of plunger


2Y 42∼50, 3Y 42∼50, 4Y 42∼50, 5Y 42∼50 2.0 

2Y 55∼69, 3Y 55∼69, 4Y 55∼69, 5Y 55∼69 2.5 

(c) Where the bending angle 120° is not achieved, the specimen may be considered as fulfilling
the requirements, if the bending elongation on a gauge length Lo shown in Fig 2.2.39 ful-
fills the minimum elongation requirements stated in Table 2.2.67 of the Rules

192 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.39 gauge length Lo

(4) Butt weld impact test


(a) Kinds, numbers and selection method of the butt weld impact test specimens being taken
from each test assembly are to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 5 (4), 603.
5 (4) or 604. 5 (4) according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(b) Testing temperature and minimum mean absorbed energy are to comply with the require-
ments specified in Table 2.2.67 according to the grade of the welding consumables.
(c) The requirements specified in the preceding 602. 5 (4), (b) and (d) are to be applied to
these tests.
6. Hydrogen test
(1) Hydrogen Test is to be carried out for welding consumables except gas shielded arc solid wire
by the glycerine method, mercury method, gas chromatographic method or other methods
deemed appropriate by the Society.
(2) The average volume of hydrogen is to comply with the requirements specified in Table 2.2.70
according to the test procedures specified in preceding (1) or the type of suffixes to be added
to the grade marks.

Table 2.2.70 Requirements for hydrogen Contents

Requirements for Hydrogen Contents (cm g)


Grade of welding
Suffixes Glycerine Mercury Gas chromatographic
consumable
method method method

2Y42∼50, 3Y 42∼50,
H 10 0.05 max. 0.10 max. 0.10 max.
4Y 42∼50, 5Y 42∼50

2Y55∼69, 3Y 55∼69,
H5 - 0.05 max. 0.05 max.
4Y 55∼69, 5Y 55∼69

7. Fillet weld test assemblies


(1) Welding of fillet weld test assemblies The test assemblies are to be in accordance with the re-
quirements in 602. 7 (1).
(2) Fillet weld macro-structure test The macro-structure test is to be correspondingly in accord-
ance with the requirements in 602. 7 (2).
(3) Fillet weld hardness test The hardness test is to be correspondingly in accordance with the re-
quirements in 602. 7 (3).
(4) Fillet weld fracture test The fracture test is to be correspondingly in accordance with the re-
quirements in 602. 7 (4).

Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 193


Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

8. Annual inspections
Annual inspections are to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 8, 603. 8 or 604. 8 ac-
cording to the grade of the welding consumables. However, in general, annual inspections for auto-
matic welding consumables are to comply with the requirements specified for multi run technique.
9. Change in grades
The changes in grades relating to the strength or toughness of approved welding consumables are
to comply with the requirements specified in 602. 9, 603. 9 or 604. 9 according to the grade of
the welding consumables.

194 Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012


2012

Guidance Relating to
the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships

Part 2

Materials and Welding

GA-02-E KOREAN REGISTER OF SHIPPING


APPLICATION OF THE GUIDANCE

This "Guidance relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships"
(hereafter called as the Guidance) is prepared with the intent of giving
guidance as to the treatment of the various provisions for items required the
unified interpretations and items not specified in details in the Rules, and the
requirements specified in the Guidance are to be applied, in principle, in
addition to the various provisions in the Rules.
As to any technical modifications which can be regarded as equivalent to any
requirements in the Guidance, their flexible application will be properly
considered.
Amendments to the Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships
( PART 2 MATERIALS AND WELDING, 2011 Edition )

Effective Date 1 July 2012

CHAPTER 1 MATERIALS

Section 3 Rolled Steels


- 301. 6. has been newly established.
- 305. 3. has been newly established.
- 306. has been newly established.

Section 5 Castings
- 502. has been newly established.

Section 6 Steel Forgings


- 601. 6. (2) has been deleted.
- 603. has been newly established.

CHAPTER 2 WELDING

Section 4 Welding Procedure Qualification Tests(WPQT)


- 407. 1. has been amended.

Section 5 Welders and Welder Performance Qualification Tests


- 501. 1. (3) and (4) have been newly established.

ANNEX

Annex 2-6 Guidance for liquid penetrant inspection and repair of defects of copper
alloy propeller castings
- Fig 1 has been amended.

Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship hull steel welds
- amended.

Annex 2-9 Offshore Mooring Chain


- newly established.

- i -
CONTENTS

CHAPTER 1 MATERIALS ·································································································1

SECTION 1 General ·············································································································1


101. Application ···················································································································· 1
102. Approval of manufacturing process and manufacturing control ······························· 1
103. Chemical composition ·································································································· 1
104. Testing and inspection ································································································· 1
109. Retest procedure ··········································································································· 1

SECTION 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures ···············································2


201. General ·························································································································· 2
202. Form and dimension of test specimen ······································································· 2

SECTION 3 Rolled Steels ···································································································4


301. Rolled steels for hull ··································································································· 4
302. Rolled steel plates for boilers ····················································································· 7
303. Rolled steel plates for pressure vessels ····································································· 7
304. Rolled steels for low temperature service ································································· 8
305. Rolled stainless steels ·································································································· 8
306. Round bars for chain ·································································································· 9
308. High Strength Quenched and Tempered Steels for Welded Structures ··················· 9
309. Stainless clad steel plates ·························································································· 10
310. Additional requirements for through thickness properties ······································· 10

SECTION 4 Steel Tubes and Pipes ··············································································11


401. Steel tubes for boilers and heat exchangers ···························································· 11
402. Steel pipes for pressure piping ················································································· 12

SECTION 5 Castings ··········································································································13


501. Steel castings ·············································································································· 13
502. Steel castings for chains ···························································································· 14
505. Stainless steel casting for propeller ·········································································· 14
506. Grey iron casting ······································································································· 16

SECTION 6 Steel Forgings ·······························································································17


601. Steel Forgings ············································································································· 17
603. Steel Forgings for chains ·························································································· 19

SECTION 7 Copper and Copper Alloys ········································································20


702. Copper alloy castings ································································································· 20

SECTION 8 Aluminium Alloys ··························································································21


801. Aluminium alloys ······································································································· 21

CHAPTER 2 WELDING ····································································································23

SECTION 1 General ···········································································································23

- iii -
103. Special weldings ········································································································· 23

SECTION 3 Welding Works and Inspection ································································25


303. Application of welding consumables ········································································ 25
304. Preparation for welding ····························································································· 25
305. Welding sequence and direction of welding ···························································· 25
306. Main welding ············································································································· 27
309. Quality of welds ········································································································ 27

SECTION 4 Welding Procedure Qualification Tests(WPQT) ···································28


401. General ························································································································ 28
404. Butt welded joints ······································································································ 28
405. Test for fillet welded joints ······················································································ 30
407. Validity of qualified welding procedure specification ············································· 31

SECTION 5 Welders and Welder Performance Qualification Tests ·····················33


501. General ························································································································ 33
503. Testing procedure ······································································································· 35

SECTION 6 Welding Consumables ················································································37


602. Electrodes for manual arc welding for normal strength steels, higher strength
steels and steels for low temperature service1.General provision for tests ··········· 37

<ANNEX>
Annex 2-1 Guidance for seamless forged steel drums ·················································· 39
Annex 2-2 Guidance for non-destructive examination of marine steel castings ·········· 40
Annex 2-3 Guidance for surface inspection of cast steel crankshafts ·························· 48
Annex 2-4 Guidance for repairs by welding for cast steel crank throws ··················· 51
Annex 2-5 Guidance for non-destructive examination of hull and machinery steel
forgings ··········································································································· 54
Annex 2-6 Guidance for liquid penetrant inspection and repair of defects of copper
alloy propeller castings ·················································································· 64
Annex 2-7 Guidance for non-destructive testing of ship hull steel welds ··················· 71
Annex 2-8 Reinforced plastic materials ·········································································· 85
Annex 2-9 Offshore mooring chain ················································································· 91

- iv -
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

CHAPTER 1 MATERIALS

SECTION 1 General

101. Application
1. Seamless shells of boilers made of steel forgings are to comply with the Annex 2-1.
2. Reinforced plastic materials used for construction or repair of plastic pipes, FRP ships or composite
vessel are to comply with the Annex 2-8.

102. Approval of manufacturing process and manufacturing control


"control imperfection" referred in 102. 2 (2) of the Rules includes the deviation from the pro-
grammed rolling schedules or normalizing or quenching and tempering procedures.

103. Chemical composition


1. The application to 103. 1 of the Rules is to be in accordance with the followings:
(1) The chemical composition analyses from each ladle are to be applied to steel.
(2) The chemical composition analyses from each cast are to be applied to non-ferrous metals.
2. The application to 103. 2 of the Rules is to be in accordance with the followings :
(1) Selection of samples for the check analyses
Samples for the check analyses are to be taken from specimens for mechanical tests or from
the portion of the body adjacent to the part where mechanical specimens had been taken.
(2) Production analysis and its tolerance for steel
Production analysis and its tolerance for steel is to comply with KS D 0228 (Production Analysis
and its Tolerance for Wrought Steel) or the standard internationally recognized subject to the
approval by the Society.

104. Testing and inspection


"The approval of quality assurance scheme specially specified by the Society" referred in 104. 4 of
the Rules means where the quality assurance scheme of material manufacturer has been already ap-
proved according to the requirements of Ch 5 of "Guidance for Approval of Manufacturing Process
and Type approval etc." by the Society.

109. Retest procedure


"Any part of fracture is outside the one-fourth of the gauge length from the centre of gauge
length" specified in 109. 4 of the Rules means the parts of "B" and "C" as shown in Fig 2.1.1
of the Guidance.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 1
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 2 Test Specimens and Testing Procedures

201. General
1. Application
In case where test specimens or test procedures specified in the requirements of ISO or KS are
adopted, the approvals by the Society may be dispensed with, notwithstanding the requirement in
201. 1 (2) of the Rules.
2. Selection of test specimens
"Where otherwise specified or agreed with the Surveyor" referred in 201. 3 (2) of the Rules
means only where manufacturing process of the material has been already approved according to
the requirements of Ch 2 of "Guidance for Approval of Manufacturing Process and Type
Approval, etc" by the Society

202. Form and dimension of test specimen


1. Tensile test specimen
(1) The gauge length of the R 14B tensile test specimens specified in Fig 2.1.1 of the Rules may
be used as given in Table 2.1.1 of Guidance in accordance with 201. 1 (2) of the Rules.

Table 2.1.1 Rounding of Gauge Length

Thickness of test specimen t (mm) Width of test specimen W (mm) Gauge length L (mm)

3 ≤ t ≤ 4 50

4 < t ≤ 5 60

5 < t ≤ 7 70

7 < t ≤ 10 80
25
10 < t ≤ 15 100

15 < t ≤ 20 120

20 < t ≤ 30 140

30 < t ≤ 40 160

(2) In application to 202. 1 (4) of the Rules, corrections for elongation are to be in accordance
with the followings :
(A) Stainless steel and aluminium alloys are to be considered as Material 1 in Table 2.1.1 of
the Rules. However, corrections for elongation specified in 202. 1 (4) of the Rules may not
be required in the case of copper alloy.
(B) In case where the corrections by the requirements of 202. 1 (4) of the Rules are deemed
troublesome because of a great number of test specimens, the value of specified elongation
may be corrected by using the following formula. In such case, the corrected specified elon-
gation is to be recorded in the certificates of the material test.

  ∙

where
 = Elongation equivalent to where the proportional specimens (   
 ) specified
in Fig 2.1.1 of the Rules are used.
 = Elongation where optional test specimens are used.

2 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

 = Coefficient of correction for elongation are shown in Table 2.1.2 of the


Guidance according to the gauge length.

Table 2.1.2 Values of F

Gauge length (  ) Material 1 Material 2


8 1.21 1.29


 1.15 1.21

4 0.91 0.88


 0.87 0.82

 : Diameter of the test specimen


 : Sectional area of the test specimen

2. Impact test specimen


(1) In application to 202. 3 (3) of the Rules, the sub-size specimens permitted according to thick-
ness of the steels are to be as follows;

Steel thickness Width of the sub-size specimen


 mm ≤  ≺  mm 5 mm
 mm ≤  ≺  mm 7.5 mm

(2) In application to 202. 3 (5) of the Rules, in case where the capacity of impact tester limits the
use of normal impact test specimens, sub-size specimens can be used provided that the test re-
sults using sub-size specimens are to comply with the requirements specified for the normal im-
pact test specimens.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 3
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 3 Rolled Steels

301. Rolled steels for hull


1. Manufacturing process
(1) The term of "thermo-mechanical controlled processing(TM CP )" in 301. 3 of the Rules is defined
in the following 2 of this Guidance.
(2) The carbon equivalent value of higher strength steels supplied in TM CP condition in Remarks
(13) to Table 2.1.6 of 301. 3 of the Rules is to comply with the requirements of Table 2.1.3
of the Guidance.

Table 2.1.3 Carbon Equivalent of Higher Strength Steels supplied in TMCP Condition

Carbon Equivalent(%)
Grade
 ≤ 50 mm 50 <  ≤ 100 mm
AH 32, DH 32, EH 32, FH 32 0.36 max. 0.38 max.
AH 36, DH 36, EH 36, FH 36 0.38 max. 0.40 max.
AH 40, DH 40, EH 40, FH 40 0.40 max. 0.42 max

(3) The cold cracking susceptibility (  ) calculated by following a formula instead of carbon equiv-
alent of previous (2) may be required to be submitted when deemed necessary by the Society.

          
                  
      

2. Heat treatment
The definition of heat treatment mentioned in Remarks (1) to Table 2.1.8 and Table 2.1.9 of
301. 4 of the Rules are as follows : (Refer to Fig 2.1.2)
(1) As rolled, AR
This procedure involves the rolling of steel at high temperature followed by air cooling. The
rolling and finishing temperatures are typically in the austenite recrystallization region and
above the normalising temperature. The strength and toughness properties of steel produced by
this process are generally less than steel heat treated after rolling or than steel produced by ad-
vanced processes.
(2) Normalising, N
Normalising involves heating rolled steel above the critical temperature, AC3, and in the lower
end of the austenite recrystallization region followed by air cooling. The process improves the
mechanical properties of as rolled steel by refining the grain size.
(3) Controlled Rolling(Normalising Rolling), CR(NR)
A rolling procedure in which the final deformation is carried out in the normalising temperature
range, resulting in a material condition generally equivalent to that obtained by normalising.
(4) Quenching and Tempering, QT
Quenching involves a heat treatment process in which steel is heated to an appropriate temper-
ature above the AC3 and then cooled with an appropriate coolant for the purpose of hardening
the microstructure. Tempering subsequent to quenching is a process in which the steel is re-
heated to an appropriate temperature not higher than the AC1 to restore toughness properties by
improving the microstructure.
(5) Thermo-mechanical Rolling(Thermo-mechanical Controlled Processing), TM(TMCP)
This is a procedure which involves the strict control of both the steel temperature and the roll-
ing reduction. Generally a high proportion of the rolling reduction is carried out close to the
Ar3 temperature and may involve the rolling in the dual phase temperature region. Unlike con-
trolled rolled (normalised rolling) the properties conferred by TM (TM CP ) cannot be reproduced
by subsequent normalising or other heat treatment. The use of accelerated cooling on completion
of TM-rolling may also be accepted subject to the special approval of the Society.

4 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(6) Accelerated Cooling Processing, AcC


Accelerated cooling is a process, which aims to improve mechanical properties by controlled
cooling with rates higher than air cooling in the range of Ar3 temperature or below. However,
direct quenching is excluded from accelerated cooling.

Type of Processing
Conventional Processes Thermo-Mechanical Processes
Structure Temperature
CR
AR N QT TM
(NR)

Normal Slab
Heating Temp
Recrystallized
Austenite Normalizing
or Quenching
Temp.

Non-recrystallized
Austenite Ar3 or Ac3

Austenite + Ferrite
Ar1 or Ac1

Ferrite + Pearlite
or Tempering
Ferrite + Bainite Temp.

(Note)
R : Reduction AR : As rolled
N : Normalising CR(NR) : Controlled Rolling(Normalising Rolling)
AcC : Accelerated cooling
TM(TMCP) : Thermal-mechanical rolling (Thermal-Mechanical Controlled Process))
(*) : Where final rolling is carried out in austenite-ferrite duplex.

Fig 2.1.2 Rolled Processes for Rolled Steels for Hull

3. Selection of test samples


"Where specially approved by the Society" specified in 301. 6 (3) of the Rules may be dealt
with as follows :
(A) Impact tests for AH 32 and AH 36 may be dispensed with as far as periodical examinations
are carried out in the presence of the Society's Surveyor, except otherwise specially speci-
fied on the approval of the manufacturing process.
(B) “Periodical” in (A) above means once a month. In this case, impact tests specified are car-
ried out for a set (3 pieces) of specimens and the results of which are to be confirmed in
compliance with the specifications.
(C) In case where the result does not comply with the specifications, retests for the lot of steel
material to which the failed specimens are belonging may be carried out in accordance with
the requirements in 301. 10 of the Rules.
(D) Where the result of the retest does not comply with the requirements, impact tests provided
in Table 2.1.8 and 2.1.9 of 301. 6 of the Rules are to be carried out for all the steels
manufactured thereafter. Where the test results during 6 months are confirmed as being sat-
isfactory, the procedure specified in (B) above may be applied again.
(E) Every manufacturer is to submit the annual report compiling the results of the impact tests
to the Society.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 5
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

4. Surface inspection and verification of dimensions


The application to 301. 8 of the Rules is to be in accordance with the follows :
(1) The Society may require the surface inspection of rolled steels to confirm in compliance with
the quality same as that of those days of approval of the manufacturing process.
(2) Criteria of surface inspection for flaw, pin hole and blow hole of steel plate is to comply with
KS D 0208 (Method of macro-streak-flaw test for steel).
(3) Tolerance for rolled steel other than under thickness tolerance for plate is to comply with KS D
3051(Dimensions weight and permissible variations of hot rolled steel bar in coil), KS D
3052(Shape, dimensions, weight and tolerance of hot rolled steel flats), KS D 3500 (Dimensions
weight and permissible variations of hot rolled steel plates, sheets and strips) and KS D 3502
(Dimensions, weight and tolerances of hot rolled steel sections).
5. Quality and repair of defects
(1) Ultrasonic test procedures and acceptance criteria, specified in 301. 9 (2) of the Rules, are to
be in accordance with either EN 10160 Level S1/E1 , ASTM A 578 Level C or accepted stand-
ard at the discretion of the Society.
(2) The application to 301. 9 (3) of the Rules is to be in accordance with the followings:
(A) The surface defects may be removed by local grinding, in the presence of the Surveyor,
provided:
(a) the nominal product thickness will not be reduced by more than 7 % or 3 mm, whichever
is the less
(b) each single ground area does not exceed 0,25 m  and all ground areas do not exceed 2 %
of the total surface in question.
(c) Ground areas lying opposite each other on both surfaces must not decrease the product
thickness by values exceeding the limits as stated above (a)
(d) Complete elimination of the defects may be verified by a magnetic particle or dye pene-
trant test procedure at the Surveyor's discretion.
(e) Where necessary, the entire surface may be ground to a depth as given by the under thick-
ness tolerances of the product. Ground areas lying in a distance less than their average
breadth to each other are to be regarded as one single area.
(B) Local defects which cannot be repaired by grinding as stated above may be repaired with
the Surveyor's consent by chipping and/or grinding followed by welding subject to the fol-
lowing conditions:
(a) Any single welded area shall not exceed 0,125 m  and the sum of all areas shall not ex-
ceed 2 % of the surface side in question. The distance between two welded areas shall not
be less than their average width.
(b) The weld preparation must not reduce the thickness of the product below 80 % of the
nominal thickness.
(c) the welding is to be carried out by an approved procedure, by the welder qualified by the
Society, with approved electrodes, And the electrodes shall be of low hydrogen type and
must be dried in accordance with the manufacturer's requirements and protected against re-
humidification before and during welding.
(d) All weldings are to be of reasonable length and must have at least 3 parallel welding
beads. Weld metal is to have at least 1.6 mm reinforcement, which is to be removed by
grinding or chipping and grinding flush with the rolled surface, and is to present a work-
manlike finish.
(e) The deposited metal must be sound without any lack of fusion, undercut, cracks and other
defects which could impair the workability or use of the product. The finished products
are to be presented to the Surveyor for acceptance. The soundness of the repair may be
verified by ultrasonic, magnetic particle or dye penetrant methods at the Surveyor's
discretion.
(f) Products which are to be supplied in a heat treated condition are to be welded prior to the
heat treatment; otherwise, a new heat treatment may be required. Products supplied in the
controlled rolled (CR ) or as rolled (AS ) condition may require a suitable heat treatment af-
ter welding. However, the post weld heat treatment may be omitted provided the manu-
facturer has demonstrated by a procedure test that the required properties will be main-
tained without heat treatment.

6 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(g) For every welding repair the manufacturer must provide the Surveyor with a written report
and a sketch showing sizes and location of the defects and full details of the repair proce-
dure including the welding consumables, post weld heat treatment and non-destructive
testing.
(C) Shapes may be conditioned by the manufacturer for the removal of surface defects in ac-
cordance with the following limitations.
(a) For material less than 9.5 mm thickness, in which the defects are not more than 0.8 mm in
depth, the defects may be removed by grinding or chipping.
(b) For material 9.5 mm and over in thickness, in which the defects are not more than 1.6 mm
in depth, the defects may be removed by grinding or chipping.
(c) Surface defects which are greater in depth than the limits shown above (a) and (b) may be
removed by chipping or grinding and then depositing weld metal, in the presence of the
Surveyor, subject to the following conditions.
(i) The total area of the chipped or ground surface of any piece is not to exceed 2 % of
the total surface area of that piece.
(ii) After removal of any defect preparatory to welding, the thickness of the shape is not
to be reduced by more than 30 % of the nominal thickness, nor is the depth of de-
pression prior to welding to exceed 12.5 mm in any case.
(D) Before repair works prescribed in above (B) or (C) (c), the following documents are to be
submitted to the Society for approval.
(a) Specifications of repairing procedure which state about kind of surface defects, the way of
chipping, grinding and welding, etc.
(b) Reports on results of tensile test, bend test, impact test, macro-structure inspection and
hardness test on test samples repaired according to the procedure specified in above (a).
6. Forming
The cold deformation limit specified in 301. 12 of the Rules are to be dealt with as follows :
(1) For steels in structural members, the cold deformation rate shall be less than 10 %.(the inside
bending radius shall not be less than 4.5 times the plate thickness)
(2) Where steels are subjected to the permanent deformation exceeding 10 %, an additional test may
be required by the Society.
(3) The use of hammering is not to be employed.

302. Rolled steel plates for boilers


1. Selection of test samples
In application to 302. 6 of the Rules, selections of test samples in case that where the purchasers
carry out normalizing specified in 302. 3 (2) of the Rules at their factories are to comply with the
following requirements :
(1) The manufacturer is to carry out normalizing of the test sample conforming to the requirements
by the purchaser. Where no requirements have been given by the purchaser, the manufacturer
may carry out normalizing as considered preferable. In this case, the manufacturer is to inform
the purchaser the conditions of normalizing which had been carried out.
(2) The test samples is taken from the steel plates normalized at purchasers factory or normalized
together with the steel plates simultaneously.
(3) The mechanical properties obtained by the test specimens specified in (1) and (2) above are to
comply with the provisions in Table 2.1.12 of the Rules.
2. Marking
The markings related to the heat treatment of the steel plates provided in 302. 1 of the Rules are
to be "TN " showing the case where normalizing is carried out for test samples only.

303. Rolled steel plates for pressure vessels


1. Selection of test samples
In application to 303. 6 of the Rules, selections of test samples in case that where the purchasers
carry out normalizing specified in 303. 3 (2) of the Rules at their factories are to comply with the

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 7
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

following requirements :
(1) The manufacturer is to carry out normalizing of the test sample conforming to the requirements
by the purchaser. Where no requirements have been given by the purchaser, the manufacturer
may carry out normalizing as considered preferable. In this case, the manufacturer is to inform
the purchaser the conditions of normalizing which had been carried out.
(2) The test samples is taken from the steel plates normalized at purchasers factory or normalized
together with the steel plates simultaneously.

(3) The mechanical properties obtained by the test specimens specified in (1) and (2) above are to
comply with the provisions in Table 2.1.15 of the Rules.
2. In 303. 7 (2) of the Rules, the application to "deemed necessary by the Society" is to be in ac-
cordance with the follows :
(1) Where the steel plates are used for spherical tanks or end plates, etc. of cylindrical tanks to
contain cold liquefied gas at normal temperature, the impact test specimens are to be taken with
their longitudinal axis normal (T direction) to the final direction of rolling.
(2) In previous (1), the specified values of the impact tests are to be in accordance with Table
2.1.15 of the Rules.
3. Marking
The markings related to heat treatments of the steel plates provided in 303. 1 of the Guidance are
to be "TN " showing case where normalising is carried out for test samples only.

304. Rolled steels for low temperature service


1. Mechanical properties
Minimum elongation where the R 5 specimen instead of R 1B specimen mentioned in Remarks (2)
to Table 2.1.17 of the Rules is used may apply to the values of Table 2.1.4 of the Guidance.

Table 2.1.4 Minimum Elongation (%)

Thickness  (mm)
 ≤ 5 5 <  ≤ 10 10 <  ≤ 15 15 <  ≤ 20 20 <  ≤ 25
Grade
RL 24A, RL 24B, RL 27 22 24 26 28 30
RL 33 23 26 29 32 35
RL 37 24 27 30 33
21
RL 2N30, RL 3N32, RL 5N43 23 27 29
25
RL 9N53, RL 9N60 19 22 28 31

305. Rolled stainless steels


1. Application
In application to 305. 1 (3) of the Rules, the grade, chemical composition and mechanical proper-
ties of austenitic-ferritic stainless steel (hereinafter referred to as "duplex stainless steels") not ex-
ceeding 75 mm in thickness are to be as specified on the followings.
(1) Grades and chemical composition
The grade and chemical composition of duplex stainless steels are to comply with the provisions
in Table 2.1.5 of the Guidance.

Table 2.1.5 Grades and chemical composition

Chemical composition(%)
Grade
        
S31803 0.030 1.00 2.00 0.035 0.015 4.5∼6.5 21.0∼23.0 2.5∼3.5 0.10∼0.22
S32750 max. max. max. max. max. 6.0∼8.0 24.0∼26.0 3.0∼4.5 0.24∼0.35

8 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(2) Mechanical properties


The mechanical properties of duplex stainless steels are to comply with the provisions in Table
2.1.6 of the Guidance.

Table 2.1.6 Mechanical properties

Tensile test Impact test


Grade Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation(%) Test temp. Average absorbed energy(J)
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
) (℃) L T
S31803 460 min. 640 min 25 min 41 -
- 20
S32750 530 min 730 min 25 min - 27

2. Mechanical properties
In application to 305. 5 (1) of the Rules, the minimum yield strength specified in Table 2.1.20
of the Rules may be altered to other values subject to the approval of the Society. In this case,
minimum yield strength and indication symbol of heat treatment specified in 301. 2 of the
Guidance will be added after the steel grade mark.(eg. : RSTS 316LN - 400TM )
3. Forming
The deformation limit specified in 305. 12 of the Rules are to be dealt with as follows :
(1) For rolled stainless steels in structural members, the deformation rate shall be less than 20 %.
(the inside bending radius shall not be less than 2 times the plate thickness)

306. Round bars for chain


Round bars for offshore mooring chain are to comply with Annex 2-9, 2 of this guidance.

308. High Strength Quenched and Tempered Steels for Welded Structures
1. Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
(1) In application to 308. 3 (3) of the Rules, the cold cracking susceptibility(  ) for evaluating
weldability is to be calculated from the ladle analysis in accordance with the formula specified
in 301. 1 (3) of the Guidance.
(2) The maximum P cm for high strength quenched and tempered steels is to comply with the re-
quirements of Table 2.1.7 of the Guidance.

Table 2.1.7 Grades and Cold Cracking Susceptibility

Cold Cracking Susceptibility (  )(%)


Grades Thickness  (mm)
 ≤ 50 50 <  ≤ 70
AH 43, DH 43, EH 43, FH 43 0.25 max. 0.27 max.
AH 47, DH 47, EH 47, FH 47 0.26 max. 0.28 max.
AH 51, DH 51, EH 51, FH 51 0.26 max. 0.28 max.
AH 56, DH 56, EH 56, FH 56 0.28 max. 0.30 max.
AH 63, DH 63, EH 63, FH 63 0.29 max. 0.31 max.
AH 70, DH 70, EH 70, FH 70 0.30 max. 0.32 max.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 9
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

309. Stainless clad steel plates


1. Mechanical properties
Shearing strength test method complies with KS D 0234.(Testing methods for clad steel)
2. Quality and repair of defects
Ultrasonic test generally complies with KS D 3693 (Stainless-clad steel) and KS D 0234.(Testing
methods for clad steel)

310. Additional requirements for through thickness properties


1. Ultrasonic tests
(1) Ultrasonic test procedures and acceptance criteria, specified in 310. 7 (2) of the Rules, are to
be in accordance with either EN 10160 Level S1/E1 , ASTM A 578 Level C or accepted stand-
ard at the discretion of the Society

10 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 4 Steel Tubes and Pipes

401. Steel tubes for boilers and heat exchangers


1. The definition of heat treatment mentioned in Table 2.1.40 of 401. 3 of the Rules are as follows
(1) Low temperature annealing : An annealing treatment which is performed to eliminate internal
stress or reduce quenching strain .
(2) Normalizing : Heating a ferrous alloy to a suitable temperature above  or  and then
cooling in still air to a temperature substantially below  . Is performed to refine the crystal
structure and eliminate internal stress.
(3) Full Annealing : An annealing treatment in which a steel is austenitized by heating to a tem-
perature above the upper critical temperature (  or  ) and then cooled slowly to room
temperature.
(4) Isothermal Annealing : A process in which a ferrous alloy is heated to produce a structure
partly or wholly austenitic, and is then cooled to and held at a temperature that causes trans-
formation of the austenite to a relatively soft ferrite-carbide aggregate.
2. Chemical composition

The chemical composition of RSTH 33 is to comply with the requirements given in Table 2.1.8.

Table 2.1.8. Chemical composition

chemical composition (%)


Grade
    
RSTH 33 0.18max. 0.35max 0.25∼0.60 0.035max 0.035max

3. Heat treatment and mechanical properties


(1) The heat treatment of RSTH 33 is to be same as the requirement for RSTH 35
(2) The mechanical properties of RSTH 33 are to comply with the following requirements.
(a) Tensile test : The tensile test of RSTH 33 is to comply with the requirements given in
Table 2.1.9.

Table 2.1.9 Mechanical properties


Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation (%)
Grade
(Nmm  ) (Nmm  ) (   
)
RSTH 33 175 min 325 min 26(22) min
NOTES:
1. The values of elongation in parenthesis are applicable to the test specimens taken transversely. In
this case, the sampling material is to be heated 600℃ to 650℃ after flattened and annealed in
order to make it free from strain.
2. In case where test specimen of non-tubular section is taken from an electric-resistance welded
steel tube, the test specimen is to be taken from the parts that do not include the welded line.

(b) Flattening test : The flattening test of RSTH 33 is to comply with the requirements given in
401. 5 (2) of the Rules. However, the value of e is to be 0.09
(c) Flanging test : A section of steel tube which is taken from its end is to be turned over
cold so as to have a flange, the outside diameter of which is not less than specified in
Table 2.1.10, at right angle to the axis without cracking or showing flaw. In this case,
the flanging test specimen is to be of length L such that after testing the remaining cylin-
drical portion is not less than 0.5 D . But, this test is to be made only for RSTH 33 tubes
having wall thickness not more than 1/10 of its outside diameter and not more than 5 mm.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 11
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Table 2.1.10 Outside Diameter of Flange after Flanging

Outside diameter of steel tube Outside diameter of flange

Less than 63 mm 1.3 times the outside diameter of steel tube

63 mm and over Outside diameter of steel tube + 20 mm

(d) Crushing test : Where required by the Surveyor, a crushing test is to be made on a section
of steel tube of 65 mm in length which is to stand crushing longitudinally without cracking
or splitting to the height specified in Table 2.1.11.

Table 2.1.11 Height of Section after Crushing

Thickness of steel tube  (mm) Height of section after crushing


 ≤ 3.4 19 mm or until outside folds are in contact
 > 3.4 32 mm

(e) Reverse flattening test : The reverse flattening test of RSTH 33 is to comply with the re-
quirements given in 401. 5 (4) of the Rules.
(f) Hydraulic test : The hydraulic test of RSTH 33 is to comply with the requirements given in
401. 5 (5) of the Rules.
(3) The non-destructive inspection, substituted for the hydraulic tests, specified in 401. 5 (5), (d) of
the Rules are to be either ultrasonic tests or eddy current tests.
(a) Ultrasonic test is to comply with KS D 0250 (Ultrasonic examination for steel pipes and
tubes). Steel tubes and pipes not to be detected the signal equivalent to that to be detected
at artificial holes of reference block from detection sensitivity UD are accepted.
(b) Eddy current test is to comply with KS D 0251 (Eddy current examination for steel pipes
and tubes). Steel tubes and pipes not to be detected the signal equivalent to that to be de-
tected at artificial holes of reference block from detection sensitivity EY are accepted.
4. Selection of test specimen
The test specimens of RSTH 33 are to be taken in accordance with the following requirements, from
each grade and each size which has been heat treated at the same time in the same heating fur-
nace for heat-treated tubes and from each grade and each size for non-heat-treated steel tubes
respectively.
(1) Seamless steel tubes : One sampling steel tube is to be selected from each lot of 100 tubes or
fraction thereof, and one tension, one flattening and one flanging or flaring test specimens are
to be taken from each of the sampling steel tubes.
(2) Electric-resistance welded steel tubes : In addition to the requirements in (1), one sampling steel
tube is to be selected from each lot of 50 tubes or fraction thereof for 100 and less steel
tubes, and each lot of 100 tubes or fraction thereof for 100 over steel tubes, and one reverse
flattening test specimen is to be taken from each of the sampling steel tubes.

402. Steel pipes for pressure piping


1. Mechanical properties
“The non-destructive inspection deemed appropriate by the Society" specified in 402. 5 (4), (d) of
the Rules are dealt with according to the provisions in 401. 3 (3) of the Guidance.

12 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 5 Castings

501. Steel castings

1. Chemical composition
(1) In application to 501. 4 of the Rules, the chemical composition of special carbon steel casting
with higher toughness requirements such as high holding power anchors etc. is to comply with
the requirements of Table 2.1.12 of the Guidance.
The suitable grain refining elements such as aluminium etc. are to be used at the discretion of
the manufacturer. The content of such elements is to be reported in the ladle analysis.

Table 2.1.12 Chemical Composition

Chemical composition (%)


Materials
C Si Mn P S Al others

Special carbon 0.23 0.60 1.60 0.035 0.035 0.015∼ to comply with Table
steel casting max. max. max. max. max. 0.08 2.1.67 of the Rules

(2) "Subject to approval by the Society," referred in note (1), Table 2.1.67 of 501. 4 of the Rules
means only where welding procedure qualification test of the casting for welded construction
with same chemical composition has been satisfied by the Society
2. Mechanical properties
In application to 501. 6 (2) of the Rules, the results of impact test is to comply with the require-
ments of Table 2.1.13 of the Guidance.

Table 2.1.13 Impact Test Requirements

Impact test
Grade
Test temp.(℃) Average absorbed energy(J)

RSC 410, RSC 450, RSC 480,


0 27 min.
RSC 560, RSC 600

3. Surface and dimension inspection


The surface inspection of stern frames, rudder frames and crank shaft specified in 501. 8 of the
Rules are to be dealt with as follows :
(1) The surface inspection of stern frame and rudder frame are to comply with the Annex 2-2.
(2) The surface inspection of crank shafts made of steel castings are to comply with the Annex
2-3.
4. Non-destructive inspection

The non-destructive inspection for steel castings specified in 501. 10 (1) and (2) of the Rules are
to be dealt with as follows :
(1) The non-destructive inspection of stern frame and rudder frame are to comply with the Annex
2-2.
(2) The non-destructive inspection of crank shafts made of steel castings are to comply with the
Annex 2-3.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 13
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

5. Repair of defects

Repairs by welding for steel casting specified in 501. 11 (1), (b) of the Rules are to be dealt with
as follows :
(1) Repairs by welding of crank throws made of steel castings are to comply with the Annex 2-4.
(2) Repairs by welding of steel alloy castings are to comply with 7 (the preparatory tests) of the
Annex 2-4.
(3) Repairs of steel castings such as stern frame, rudder frame and others intended for important
parts of hull structure are to comply with the Annex 2-2, 8.

502. Steel castings for chains


Steel castings for offshore mooring chain are to comply with Annex 2-9, 4 of this guidance.

505. Stainless steel casting for propeller

1. Non-destructive inspection
(1) The liquid penetrant test of steel propeller casting specified in 505. 8 (1) of the Rules is to
comply with Annex 2-6.
(2) The division of severity zones of steel propeller casting specified in 505. 8 (2) is to comply
with the Figs. 1 and 2 of Annex 2-6.
2. Repair of defects

In application to 505. 9 (4) of the Rules, the repair welding procedure is to comply with the fol-
lowings
(1) The limits of repair welding are to comply with Annex 2-6, 3 (2) to (4).
(2) Repair welding procedure
When steel propeller casting is repaired by welding in accordance with the previous (1), the fol-
lowing requirements apply.
(A) Before welding is started, a detailed welding procedure specification is to be submitted cov-
ering the weld preparation, welding positions, welding parameters, welding consumables,
preheating, post weld heat treatment and inspection procedures to the Society. The welding
procedure qualification tests are to carried out in accordance with following (3).
(B) All weld repairs are to be made by welders qualified as deemed appropriate by the Society.
(C) Welding is to be done under controlled conditions free from draughts and adverse weather.
(D) The welding consumables used in the welding procedure qualification tests are to be used.
The welding consumables are to be stored and handled in accordance with the manu-
facturer’s recommendations.
(E) The martensitic steels are to be furnace re-tempered after weld repair. Subject to prior ap-
proval of the Society, however, local stress relieving may be considered for minor repairs.
(F) On completion of heat treatment the weld repairs and adjacent material are to be ground
smooth. All weld repairs are to be liquid penetrant tested.
(G) The foundry is to maintain records of welding, subsequent heat treatment and inspections
traceable to each casting repaired. These records are to be reviewed by the Surveyor.
(3) Welding procedure qualification test
(A) Preparation of test sample
The test sample is to be as shown Fig 2.1.3 of the Guidance. The edge preparation, in
principle, to be V-shape and bevel angle is to be not less than 60°.

14 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(B) Non-destructive testing


The test sample is to be visually inspected and liquid penetrant tested.
(C) Macro-structure examination
Two macro-sections shall be prepared. No pores greater than 3 mm and cracks in welded
sections is permitted.

Fig 2.1.3 Test Sample for Butt Welding Test

(D) Tensile testing


Two flat transverse tensile test specimens shall be prepared. The tensile strength shall meet
the specified minimum value of the base material. The location of fracture is to be reported,
i.e. weld metal, HAZ or base material.
(E) Bend testing
Two transverse side bend test specimens shall be prepared . The former diameter shall be 4
x thickness except for austenitic steels, in which case the former diameter shall be 3 x
thickness.
The test specimen, when visually inspected after bending, shall show no surface im-
perfections greater than 2 mm in length.
(F) Impact testing
Impact test is not required, except where the base material is impact tested. Two sets shall
be taken, one set with the notch positioned in the center of the weld and one set with the
notch positioned in the fusion line, respectively. The test temperature, and impact energy
shall comply with the requirement specified for the base material.
(G) Hardness testing
One of the macro-sections shall be used for Hv5 hardness testing. At least three individual
indentations in the weld metal, the HAZ (both sides) and in the base material. The values
are to be reported for information.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 15
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

506. Grey iron casting


1. Test samples
The chill test specified in 506. 6 (7), (d) of the Rules is to comply with ASTM A 367-60(Standard
test methods of chill tests of cast iron

16 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 6 Steel Forgings

601. Steel Forgings


1. Manufacturing process
(1) The application to the requirements of 601. 3 (5), (a) of the Rules is to be in accordance with
the following :
For crankshafts, where grain flow is required in the most favourable direction having regard to
the mode of stressing in service, the proposed method of manufacture may require special ap-
proval by the Society. In such cases, tests may be required to demonstrate that a satisfactory
structure and grain flow are obtained.
(2) The application to the requirements of 601. 3 (6) of the Rules is to be in accordance with the
following :
These requirements apply to where gas workings are being carried out on the parts subjected to
high stress such as mass removal of crankshaft. The data related to the processes (including
preheating) and change of material due to working are to be submitted approval of the Society.
2. Heat treatment
The application to 601. 4 (1) of the Rules is to be in accordance with the following :
(1) Overall length of the product is not afforded to be heat treated simultaneously, it is requested
that an approval of the surveyor be obtained beforehand. In this case, one set of test specimens
is to be taken from each end of the product. Degree of heterogeneity in micro structure at the
boundary zone caused by such a heat treatment is to be examined by the method deemed ap-
propriate by the Society and ultrasonic test.
3. Mechanical properties

In application to 601. 6 Note (4) of Table 2.1.82 of the Rules, the kinds and average absorbed
energy for low alloys steel forgings intended to be used for important parts of machinery which
the impact test may be required are to comply with the requirements of Table 2.1.14 of the
Guidance.

Table 2.1.14 Kinds and Average Absorbed Energy for Low Alloys Steel Forgings

Charpy V notch Impact test


Low Alloys Steel
Grades Average absorbed energy(J)
forging applied
L T
RSF 600AM 41 min. 24 min.

RSF 700AM 32 min. 22 min.


- Crankshaft
RSF 800AM 32 min. 20 min.
- Forgings for gears
RSF1000AM 25 min. 16 min.

RSF1100AM 21 min. 13 min.

(Note) Impact tests are to be carried out at ambient temperature (18~25).

4. Selection of test specimen


Selection of the test specimens for forgings subjected to surface hardening, except for carburizing,
specified in 601. 7 (9) of the Rules and hardness test are to comply with the following
requirements.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 17
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

(1) Induction hardened or nitrized gears


(A) Tensile and impact test specimens
The test specimens are to be taken from the product after the final heat treatment and be-
fore the surface hardening in accordance with the requirements specified in 601. 7 (3), (b)
through (e) of the Rules
(B) Depth of the hardened layer
(a) In case of induction hardening
The depth of the hardened layer of the product is to be measured when the gear is
produced for the first time, and tests thereafter may be dispensed with.
(b) In case of nitrization
(i) Selection of test samples
Test samples are to be made of the same material as the product having been proc-
essed under the same conditions.
(ii) Size of test samples
The size of the test samples may be optional.
(iii)Heat treatments of test samples
The test samples are to be heat treated and nitrized simultaneously together with the
product.
(iv)Measurements of depth of hardened layer
The depth of hardened layer is to be measured every lot of same nitrization.
(2) The hardness tests of the surface hardened gears are to be dealt with as follows :
(A) The requirements for the measurement of hardness after surface hardening processes have
been required related to the Shafting and Power Transmission Systems in Pt 5, Ch 3 of
the Rules, and the measured hardness value is to be approved by the Society in relation of
the approval of the manufacturing processes.
(B) In case where the measurements of hardness for every forged products are difficult owing to
their sizes and shapes, the hardness may be measured at appropriate locations considered to
be representative in respect to the value of hardness resulted from the approval tests for the
manufacturing processes referred to in (A) above.
5. Surface inspection

The requirements specified in 601. 8 of the Rules are to be dealt with as follows :
(1) The surface inspection of steel forgings is to comply with the Annex 2-5, 2.
6. Non-destructive inspection
(1) Non-destructive inspection of steel forgings specified in 601. 10 (1) and (2) of the Rules are to
be dealt with as follows:
(A) The non-destructive inspection of steel forgings are to comply with the Annex 2-5, 2 and
3.
7. Repair of defects

The application to 601. 11 (4) of the Rules is to be accordance with the following:
(1) Repair by welding in order of correct shapes for the portions not subjected to high stress may
be accepted.
8. Additional requirements for crank shafts
(1) In 601. 14 (1) of the Rules, where the heat treatments of the crank throws of solid crank
shafts are carried out without mass removal, one set of test specimens are to be taken from the
removed mass of the central crank throw at the part neighboring the pin, as shown in Fig
2.1.4 of the Guidance after the heat treatment.

18 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

Fig 2.1.4 Location of Test Specimens

(2) In relation to the tests for semibuilt-up crank throws specified in 601. 14 (2) of the Rules, fol-
lowing requirements are to be complied with.
(A) Test specimens are to be taken, in general, one set from each arm in the longitudinal
direction.
(B) In case where either the process of manufacturing those approved are intended to be
changed or cranks larger than ever approved are intended to be manufactured, the tests in-
structed by the Society are to be newly carried out.

603. Steel forgings for chains


Steel forgings for offshore mooring chain are to comply with Annex 2-9, 3 of this guidance.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 19
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 7 Copper and Copper Alloys

702. Copper alloy castings


1. Manufacturing process
In application to 702. 3 (3) of the Rules, the stress relieving temperatures and holding times are to
comply with the Annex 2-6.
2. Mechanical properties
The wording " specially required considering the design by the Society" in Table 2.1.94, Note 1
of 702. 5 of the Rules means in case where the requirements specified in Pt 5, Ch 3, 305. 2 (1)
(g) of the Guidance are applied.
3. Surface and dimension inspection
In application to 702. 7 (2) of the Rules, procedure for straightening of propeller casting is to
comply with Annex 2-6.
4. Non-destructive inspection
(1) The liquid penetrant test of steel propeller casting specified in 702. 9 (1) of the Rules is to
comply with Annex 2-6.
(2) The division of severity zones of steel propeller casting specified in 702. 9 (2) is to comply
with the Fig 1 and 2 of Annex 2-6.
5. Repair of Defects
In application to 702. 10 (5) of the Rules, repair welding of propeller castings is to comply with
Annex 2-6.

20 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

SECTION 8 Aluminium Alloys

801. Aluminium alloys


1. Mechanical properties
(1) In connection with the 801. 5 (2) of the Rule, for verification of proper fusion of press welds
for closed profiles, the Manufacturer has to demonstrate by drift expansion tests of closed as
follows;
(a) Batches of five profiles or less shall be sampled one profile. Each profile sampled will have
two samples cut from the front and back end of the production profile. The test specimens
are to be cut with the ends perpendicular to the axis of the profile.
(b) Profiles with lengths exceeding 6 m shall be sampled every profile in the start of the
production. The number of tests may be reduced to every fifth profile if the results from
the first 3-5 profiles are found acceptable.
(c) The size of the specimen and testing procedure are to be in accordance with the require-
ments in 401. 5 (3) of the Rule.
(d) The sample is considered to be unacceptable if the sample fails with a clean split along the
weld line which confirms lack of fusion.
2. Heat treatment
In application to 801. 4, Note (2) of Table 2.1.97 and Table 2.1.98 of the Rules, definitions of
the symbols used in temper condition are to comply with the requirements in Table 2.1.19 of the
Guidance.

Table 2.1.19 Definition of the symbols used in temper condition


(1)
Symbols Definition Application(1)
Applies to wrought alloys which are annealed to
O Annealing
obtain the softest temper
Applies to products which are strain-hardened to
H111, H112 and
Work hardened only. achieve the strength desired without additional
H116
thermal treatment
Applies to alloys that are strain-hardened and
whose mechanical properties are stabilized by a
Stabilizing treatment after work
H321 low temperature thermal treatment that results in
hardened(2)
slightly lowered tensile strength and improved
ductility.
Applies to alloys which are not cold worked after
T5 Artificial age hardening only(3) cooling from an elevated temperature shaping
process
Artificial age hardening
Applies to alloys which are not cold worked after
T6 treatment(3) after solution
(4) solution heat-treatment
treatment

Note
(1) Refer to KS D0049(Ferrous products-Heat treatments-Vocabulary) and KS D0004(Temper Designation for
Aluminium and Aluminium Alloys)
(2) Stabilising is the relief of residual internal stresses by heating to a predetermined temperature, usually in
the region of 250ºC, then cooling slowly.
(3) Age hardening is the increasing the hardness of an alloy by a relatively low-temperature heat treatment
that causes precipitation of components or phases of the alloy from the supersaturated solid solution.
(4) Solution treatment is the heating and holding an alloy at a temperature at which one (or more) constituent
enters into solid solution, then cooling the alloy rapidly to prevent the constituent from precipitating

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 21
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 1 Materials Pt 2, Ch 1

3. Corrosion testing
In connection with the 801. 8 (3) of the Rule, corrosion testing methods and acceptance criteria
are to be in accordance with the followings:
(1) Micro-structure test
Micro-structure test is to be in accordance with ASTM B928 or equivalent standards agreed by
the Society.
(2) Corrosion tests
(a) Corrosion tests with respect to exfoliation and intergranular corrosion resistance are to be in
accordance with ASTM G 66 and G 67 or equivalent standards agreed by the Society.
(b) The samples have exhibited no evidence of exfoliation corrosion and a pitting rating of PB
or better when subjected to the test described in ASTM G 66 .
(c) The samples shall also have exhibited resistance to intergranular corrosion at a mass loss no
2
greater than 15 mg/cm , when subjected to the test described in ASTM G 67 .
4. Surface inspection and dimensional tolerance
"Dimension tolerance except those specified in previous (2)" given in requirements of 801. 8 (3) of
the Rules may comply with a recognized national or international standard accepted by the Society.

22 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

CHAPTER 2 WELDING

SECTION 1 General

103. Special weldings


Production weld test for tanks of ships carrying liquefied gases in bulk, and tank circumference
hull construction units.
1. Application
When welding is made for independent tanks of ships carrying liquefied gases in bulk, the pro-
duction weld tests are to be carried out for each position of welding in accordance with the fol-
lowing requirements, in addition to the welding procedure qualification tests specified in Ch 2,
Sec. 4 of the Rules.
(1) For Type A independent tanks, the production weld test is to be carried out on at least one test
sample for every 50 m of welding length of butt joints of principal structural members.
However, consideration may be given for reduction of the number of test sample or omission of
the production weld test by taking into account the past records and the actual state of quality
control system of the manufacturer.
(2) For Type B independent type tanks, the production weld tests are to be carried out on at least
one test sample for every 50 m of welding length of butt joints of principal structural members.
However, the number of test sample may be reduced to one test sample for every 100 m of
welding length by taking into account the past records and the actual state of quality control
system of the manufacturer. In this case, however, at least one or more test specimens are to
be selected for one tank.
(3) For Type C independent type tanks, the production weld tests are to be carried out on at least
one test sample for every 30 m of welding length of butt joints of principal structural members.
However, the number of test sample may be reduced to one test sample for every 50 m of
welding length by taking into account the past records and the actual state of quality control
system of the manufacturer.
Remark : The definitions of type A, B and C independent tank comply with the requirements
in the Pt 7, Ch 5, 402. 4 of the Rules.
2. Test procedure
(1) The production weld tests are to be carried out for every welding length specified in the above
1. for welded joints made under the same welding procedure, position of welding and welding
conditions.
(2) Test samples are, in principle, to be located on the same line as the welded joints of the body
and to be welded at the same time of welding of the body.
3. Kind of test
Kinds of the test are to be as given in Table 2.2.1 of the Guidance.

Table 2.2.1 Kind of Test

Material Kind of Test


9 % Ni steel Tensile test, bend test and impact test
Stainless steel Tensile test and bend test
Aluminium alloys Tensile test and bend test
Steel for low temperature service (excluding 9 % Ni steel) Tensile test, bend test and impact test

4. Test assemblies
The shape and size of test assemblies are to be as shown in Fig 2.2.1 of the Guidance. In cases
of Type A and Type B independent tanks, tensile test may not be required.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 23
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

5. Test specimens
(1) The shape and size of tensile test specimens are to be of the R 2A test specimen specified in
Table 2.2.1 of the Rules.
(2) The shape and size of bend test specimens are to be of the RB 1 or RB 2 test specimens speci-
fied in Table 2.2.2 of the Rules. For test specimens with a thickness exceeding 19 mm, side
bend test specimens are to be substituted for face bend and root bend test specimens.
(3) Impact test specimens are to be the R4 test specimen specified in Table 2.1.3 of the Rules.
In the impact test, one set of test specimens comprising three pieces are to be taken from every
test assembly. The test specimens are to be taken alternately from the position "a" and from a
position among "b" through "e" where the lowest value is recorded in the welding procedure
qualification test, shows in Fig 2.2.7 of the Rules. This means that one set of three test speci-
mens are taken from a test assembly at the position "a", hence other set of three test specimens
are taken in the subsequent test assembly from the position among "b" through "e" where the
lowest value is recorded, and this procedure is repeated. No impact test specimens is required
in cases of stainless steel and aluminium alloy.
6. Tensile test
(1) The tensile strength of 9 % Ni steels is to be 630 Nmm  or more.
(2) The tensile strength of stainless steels, aluminium alloys and steels for low temperature service
(excluding 9 % Ni steels) is to be more than the specified value of the base metal.
7. Bend test
(1) The bend test specimen is to be bent up to an angle of 180 〫 by a test jig with an inner radi-
us of double (three and a third times for aluminium alloys) the thickness of the test specimen.
(2) The results of the bend test are to be as free from cracks exceeding 3 mm in length in any di-
rection on the outer bent surface and from other significant defects.
8. Impact test
The specified values for the impact test are as given in Table 2.2.8 of the Rules.

24 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 3 Welding Works and Inspection

303. Application of welding consumables


Hydrogen cracking test specified in 303. (4) of the Rules is to comply with KS B 0870 or
equivalent.

304. Preparation for Welding


1. Tack welding
(1) The application to 304. 2. (3) of the Rules is to be in accordance with the followings:
(A) The bead length of tack welds is to comply with Table 2.2.2 of the Guidance.

Table 2.2.2 Bead length of tack welds

Steel grade Kinds Required Bead length Remark

Higher strength- low alloy steel Ceq>0.36% ≥ 50 mm


including TMCP
Steel casting Ceq≤0.36% ≥ 30 mm

grade E mild steel ≥ 30 mm

(B) The pitch of tack welds should generally be approximately 400 mm or shorter.

305. Welding sequence and direction of welding


1. "The special approval of the Society" specified in 305. 3 of the Rules means the fillet weld to
satisfy the following.
(1) The welding procedure qualification tests specified in Sec. 4 of the Rules are accepted as
successful.
(2) The welding consumables are to be those for welding with direction of vertical-downward ap-
proved by the Society.
(3) The joints of steels which welding with direction of vertical- downward is restricted, in general,
is to comply with Table 2.2.3-1 of the Guidance.

Table 2.2.3-1 Joints of Steels which Welding with Direction of Vertical Downward is restricted
Grade of steels Welded joints
Rolled steels for hull Joints of any E grade to any E grade(E, EH32 and EH36)
Rolled steels for low Joints of any steels for low temperature service to any steels for low temperature service,
temperature services Joints of any steels for low temperature service to any grade of steels
High Strength Quenched Joints of any high strength quenched and tempered steels to any high strength quenched
and Tempered Steels for and tempered steels,
Welded Structures Joints of any high strength quenched and tempered steels to any grade of steels
Joints of any stainless clad steel plates to any stainless clad steel plates,
Stainless clad steel plates
Joints of any stainless clad steel plates to any grade of steels
Joints of any rolled stainless steels to any rolled stainless steels,
Rolled stainless steels
Joints of any rolled stainless steels to any grade of steels

(4) The zones where welding with direction of vertical- downward is restricted to hull structure, in
general, is to comply with Table 2.2.3-2 of the Guidance.
2. Notwithstanding the provisions of 1 (3) and (4), the other plans presented by shipbuilder or manu-
facturer may be accepted provided that the quality control system of shipbuilder and the importance
of the welds are considered and deemed appropriate by the Society.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 25
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.3 Zones where Welding with Direction of Vertical Downward is restricted
Divisions Locations and members
- The welds of BHD(See Fig 2.2.2, (a) of the Guidance)
- Cross hatching areas of Fig 2.2.2, (c) of the Guidance within connection areas of
Fillet welded joints of primary
solid floor and girder
strength member
- Connection areas of primary strength member and bottom shell, side shell, upper
deck and double bottom tank top
- Boundary line where water, oil and air tightness are required
Areas where water, oil and air
tightness are required - The area whose distance from the end of tight collar plate shall be at least 50 
(See Fig 2.2.2, (d) of the Guidance)
Areas where structural continuity
- The end of heavy bracket (See Fig 2.2.2, (b) of the Guidance)
is required or where high con-
- Longitudinal strength members (See Fig 2.2.2, (e) of the Guidance)
centrated stress is expected
Areas where high concentrated - The lower part of crane post
loads is expected - The lower part of crane pedestal
- The lower part of main engine : Connection areas of main engine girder and follr
- Hatch cover : Connection area of side plate and end plate
- Hatch coaming : Connection areas of main plate and top plate, Connection areas of
main plate main plate
Specified areas - Shaft bed
- Rudder horn : Connection areas of casting steels and normal strength steels
- Rudder : Connection areas of rudder main pieces and rudder stocks, Connection
areas of casting forging steels and normal strength steels
- Bracket toe
(Note)
Harmful defects such as cracks may, if necessary, be inspected by magnetic particle inspection or liquid penetrant in-
spection and, where the condition of the quality is serious, the welding work is to discontinue until measures for im-
portance are planned.

26 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

306. Main welding


1. In application of 306. 2 of the Rules, minimum preheating temperature for welding hull steels at
low temperature is to comply with Table 2.2.4 of the Guidance.

Table 2.2.4 Preheating for Welding Hull Steels at Low Temperature

Standard
Grades Base metal temperature
Minimum preheating temperature
needed preheating
Normal strength steels (A, B, D, E)
(1)
Higher strength steels below 0℃ 20℃ or over
(AH 32, DH 32, EH 32, AH 36, DH 36, EH 36)
Note :
(1) This level of preheat is to be applied unless the approved welding procedure specifies a higher level

2. "The welding inserting a liner of suitable size" in 306. 8 of the Rules complies with the Fig
2.2.3 of the Guidance.

309. Quality of welds


In 309. 3 of the Rules, the application to the non-destructive inspection specified elsewhere is to
comply with Annex 2-7.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 27
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 4 Welding Procedure Qualification Tests(WPQT)

401. General
1. Application
In application to 401. 1 (2) of the Rules, the welding procedure qualification tests on materials for
machinery installations are to be as follows.
(1) Application
(A) The requirements are to apply to the welding procedure qualification tests for boiler, pres-
sure vessels and piping system.
(B) The requirements, other than this requirement, are to be in accordance with Ch 2, Sec 4 of
the Rules,
(2) General requirements of WPQT
(A) The manufacturers are to conduct the welding procedure qualification tests, if they plan to
carry out for the first time the welding word as follows.
(i) Welding work for boiler, Class 1 and Class 2 pressure vessels
(ii) Welding work for principal components of machinery (the principal components specified
in Table 5.2.1 of Pt 5, Ch 2 and Ch 3 of the Rules) and piping system
(iii)Welding work using special materials
(iv)Welding work using special welding process
(B) Where the procedure qualification test is required, the following data and information in
connection with the welding procedure qualification tests are, in general, to be submitted
and reviewed. :
(i) Outline of plant facilities and equipment (outline of plant installations, type and number
of important welding machines, outline of facilities for heat treatment and installations
for test and inspection)
(ii) Qualification and number of welders
(iii) Production records of welded constructions
(iv) Data covering the welding quality control system and working process standards
(v) Welding procedure intended to be tested, and type or name of product to which the
welding procedure is to be applied
(vi) Maximum plate thickness of above product, kind and specification of material
(vii)Draft proposal for welding procedure qualification tests(type of test, sampling procedure
of test specimens and dimensions of test specimens etc, are to be specified)
(3) Welding procedure qualification tests
(A) Where procedure qualification test is required, the test assembly is to be welded in the
same or similar environment and the qualification tests are to be carried out under the
welding conditions given in the welding procedure specifications.
(B) The qualification test is to be carried out in the presence of the Society's surveyor.
(4) Tests for butt and fillet welded joints
(A) Kinds of test and number of specimens taken from test assembles
The kinds of test and number of specimens are to comply with Table 2.2.5 of the
Guidance.
(B) Test assemblies, test specimens and testing procedure
The dimensions and types of test assemblies and test specimens, and testing procedure are
to comply with Pt 2, Ch 2, Sec 4 of the Rules.

404. Butt welded joints


1. Tensile test
(1) In application to 404. 7 (1) (e) of the Rules, "lower toughness grade of steel" means grade D
of Fig 2.2.4, (1) of the Guidance.
(2) In application to 404. 5 (2) of the Rules, "lower strength grade of steel" means grade E of
Fig 2.2.4, (2) of the Guidance.
(3) "Where the consumables are avoidably applied" of 404. 5 (3) of the Rules means as follows.
(a) For the urgency of the corresponding work schedule
(b) For a small quantity of welding consumables with the rare frequency of the survey in fu-
ture

28 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.5 Kinds of Test and Number of Specimens taken from Test Assemblies
(1)(2)
Kinds of test and number of specimens taken from test assembles
Butt welded joints Fillet welded joints
Divisions (5)(6)
Impact test
M acro- Hard- M acro-
Visual radiographic Tensile Bend Visual Fracture
structure ness (4) No. of Position structure
inspection examination test test insp. test
inspection test sets of notch inspection
Boiler and
class 1 1 1 2 4 3 a, b, c
Welding pressure vessel welding welding welding
of boiler 1 2
position position position
and Class 2
1 1 2 4 - -
pressure pressure vessel
vessel
Class 3
The tests may be omitted according to the discretion of the Surveyor.
pressure vessel
The pipes for
1 1 2 4 - -
ordinary piping
Welding
of The pipes used welding welding(3) - - -
(8) for high position position
piping 1 1 2 4 1 a
temperature and
high pressure(7)
Notes :
(1) In a case where special materials are used, special welding procedure is employed or where deemed
necessary by the Society, the other tests or test conditions than those specified in this Section for the
welding procedure qualification may be required
(2) For the welding procedure qualification tests on materials used at high temperature, the Society may re-
quire a creep test or high temperature tensile test.
(3) For those with an outer diameter of 130 mm or above, and with a design working pressure 30 kgfcm 
or above, and further with maximum design temperature over 400℃. However, even for the pipes having
an outer diameter of less than 130 mm, radiographic examination depending on material and working
condition may be required.
(4) Where preparation of the above test specimens is not possible depending on pipe's diameter, test speci-
mens for face bend test and root bend test may be reduced to one set each for those of 19 mm thick-
ness or less, and for side bend test may be reduced to one set for those of over 19 mm.
(5) Position of notch is as shown in Fig 2.2.7 of the Rules.
(6) In a case where preparation of impact test specimens is not possible depending on pipe's dimensions or
in case where welding is made with a base metal having no impact value required, impact test may be
omitted subject to the approval of the Society.
(7) For steam pipes and flanges to be used in the place where the design pressure is not less than 30
kgfcm  and the design temperature exceeds 400℃.
(8) Regardless of the above, as for those of less than 50 mm in outer diameter, test assemblies are to be
prepared by two sets, one for tensile test, the other for macro, micro structure and hardness distribution
examinations to be carried out respectively.

Fig 2.2.4 Butt Welds between Different Steel Grades

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 29
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

2. Non-destructive inspection

In application to 404. 9 of the Rules, the relevant Rules for the acceptance criteria of non-destruc-
tive inspection are to be in accordance with the following. However, if agreed by the Society, im-
perfections detected by visual or non-destructive testing may be assessed in accordance with ISO
5817, class B.
(1) Rolled steels for hull - Annex 2-7
(2) High strength quenched and tempered steels for welded structures - Annex 2-7 or Pt 7, Ch 5
of the Rules
(3) Rolled steels for low temperature service - Pt 7, Ch 5 of the Rules
(4) Materials for machinery installation(boilers, pressure vessel and piping system) - Pt 5, Ch 5 or
Ch 6 of the Rules
3. Hardness test

The hardness test specified in 404. 10 of the Rules is to be as follows.


(1) Hardness distribution at positions shown in Fig 2.2.5 of the Guidance is to be measured.

Fig 2.2.5 Hardness Test (Units : mm)

(2) Hardness test is required for steel for low temperature service(Ni steels).
(3) Measuring load is to be 10 kg vickers and measuring intervals are to be 1 mm.

405. Test for fillet welded joints


1. Hardness test
In application to 405. 7 of the Rules, hardness test, if required, is to comply with the following
requirements :
(1) Hardness test is to be carried out in accordance with Fig 2.2.6 of the Guidance.
(2) Hardness test is required for steel for low temperature service(Ni steels).
(3) Measuring load is to be 10 kg vickers and measuring intervals are to be 1 mm.

30 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.6 Hardness test for fillet welded joint (unit : mm)

407. Validity of qualified welding procedure specification

1. Validity of qualified welding procedure specification for aluminium alloy


In application to 407. 1 (4) of the Rules, the validity of qualified welding procedure specification
for aluminium alloy is to comply with the followings:
(1) General
(a) The approval of the WPS obtained by a shipyard or a manufacturer is valid for welding in
all its workshops under the same technical and quality control.
(b) All the conditions of validity stated below should be met independently of each other.
Changes outside of the ranges specified may require a new welding procedure test.
(2) Base metal
(a) The aluminium alloys are grouped into three groups:
(i) Group A: aluminium-magnesium alloys with Mg content = 3.5 % (alloy 5754)
(ii) Group B: aluminium-magnesium alloys with 4% = Mg = 5.6 % (alloys 5059, 5083,
5086, 5383 and 5456)
(iii) Group C: aluminium-magnesium-silicon alloys (alloys 6005A, 6061 and 6082)
(b) For each Group, the qualification made on one alloy qualifies the procedure also for the
other alloys of the same Group with equal or lower specified tensile strength after welding.
(c) The qualification made on Group B alloy qualifies the procedure also for Group A alloys.
(3) Thickness
(a) The qualification of a WPS carried out on a test assembly of thickness t is valid for the
thickness range given in Table 2.2.6.

Table 2.2.6. Range of qualification for parent material thickness


Thickness of the test piece t (mm) Range of approval

t ≤ 3 0.5t ~ 2t

3 < t ≤ 20 3 ~ 2t

t > 20 ≥ 0.8t

(b) In case of butt-joints between dissimilar thickness, t is the thickness of the thinner material.
In case of fillet joints between dissimilar thickness, t is the thickness of the thicker
material.
(c) In addition to the requirements of Table 2.2.6, the range of qualification of the throat
thickness a is given in Table 2.2.7.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 31
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Table 2.2.7. Range of qualifications for the throat thickness of fillet welds
Throat thickness of the test piece, a(mm) Range of qualifications

a < 10 0.75a ~ 1.5a

a ≥ 10 ≥ 7.5

(d) Where a fillet weld is qualified by means of a butt weld test, the throat thickness range
qualified should be based on the thickness of the deposited weld metal.
(e) Where the majority of production work is fillet welding, an additional fillet weld test may
be required.
(4) Welding position
Provided that comparable welding parameters are used for the included welding positions a test
in any one position qualifies for welding in all positions except for vertical downwards (PG)
position where in any case separate welding procedure test is required.
(5) Type of joint
The range of approval for the types of joint in relation to the type of joint used in the proce-
dure qualification test is as follows:
(a) butt-joint welded from one side with backing qualifies also for welding from both sides with
gouging;
(b) butt-joint welded from one side without backing qualifies also for welding from one side
with backing, from both sides with gouging and from both sides without gouging;
(c) butt-joint welded from both sides with gouging only qualifies that condition,
(d) butt-joint welded from both sides without gouging qualifies also for welding from both sides
with gouging and from one side with backing.
(6) Welding process
(a) The approval is valid only for the welding process used in the welding procedure test.
(b) It is not permitted to change a multi run deposit into a single run (or single run on each
side) or vice versa for a given process.
(c) In the case of a multi-process procedure, the approval is only valid for applying the proc-
esses in the order used during the procedure qualification tests.
(d) For multi-process procedures each welding process may be approved separately or in combi-
nation with other processes.
(7) Welding consumables
The welding consumable used in the qualification tests qualifies:
(a) Approved welding consumables of the same strength as the consumable used in the proce-
dure qualification tests.
(b) Approved welding consumables of higher strength than the consumable used in the proce-
dure qualification tests.
(c) The qualification given to shielding gas and backing gas is restricted to the gas/gas mixture
used in the welding procedure test, see ISO 14175 or other recognised standards for gas
designations.
(8) Type of current
Changes in the type of current (AC , D C , pulsed) and polarity require a new welding procedure
qualification.
(9) Preheat and interpass temperature
The lower limit of approval is the preheat temperature applied at the start of the welding proce-
dure test. The upper limit of approval is the interpass temperature reached in the welding proce-
dure test.
(10) Post-weld heat treatment or ageing
Addition or deletion of post weld heat treatment or ageing is not permitted except that artificial
ageing for 6000 series alloys gives approval for prolonged natural ageing.

32 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 5 Welders and Welder Performance Qualification Tests

501. General
1. Qualification of tack welder
Qualification tests for tack welder, specified in 501. 2 of the Rules, are to be carried out in ac-
cordance with the followings:
(1) Test assembly is to comply with Fig 2.2.7 of the Guidance. The leg length of tack welds will
not be more than 6 mm. The bead length of tack welds may be of about 50 mm

Fig 2.2.7 Type and dimension of test assembly for qualification of tack welder

(2) Visual inspection is to comply with Pt 2, Ch 2, 503. 3 (2) of the Rules and fracture test is to
comply with Pt 2, Ch 2, 503. 3 (5) of the Rules.
(3) The qualified thickness range is more than 3 mm.
(4) The positions for qualification test and positions qualified for actual welding work are to com-
ply with the requirements for the fillet joint of plates in Pt 2, Ch 2, 502. 6, Table 2.2.14 of
the Rules.
2. Qualification of welding operator
Qualification of welding operator specified in 501. 3 of the Rules are to be carried out as follows:
(1) Test assembly is to comply with Pt 2, Ch 2, 404. 3 of the Rules. The width of test assembly
is not to be less than 300 mm and the length not to be less than 400 mm.
(2) Tests and inspections are to comply with Pt 2, Ch 2, 503. 3 of the Rules.
3. Qualification of Gas welders
In application to 501. 4 of the Rules, the Qualification of gas welder is to comply with the fol-
lowings:
(1) Gas welders are to have the qualification in Table 2.2.12, 2.2.13 and 2.2.14 of the Rules ac-
cording to the kind of welding material, plate thickness and welding position.
(2) Test assemblies used in the qualification test are to be of without backing, and gas welding
rods are to be those for mild steel complying with a KS D 7005 (Gas welding rods for mild
steel) or those considered appropriate by the Society.
(3) To the kind and procedure of the qualification tests, the requirements specified in Sec 5 of the
Rules are to be applied. For roller bend test, the radii of the plunger of the jig and support
roller are to be 10 mm, and the roller spans to be 53 mm.
(4) The qualifications for gas welders is to represent "symbol G ".
4. qualification test for 9 % Ni steel
In application to 501. 4 of the Rules, the Qualification test for 9 % Ni steel is to comply with the
followings:
(1) Qualification
(a) Welders are to have the qualification given in Table 2.2.12, 2.2.13 and 2.2.14 of the

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 33
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Rules according to the actual welding procedure, and the thickness of welding materials and
welding position. However, the requirements equivalent to mild steel apply to welder having
the qualification for all positions.
(b) Any applications who intends to be qualified for each Grade and each Kind of 9 % Ni steel
are to have performance qualification of the corresponding Kind and Grade of mild steel.
(c) The kinds of welding procedure are shield metal arc welding (hereinafter referred to
"SMAW") and semi-automatic welding. The welders are to be pass the performance qual-
ification test required according to the each applicable procedure.
(d) Notwithstanding the requirements given in (c), welder having the qualification for SMAW
who intended to be qualified for semi-automatic welding may make the performance qual-
ification test for semi-automatic welding of the corresponding and lower qualification with
the his SMAW qualification by the Society's approval.
(2) Kinds and procedures
The welding procedure, welding position and test procedure for welders are to be in accordance
with Table 2.2.12 and Table 2.2.13 of the Rules, respectively. In the test procedure for plates,
longitudinal face bend test may be substituted for face bend test and root bend test, and longi-
tudinal face bend test for side bend test. In the test procedure for pipes, radiographic inspection
may be substituted for bend test.
(3) Test assemblies and welding consumables
(a) The test assemblies for plates are to be of RL 9N53 or RL 9N60 specified in Ch 1 of the
Rules or those considered equivalent by the society.
(b) The test assemblies for pipes are to be of RLP 9 specified in Ch 1 of the Rules or those
considered equivalent by the Society.
(c) Welding consumables used in the test are to be those for 9 % Ni steel recognized by the
Society.
(4) Test assemblies for plates
The shape and size of the test assemblies of plates are to be in accordance with Fig 2.2.8-1
of the Guidance.

Fig 2.2.8-1 Dimensions and Types of Plate Test Assembly of the Qualification Test for 9% Ni Steel
(Units : mm)

34 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(5) Test assemblies for pipes


The shape and size of the test assemblies for pipe welding are to comply with Fig 2.2.8-2 of
the Guidance.

Fig 2.2.8-2 Dimensions and Types of Pipe Test Assembly of the Qualification Test for 9% Ni Steel
(Units : mm)

(6) Longitudinal bend test


The shape and size of the longitudinal bend test specimen are to be of RB 1 in Table 2.2.2 of
the Rules. The test specimen is to be face bent jig shown in Fig 2.2.1 or 2.2.2 of the Rules,
and no cracks of 3 mm or more in length in any direction or no remarkable defect are to exist
on the bent outer surface.
(7) Radiographic test
Radiographic test is to be carried out on all welding lines of the pipe test assemblies where no
significant defects are to exist.
5. Application of equivalent standards
In application to 501. 5 of the Rules, it may be considered as equivalent for that the requirements
of the standard internationally recognized(AWS, ASME etc) or considered as equivalent for those by
the Society instead of the requirements for welder performance qualification of this section are
applied.

503. Testing procedure


1. Test assembly
In application to 503. 2 (3) of the Rules, the test position, dimensions of test assembly and edge
preparation for welding in 2G position are to comply with Fig 2.2.9 of the Guidance.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 35
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

Fig 2.2.9 Dimensions of test assembly and edge preparation in 2G position

2. Radiographic testing
In application to 503. 3 (4) of the Rules, the radiographic testing procedures and acceptance criteria
are to be in accordance with the followings :
(1) Where deemed the excess of the amount of heat input by visual inspection after welding, bend
tests other than radiographic testing may be required additionally.
(2) The acceptance criteria for radiographic examination is to comply with the requirements speci-
fied in 3 (3) of Annex 2-7.
3. General requirements for qualification validity
(1) In application to 503. 6 (3) of the Rules, the suspension of welder qualification is to be in ac-
cordance with the followings.
(A) When welder quits his job from the company where he had employed and certified.
(B) Where there is some specific reason to question a qualified welder's ability.
(2) The effectiveness of qualification of welder who has switched his job may be considered as re-
maining, provided that the followings are satisfied
(A) It is to be proved that the welders have kept performance qualification at previous company.
(B) It is to be proved that welding condition is similar to those of previous company, and the
welders carried out qualified work with acceptance welding performance.
(C) When welders have not used a particular process and equipment for a period excessing six
months.

36 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

SECTION 6 Welding Consumables

602. Electrodes for manual arc welding for normal strength steels, higher strength
steels and steels for low temperature service. General provision for tests
1. General provisions for tests
Hot cracking test specified in 602. 3 (1) of the Rules is to be done as follows :
(1) Test assemblies are to be T-joint shape as shown in Fig 2.2.9 of the Guidance. The bottom of
the vertical plate is to grind straight, and adhere closely on the surface of horizontal plate. All
surface rough( ) on the plate is to be removed before welding. The tack welds in prepara-
tion for the fillet welds is to make at the both ends of the plate. Three transverse stiffeners are
to reinforce the horizontal plate to prevent welding deformation.

Fig 2.2.9 Hot Cracking Test Assemblies (Units : mm)

(2) The number of test assembly is to be prepared for every each diameter (4 mm, 5 mm or 6 mm)
of electrodes.
(3) The fillet welding is to be carried out in the downhand position in one pass on each side and
the welding current used is to be the maximum of the range recommended by the manufacturer
for the size of electrode used.
(4) The second fillet weld is to be started immediately after the completion of the first fillet weld
from the end of the test specimen at which the first fillet weld was finished. Both fillet welds
are to be executed at a constant speed and without weaving.
(5) Length of fused electrode in hot cracking test are to be as shown Table 2.2.9 of the Guidance
according to the diameter of electrodes.
(6) After welding, the slag is to be removed from the fillet welds and after complete cooling, they
are to be examined for cracks by a magnifying glass or by using penetrant fluids.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 37
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Ch 2 Welding Pt 2, Ch 2

(7) The first fillet weld is then to be removed by machining or gouging and the second weld bro-
ken by closing the two plates together, subjecting the root of the weld to tension (See Fig
2.2.10 of the Guidance). The weld is then to be examined for evidence of hot cracking.

Table 2.2.9 Length of Fused Electrode in Hot


Cracking Test (Units : mm)

Length of fused electrode


Diameter of electrode
1st fillet 2nd fillet
4 Approx. 200 Approx. 150
5 Approx. 150 Approx. 100
6 Approx. 100 Approx. 75 Fig 2.2.10 Hot Cracking Test

(8) There is to be no cracking in the fillet welds either superficial or internal except crater crack.

38 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-1 Guidance for Seamless Forged Steel Drums Pt 2, Annex 2-1

Annex 2-1 Guidance for seamless forged steel drums

1. Seamless forged steel drums


1.1 Application
(1) This requirements apply to seamless forged steel drums intended for boiler construction
(hereinafter referred to as “forged drums”).
(2) Items differing from those specified in this Guidance are to comply with the requirements in Pt
2, Ch 1, Sec. 1 and 2 of the Rules.
1.2 Kind
The forged drums are classified into grades as given in Table 1.

Table 1 Kind

Grades
RSFB 410
RSFB 520

1.3 Mechanical properties


The forged drums are to comply with the following requirements.
(1) Tensile test
The forged drums are to conform to the requirements given by Table 2 in the tensile test.

Table 2 Tensile Test

Yield strength Tensile strength Elongation (%) Reduction of area


Grade
(Nmm  〕 (Nmm  〕 (L = 5D) (%)

RSFB 410 205 min. 410 min. 24 min. 38 min.


RSFB 520 255 min. 520 min. 22 min. 40 min.

(2) Bend test


The test specimen is to stand being bent cold through l80 degrees without cracking outside to
the inside radius given in Table 3.

Table 3 Bend Inside Radius

Grades RSFB 410 RSFB 520


 
Bend Tensile strength not more than 490 Nmm : Tensile strength not more than 560 Nmm
inside 6 mm : 9.5 mm
radius Tensile strength over 490 Nmm  : 9.5 mm Tensile strength over 560Nmm  : 16 mm

1.4 Selection of test specimens


(1) One set specimens each for tensile test and bend test are to be taken from each end of the
forged drum, perpendicular to the centreline of the forged drum as well as opposite side each
other with the centreline.
(2) Only in the case where ends of the forged drums are closed by reforging after machining, the
test coupon may be cut from the forged drum before the reforging and heat treated simulta-
neously with the forged drum. In such a case, the forged drum is to be heat treated again after
reforging. The latter heat treatment is to be annealing at a temperature above the critical tem-
perature but not above the temperature of the first annealing when the former heat treatment is
annealing, and to be same treatment as the former when the former heat treatment is normaliz-
ing and tempering.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 39
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

Annex 2-2 Guidance for non-destructive examination of marine steel


castings

1. Application
(1) The requirements in this Guidance is intended to give general guidance on the extent, methods
and recommended quality levels applicable to the non-destructive examinations (NDE), of marine
steel castings(hereinafter referred to as "castings") specified in Pt 2, Ch 1, 501. 8 and 10 of
the Rules, except in those cases where alternative criteria have been otherwise approved or
specified.
(2) Although no detailed Guidance are given for machinery components, the requirements in this
Guidance may apply correspondingly considering their materials, kinds, shapes and stress con-
ditions being subjected.
2. Personnel Requirements
(1) Personnel carrying out NDE are generally to be qualified and certified to Level II of a recog-
nised certification scheme such as KS B ISO 9712, SNT-TC-1A , EN 473, ASNT Central
Certification Program (ACCP ) or equivalent.
(2) Personnel responsible for the NDE activity including approval of procedures should be qualified
and certified to Level III.
(3) Personnel qualifications are to be verified by certification.
3. Casting Condition
(1) Non-destructive examinations applied for acceptance purposes should be made after the final heat
treatment of the casting. Where intermediate inspections have been performed the manufacturer
shall furnish the documentation of the results upon request of the Surveyor.
(2) Castings are to be examined in the final delivery condition free from any material such as
scale, dirt, grease or paint that might affect the efficacy of the inspection. A thin coating of
contrast paint is permissible when using magnetic particle techniques.
(3) Unless otherwise specified in the order, magnetic particle test shall be carried out within 0.3 mm
of the final machined surface condition for AC techniques or within 0.8 mm for D C techniques.
(4) Ultrasonic testing is to be carried out after the castings have been ground, machined or shot
blasted to a suitable condition. The surfaces of castings to be examined should be such that ad-
equate coupling can be established between the probe and the casting and that excessive wear
of the probe is avoided.
4. Extent of Examinations
(1) Castings to be examined
Castings to be examined by NDE methods are identified in Fig 1 to Fig 3 of this Guidance.
Criteria for the examination of other castings not identified in Fig 1 to Fig 3 of this Guidance
will be subject to agreement.
(2) Zones to be examined
(A) Zones to be examined in nominated castings are identified in Fig 1 to Fig 3 of this
Guidance. Examinations are to be made in accordance with an inspection plan approved by
the Society. The plan should specify the extent of the examination, the examination proce-
dure, the quality level or, if necessary, level for different locations of the castings.
(B) In addition to the areas identified in Fig 1 and Fig 2 of this Guidance, surface inspections
shall be carried out in the following locations:
(a) at all accessible fillets and changes of section,
(b) in way of fabrication weld preparation, for a band width of 30mm,
(c) in way of chaplets,
(d) in way of weld repairs,
(e) at positions where surplus metal has been removed by flame cutting, scarifying or
arc-air gouging.
(C) Ultrasonic testing shall be carried out in the zones indicated in Fig 1 and Fig 3 of this
Guidance and also at the following locations:
(a) in way of all accessible fillets and at pronounced changes of section,
(b) in way of fabrication weld preparations for a distance of 50 mm from the edge,
(c) in way of weld repairs where the original defect was detected by ultrasonic testing.
(d) in way of riser positions,

40 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

(e) in way of machined areas particularly those subject to further machining such as bolt
hole positions.

Fig 1 Detection Area for Non-destructive Test

Fig 2 Example of Application of Magnetic Particle Tests

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 41
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

Fig 3 Examples of Application of Ultrasonic Tests

5. Examination Procedures
(1) Visual Inspection
Steel castings nominated for NDE shall be subjected to a 100% visual examination of all acces-
sible surfaces by the Surveyor. Lighting conditions at the inspected surfaces shall be in accord-
ance with a nationally or internationally recognised standard. Unless otherwise agreed, the visual
and surface crack detection inspections are to be carried out in the presence of the Surveyor.
(2) Surface Crack Detection
(a) Magnetic particle inspection will be carried out in preference to liquid penetrant testing ex-
cept in the following cases;
(i) austenitic stainless steels,
(ii) interpretation of open visual or magnetic particle indications,
(iii) at the instruction of the Surveyor.
(b) The testing procedures, apparatus and conditions of magnetic particle testing and liquid pene-
trant testing other than those specified in this Guidance are to comply with recognised na-
tional or international standards.
(c) Magnetic particle testing is to be carried out along two directions so that magnetic field can
be directed at an right angle each other by means of the wet prod methods or the yoke
method. In making magnetization by the prod method, the distance between prods is to be
200∼300 mm. The magnetizing current is to be D C 800∼1200 A for the prod method. For
the yoke method, lifting power is to be 4.5 kg for AC , 18 kg over for D C .
(d) For magnetic particle testing attention is to be paid to the contact between the casting and
the clamping devices of stationary magnetisation benches in order to avoid local overheating
or burning damage in its surface. Prods shall not be permitted on finished machined items.
Note that the use of solid copper at the prod tips must be avoided due to the risk of cop-
per penetration.

42 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

(e) When indications have been detected as a result of the surface inspection, acceptance or re-
jection is to be decided in accordance with Art 6.
(3) Ultrasonic testing
(a) Volumetric inspection in accordance with these guidance is to be carried out by ultrasonic
testing using the contact method with straight beam and/or angle beam technique. The test-
ing procedures, apparatus and conditions of ultrasonic testing are to comply with the recog-
nised national or international standards. Radiographic testing may be carried out on the ba-
sis of prior agreement with the Society.
(b) Only those areas shown in the agreed inspection plan need to be tested. The plan should
include those locations nominated in 4. (2), (c) together with the scanning zones identified
for the relevant casting in Fig 1 to Fig 3.
(c) Ultrasonic scans are to be made using a normal probe of 1~4 MHz (usually 2 MHz)
frequency. Whenever possible scanning is to be performed from both surfaces of the casting
and from surfaces perpendicular to each other.
(d) The back-wall echo obtained on parallel sections should be used to monitor variations in
probe coupling and material attenuation. Any reduction in the amplitude of the back-wall
echo without evidence of intervening defects should be corrected. Attenuation in excess of
30dB could be indicative of an unsatisfactory annealing heat treatment.
(e) Machined surfaces, especially those in the vicinity of riser locations and in the bores of
stern boss castings, should also be subject to a near surface (25 mm) scan using a twin
crystal 0o probe. Additional scans on machined surfaces are of particular importance in cas-
es where bolt holes are to be drilled or where surplus material such as 'padding' has been
removed by machining thus moving the scanning surface closer to possible areas of
shrinkage. Also, it is advisable to examine the machined bores of castings using circum-
ferential scans with 70° probes in order that axial radial planar flaws such as hot tears can
be detected. Fillet radii should be examined using 45°, 60°, or 70° probes scanning from
the surfaces/direction likely to give the best reflection.
(f) In the examinations of those zones nominated for ultrasonic examination the reference sensi-
tivity is to be established against a 6mm diameter disk reflector. Sensitivity can be cali-
brated either against 6mm diameter flat bottomed hole(s) in a reference block (or series of
blocks) corresponding to the thickness of the casting provided that a transfer correction is
made, or, as a preferred alternative, by using the D G S (distance-gain-size) method. The DGS
diagrams issued by a probe manufacturer identify the difference in dB between the ampli-
tude of a back wall echo and that expected from a 6mm diameter disk reflector. By adding
this difference to the sensitivity level initially set by adjusting a back wall echo to a refer-
ence height eg 80 %, the amended reference level will be representative of a 6mm diameter
disk reflector. Similar calculations can be used for evaluation purposes to establish the dif-
ference in dB between a back wall reflector and disk reflectors of other diameters such as
12 or 15 mm.
(g) Having made any necessary corrections for differences in attenuation or surface condition be-
tween the reference block and the casting any indications received from the nominated zones
in the casting that exceed the 6mm reference level should be marked for evaluation against
the criteria given in 6. (3) below. Evaluation should include additional scans with angle
probes in order that the full extent of the discontinuity can be plotted.
6. Acceptance Criteria
(1) Visual Testing
(a) All castings shall be free of cracks, crack-like indications, hot tears, cold shuts or other in-
jurious indications. Thickness of the remains of sprues or risers is to be within the casting
dimensional tolerance.
(b) Additional magnetic particle, dye penetrant or ultrasonic testing may be required for a more
detailed evaluation of surface irregularities at the request of the Surveyor.
(2) Surface Crack Detection
(A) The following definitions relevant to indications apply:
(a) Linear indication : an indication in which the length is at least three times the width.
(b) Non-linear indication : an indication of circular or elliptical shape with a length less
than three times the width.
(c) Aligned indication : three or more indications in a line, separated by 2 mm or less
edge-to-edge.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 43
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

(d) Open indication : an indication visible after removal of the magnetic particles or that
can be detected by the use of contrast dye penetrant.
(e) Non-open indication : an indication that is not visually detectable after removal of the
magnetic particles or that cannot be detected by the use of contrast dye penetrant.
(f) Relevant indication : an indication that is caused by a condition or type of discontinuity
that requires evaluation. Only the indications which have any dimension greater than 1.5
mm shall be considered relevant.
(B) For the purpose of evaluating indications, the surface is to be divided into reference band
length of 150 mm for level MT1/PT1 and into reference areas of 225 cm2 for level
MT2/PT2. The band length and/or area shall be taken in the most unfavourable location rel-
ative to the indications being evaluated.
(C) The following quality levels recommended for magnetic particle testing (MT) and/or liquid
penetrant testing (PT) are;

Level MT1/PT1 - fabrication weld preparation and weld repairs.


Level MT2/PT2 - other locations nominated for surface crack detection in Fig 1 and Fig 2

The allowable numbers and sizes of indications in the reference band length and/or area are
given in Table 1. The required quality level should be shown on the manufacturer's in-
spection plan. Cracks and hot tears are not acceptable.

Table 1 Allowable number and size of indications in a reference band length/area

Max. number of Max. number for Max. dimension of


Quality Level Type of indication
indications each type single indication, (mm)(2)
Non-linear 4(1) 5
4 in 150 mm
MT1/PT1 Linear 4(1) 3
length
Aligned 4(1) 3
Non-linear 10 7
20 in 22500 ㎟
MT2/PT2 Linear 6 5
area
Aligned 8 5
Notes:
(1) 30 mm min. between relevant indications.
(2) In weld repairs, the maximum dimension is 2 mm.

(3) Ultrasonic testing


(A) Acceptance criteria for ultrasonic testing are identified in Table 2 as UT1 and UT2. As
stated in 4 (2), (a), the quality levels applicable to the zones to be examined are to be
identified on an inspection plan. The following quality levels are nominated for the castings
identified in Fig 1 and Fig 3.
(B) Level UT1 is applicable to:
(a) fabrication weld preparations for a distance of 50 mm,
(b) 50 mm depth from the final machined surface including bolt holes and fillet radii to a
depth of 50 mm and within distance of 50 mm from the radius end,
(c) castings subject to cyclic bending stresses e.g. rudder horn, rudder castings and rudder
stocks - the outer one third of thickness in the zones nominated for volumetric exami-
nation by Fig 1 and Fig 3.
(d) discontinuities within the examined zones interpreted to be cracks or hot tears.
(C) Level UT2 is applicable to:
(a) other locations nominated for ultrasonic testing in Fig 1 and Fig 3 or on the inspection
plan.
(b) positions outside locations nominated for level UT1 examination where feeders and gates
have been removed
(c) castings subject to cyclic bending stresses - at the central one third of thickness in the
zones of nominated for volumetric inspection by Fig 1 and Fig 3.

44 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

(D) Ultrasonic acceptance criteria for other casting areas not nominated in Fig 1 and Fig 3 will
be subject to special consideration based on the anticipated stress levels and the type, size
and position of the discontinuity.

Table 2 Ultrasonic Acceptance Criteria for steel castings

Allowable disc shape Max. number of indications Allowable length of


Quality Level
according to DGS (1) (mm) to be registered(2) linear indications (mm)(3)
UT1 >6 0 0

12-15 5 50
UT2
>15 0 0
Notes:
(1) DGS: distance-gain size.
(2) grouped in an area measuring 300 x 300 mm
(3) measured on the scanning surface

7. Reporting
(1) All reports of non-destructive examinations should include the following items;
(a) Date of testing.
(b) Names and qualification level of inspection personnel.
(c) Type of casting.
(d) Product number for identification.
(e) Grade of steel.
(f) Heat treatment.
(g) Stage of testing.
(h) Locations for testing.
(i) Surface condition.
(j) Test standards used.
(k) Results.
(l) Statement of acceptance / non-acceptance.
(m) Locations of reportable indications.
(n) Details of weld repairs including sketches.
(2) In addition to the items listed in 7 (1), reports of surface crack detection inspections are to in-
clude at least the following items:
(a) for liquid penetrant testing; the consumables used,
(b) for magnetic particle testing: method of magnetising, test media and magnetic field strength.
(3) In addition to the items listed in 7 (1), reports of ultrasonic inspection should include at least
the following items:
(a) flaw detector, probes, calibration blocks and couplant used.
8. Rectification of Defects
(1) General
(a) Defects and unacceptable indications must be repaired as indicated below.
(b) In either case where, after removing defects, the steel castings are used as they are or re-
pair welding are carried out approval of the surveyor is to be obtained. In case where the
depth of the recess after removing the defects is not larger than 15 mm (or 10 % of the
thickness of the steel castings, whichever is smaller) and the length is not more than 100
mm, the steel castings may be used without repair welding.
(2) Rectification of Defects
Defective parts of material are to be completely removed either by grinding, or by chipping and
grinding, or by arc air-gouging and grinding and to be repaired by either of the following
methods. Thermal methods of metal removal should only be allowed before the final heat
treatment.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 45
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

(A) In case of no repair welding being carried out


The portions required no repair welding after removing defects, are to be finished with a
grinder etc. in accordance with the following:
(a) All grooves shall have a bottom radius of approximately three times the groove depth.
(b) Grooves and their vicinity are to be finished smoothly avoiding abrupt changes in
configuration.
(c) The portions where defects have been removed are to be verified that they are free
from harmful defects by liquid penetrant test or magnetic particle test after finishing of
the surface configuration.
(B) The portions required repair welding are to be suitably shaped and verified that they are
free from harmful defects by nondestructive tests specified in (2) (A) (c) above and also re-
paired in accordance with the requirements in 3. of this Appendix. Weld repairs should be
suitably classified as follows.;
(a) Major repairs
(i) where the depth is greater than 25 % of the wall thickness or 25 mm whichever is
less,
(ii) where the total weld area on a casting exceeds 2 % of the casting surface noting
that where a distance between two welds is less than their average width, they are
to be considered as one weld.
(iii)Major repairs require the approval of the Society before the repair is carried out.
The repair should be carried out before final furnace heat treatment.
(b) Minor repairs
(i) where the total weld area (length x width) exceeds 500 mm 
(ii) Minor repairs do not usually require the approval of the Society but should be re-
corded on a weld repair sketch as a part of the manufacturing procedure documents.
These repairs should be carried out before final furnace heat treatment.
(c) Cosmetic repairs
(i) all other welds.
(ii) Cosmetic repairs do not require the approval of the Society but should be recorded
on a weld repair sketch. These repairs may be carried out after final furnace heat
treatment but are subject to a local stress relief heat treatment.
(3) Procedure of repair welding
The procedure of repair welding is to be as follows.
(A) Welders
Welders intended to engage in repair work by welding are to pass the qualification tests of
the Society.
(B) Welding consumables
The welding consumables are to be either low hydrogen type approved by the Society or
those deemed equivalent.
(C) Preheating
(a) In cases where the carbon equivalent of the steel castings exceeds 0.44 %, the portions
of repair welding and their vicinity are to be preheated to a temperature higher than
200°C. In this case, the carbon equivalent is to be calculated by the following formula.

      
               
     

(b) Even in case where carbon equivalent is 0.44 % or less, preheating may be required
taking into account the shape and size of the steel castings.
(D) Position of welding
The positions of welding are to be as given in the following Table 3 in general.

46 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-2 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Marine Steel Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-2

Table 3 Position of Welding

Position
welding Flat Vertical Horizontal Overhead
Kind

Manual welding ○ ○ ○ ○

Semi-automatic welding ○ ─ ○ ─

(E) Post weld heat treatment


(a) Post weld heat treatment may be exempted in the following cases, provided that the
carbon equivalent does not exceed 0.44 %.
(i) In case where the depth of chipping after the removal of defects is not more than
25 mm (or 20 % of the thickness, whichever is smaller) and the length is not more
than 200 mm.
(ii) In cases where the depth of chipping after the removal of defects is not more than
15 mm and also the area is not more than 250,000 mm 
(b) Post weld heat treatment is to be carried out in furnaces. The holding temperature is to
be 550℃∼650℃ and the period is to be not less than one hour per every 25 mm of
welding depth. In case where annealing in furnace is impossible depending on the final
condition of the steel castings to be finished, etc. or where the welding depth is not
more than 50 mm as well as the length is not more than 300 mm, partial post weld
heat treatment may be accepted as an alternative. By the partial post weld heat treat-
ment, the welded portions and their vicinity within 100 mm therefrom are to be heated
to a temperature not lower than 600℃ and kept at the temperature in a period not less
than 10 minutes per every 25 mm of the welding depth, and then to be cooled
gradually.
(F) Finishing after repair welding
The portions repaired by welding are to be finished by grinding, etc. so that inspection can
be available.
(G) Inspection after repair welding
Parts which are repaired should be examined by the same method as at initial inspection as
well as by additional methods as required by the Surveyor.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 47
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-3 Guidance for Surface Inspection of Cast Steel Crankshafts Pt 2, Annex 2-3

Annex 2-3 Guidance for surface inspection of cast steel crankshafts

1. Application
(1) This Guidance provides for the surface inspection of the cast steel crankshaft to be carried out
on completion of machining (for shrunk parts, before shrinkage).
(2) The surface inspection is to be carried out by the methods specified in 3. Where defects were
found as a result of the inspection, the Surveyor is to decide pass or rejection of the crankshaft
by the standards for allowable limit of defects prescribed in 6.
(3) The inspection during the intermediate stage under construction is to be carried out actively by
the manufacturer. The inspection methods are prescribed in 4.
(4) NDE personnel requirements and inspection plans are to comply with the requirements specified
in Annex 2-2, 2 and 4 (2) (a) of this Guidance.
2. Divisions for inspection surface
The inspected surface of the crankshaft is divided into the following I to IV zones as shown in
Fig 1. The inspection methods and standards are specified depending on the zones respectively.

Fig 1 Divisions for Inspection Surface

48 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-3 Guidance for Surface Inspection of Cast Steel Crankshafts Pt 2, Annex 2-3

3. Methods of inspection
(1) The surface is to be inspected as under in accordance with Divisions for inspection surface
prescribed in 2. But where CC defects (refer to Table 1) have been detected as a result of the
inspection, the Surveyor may demand ultrasonic inspection additionally.

Kinds Inspections

Zone I and II Magnetic particle inspection or dye penetrant inspection

Zone III and IV Visual inspection

(Notes)
1. Regarding the parts used as forged or cast condition, it is to be subjected to magnetic
particle inspection notwithstanding the above requirement.
2. Regarding the Zone III of the crankshaft to which quenching and tempering heat treat-
ments are applied, or the same zone of the crankshaft to which surface hardening treat-
ment is applied, it is to be subjected to either magnetic particle inspection or dye pene-
trant inspection notwithstanding the above requirement.

(2) The methods of magnetic particle inspection, dye penetrant inspection and visual inspection are
to be as deemed appropriate by the Society.
4. Inspection during intermediate stage
(1) The manufacturer is recommended to carry out actively ultrasonic inspection for the crankshaft
at the appropriate stage during the manufacturing process and prove that the crankshaft has no
harmful defects internally.
(2) The manufacturer should carry out actively the surface inspection at each stage under
production. As the results when harmful defects of the material were found, the manufacturer is
to inform the Surveyor of the facts and obey his instruction. Regarding cast steel crankshafts,
when accepted by the Surveyor, defects can be remedied by welding according to the Annex
2-4.
(3) Regarding the crankshaft which surface hardening treatment is taken, the manufacturer is actively
to inspect the surface. The records of surface inspection are to be submitted to the Surveyor
when he requires.
5. Standards for surface inspection
(1) When defects have been detected as a result of the surface inspection prescribed in 3, pass or
rejection is to be decided by the following 6, considering the results of the inspection of 4.
But even those which have failed to comply with these limits may be taken as passed, if in
consideration with the position, size, direction and nature of the defects as well as the shape
and dimension of such crankshafts, and the Surveyor accepted justifiable. Conversely, even those
which have complied with these limits would be disqualified if they should contain such numer-
ous defects as to make them unsuitable as crankshaft from the nature, distribution and direction
of the defects.
(2) The treatment of defects for surface inspection is to be as the followings:
(A) The lengths of the defects in the Standards are the actual lengths appeared by visual
inspection.
(B) The defects can be removed after acceptance of the Surveyor.
(C) Removal of defects is to be carried out by grinding.
(D) Where two defects spaced less than 5 mm apart, these are to be removed regarding as one
defect.
(E) The grooves caused by removing are to be smoothly rounded off by as large radius as pos-
sible toward the shaft surface.
(F) The size of grooves caused by removing means the size before rounding off
(G) Regarding cast steel crankshafts, when accepted by the Surveyor, defects can be remedied
by welding according to the Annex 2-4.
(H) When defects were removed, it is to be confirmed that the defects have been completely re-
moved by magnetic particle inspection or dye penetrant inspection.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 49
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-3 Guidance for Surface Inspection of Cast Steel Crankshafts Pt 2, Annex 2-3

(I) Regarding the crankshaft which defects are left and removed, the manufacturer is to make
detailed inspection records and submit the same to the Surveyor. In these inspection records,
the position, size, direction and nature of the defects on the inspected surface and the posi-
tion and size of grooves caused by removing the defects is to be recorded.
6. Standards for allowable limit of defects for surface inspection
(1) Application
(a) The standards are to be applied to the semi builtup cast steel and full built up crankshafts.
(b) Defects specified in this Guidance are Grade CC shown in (B).
(2) Classification of material defects
The surface defects are classified as the following Table 1, but Grade CA and CB defects are
excluded from consideration by this Guidances.

Table 1 Classification of Material Defects

Classification Names of defects

Grade CA defects Microscopic non-metal inclusion

Grade CB defects Pin hole and inclusion which do not exceed 0.2 mm in length

· Exceed 0.2 mm in length, Pin-hole, blowhole, sand-inclusion, slag inclusion


Grade CC defects · Shrinkage cavity,
· Hot tear, cold crack

(3) Standards
For Standards, Table 2 is to be applied.

Table 2 Standards

Divisions Standards

All defects which are detected are to be removed.


The depth of grooves caused by such removing is to be less than 0.01. In this case, the fillet
I parts are to be so finished that the original shape is retained. For parallel and plane parts, the
grooves are to be so rounded off that the bottom radius of the grooves is not less than three
times the depth of the groove.

All defects which are detected are to be removed, except the following defects:
(i) Defects not exceeding 1 mm which are not crowded.
(ii) Defects not exceeding 3 mm with sufficient spacing between each two.
II
The depth of grooves caused by such removing is to be less than 0.01 , and the grooves are to
be so rounded off that the bottom radius of the grooves is not less than three times the depth of
the groove, and in no case it shall be less than twice the depth.

All defects which are detected are to be removed, except the following defects:
(i) Defects not exceeding 3 mm which are not crowded.
(ii) Defects not exceeding 5 mm with sufficient spacing between each two.
III
The depth of grooves caused by such removing is to be less than 0.01 , and the grooves are to
be so rounded off that the bottom radius of the grooves is not less than twice the depth of the
groove.

All defects which are detected are to be removed, except those not exceeding 8 mm. The depth of
IV grooves caused by such removing is to be such that it does not affect the strength of the zone,
and for the depth, it is necessary to receive the Surveyor's approval.

50 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-4 Guidance for Repairs by Welding for Cast Steel Crank Throws Pt 2, Annex 2-4

Annex 2-4 Guidance for repairs by welding for cast steel crank throws

1. Applications
(1) Where defects are discovered in the crank throws of cast steel crankshafts under manufacture
(including full built-up crank webs: hereafter called, the crank throws), repairs by welding may
be carried out in accordance with the following standards. However where the depth of the de-
pression from which all defects have been removed is less than 0.05  (  is the web s thick-
ness), it is recommended that no repairs by welding be carried out. In this case the finishing of
the base part of the depression shall be such that the rounding there is over twice the depth of
the depression, and the angle between it and surface is sufficiently rounded up.
(2) When the manufacturer desires to carry out repairs by welding, he shall apply in advance to the
Surveyor for approval. In the case the Surveyor has found that such repairs by welding are not
suitable or has perceived that there are too many places to be welded in such repairs, he will
not approve the application, advising scrapping of the crank throw in question.
(3) When the manufacturer desires to carry out repairs by welding, he shall arrange in advance for
the crank throw to be subjected to the preliminary tests stipulated in 7 below.
2. The scope and conditions permitting repairs
(1) The base part of the pin and web : Repairs by welding are not to be carried out the crosshatch
zones marked on Fig 1.
(2) The depth of the depression from which all defects have been removed is to be less than 0.1  .

Fig 1 Zones where Repairs of Welding should not be carried out (Cross hatching zone)

3. Timing for repairs


Repairs by welding are to be carried out before the crank throws being given a formal heat
treatment. However when approved by the Surveyor the weld repairing of comparatively minor de-
fects may be carried out after the formal heat treatment.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 51
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-4 Guidance for Repairs by Welding for Cast Steel Crank Throws Pt 2, Annex 2-4

4. Methods of repairs
Repairs by welding are to be carried out in conformity with the requirements of the following
items:
(1) Welder
The welder engaging in repairs shall be the one who has passed the qualification tests of the
Society and who has further had the experience in the preliminary tests stipulated in 7 below.
(2) Removal of defects
After defects have been removed by grinding or gouging, the depression is to be made shapely
so as to fit for welding; while it is to be confirmed that the defects have been completely re-
moved by means of the magnetic particle inspection or dye penetrant inspection.
(3) Preheating
The part undergoing the weld repairing and its neighbourhood are to be preheated to temper-
atures exceeding 200℃.
(4) Welding method
Welding is to be the downhand electric arc welding.
(5) Electrode
The low hydrogen electrode approved by the Society is to be used.
(6) Post heating
On completion of welding the crank throws are to be heat-treated as specified, but those
heat-treated formally previous to repairs by welding with the approval of the Surveyor may re-
quire the annealing process only used 600 - 650℃ for stress relief.
(7) Finish after repairs
The repaired part shall be finished smoothly by grinding.
5. Inspection after repairs
It is to be confirmed by means of the magnetic particle inspection that the welded part and its
neighbourhood are free from harmful defects.
6. Records
The manufacturer is to make a documentation of the records including sketches of the positions
and dimensions of the welded repairs, methods of repairs, details the heat treatment and inspection
results for submission to the Surveyor.
7. Preliminary test
The manufacturer shall arrange for the following preliminary tests to be given before repairs by
welding; provided however except the cases where change has been made in the material used,
welding conditions or welders or where the Society has recognized the necessity specifically, these
tests need not be repeated on every occasion.
(1) Mold cavity weld test
(A) Test piece
Material of same quality with the crank throw.
(B) Shape of test piece and main point of repairs by welding
The dimensions of test piece are shown in Fig 2 Make the cavities as shown there, and
then carry out padding welding.
(a) Sizes cavities
Proper sizes within the scope permitting free use of the operating electrode.
(b) Distribution of cavities
Distribution of cavities and distance of each cavity of the edge of test piece shall be
such that these simulate the actual situation in the crank throw to be welded.
(c) Welding process
Same as in the actual welding.
(d) Electrode
The welding rod same as in the actual welding shall be used.
(e) Preheating and post heating
Similar heat treatments to those applied for the crank throw.

52 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-4 Guidance for Repairs by Welding for Cast Steel Crank Throws Pt 2, Annex 2-4

Fig 2 Dimensions and Shape of Test Coupon (Units : mm)

(C) Tests
(a) Macro-structure test
After heat treatment cut down the test piece at the place where the welded part is in-
cluded, confirming that there is no penetration in the root part of weld nor is any
crack.
(b) Hardness test
Check and confirm that there are no changes in the hardness of the weld metal, base
metal and the boundary part between them.
(c) Micro-structure
Check and confirm that there are no changes in the structure of the weld metal, base
metal and boundary part between them.
(2) Butt weld test
(A) Test coupon
Material of same quality with the crank throw.
(B) Shape of test coupon and main point of repairs by welding
Dimensions and shape of test coupon are shown in Fig 3. The welding conditions and heat
treatment are same as in (I) above.

Fig 3 Dimensions and Shape of Test Coupon Fig 4 Test Assembly

(C) Test
Each two test pieces are to be prepared for tension test and bending test respectively as
shown in Fig 4 from the test coupon described in Fig 3.
(a) Tensile test
Tensile test is to be carried out with the welded metal at the center part of the gauge
length. The value obtained is not to be less than the specified minimum value of the
base metal. (Test piece dimension = 14 mm  × 70 mm)
(b) Bending test
Place the welded metal on the center part of test piece, bending to l80° with the inside
radius of 25 mm, and confirm that no defects have appeared in the welded part and
heat affecting part.
(Test piece dimension = 25 mm × 19 mm × any given length)

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 53
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

Annex 2-5 Guidance for non-destructive examination of hull and


machinery steel forgings

1. Application
(1) The requirements in this Guidance is intended to give general guidance on the extent, methods
and recommended quality levels applicable to the non-destructive examinations (NDE) of steel
forgings(hereinafter referred to as "forgings") specified in Ch 1, 601. 8 and 10 of the Rules.
(2) For steel forgings(e.g. components for couplings, gears, boilers and pressure vessels) other than
those specified in this Guidance, the requirements in this Guidance may apply correspondingly
considering their materials, kinds, shapes and stress conditions being subjected.
(3) Forgings should be examined in the final delivery condition. Where intermediate inspections
have been performed the manufacturer shall furnish a documentation of the results upon the re-
quest of the Surveyor.
(4) Where a forging is supplied in semi finished condition, the manufacturer shall take into consid-
eration the quality level of final finished machined components.
(5) NDE personnel requirements and inspection plans are to comply with the requirements specified
in Annex 2-2, 2 and 4 (2), (a) of this Guidance.
2. Surface Inspections
(1) General
(a) Surface inspections in this Guidance are to be carried out by visual examination and mag-
netic particle testing or liquid penetrant testing.
(b) The testing procedures, apparatus and conditions of magnetic particle testing and liquid pene-
trant testing are to comply with the recognized national or international standards.
(c) Personnel engaged in visual examination is to have sufficient knowledge and experience.
Personnel engaged in magnetic particle testing or liquid penetrant testing is to be qualified
in accordance with the Society’s Rules. The qualification is to be verified by certificates.
(2) Products
(A) The steel forgings specified in Pt 2, Ch 1, 601. shall be subjected to a 100 % visual ex-
amination by the Surveyor. For mass produced forgings the extent of examination is to be
as deemed appropriate by the Society.
(B) Surface inspections by magnetic particle and/or liquid penetrant methods generally apply to
the following steel forgings:
(a) crankshafts with minimum crankpin diameter not less than 100 mm;
(b) propeller shafts, intermediate shafts, thrust shafts and rudder stocks with minimum diam-
eter not less than 100 mm;
(c) connecting rods, piston rods and crosshead with minimum diameter not less than 75 mm
or equivalent cross section,
(d) bolts with minimum diameter not less than 50 mm, which are subjected to dynamic
stresses such as cylinder cover bolts, tie rods, crankpin bolts, main bearing bolts, pro-
peller blade fastening bolts.
(3) Zones for Surface Inspections
Magnetic particle or where permitted liquid penetrant testing, shall be carried out in the zones I
and II as indicated in Figs 1 to 4.
(4) Surface Condition
The surfaces of forgings to be examined are to be free from scale, dirt, grease or paint.

54 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

(a) Solid crankshaft

(a) Semi built-up crankshaft


Notes)
1. Where the crankpin or journal has oil holes, the circumferential surfaces of the oil
holes are to be treated as Zone I. (See the figure in the right.)
2. In the above figures, "θ", "a" and "b" mean:
θ= 60°
a = 1.5 r
b = 0.05 d (circumferential surfaces of shrinkage fit)
where,
r : fillet radius
d : journal diameter
3. Identification of the Zones (Similar in Figs. 1 thru 4):
: Zone I db : oil hole bore diameter
: Zone II
Fig 1 Zones for magnetic particle / liquid penetrant testing on crankshafts

(b) Intermediate shaft

(a) Propeller shaft (c) Thrust shaft

Note) For propeller shaft, intermediate shafts and thrust shafts, all areas with stress raisers such as radial
holes, slots and key ways are to be treated as Zone I.

Fig 2 Zones for magnetic particle / liquid penetrant testing on shafts

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 55
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

(c) Cross head

(a) Connecting rod (b) Piston rod (d) Bolt

Fig 3 Zones for magnetic particle / liquid penetrant testing on machinery components

(a) Type A

(b) Type B

(c) Type C
Fig 4 Zones for magnetic particle / liquid penetrant testing on rudder stocks

(5) Surface Inspection


(a) Where indicated by Figs 1 to 4, magnetic particle inspection will be carried out with the
following exceptions, when liquid penetrant testing will be permitted :
- austenitic stainless steels;
- interpretation of open visual or magnetic particle indications,
- at the instruction of the Surveyor.
(b) Unless otherwise specified in the order, the magnetic particle test shall be performed on a
forging in the final machined surface condition and final thermally treated condition or with-
in 0.3 mm of the final machined surface condition for AC techniques (0.8 mm for D C tech-

56 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

niques).
(c) Unless otherwise agreed, the surface inspection is to be carried out in the presence of the
Surveyor. The surface inspection is to be carried out before the shrink fitting, where
applicable.
(d) For magnetic particle testing, attention is to be paid to the contact between the forging and
the clamping devices of stationary magnetization benches in order to avoid local overheating
or burning damage in its surface. Prods shall not be permitted on finished machined items.
(e) When indications were detected as a result of the surface inspection, acceptance or rejection
is to be decided in accordance with clause (6)
(6) Acceptance Criteria and Rectification of Defects
(A) Acceptance Criteria Visual Inspection
(a) All forgings shall be free of cracks, crack-like indications, laps, seams, folds, or other
injurious indications. At the request of the Surveyor, additional magnetic particle, liquid
penetrant and ultrasonic testing may be required for a more detailed evaluation of sur-
face irregularities.
(b) The bores of hollow propeller shafts are to be visually examined for imperfections un-
covered by the machining operation. Machining marks are to be ground to a smooth
profile.
(B) Acceptance Criteria Magnetic Particle Testing and Liquid Penetrant Testing
(a) The following definitions relevant to indications apply:
(i) Linear indication : an indication in which the length is at least three times the
width;
(ii) Nonlinear indication : an indication of circular or elliptical shape with a length less
than three times the width;
(iii)Aligned indication : three or more indications in a line, separated by 2 mm or less
edge-to-edge;
(iv)Open indication : an indication visible after removal of the magnetic particles or
that can be detected by the use of contrast dye penetrant;
(v) Non-open indication : an indication that is not visually detectable after removal of
the magnetic particles or that cannot be detected by the use of contrast dye pene-
trant,
(vi)Relevant indication : an indication that is caused by a condition or type of dis-
continuity that requires evaluation. Only indications which have any dimension great-
er than 1.5 mm shall be considered relevant.
(b) For the purpose of evaluating indications, the surface is to be divided into reference
areas of 225 cm2. The area shall be taken in the most unfavorable location relative to
the indication being evaluated.
(c) The allowable number and size of indications in the reference area is given in Table 1
for crankshaft forgings and in Table 2 for other forgings, respectively. Cracks are not
acceptable. Irrespective of the results of non-destructive examination, the Surveyor may
reject the forging if the total number of indications is excessive.
(C) Rectification of Defects
(a) Defects and unacceptable indications must be rectified as indicated below and detailed in
(i) thru (v)
(i) Defective parts of material may be removed by grinding, or by chipping and
grinding. All grooves shall have a bottom radius of approximately three times the
groove depth and should be smoothly blended to the surface area with a finish
equal to the adjacent surface.
(ii) To depress is to flatten or relieve the edges of a non-open indication with a fine
pointed abrasive stone with the restriction that the depth beneath the original surface
shall be 0.08 mm minimum to 0.25 mm maximum and that the depressions be blend-
ed into the bearing surface. A depressed area is not considered a groove and is
made only to prevent galling of bearings.
(iii)Non-open indications evaluated as segregation need not be rectified.
(iv)Complete removal of the defect is to be proved by magnetic particle testing or pen-
etrant testing, as appropriate.
(v) Repair welding is not permitted for crankshafts. Repair welding of other forgings is
subjected to prior approval of the individual Class Society.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 57
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

(b) Zone I in crankshaft forgings


Neither indications nor repair are permitted in this zone.
(c) Zone II in crankshaft forgings
(i) Indications must be removed by grinding to a depth no greater than 1.5 mm.
(ii) Indications detected in the journal bearing surfaces must be removed by grinding to
a depth no greater than 3.0 mm. The total ground area shall be less than 1 % of the
total bearing surface area concerned.
(iii)Non-open indications, except those evaluated as segregation, shall be depressed but
need not be removed.

Table 1 - Crankshaft forgings ; Allowable number and size of indications in a reference


area of 225 cm2

Max. number of Type of Max. number for Max. dimension


Inspection Zone
indications indication each type (mm)

Linear 0 -
I
0 Nonlinear 0 -
(critical fillet area)
Aligned 0 -
Linear 0 -
II
3 Nonlinear 3 3.0
(important fillet area)
Aligned 0 -
Linear 0 -
III
3 Nonlinear 3 5.0
(journal surfaces)
Aligned 0 -

Table 2 - Steel forgings excluding crankshaft forgings ; Allowable number and size of
indications in a reference area of 225 cm2

Max. number of Type of Max. number for Max. dimension


Inspection Zone
indications indication each type (mm)

Linear 0(1) -
I 3 Nonlinear 3 3.0
(1)
Aligned 0 -
(1)
Linear 3 3.0
II 10 Nonlinear 7 5.0
(1)
Aligned 3 3.0
Note:
(1) Linear or aligned indications are not permitted on bolts, which receive a direct fluctuating
load, e.g. main bearing bolts, connecting rod bolts, crosshead bearing bolts, cylinder cover
bolts.

(d) Zone I in other forgings


Indications must be removed by grinding to a depth no greater than 1.5 mm. However,
grinding is not permitted in way of finished machined threads.
(e) Zone II in other forgings
Indications must be removed by grinding to a depth no greater than 2 % of the diame-
ter or 4.0 mm, whichever is smaller.
(f) Zones other than I and II in all forgings
Defects detected by visual inspection must be removed by grinding to a depth no great-
er than 5 % of the diameter or 10mm, whichever is smaller. The total ground area shall
be less than 2 % of the forging surface area.

58 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

(7) Record
Test results of surface inspections are to be recorded at least with the following items:
(a) Date of testing;
(b) Names and qualification level of inspection personnel;
(c) Kind of testing method;
- for liquid penetrant testing : test media combination
- for magnetic particle testing : method of magnetizing, test media and magnetic field
strength
(d) Kind of product;
(e) Product number for identification;
(f) Grade of steel;
(g) Heat treatment;
(h) Stage of testing;
(i) Position (zone) of testing;
(j) Surface condition;
(k) Test standards used;
(l) Testing condition;
(m) Results;
(n) Statement of acceptance/non acceptance,
(o) Details of weld repair including sketch;
3. Ultrasonic testing
(1) General
(a) Volumetric inspection in this Guidance is to be carried out by ultrasonic testing using the
contact method with straight beam and/or angle beam technique.
(b) The testing procedures, apparatus and conditions of ultrasonic testing are to comply with the
recognized national or international standards. Generally the D G S (distance-gain size) proce-
dure is to be applied using straight beam probes and/or angle beam probes with 2 to 4
MHz and inspection should be carried out using a twin crystal 0° probe for near surface
scans (25 mm) plus an 0o probe for the remaining volume. Fillet radii should be examined
using 45°, 60° or 70° probes.
(c) Personnel engaged in ultrasonic testing is to be qualified in accordance with the Society’s
Rules. The qualification is to be verified by certificates.
(2) Products
(A) Volumetric inspections by ultrasonic testing generally apply to the following steel forgings :
(a) crankshaft with minimum crankpin diameter not less than 150 mm;
(b) propeller shafts, intermediate shafts, thrust shafts and rudder stocks with minimum diam-
eter not less than 200 mm,
(c) connecting rods, piston rods and crosshead with minimum diameter not less than 200
mm or equivalent cross section.
(3) Zones for ultrasonic testing
(A) Ultrasonic testing shall be carried out in the zones I to III as indicated in Figs 5 to 8.
Areas may be upgraded to a higher zone at the discretion of the Surveyors.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 59
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

Scanning direction

(a) Solid crankshaft

(b) Semi built-up crankshaft


Note)
1. In the above figures, "a" and "b" mean:
a = 0.1d or 25mm, whichever greater
b = 0.05d or 25mm, whichever greater (circumstances of shrinkage fit)
where,
d : pin or journal diameter
2. Core areas of crank pins and/or journals within a radius of 0.25d between the
webs may generally be coordinated to Zone II.
3. Identification of the Zones (Similar in Figs. 5 thru 8.):
: Zone I
: Zone II
: Zone III

Fig 5 Zones for ultrasonic testing on crankshafts

(b) Intermediate shaft


Scanning direction

(c) Thrust shaft

(a) Propeller shaft


Notes)
1. For hollow shafts, 360° radial scanning applies to Zone III.
2. Circumferences of the bolt holes in the flanges are to be treated as Zone II.

Fig 6 Zones for ultrasonic testing on shafts

60 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

Scanning direction

(b) Piston rod

(a) Connecting rod (c) Cross head


Fig 7 Zones for ultrasonic testing on machinery components

Scanning direction for Type A and Type B

(a) Type A

(b) Type B

(c) Type C Scanning direction


Type C
Fig 8 Zones for ultrasonic testing on rudder stocks

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 61
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

(4) Surface Condition


(a) The surfaces of forgings to be examined are to be such that adequate coupling can be es-
tablished between the probe and the forging and that excessive wear of the probe can be
avoided. The surfaces are to be free from scale, dirt, grease or paint.
(b) The ultrasonic testing is to be carried out after the steel forgings have been machined to a
condition suitable for this type of testing and after the final heat treatment , but prior to the
drilling of the oil bores and prior to surface hardening. Black forgings shall be inspected af-
ter removal of the oxide scale by either flame descaling or shot blasting methods.
(5) Acceptance Criteria
(a) Acceptance criteria of volumetric inspection by ultrasonic testing are shown in Table 3 and
4.

Table 3 - Acceptance Criteria for Crankshafts

Allowable disc shape Allowable length of Allowable distance


Type of Forging Zone
according to DGS (1) indication(2) between two indications(3)

I d ≤ 0.5 mm - -
Crank shaft II d ≤ 2.0 mm ≤ 10 mm ≥ 20 mm
III d ≤ 4.0 mm ≤ 15 mm ≥ 20 mm

Notes :
(1) DGS : Distance Gain Size evaluation system
(2) The transference distance of the probe in the range where the echo height exceeds 50% of DGS line is
taken as the length of indication.
(3) In case of accumulations of two or more isolated indications which are subjected to registration the
minimum distance between two neighboring indications must be at least the length of the bigger
indication. This applies as well to the distance in axial direction as to the distance in depth. Isolated
indications with less distances are to be determined as one single indication.

Table 4 - Acceptance Criteria for Shafts and Machinery Components

Allowable distance
Allowable disc shape Allowable length of
Type of Forging Zone between two
according to DGS (1)(2) indication(3)
indications(4)

Propeller shaft, outer: d≤2 mm ≤ 10 mm ≥ 20 mm


II
intermediate shaft inner: d≤4 mm ≤ 15 mm ≥ 20 mm
Thrust shaft, outer: d≤3 mm ≤ 10 mm ≥ 20 mm
Rudder stock III
inner: d≤6 mm ≤ 15 mm ≥ 20 mm

Connecting rod, II d≤2.0 mm ≤ 10 mm ≥ 20 mm


Piston rod, Crosshead III d≤4.0 mm ≤ 10 mm ≥ 20 mm

Notes :
(1) DGS : Distance Gain Size evaluation system
(2) Outer part means the part beyond one third of the shaft radius from the center, the inner part means the
remaining core area.
(3) The transference distance of the probe in the range where the echo height exceeds 50% of DGS line is
taken as the length of indication.
(4) In case of accumulations of two or more isolated indications which are subjected to registration the
minimum distance between two neighboring indications must be at least the length of the bigger
indication.

62 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-5 Guidance for Non-destructive Examination of Hull and Machinery Steel Forgings Pt 2, Annex 2-5

(6) Record
Test results of volumetric inspection are to be recorded at least with the following items:
(a) Date of testing;
(b) Names and qualification level of inspection personnel;
(c) Kind of testing method;
(d) Kind of product;
(e) Product number for identification;
(f) Grade of steel;
(g) Heat treatment;
(h) Stage of testing;
(i) Position (zone) of testing;
(j) Surface condition;
(k) Test standards used;
(l) Testing condition;
(m) Results,
(n) Statement of acceptance/non acceptance;

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 63
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

Annex 2-6 Guidance for liquid penetrant inspection and repair of


defects of copper alloy propeller castings

1. Applications
This requirement applies to the liquid penetrant inspection and repair of defects of propeller
castings. Repair method for propeller differing from those specified in this Guidance are to comply
with the discretion of the Society.
2. The liquid penetrant inspection
(1) Area of test (Severity zones)
(a) In order to relate the degree of inspection to the criticality of defects in propeller blades
and to help reduce the risk of failure by fatigue cracking after repair, propeller blades are
divided into the three zones designated A, B and C as shown in Fig 1 and Fig 2
(b) The severity zones "A" are to be subjected to a dye penetrant inspection in the presence of
the Surveyor. In zones "B" and "C" the dye penetrant inspection is to be performed by the
manufacturer and may be witnessed by the Surveyor upon his request.
(c) If repairs have been made either by grinding or by welding the repaired areas are addition-
ally to be subjected to the dye penetrant inspection independent of their location and/or se-
verity zone.

Fig 1 Zones for Non-destructive Inspection of Propeller Castings

Fig 2 Zones for Non-destructive Inspection on the Root Area of the Controllable
Pitch or Build up Propeller Blades and Controllable Pitch Propeller Boss

64 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

(2) Methods of testing


(a) The methods of testing are to conform to the standard of KS B 0816 or equivalent.
(b) In the dye penetrant inspection an indication is the presence of detectable bleed-out of the
penetrant liquid from the material discontinuities appearing at least 10 minutes after the de-
veloper has been applied.
(c) Where indications of defects appear, the type of defects and the size of the indications are
to be recorded in detail. These records are to be presented to the Surveyor. For reference,
the true size of the defects are also to be confirmed.
(3) Types of defects
The defects detected by the liquid penetrant test are divided into following types of (A) to (D).
(A) Cracks : the defects regarded as a crack.
(B) Circular defects : the defects other than crack, in which the length is less than 3 times the
width.
(C) Linear defects : the defects other than crack, in which the length is equal to or greater than
3 times the width.
(D) Aligned defects : Aligned defects consisting of two or more linear or circular defects which
are almost aligned and the spacings between them do not exceed 2 mm. The length of an
aligned defect is to be equal to the sum of the lengths of a1l individual defects and all
spacings between them.
(4) Acceptance criteria
(A) Where cracks or other defects which do not meet the acceptance criteria given in Table 1
are detected by the penetrant test, the defects are to be repaired in accordance with the re-
quirements in 3.

Table 1 Acceptance Criteria

Acceptance Criteria
Type of Defect
Max. total defects of same type
Are of test (excluding
crack) number of Max. number of each Max. size for each indication(III)
all defects(1) type(II) (mm)
Circular 5 4
Zone A Linear 7 2 3
Aligned 2 3
Circular 10 6
Zone B Linear 14 4 6
Aligned 4 6
Circular 14 8
Zone C Linear 20 6 6
Aligned 6 6
(Notes)
(1) The defects are to be repaired when they do not meet one or more criteria of (I) through (III) in
this table.
(2) The counting of the number of defects is to be conducted at the most unfavourable location rela-
tive to the indication being evaluated. The area of a reference zone is to be 100cm 
(3) Singular circular indications less than 2 mm for zone A and less than 3 mm for other zones may
be disregarded.
(4) Where only circular defects were detected, all defects(I) are to be repaired for the judgement.

(B) Areas which are prepared for welding are independent of their location always to be as-
sessed according to zone A. The same applies to the welded areas after being finished ma-
chined and/or grinded.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 65
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

(C) Indications exceeding the acceptance standard of Table 1, cracks, shrinkage cavities, sand,
slag and other non-metallic inclusions, blow holes and other discontinuities which may im-
pair the safe service of the propeller are defined as defects and must be repaired in accord-
ance with the requirements specified in 3 below.
3. Repair of defects
(1) Repair procedures
(A) In general, the repairs are to be carried out by mechanical means, e. g. by grinding, chip-
ping or milling. After milling or chipping, grinding is to be applied for such defects.
(B) The contour of the ground depression is as smooth as possible in order to avoid stress con-
centrations or to minimize cavitation corrosion.
(2) Repair of defects in zone A
(a) In zone A of Fig 1 and Fig 2, repair welding will generally not be allowed unless spe-
cially approved by the Society.
(b) Grinding may be carried out to an extent which maintains the blade thickness of the ap-
proved drawing.
(c) The possible repair of defects which are deeper than those referred to above is to be con-
sidered by the Society.
(3) Repair of defects in zone B
(a) In zone B of Fig 1 and Fig 2, defects that are not deeper than dB = (t/40) mm (t = min.
local thickness in mm according to the Rules) or 2 mm (whichever is greatest) below min.
local thickness according to the Rules should be removed by grinding.
(b) Those defects that are deeper than allowable for removal by grinding may be repaired by
welding.
(c) Where the propellers in zone B in accordance with the requirements specified in previous
(b) are repaired by welding, the limits of the repair welding are to be as shown in Table
2.

(2)(3)
Table 2 Limits of Repair Welding

Pressure side Suction side


 
Each area of repair welding(1) 75 cm or 0.006 S whichever is 150 cm or 0.01 S whichever is
larger larger

Total area of repair welding 200 cm  or 0.02 S whichever is larger


Depth of welding() 0.1  basically 0.15 basically
Notes:
(1) Welding of areas less than 5 cm2 is to be avoided.

  ∙ 
(2)    cm  

 = Diameter of the propeller (cm)
 = Number of propeller blade
 = Developed area ratio

(3) t is the thickness of the blade at the portion of repair welding.(cm)

(4) Repair of defects in zone C


In zone C of Fig 1 and Fig 2, repair welds are generally permitted.
4. Repair Welding
Repair welding which permitted in accordance with the requirements in 3 (3) and (4) above is to
comply with the following;
(1) General
(a) Companies wishing to carry out welding work on propellers must have at their disposal the
necessary workshops, lifting gear, welding equipment, preheating and, where necessary, an-
nealing facilities, testing devices.

66 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

(b) All welding work is to be carried out preferably in the shop free from draughts and influ-
ence of the weather.
(2) Welder
The welders are to have qualifications deemed appropriate by the Society.
(3) Edge preparation
(a) Defects to be repaired by welding are to be ground to sound material according to the re-
quirements as given under para 3 (1). To ensure complete removal of the defects the
ground areas are to be examined by dye penetrant methods in the presence of the Surveyor.
(b) The edge preparation for repair welding after removing the defects is to be as shown in Fig
3 and 4.
(4) Propeller drawing out
For heating the boss to draw out the propeller, propeller is to be heated slowly and below 15
0℃. In this case, the heating method which the heat is concentrated is not be used. A heat
source such as electric heater and steams recommended.

Fig 3 Edge Preparation after Removing Defects

Fig 4 Edge Preparation for Repair Welding of Blade Edge

(5) Welding repair procedure


(a) Arc welding with coated electrodes and gas-shielded metal arc process (G M AW ) are gen-
erally to be applied. Argon-shielded tungsten welding (G TAW ) should be used with care due
to the higher specific heat input of this process.
(b) For material thickness less than 30 mm, gas welding may give a satisfactory weldment for
CU 1 and CU 2 materials.
(c) Recommended filler metals, pre-heating and stress relieving temperatures are listed in Table
3. However, the welding consumables are to be approved by the approval tests for welding
procedure specified in (5).
(d) All propeller alloys are generally to be welded in down-hand (flat) position. Where this can-
not be done, gas-shielded metal arc welding should be carried out.
(e) The section to be welded is to be clean and dry. Flux-coated electrodes are to be dried be-
fore welding according to the maker's instructions.
(f) Adequate pre-heating is to be carried out with care to avoid local overheating, c.f. Table 3.
(g) Slag, undercuts and other defects are to be removed before depositing the next run.
(h) To minimize distortion and the risk of cracking, interpass temperatures are to be kept low.
This is especially the case with CU 3 alloys.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 67
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

Table 3 Recommended filler metals and heat treatments

Preheat Interpass Stress relief


Alloy type Filler metal
temperature (℃) temperature (℃) temperature (℃)
(1)
Al-bronze
CU 1 150 min 300 max 350∼500
M n-bronze
Al-bronze
CU 2 150 min 300 max 350∼550
Ni-M n-bronze
Al-bronze
CU 3 Ni-Al-bronze(2) 50 min 250 max 450∼550
M n-Al-bronze
CU 4 M n-Al-bronze 100 min 300 max 450∼600
Notes:
(1) Ni-Al-bronze and M n-Al-bronze are acceptable.
(2) Stress relieving not required, if filler metal Ni-Al-bronze is used.

(i) With the exception of alloy CU 3 (Ni-Al -bronze) all weld repairs are to be stress relief
heat treated, in order to avoid stress corrosion cracking. However, stress relief heat
treatment of alloy CU 3 propeller castings may be required after major repairs in zone
B (and specially approved welding in Zone A) or if a welding consumable susceptible
to stress corrosion cracking is used. In such cases the propeller is to be either stress re-
lief heat treated in the temperature 450 to 500°C or annealed in the temperature range
650-800°C, depending on the extent of repair, c. f. Table 3.
(j) The soaking times for stress relief heat treatment of copper alloy propellers should be
in accordance with Table 4. The heating and cooling is to be carried out slowly under
controlled conditions. The cooling rate after any stress relieving heat treatment shall not
exceed 50°C/h until the temperature of 200°C is reached.

Table 4 Soaking times for stress relief heat treatment of copper alloy propellers

Alloy grade CU1 and CU2 Alloy grade CU3 and CU4
Stress relief
Temp. Hours per Max. recommended Hours per Max. recommended
25 mm thickness total time hours 25 mm thickness total time hours

350 5 15 - -
400 1 5 - -
450 1/2 2 5 15
500 1/4 1 1 5
550 1/4 1/2 1/2 2
600 - - 1/4 1

(6) Welding procedure qualification test


The manufacturer of propellers intending to carry out repair welding in zone B and zone C is
to pass the welding procedure qualification test as shown below. The qualification test is also to
be in accordance with the requirements specified in Pt 2, Ch 2, Sec 4 of the Rules, in addi-
tion to the following requirements:
(a) Tests for butt welding
(i) Test assembly
The test assembly as specified in Fig 5 is to be prepared by means of butt welding.
The edge preparation is, in principle, to be either the V shape or an appropriate shape
and the bevel angle is to be not less than 60°.

68 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

(ii) Welding procedure


The welding procedures are to comply with the requirements in (5) above.
(iii) Visual inspection
The welded surface is to be regular and uniform and free from harmful defects such as
cracks and undercuts.
(iv) Tensile test
Tensile tests are to be carried out using the two test specimens taken in accordance
with Fig 5, and the values obtained are to be less than those given in Table 5. The
form of the test specimens are to comply with Fig 6.

Table 5 Tensile Test Requirements for Approval Test

Material Tensile Strength (Nmm  )


CU 1 370 min.
CU 2 410 min.
CU 3 500 min.
CU 4 550 min.

Fig 5 Test Assembly (Unit: mm) Fig 6 Size of Tensile Test Specimen (Unit : mm)

(v) Non-destructive inspection


Welded joint is to be tested for the whole length by liquid penetrant test, and is to
show that there are no crack and other injurious defects.
(vi) Macro-structure inspection
Macro etched test specimen is to be prepared as shown in Fig 5. Pores greater than 3
mm and cracks not permitted.
(b) Test of mold cavity welding
(i) Test piece and dimension of test piece
Test piece is to be of the material of same quality as the actual propeller. The di-
mensions of test piece are shown in Fig 7. The cavities are made as shown in the
figure and then welding same as condition in the actual welding is carried out.
(ii) Sizes of cavities
Proper sizes permitting free operation of electrode.
(iii) Distribution of cavities
Distribution of cavities and distance of each cavity from the edge of test piece is to be
such that these simulate the actual condition in the propeller to be welded.
(iv) Welding process
To be same as in the actual welding.
(v) Macro structure test
Macro structure test is to confirm that no defects such as crack exist in the cross sec-
tions of weld parts.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 69
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-6 Guidance for Liquid Penetrant Inspection and Repair of Defects of Copper Alloy Propeller Castings Pt 2, Annex 2-6

Fig 7 Test of mold cavity welding (Unit : mm)

(vi) Hardness test


Hardness test is to confirm that there is no unacceptable fluctuation in hardness between
the deposit metal, base metal and heat-affected zones.
(vii)Non-destructive inspection
Welded joint is to be tested by liquid penetrant inspection or ultrasonic inspection and
is to free from any crack and other harmful defects.
(c) Additional tests
Where deemed necessary, additional tests may be requested by the Society.
5. Straightening
(1) Hot straightening
(a) Straightening of a bent propeller blade or pitch modification is to be carried out after heat-
ing the bent region and approximately 500 mm wide zones on either side of it to the sug-
gested temperature range given in Table 6. The heating is to be slow and uniform and the
concentrated flames such as oxy-acetylene and oxy-propane is not used.
(b) Sufficient time is to be allowed for the temperature to become fairly uniform through the
full thickness of the blade section. The temperature must be maintained within the range
given in Table 6 through the straightening operation.

Table 6 Temperature Range for hot Straightening

Material CU 1 CU 2 CU 3 CU 4

Temperature of hot straightening (℃) 500∼800 500∼800 700∼900 700∼850

(c) A thermocouple instrument or temperature indicating crayons are to be used for measuring
the temperature.
(d) The area heated is to be enclosed with asbestos or similar material to reduce the cooling
speed after straightening.
(2) Cold straightening
Cold straightening is to be used for minor repairs of tips and edge only. Cold straightening on
CU 1, CU 2 and CU 4 are to be followed by a stress relieving heat treatment(See Table 3 and
Table 4)
(3) Application of load
For hot straightening, static loading and dynamic loading are to be used, but for cold straighten-
ing, static loading is to be used only.

70 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

Annex 2-7 Guidance for non-destructive testing of ship hull steel welds

1. General
(1) Application
(A) This Guidance applies to the Non-destructive inspection for all hull welds of ships whose,
in general, length exceeds 30 m to confirm the quality of the hull welds.
(B) In ships of less than 30m in length, the range of the inspection, the members to be in-
spected and the number of checkpoints are to be determined by the Surveyor based on con-
sultation with the manufacturer.
(C) The quality levels given in this Guidance refer to production quality and not to fitness
for-purpose of the welds examined.
(D) The non-destructive testing is normally to be performed by the Shipbuilder or its subcon-
tractors in accordance with this Guidance. Surveyor may require to witness some testing.
(E) It should be the Shipbuilder's responsibility to assure that testing specifications and proce-
dures are adhered to during the construction and the report is made available to the Society
on the findings made by the NDT.
(F) This Guidance is intented to apply to welds of irons and nonferrous metals. Other marine
structures may be applied subject to the approval by the Society. However, in case of ultra-
sonic inspection, the transducer design and calibration block material used are appropriate to
the material under inspection.
(2) Means of Non-destructive Inspection
(A) Applicable methods for testing of the different types of weld joints are given in Table 1.

Table 1 Applicable methods for testing of weld joints


Weld Joint Parent material thickness(mm) Applicable testing methods
t≤8 VT, PT, MT, RT
Butt welds with full penetration
t>8 VT, PT, MT, UT, RT

Tee joints, corner joints and cruciform joints t ≤ 10 VT, PT, MT


with full penetration t > 10 VT, PT, MT, UT
Tee joints, corner joints and cruciform joints (1)
All VT, PT, MT, UT
without full penetration and fillet welds
Note:
(1) UT can be used to monitor the extent of penetration in tee, corner and cruciform joints.

(B) All welds should be subject to visual testing by personnel designated by the Shipyard.
(C) Non-destructive inspection for detection of surface imperfections of weld joints of hull con-
struction is, in principle, to be magnetic particle testing specified in 2 (2) However liquid
penetrant testing can be applied under consideration of this Society.
(D) Non-destructive inspection for detection of internal imperfections is, in principle, to be radio-
graphic inspection specified in 3. However, for larger thickness over 30 mm, ultrasonic in-
spection specified in 4 is to be used as the primary inspection method.
(E) For welded joints of hull construction in thickness of 8 mm and above, a part or all of ra-
diographic inspection may be replaced by the ultrasonic inspection based on the requirements
given in 4, in case that the shipyard submitting ultrasonic testing specifications containing
information on the items mentioned below
(a) Approval of inspection manual
Prior to carrying out the inspection, the shipyard has to submit the inspection manual
containing the items mentioned below, and have the manual approved by the Society.
(i) Type of ultrasonic detector and kind of probe (nominal frequency and material, di-
mension, type and nominal angle of refraction of transducer), and the applicable
range of the testing (thickness, welding process, etc.)
(ii) Calibration block and reference block for calibration
(iii)Kind of ultrasonic test process (Angle beam technique is to be of standard one),
and extent of the measurements and method for sensitivity adjustment for the proc-

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 71
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

ess
(iv)Judgement criteria for ultrasonic test (The criteria for angle beam technique test is
to be in accordance with Table 11. For the other kind of ultrasonic test process,
judgement criteria are to be described in detail.)
(v) Record of the results of ultrasonic test
(vi)List of operators and judges
(b) The capability of shipyard
The capability of shipyard about the reliability of the test methods is to judged by the
items mentioned below.
(i) Qualification of engineers
(ii) Quality control conditions
(iii)Reliability
(iv)Keeping the Standards and their application ability
(v) Documents for type, extent and repair of defects
(c) Confirmation by radiographic inspection
(i) When the initial ultrasonic inspection is carried out according to this Guidance, ul-
trasonic testing for 1/10 of welds to be subject, based on the instructions of the
Surveyor, to radiographic testing of at least three ships to confirm that the results
match those of (a) (iv) and is approved by the Society for the consistence. However
the confirmation by radiographic inspection can be waived for the shipyard which
has the records to carry out confirmation inspection more than 3 ships.
(F) Where a yard desires to use ultrasonic inspection as the primary inspection method accord-
ing to (E), following requirements to be complied.
(a) a reasonable amount of checkpoints are to be examined by the radiography or alter-
native means approved by the Society. The amount examined together with the area
covered are to be agreed and marked on the NDE plan specified in (5). In principle,
such amount is not to exceed 10 % of total numbers of checkpoints.
(b) Radiographic inspection may be required at random in important locations at the dis-
cretion of the Surveyor.
(G) Alternative means to the radiographic inspection
(a) In case where shipyard intend to apply the new advanced NDT technologies such as
Phased array UT (PAUT) or Time of Flight Diffraction (TOFD) in lieu of radiographic
inspection, the shipyard has to submit the inspection manual as specified above (E), (a)
and have the manual approved by the Society.
(b) Additional test and/or data for comparison of alternative means with radiographic in-
spection may be required when deemed necessary by the Society.
(H) The additional non-destructive inspection required for workmanship control of welded joints
of hull is to be in accordance with the requirements specified in 3 (2), (C).
(3) Testing apparatus
The testing apparatus of radiographic and ultrasonic Inspection are to be calibrated and/or cor-
rected in accordance with the recognised national or international standards.
(4) Personnel requirements
(a) Personnel carrying out non-destructive inspection are generally to be qualified and certified
to Level II or above in KS B ISO 9712, SNT-TC-1A , EN 473, ASNT Central Certification
Program (ACCP) or equivalent. However, the personnel qualified to Level I can engage in
the testing under supervision of those qualified for Level II 2 or above.
(b) Personnel responsible for the radiographic and/or ultrasonic Inspection activity including ap-
proval of procedures should be qualified and certified to Level III.
(c) Periodic re-evaluations of test personnel are to be conducted in accordance with KS B ISO
9712 or equivalent to verify that such capability is maintained.
(5) NDE plan
(a) The Shipbuilder should submit a plan for approval by the Society, specifying the areas to
be examined and the extent of testing with reference to the NDT procedures to be used ac-
cording to the ship design, ship type and welding processes used. Particular attention should
be paid to highly stressed areas.
(b) The plan should only be released to the personnel in charge of the NDT and its
supervision.
(c) The identification system should identify the exact locations of the lengths of weld
examined.

72 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

(d) Welded connections of large cast or forged components (stern frame, stern boss, rudder
parts, shaft brackets...) should be tested over their full length using MT or PT and at
agreed locations using RT or UT.
(e) All start/stop points in welds made using automatic (mechanised) welding processes should
be examined using RT or UT except for internal members where the extent of testing
should be agreed.
(6) Timing of NDT
(a) NDT should be conducted after welds have cooled to ambient temperature and after post
weld heat treatment where applicable.
2
(b) For steels with specified minimum yield stress of 420 N/mm and above, NDT should not
be carried out before 48 hours after completion of welding. Where post weld heat treatment
(PWHT) is carried out the requirement for testing after 48 hours may be relaxed.
(7) Performance and responsibility
(A) The non-destructive testing is normally to be performed by the Shipbuilder or its subcon-
tractors in accordance with inspection manual and NDE plan approved by the Society. The
Surveyor may require to witness some testing.
(B) It should be the Shipbuilder's responsibility to assure that testing specifications and proce-
dures are adhered to during the construction and the report is made available to the Society
on the findings made by the NDT.
(8) Surface inspections
(a) Surface inspections shall be carried out as bellows;
(b) The surface of welds to be radiographed are to be sufficiently free from irregularities that
may mask or interfere with interpretation
(c) The test surface (within I skip distance from welds edge) to be ultrasonic tested are free
from spatter, floating scales, painting film, remarkable rust which prevent transmission of ul-
trasonic wave and the likes. They are removed if existed.
2. NDT for detection of surface imperfections
(1) Visual testing
(a) The welds examined should be clean and free from paint.
(b) Acceptance criteria are given in Table 2.

Table 2 Acceptance criteria for visual testing, magnetic particle and liquid penetrant testing
Surface discontinuity Acceptance criteria for visual testing

Crack not accepted

Lack of fusion not accepted


Incomplete root penetration in
not accepted
butt joints welded from one side
(1) (1)
Single pore diameter d ≤ 0.25t for butt welds (d ≤0.25a for
Surface pore fillet welds) with maximum diameter 3mm;
2.5d as minimum distance to adjacent pore.

depth ≤ 0.5mm whatever is the length


Undercut in butt welds
depth ≤ 0.8mm with a maximum continuous(2) length of 90mm

Undercut in fillet welds depth ≤ 0.8mm whatever is the length

Note:
(1) “t” is the plate thickness of the thinnest plate and “a” is the throat of the fillet weld.
(2) Adjacent undercuts separated by a distance shorter than the shortest undercut should be regarded
as a single continuous undercut.

(2) Magnetic particle testing


(a) Methods of inspection not specified in this Guidance are to comply with the KS B ISO
9934-1 or other recognized standard subject to the approval by the Society.
(b) The Shipbuilder should submit a procedure for approval by the Surveyor, specifying the sur-
face preparation, magnetizing equipment, calibration methods, detection media and applica-

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 73
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

tion, viewing conditions and post demagnetization.


(c) The surface to be examined should be free from scale, weld spatter, oil, grease, dirt or
paint and should be clean and dry.
(d) When using current flow equipment with prods, care shall be taken to avoid local damage
to the material. Copper prod tips must not be used. The prod tips should be lead, steel,
aluminium or aluminium-copper braid.
(e) To ensure detection of discontinuities of any orientation, the welds are magnetized in two
directions approximately perpendicular to each other with a maximum deviation of 30°.
Adequate overlapping shall ensure testing of the whole zone.
(f) Continuous wet particle method should be used as far as practicable.
(g) magnetic particle testing should cover a minimum weld length of 500 mm.
(h) Acceptance criteria are given in Table 2. Only the indications which have any dimension
greater than 2 mm should require evaluation.
(3) Liquid penetrant testing
(a) Methods of inspection not specified in this Guidance are to comply with the KS B ISO
3452 or other recognized standard subject to the approval by the Society.
(b) The Shipbuilder should submit a procedure for approval by the Surveyor, specifying the cal-
ibration equipment, surface preparation, cleaning and drying prior to testing, temperature
range, type of penetrant, cleaner and developer used, penetrant application and removal, pen-
etration time, developer application and development time and lighting conditions during
testing.
(c) The surface to be examined should be clean and free from scale, oil, grease, dirt or paint
and should include the weld bead and base metal for at least 10 mm on each side of the
weld, or the width of the heat affected zone, whichever is greater.
(d) The temperature of parts examined should be typically between 5°C and 50°C, outside this
temperature range special low/high temperature penetrant and reference comparator blocks
should be used.
(e) The penetration time should not be less than 10 minutes and in accordance with the manu-
facturer’s specification. The development time should not be less than 10 minutes and in ac-
cordance with the manufacturer’s specification, normally between 10∼30 minutes.
(f) magnetic particle testing should cover a minimum weld length of 500 mm.
(g) Acceptance criteria are given in Table 2. Only the indications which have any dimension
greater than 2 mm should require evaluation.
(4) Survey records
(A) In addition to generic items, reports of magnetic particle testing should include the following
specific items and their records are to be filed to compare the inspection locations with
their results.
(a) type of magnetization
(b) magnetic field strength
(c) detection media
(d) viewing conditions
(e) demagnetization, if required
(B) In addition to generic items, reports of liquid penetrant testing should include the following
specific items and their records are to be filed to compare the inspection locations with
their results.
(a) type of penetrant, cleaner and developer used
(b) penetration time and development time
3. Radiographic Inspection
(1) Methods of radiography
(A) Methods of inspection not specified in this Guidance are to comply with the KS B
0845(Methods of radiographic examination for welded joints in steel) or other recognized
standard subject to the approval by the Society.
(B) Test range of radiographic inspection is to be not less than 250 mm or overall length of the
welds inspected, whichever is smaller.
(C) Processed films should display hull no., frame no., weld boundary indicators, Port/Starboard,
location (or film serial number) and date as radiographic image.
(D) Film density
Film density through the area of interest shall be within 1.8 to 4.0 except for the defect

74 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

images.
(E) Penetrameter
(a) The penetrameter is to be a wire type image quality indicator specified in the KS A
4054 (Radiographic image quality indicators for non-destructive testing - Principles and
identification)
(b) The penetrameters including wire having minimum perceptible diameter are to be placed
across a weld and near the both edge (end) of the weld, facing the radiation source.
However, if the length under examination is less than three times the width of pene-
trameter, only one penetrameter may be laid on the center of the weld length.
(c) Minimum perceptible wire diameter of penetrameter on the radiographic films are to be
less than the value specified in Table 3.
(d) When using IQI's of wire type, the image of a wire is considered visible on the film if
a continuous length of at least 10 mm is clearly visible in a section of uniform optical
density.

Table 3 Minimum perceptible wire diameter of penetrameter (Unit : mm)

Minimum perceptible wire Minimum perceptible wire


Thickness of Thickness of
diameter of diameter of
base metal base metal
penetrameter (mm) penetrameter (mm)
t ≤ 4.0 0.10 32.0 < t ≤ 40.0 0.63
4.0 < t ≤ 6.3 0.16 40.0 < t ≤ 63.0 0.80
6.3 < t ≤ 10.0 0.20 63.0 < t ≤ 80.0 1.00
10.0 < t ≤ 12.5 0.25 80.0 < t ≤ 125 1.25
12.5 < t ≤ 16.0 0.32 125 < t ≤ 200 1.60
16.0 < t ≤ 20.0 0.40 200 < t ≤ 320 2.00
20.0 < t ≤ 32.0 0.50 320 < t 2.50

(2) Extent of survey


(A) Survey of welded joints of the shell and deck plating in ships
(a) The number of checkpoints
The minimum number of radiographic check points for the welded joints of the shell
and deck plating in ships is to be governed by the following equation or the same as
the length of the ship(m), (round off), whichever is the greater.
    
 


where,
 = minimum number of checkpoints
 = length specified in Pt 3, Ch 1, 102. of the Rules (m)
 = breadth specified in Pt 3, Ch 1, 104. of the Rules (m)
 = depth specified in Pt 3, Ch 1, 106. of the Rules (m)
(b) Survey location and distribution of checkpoints
(i) Survey location and distribution of checkpoints are to comply with the requirements
in Table 4. These inspection spots are not to adjoin each other.
(ii) In the distribution of checkpoints, the selection of inspection locations is to be con-
sidered the followings and carried out by the field Surveyor.
① Welds in high stressed areas
② Welds which are inaccessible or very difficult to inspection in service
③ Intersections of field erected welds
(iii)If the welds to be inspected can not be inspected because of the structure, other
possible welds in the vicinity of that weld are to be subjected to radiographic
inspection.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 75
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

Table 4 Survey location and distribution of checkpoints for the welded joints of the shell and
deck plating in ships
distribution of checkpoints
Survey location Butt welds within Butt welds outside
0.6 L midship 0.6 L midship
(1) Strength deck(excluding the area within
hatch side lines)
(2) Sheer strake,
(2) 
(3) Side shell plating,   

(4) bilge strake
(5) Bottom shell plating, (including flat plate keel.)
(1)
(6) Hatch side coaming(including the top plate)
Note
(1) Butt joints of the hatch side coaming exceeding 0.15L in length.
(2) one-third of the number of checkpoints is to be the intersections of weld lines.

(B) Survey of welded joints of internal structural members of ships


(a) Survey location and distribution of checkpoints are to comply with Table 5. These in-
spection spots are not to adjoin each other.
(b) Distribution of checkpoints is to be as specified in (2), (A), (b), (ii)

Table 5 Survey location and distribution of checkpoints for the welded joints of internal structural
members of ships
distribution of checkpoints(1)(2)
Survey location within 0.6L midship outside 0.6L midship
Butt welds
(1) Web and face plates of longitudinal members on the
strength deck (deck longitudinal, girders under deck and 
 
above deck).(longitudinal on the deck within the side 
lines of a cargo hatch opening are excluded.)

(2) Uppermost steel plate of longitudinal bulkheads.  


  
(3) Lowermost plate of the longitudinal bulkhead.   

(4) Web and face plates of longitudinal members 
(longitudinal frames, centerline girder plate, etc.) on sheer  

strake, shell plating, turn of bilge strake and keel plate.

(5) Web and face plates of transverse and horizontal girders.  

Note
(1) Number of inspections is to round up decimal places per joints of each members subject to inspections.
(2) Distribution of number of inspections may change in consideration of the type of ship, structural arrang
ement, welding process, arrangement of joints, etc.

(C) Workmanship control of welded joints of hull


(a) In addition to preceding (A) and (B), non-destructive testing may be required addition-
ally for parts of start, interrupted and end points of automatic welded joints, welded
joints of hatch corner, connections of stern frame or rudder horn made of casting steel
to rolled steels for hull, welded joints of insert plate for working holes and welded
joints in the vicinity of parts where stress is concentrated.
(b) In addition to (a) above, non-destructive testing may be required additionally for the

76 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

areas where welding workmanship is suspect, the areas where new welding methods
have been adopted, the areas where defects are liable to occur easily, the welds which
are inaccessible or very difficult to inspect in service and other appropriate areas
deemed necessary by the Surveyor to encourage good welding work.
(c) The locations of and the number of joints to be inspected additionally according to (a)
and (b) above are to be appropriately decided by the Surveyor according to the actual
status of workmanship of the shipyard.
(D) Addition/Reduction in the number of checkpoints
(a) If it is deemed necessary in considering the results of visual inspection for welds of the
members, the Surveyor may require, additional non-destructive inspections for welds oth-
er than those subject to non-destructive inspection, or alteration of non-destructive in-
spection procedure.
(b) If the survey results (before repair) of a previously constructed ship show that the num-
ber of welds that need to be repaired exceeds 20 % of the total number of locations,
then the number of checkpoints is to be a minimum of twice the number required.
(c) If automatic welding has been carried out at joints to be surveyed and the results of
the survey verify that the quality of the welding procedure is consistent satisfactory
quality, the number of checkpoints may appropriately be reduced.
(d) If a weld that needs to be repaired is found from automatically welded joints whose
number has been reduced in accordance with (c), additional radiographs amounting to
the number of checkpoints as prescribed in (c), are to be taken immediately. The num-
ber of checkpoints is not to be reduced until an appropriate period has elapsed and the
quality is verified to be stable and satisfactory.
(e) For ships whose length 120 m or under, the survey locations and the number of check-
points can be reduced.
(3) Acceptable Criteria of Radiographic Inspections
In radiographic testing, the Surveyor is to decide whether or not the results are acceptable when
the test records specified in 3. (5) The judgement may be required to the engineers of the ship-
builder (personnel with qualifications) but the results of its judgement frequently are to be
verified. Where deemed necessary by the society, all radiographic films related with the ship are
to be submitted.
(A) Classification of Defects
(a) Classification of defects is to be as given in Table 6.

Table 6 Classification of defects


Types of defects Kind of defects
Type 1 Porosity(blow hole) and similar defects
Elongated slag inclusion, pipe, incomplete penetration, incomplete fu-
Type 2
sion, and similar defects
Type 3 Crack and similar defects

(b) Where it is difficult to classify the defects into type 1 or type 2, classify respective de-
fects into type 1 or type 2, and then decide whether or not the results are acceptable.
(c) In case of butt welded joints between plates with different thickness, thickness of the
thinner plate is taken.
(B) Defect of Type 1
(a) Size of defect of type 1 is to be represented by score and maximum length of the
defect. The test field vision specified in Table 8 is to be selected from radiographic so
that the defects of maximum size exists and the sum of size of defects is maximum.
Where the flaw falls on the boundary of the test field of vision, the part outside the
test field of vision shall be included for measurement.
(b) The score of defect in the case of single defect of type 1 shall be determined by using
the value in Table 7 according to the dimension of the major diameter of the defect.
The score of defect for two or more defect of type 1 shall be the grand total of the
score for each defect in the test field of vision.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 77
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

Table 7 Score of defect Units : mm


Major Up to Over 1.0, Over 2.0, Over 3.0, Over 4.0, Over 6.0,
diameter of and incl. up to and up to and up to and up to and up to and Over 8.0
flaw (mm) 1.0 incl. 2.0 incl. 3.0 incl. 4.0 incl. 6.0 incl. 8.0
Score 1 2 3 6 10 15 25

(c) The defects of type 1 are to be judged unacceptable, if the size of the defects exceeds
the value of acceptable criteria specified in Table 8.

Table 8 Acceptance criteria for type 1 defect


Thickness of base metal t(mm) t ≤ 10 10 < t ≤25 25 < t ≤50 50 < t ≤ 100
Test field of vision 10 mm × 10 mm 10 mm × 20 mm

Acceptance Maximum size of single defect (mm) 4 5 t/5 10


criteria Total score of defect 6 12 24 30
Note
(1) Where the thickness of base metal is not more than 25 mm, the defects of not more than 0.5
mm may be ignored. Where the thickness of base metal is more than 25 mm, the defects of n
ot more than 0.7 mm may be ignored.

(C) Defect of Type 2


(a) Size of defect of type 2 is to be represented by length of the defect. Where defects are
present in a row and the distance between the mutual defects does not exceed the
length of larger defect, the sizes of all defects including the spaces between the mutual
defects is to be considered as the length of the defect.
(b) The defects of type 2 are to be judged unacceptable, if the length of a defect exceeds
the value of acceptable criteria specified in Table 9.
(c) Incomplete root penetration is not accepted in butt joint welded from one side

Table 9 Acceptance criteria for type 2 defect


Thickness of base metal t (mm) t ≤ 12 12 < t ≤ 50 50 < t
Acceptance criteria Sum of size of defect (mm) 6 or under t/2 or under 24 or under

(D) Defect of Type 3


Any defect of type 3 is to be judged unacceptable.
(E) In Case of Coexistence of Defects of Type 1 and Type 2
Where two or more types of defects are coexistent, the defects are to be judged un-
acceptable, provided the size of defects of each type are more than half of the size speci-
fied in Table 8 and Table 9 respectively.
(4) Repair and Treatment after the Repair
(A) Unacceptable indications should be eliminated and repaired where necessary. The repair
welds should be examined on their full length using magnetic particle and ultrasonic or ra-
diographic testing method.
(B) When unacceptable indications are found, additional areas of the same weld length should
be examined unless the indication is judged isolated without any doubt. In case of automatic
welded joints, additional NDT should be extended to all areas of the same weld length.
Same weld length mean the locations where, for manual and semi-automatic welding, identi-
cal person, identical postures and identical time and, for automatic welding, identical weld-
ing method, and identical time.
(C) The extent of testing can be extended at the surveyor's discretion when repeated non-
acceptable discontinuities are found.
(D) The Shipbuilder should take appropriate actions to monitor and improve the quality of welds
to the required level. The repair rate at which corrective action is to be instigated should be

78 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

identified in the builder’'s QA system.


(5) Survey records
(A) The survey results are to be recorded to the survey records such as followings and their re-
cords are to be filed to compare the inspection locations with their results.
(a) Radiation source, type and focal spot size
(b) Geometry of radiographic setup
(c) Film type
(d) Intensifying screens
(e) Film coverage
(f) Image quality indicators
(g) Film identification marking
(h) Exposure conditions
(i) Film processing
(j) Film density
(k) Film viewing conditions
(l) The result of judgement for acceptance
(m) Name of personnel performed the radiographic inspection
(n) Name of personnel performed the radiographic review
(B) The Society may require to duplicate some radiographs in order that some processed films
are handed over to the Society together with testing reports. Alternative method to duplicate
the processed film can be agreed with the Society.
4. Ultrasonic Inspection
(1) Methods of ultrasonic inspection
(A) General
(a) The inspection methods other than those specified in this Guidance are to comply with
KS B 0896 (Method for ultrasonic examination for welds of ferritic steel) except in
those cases where alternative criteria have been otherwise approved or specified.
(b) In general, the scanning of weld is performed by using angle beam technique. However,
normal beam technique is appled to the place where the application of angle beam tech-
nique is difficult or the place specially specified as that where the other technique are
more suitable than angle beam technique for detecting a discontinuity.
(c) The stage of the test is the time when the final heat treatment is completed, in the case
where heat treatment or the like after completion of weld has been specified in the
document.
(d) The test of parent materials of the part through which ultrasonic waves pass when angle
beam technique is performed, are previously tested normal technique to detect a dis-
continuity such as lamination etc.
(e) The probes may be affixed to suitable wedges designed to induce beam waves in the
material under test at the selected angles.
(f) The couplant, in general, is to be used the glycerine-water solution of 75 % or more.
The kinds and temperature of the couplant used for test are to be equivalent to those
used for calibration of ultrasonic test instrument.
(g) The weld reinforcement is adequately finished in case where its form affects the results
of the test.
(B) Checking the overall performance characteristics of ultrasonic equipment
(a) The vertical linearity is to be checked in accordance with the 4.1 of the KS B 0534
(Method for Assessing the Overall Performance Characteristics of Ultrasonic pulse echo
instrument) and the result is to be within ±3% of full scale.
(b) The linearity of the time base is to be measured in accordance with the 4.2 of the KS
B 0534 and the result is to be within ±1% of full scale.
(c) A margin of gain control is to be measured in accordance with the 4.3 of the KS B
0534 and the result is to be not less than 40dB.
(d) Periodical checks of ultrasonic test instrument are to be performed not less once every
year. However, The check of the test instrument immediately is to be performed in the

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 79
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

case that the repair relating to the performance characteristics of the ultrasonic test in-
strument was performed within this period.
(C) Probes
(a) In general, the scanning of weld is performed by using probes of angle beam technique.
In case where normal probe is used, the standard is to comply with the KS B 0896.
(b) The frequency to be used for angle beam technique is in accordance with Table 10.
However, the frequency lower than the value specified in Table 10 may be used for
the test of test object with remarkable ultrasonic attenuation and the frequency higher
than the value specified in Table 10 may be used for improving the resolution.

Table 10 Nominal Frequency to be used for Angle Beam Technique

Plate thickness of parent materials (mm) Nominal frequency (MHz )

75 or less 5 or 2
over 75 2

(c) The refraction angle of probe to be used is to comply with Table 11 according to the
thickness of parent materials. Where deemed appropriate by the Society, the different re-
fraction angle of probe may be used.

Table 11 Nominal Refraction Angle of Probe used


Plate thickness of parent materials (mm) Nominal refraction angle
40 or less 70°

Over 40 to 60 incl. 70° or 60°

Over 60 70° and 45° or 60° and 45°

(D) Adjustment of ultrasonic test instrument


(a) Measurement of probe index
The probe index is measured by using A1 calibration block or A3 calibration block
specified in KS B 0831. The probe index is measured in precision of ±1% and to be
indicated on the both sides of probe.
(b) Measurement of refraction angle
Refraction angle is measured in unit of 0.5° by using A1 calibration block or A3 cali-
bration block
(c) Adjustment of time base range and correction of the starting point
The adjustment of time base range is performed in precision of ±1% by using A1 cali-
bration block or A3 calibration block and the starting point is corrected.
(d) The equipment (instrument and probes) should be verified by the use of appropriate
standard calibration blocks at suitable time intervals.
(E) Making of curve for dividing echo height
(a) Curve for dividing echo height
The height for evaluation of the depth is made for four regions specified in Fig 2. The
positions of probe for making the curves for dividing echo height using the distance
amplitude characteristic curve are to comply with Fig 1.
(b) Determination of H line, M line and L line
The curve for dividing echo height by working sensitivity of (d) is selected to take it
as H line, and the curve for dividing echo height lower than H line by 6 dB is taken
as M line and the curve lower than H line by 12 dB is taken as L line. H line is of
over 40 %.
(c) Regions
The regions divided by H, M and L line are designated as given in Table 12 and the
examples of regional division are indicated as given in Fig 2.

80 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

Fig 1 Position of Probe for making the Curves for Dividing Echo Height

Fig 2 Examples for Drawing Curves for Dividing Echo Height

Table 12 Designation of Regional Division of Echo Height


Range of echo height Region of echo height
L line or less I
Over L to M line incl. II
Over M to H line incl. III
Over H line IV

(F) Working sensitivity


(a) Using the A2 calibration block
In the case of using nominal refraction angle of 60° or 70°, the gain of instrument is
adjusted so that the echo height of the standard hole of  4 x 4 mm agrees with H
line. In the case of using nominal refraction angle of 45°, the gain of instrument is in-
creased by 6 dB after it is adjusted so that the echo height of the standard hole of  4
x 4 mm agrees with H line. In both case, where deemed appropriate by Society, sensi-
tivity compensation calculated according to Annex of KS B 0896 to be added.
(b) Using the RB-4 reference block
The gain of instrument is adjusted so that the echo height of the standard hole agrees
with H line.
(c) Where deemed appropriate by the Society, other blocks considered as equivalent for
block specified in (a) and (b) may be used.
(d) The range and sensitivity should be set prior to each testing and checked at regular in-
tervals as per the procedure and whenever needed.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 81
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

(G) Position and direction of scanning


(a) In general, the scanning of weld is performed by using angle beam technique and scan-
ning method is comply with the Table 13 and Fig 3 depending on the type of joints
and plate thickness. However, for welds in which the surfaces have been ground, the
probe is placed on the weld surface and moved along the weld axis with the sound
beam directed parallel to the weld.

Table 13 Position and direction of scanning


Plate thickness Position and direction of
Type of Joints Scanning methods
(mm) scanning
t ≤ 100 both side of single face Directed and 1 skip reflected.
butt joints
t > 100 both side of both face Directed

T joints, t ≤ 60 single side of single face Directed and 1 skip reflected.


corner joints t > 60 single side of both face Directed

Fig 3 Position and Direction of Scanning

(b) The scanning technique should be determined to allow the testing of the entire volume
of the weld bead and base metal for at least 10 mm on each side of the weld, or the
width of the heat affected zone, whichever is greater.
(H) Ultrasonic discontinuity length and presentation of location of discontinuity
(a) Ultrasonic discontinuity length
(i) The position indicating the maximum echo height is taken as center of scanning, the
transference distance of the probe in the range where the echo height exceeds L line
is measured by scanning its circumference is taken as the ultrasonic discontinuity
length. The measurement is performed by unit of 1 mm.
(ii) In the case where the plate thickness of part where the probe is contacted is not
less than 75 mm, nominal frequency is 2 MHz and the probe with transducer size of
20 x 20 mm is used, the transference distance of the probe in the range where the
echo height exceeds one half of the height of the maximum echo is taken as the
ultrasonic discontinuity length.
(b) Presentation of location of discontinuity
The discontinuity location in the transverse section [depth(d) and distance(k) from weld
centerline] is presented by the probe location(Xp) where the maximum echo can obtain.
The discontinuity location in the plane is presented by both ends((Xs and Xe) of ultra-
sonic discontinuity length(l)

82 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

Fig 4 Presentation of location of discontinuity

(2) Extent of survey


(A) Survey of welded joints of the shell and deck plating in ships
(a) The survey location and distribution of checkpoints of ultrasonic inspection are to com-
ply with the requirements given in (A) of 3 (2).
(b) Test range of ultrasonic inspection is entire length of the joint or 750 mm, whichever is
smaller.
(B) Survey of welded joints of internal structural members of ships
(a) The survey location and distribution of checkpoints of ultrasonic inspection are to com-
ply with the requirements given in (B) of 3 (2).
(b) Test range of ultrasonic inspection is entire length of the joint or 300 mm, whichever is
smaller.
(C) Workmanship control of welded joints of hull
(a) The survey location and distribution of checkpoints of ultrasonic inspection for work-
manship control of welded joints of hull are to comply with the requirements given in
(C) of 3 (2).
(b) Test range of ultrasonic inspection is to comply with the requirements given in (B)
above.
(D) Addition/Reduction in the number of checkpoints
Addition/reduction in the number of checkpoints is to comply with the requirements given
in (D) of 3 (2).
(3) Acceptance Criteria of ultrasonic inspections
(A) Defects detected by ultrasonic inspection are to be judged in accordance with Table 14

Table 14 Acceptance criteria for defects detected by ultrasonic inspection


Thickness of base metal t (mm) t ≤ 50 50 < t t ≤ 50 50 < t
Region of maximum echo heights II and III IV
Acceptance Criteria length of defect (mm) t or less 50 or less t/2 or less 25 or less
Note:
1. (1) The symbol t is plate thickness (mm) of the parents materials of the groove side. However, in the
case of butt joint weld with different plate thickness of the parents materials, the thinner plate thickness
is adopted.
2. In applying this table, in the case where the distance between discontinuities is smaller or equal to the
length of the discontinuity with longer ultrasonic discontinuity length that the depth considered to be
same, these discontinuities are regarded as same discontinuity group and treated as a continuous dis-
continuity including such distance. In the case where the distance between discontinuities is longer than
the larger one out of the both ultrasonic discontinuity lengths, these discontinuities are regarded as in-
dependent from each other. The examination results of straddle scanning, parallel scanning by slanted
probe and longitudinal scanning on the weld line are classified in accordance with the agreement be-
tween the parties concerned.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 83
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-7 Guidance for Non-destructive Testing of ship Hull Steel Welds Pt 2, Annex 2-7

(B) Where kind of defect is considered as cracks from welding process, location of defects, etc.,
the defects are to be judged unacceptable.
(4) Repair and Treatment after the Repair
Repair and treatment after the repair is to comply with the requirements given in 3 (4).
(5) Records
(A) Making the records
The records after test are to be made.
(B) Items of Records
The records are to be included the followings.
(a) Name of the work and manufacturer
(b) Number and name of ship
(c) Name and qualification of personnel engaged in the test
(d) Date of the test
(e) Calibration and reference blocks used
(f) Performance of test instrument (identity, probe type, size, frequency, angle etc)
(g) Unusual condition of weld bead
(h) Method of welding and form of groove
(i) Materials and dimension
(j) Location and length of the welds inspected
(k) Length and location of discontinuity
(l) Classification
(m) Kind of couplant
(n) Working sensitivity
(o) Other items(designated items, subject of discussion, witness, sampling method etc.)
(c) Evaluation of records
The ultrasonic test reports is to be made under condition of rigid quality control and is to
be to the satisfaction of the Surveyor.
5. Improvement of qualification
Where the faulty welds are more than 10 % of the number of inspection specified in Table 4 or
5, the results of investigation on the substantial cause and the measures to improve the quality are
to be submitted to the Surveyor.

84 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-8 Reinforced Plastic Materials Pt 2, Annex 2-8

Annex 2-8 Reinforced plastic materials

1. General
(1) Application
(A) This Guidance applies to the base materials such as thermosetting resins, fiber reinforce-
ments and core materials (hereinafter refer to FRP materials) used in the construction or re-
pair of FRP ships, composite vessels and other marine structures which are to be certified
or are intended for classification.
(B) FRP materials or hybrid materials other than those prescribed in this Guidance may be used
where specially approved in connection with the design. In such cases, the detailed data re-
lating to the manufacturing process and mechanical properties, etc. of the materials are to be
submitted for approval.
(2) Approval
(A) FRP materials such as thermosetting resins, fiber reinforcements, core materials, etc. are to
be type approved in accordance with this Guidance and the Guidance specially specified by
the Society in advance
(B) The manufacturing process of of FRP ships, composite vessels or other marine structures
which are to be certified or are intended for classification is to be approved in accordance
with the Guidance specially specified by the Society in advance
(C) In order that a FRP materials can be approved, the manufacturer is required to demonstrate
to the satisfaction of the Society that the necessary manufacturing and testing facilities are
available and are supervised by qualified personnel.
(3) Manufacturing control
(A) It is the manufacturer's responsibility to assure that effective process and production controls
in operation are adhered to within the manufacturing specifications.
(B) Where control imperfection inducing possible inferior quality of FRP materials occurs, the
manufacturer is to identify the cause and establish a countermeasure to prevent its
recurrence. Also, the complete investigation report is to be submitted to the Surveyor.
(C) For further use, each FRP material affected by previous (B) is to be tested to the
Surveyor's satisfaction. The frequency of testing for subsequent products offered may be in-
creased to gain confidence in the quality at the discretion of the Society.
(D) The manufacturer is to provide the material producer with such information as is essential
to ensure that the FRP materials to be used are in accordance with the approval require-
ments and the product specification. This information is to include any survey requirements
for the materials.
(E) Post-cure heating is to be carried out in properly constructed ovens which are efficiently
maintained and have adequate means for control and recording of temperature. The oven is
to be such as to allow the whole item to be uniformly heated to the necessary temperature.
In the case of very large components which require post-cure heating, alternative methods
will be specially considered.
(4) Testing and inspection
(A) The FRP materials are to be tested and inspected in accordance with this Guidance and the
Guidance specially specified by the Society in advance in the presence of the Society‘s
Surveyor except otherwise specially provided, and are to comply with the requirements in
this Guidance.
(B) Where the FRP materials are manufactured by the approval of quality assurance scheme spe-
cially specified by the Society, a part or all of test and inspection in the presence of the
Society's Surveyor may be omitted.
(5) Execution of testing and inspection
(A) The manufacturers shall afford the Surveyor all necessary facilities and access to all relevant
parts of the works to enable him to verify that the approved process is adhered to, for the
selection of test materials, and the witnessing of tests, as required by this Guidance, and for
verifying the accuracy of the testing equipment.
(B) In the case of special order, the manufacturer is to show the order specifications, special re-
quirements, etc. of the FRP materials to the Surveyor prior to the material test.
(C) Before final acceptance, all test materials are to be confirmed as typical of the manufactured
product and be submitted to the specified tests and examinations under conditions acceptable
to the Surveyors. The results are to comply with the specification and this Guidance and are

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 85
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-8 Reinforced Plastic Materials Pt 2, Annex 2-8

to be to the satisfaction of the Surveyors.


(D) All tests and inspections are to be carried out at the place of manufacture before dispatch.
The test specimens and procedures are to be in accordance with 2. thru 4. of this
Guidance. All the test specimens are to be selected and stamped by the Surveyor and tested
in his presence, unless otherwise agreed.
(E) All FRP material samples for testing are to be prepared under conditions that are as close
as possible to those under which the product is to be manufactured. Where this is not pos-
sible, a suitable procedure is to be agreed with the Surveyor.
(F) During production, check test samples are to be provided as requested by the Surveyor.
Should the taking of these samples prove impossible, model samples are to be prepared con-
currently with production. The procedure for the preparation of these samples is to be
agreed with the Surveyor.
(G) Where materials are manufactured in quantity by semi-continuous or continuous processes
under closely controlled conditions, an alternative system for testing and inspection may be
adopted, subject to the agreement of the Surveyors.
(6) Retest procedure
(A) Where test material fails to meet the specified requirement, two additional tests of the same
type may be made at the discretion of the Surveyor.
(B) Where an individual test result in a group (minimum five) deviates from the mean by more
than two standard deviations in either the higher or lower direction, the result is to be ex-
cluded and a re-test made. Excluded results of tests are to be reported with confirmation
that they have been excluded. Only one exclusion is acceptable in any group of tests.
(7) Quality
(A) FRP materials are to be free from surface or internal defects which would be prejudicial to
their proper application in service.
(B) In the event of any material proving unsatisfactory during subsequent working or fabrication,
such material may be rejected, notwithstanding any previous satisfactory testing and/or certif-
ication where the Surveyor considers necessary.
(8) Identification and marking of materials
(A) The manufacturer of approved FRP materials is to identify each batch with an unique num-
ber or code.
(B) The manufacturer of FRP products is to adopt a system of identification which will enable
all finished products to be traced to the original batches of base materials. Surveyors are to
be given full facilities for tracing any component or material when required.
(9) Certification
The manufacturer is to provide the purchaser with test reports or certificates of conformity for
each batch of FRP material supplied indicating the relevant values are to comply with this
Guidance.
2. Thermosetting resins
(1) The data listed in Table 1 is to be provided by the manufacturer for each type of thermoset-
ting resin.
(2) The following tests are to be carried out on each type of thermosetting resin:
(A) Tensile strength (stress at maximum load) and stress at break.
(B) Tensile strain at maximum load.
(C) Tensile secant modulus at 0,5 per cent and 0,25 per cent strain respectively.
(D) Temperature of deflection under load.
(E) Barcol hardness.
(F) Determination of water absorption.
(G) Volume shrinkage after cure.
(H) Specific gravity of cast resin.
(3) In addition, for gel coat resins the stress at break and modulus of elasticity in flexure are to be
determined.
(4) The test methods for thermosetting resin are to be in accordance with the Guidance specially
specified by the Society.

86 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-8 Reinforced Plastic Materials Pt 2, Annex 2-8

Table 1 Data requirements for thermosetting resins


Type of resin
Data (3)
Polyester Epoxide Phenolic
Specific gravity of liquid resin O O O
Viscosity O O O
Gel time O O X
Appearance O O O
Mineral content(1) O O X(2)
Volatile content O X X
Acid value O X X
Epoxide content X O X
Free phenol X X O
Free formaldehyde X X O
Notes :
(1) This is to be the total filler in the system, including thixotrope, filler, pigments,
etc., and is to be expressed in parts by weight per hundred parts of pure resin.
(2) If the resin is pre-filled, the mineral content is required.
(3) Vinylesters are to be treated as equivalent to polyesters.

(5) Minimum property values of gel coat resins are to comply with the values specified in Table
2.

Table 2 Minimum property values of gel coat resins


Properties Minimum value

Tensile strength (stress at maximum load) 40 Nmm
Tensile stress at break 40 Nmm 
Tensile strain at maximum load 2.5 %
Modulus of elasticity in tension As measured
Flexural strength (stress at maximum load) 80 Nmm 
Modulus of elasticity in flexure As measured
Barcol hardness 35
Determination of water absorption. 60 ℃
Water absorption 60 mg(max.)
Specific gravity of cast resin As measured

(6) Minimum property values of cast thermosetting resins are to comply with the values specified in
Table 3.

Table 3 Minimum property values of cast thermosetting resins


Properties Minimum value

Tensile strength (stress at maximum load) 40 Nmm
Tensile stress at break 40 Nmm 
Tensile strain at maximum load 2.0 %
Modulus of elasticity in tension As measured
Flexural strength (stress at maximum load) 70 Nmm 
Modulus of elasticity in flexure As measured
Barcol hardness 35
Determination of water absorption. 60 ℃
Water absorption 70 mg(max.)
Specific gravity of cast resin As measured

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 87
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-8 Reinforced Plastic Materials Pt 2, Annex 2-8

3. Fiber reinforcements
(1) The following data is to be provided, where applicable, for each type of fiber reinforcement:
(A) Reinforcement type.
(B) Fibre type for each direction.
(C) Fibre tex value.
(D) Fibre finish and/or treatment.
(E) Yarn count in each direction.
(F) Width of manufactured reinforcement.
(G) Weight per unit area of manufactured reinforcement.
(H) Weight per linear metre of manufactured reinforcement.
(I) Compatibility (e.g. suitable for polyesters, epoxides, etc.).
(J) Constructional stitching –details of yarn, specific gravity, type, frequency and direction.
(K) Weave type.
(L) Binder type and content.
(M) Density of the fibre material.
(2) The following tests are to be made on each fiber reinforcement:
(A) Tensile strength (stress at maximum load).
(B) Tensile strain at break.
(C) Tensile secant modulus at 0,5 per cent and 0,25 per cent strain respectively.
(D) Compressive strength (stress at maximum load).
(E) Compressive modulus.
(F) Flexural strength (stress at maximum load).
(G) Modulus of elasticity in flexure.
(H) Apparent interlaminar shear.
(I) Fibre content.
(J) Determination of water absorption.
(3) The test methods for Fiber reinforcements are to be in accordance with the Guidance specially
specified by the Society
(4) Minimum property values of laminates are to comply with the values specified in Table 4.

Table 4 Minimum property values of laminates


Material type Property Min. value

Chopped strand Tensile strength (stress at maximum load)(Nmm  ) 200Gc+25


mat Modulus of elasticity in tension(kNmm  ) 15Gc+20

Bi-directional Tensile strength (stress at maximum load)(Nmm  ) 400Gc-10


reinforcement Modulus of elasticity in tension(kNmm  ) 30Gc-0.5

Uni-directional Tensile strength (stress at maximum load)(Nmm  ) 100Gc-1400Gc+510


reinforcement Modulus of elasticity in tension(kNmm  ) 130Gc-114Gc+39

Flexural strength (stress at maximum load)(Nmm  ) 520Gc+106.8


Modulus of elasticity in flexure(kNmm  ) 33.4Gc+2.2
Compressive strength (stress at maximum load)(Nmm  ) 150Gc+72
All Compressive modulus(kNmm  ) 40Gc-6
Interlaminar shear strength(Nmm  ) 22-13.5Gc(min. 15)
Water absorption(mg) 70(max.)
Glass content(% by weight) As measured
Notes:
(1) After water immersion, the values shall be a minimum of 75 % of the above.
(2) Where materials have reinforcement in more than two directions, the requirement will be
subject to individual consideration dependent on the construction.
(3) Gc : glass fraction by weight.

88 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-8 Reinforced Plastic Materials Pt 2, Annex 2-8

4. Core materials
(1) The following data is to be provided for each type of core material:
(A) Type of material.
(B) Density.
(C) Description (block, scrim mounted, grooved).
(D) Thickness and tolerance.
(E) Sheet/block dimensions.
(F) Surface treatment.
(G) Full application procedure for use of the product.
(2) For each type of test sample the following data are to be reported, together with the sub-
mission of a representative test sample showing the mode of failure for each density of core
material:
(A) Skin and core thickness, and core type and density.
(B) Resin/catalyst/accelerator ratio.
(C) Skin construction, including types and weight of reinforcements, resin(s), etc.
(D) Details of production method and curing conditions (temperature and times).
(E) Where additional preparation of the foam is involved, for example the use of primers or
bonding pastes, full details are to be provided.
(F) Actual span between base supports for each type of test sample.
(3) Specific requirements for end-grain balsa
(A) The supplier is to provide a signed statement that the balsa (ochroma lozopus) is cut to
end-grain, is of good quality, being free from unsound or loose knots, holes, splits, rot, pith
and corcho, and that it has been treated against fungal and insect attack, shortly after fell-
ing, followed by homogenization, sterilization and kiln drying to an average moisture content
of no more than 12 per cent.
(B) The following tests are to be carried out on the virgin material, both parallel to and perpen-
dicular to the grain. The density of the virgin material is also to be tested.
(a) Compressive strength (stress at maximum load).
(b) Compressive modulus of elasticity.
(c) Tensile strength (stress at maximum load).
(C) Where the balsa is mounted on a carrier material (e.g. scrim), any adhesive used is to be
of a type compatible with the proposed resin system.
(D) The test methods for end-grain balsa are to be in accordance with the Guidance specially
specified by the Society
(E) Minimum property values of end-grain balsa are to comply with the values specified in
Table 5.

Table 5. Minimum property values of end-grain balsa

Strength (stress at maximum load)(Nmm  ) Compressive modulus


of elasticity Shear
Apparent Compressive Tensile (Nmm  ) modulus
density of
Direction of stress Shear Direction of stress
(kgmm  ) elasticity
Parallel Perpendicular Parallel Perpendicular Parallel Perpendicular (Nmm  )
to grain to grain to grain to grain to grain to grain
96 5.0 0.35 9.00 0.44 1.10 2300 35.2 105
144 10.6 0.57 14.6 0.70 1.64 3900 67.8 129
176 12.8 0.68 20.5 0.80 2.00 5300 89.6 145

(4) Specific requirements for rigid foams (PVC, Polyurethane and other types)
(A) The foam is to be of the closed cell type and compatible with the proposed resin system
(e.g. polyester, epoxide, etc.).
(B) Foams are to be of uniform cell structure.
(C) Data is to be provided on the dimensional stability of the foam by measurement of the
shrinkage.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 89
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-8 Reinforced Plastic Materials Pt 2, Annex 2-8

(D) The following test data is to be submitted for each type of foam:
(a) Density.
(b) Tensile strength (stress at maximum load).
(c) Tensile modulus of elasticity.
(d) Compressive strength (stress at maximum load).
(e) Compressive modulus of elasticity.
(E) Additionally the compressive properties (see (D) (d) and (e)) are to be determined at a min-
imum of five points over the temperature range ambient to maximum recommended service
or 70 °C, whichever is the greater.
(F) The test methods for rigid foams are to be in accordance with the Guidance specially speci-
fied by the Society
(G) Minimum characteristics and mechanical properties of rigid expanded foams are to comply
with the values specified in Table 6.

Table 6 Minimum characteristics and mechanical properties of rigid expanded foams at 20 °C

Apparent Strength (stress at maximum load) Modulus of elasticity


Material density (Nmm  ) (Nmm  )
(kgmm  ) Tensile Compressive Shear Compressive Shear
Polyurethane 96
0.85 0.60 0.50 17.20 8.50
Polyvinylchloride 60

(H) Other types of foam will be subjected to individual consideration. A minimum core shear
strength of 0.5 Nmm  is to be achieved.

90 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-9 Offshore Mooring Chain Pt 2, Annex 2-9

Annex 2-9 Offshore mooring chain

1. Application
These requirements apply to rolled steels, forgings, castings used for the manufacture of offshore
mooring chain and accessories.
2. Rolled steel bars
(1) Steel manufacture
(A) The steels are to be manufactured by basic oxygen, electric furnace or such other process as
may be specially approved.
(B) The austenitic grain size measured in accordance with KS D 0205 or other international rec-
ognised standards is to be 6 or finer.
(C) Steel for bars intended for R 4S and R 5 chain is to be vacuum degassed.
(D) For R 4S and R 5 the following information is to be supplied by the bar manufacturer to
the mooring chain manufacturer and the results included in the chain documentation :
(a) Each heat is to be examined for non-metallic inclusions. The level of micro inclusions
is to be quantified and assessed; to be sure inclusion levels are acceptable for the final
product.
(b) A sample from each heat is to be macro etched to be sure there is no injurious segre-
gation or porosity.
(c) Jominy hardenability data in accordance with KS D 0206 or other international recog-
nised standards is to be supplied with each heat.
(2) Steel manufacture
The approval will normally be limited up to the maximum diameter equal to that of the chain
diameter tested. the rolling reduction ratio is to be recorded and is to be at least 5:1. the roll-
ing reduction ratio used in production can be higher, but should not be lower than that
qualified.
(3) Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
(A) All steels are to be killed and fine grain treated. The chemical composition of ladle samples
of each heat is to be determined by the steel maker and is to comply with the approved
specification.
(B) The steelmaker is to submit a specification of the chemical composition of the bar material,
which must be approved by the Society and by the chain manufacturer. For Grade R 4, R 4S
and R 5 chain the steel should contain a minimum of 0.20 % molybdenum.
(4) Mechanical properties
(A) The mechanical properties of chain bars are to comply with the requirements given in
Table 1.
(B) Hydrogen embrittlement test is to be carried out in accordance with the following procedure:
(a) One tensile test specimen is to be tested within max. 3 hours after machining. (for 14
mm diameter specimen, the time limit is 1.5 hours) Alternatively, tensile test specimen
may be cooled to -60℃ immediately after machining and kept at that temperature for a
period of max. 5 days.
(b) The other specimen is to be tested after baking at 250℃ for 4 hours. (for 14 mm di-
ameter specimen, the time limit is 2 hours)
(c) A slow strain rate not exceed 0.0003S-1 as far as practicable is used during the entire
test, (This is approximately 10 minutes for the 20 mm diameter specimen) and tensile
strength, elongation and reduction of area are to be measured.
(d) The test result is to comply with the following formula.

Z(1) / Z(2) ≥ 0.85

Z(1) is the reduction of area measured by the test specified in (B) (a)
Z(2) is the reduction of area measured by the test specified in (B) (b)

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 91
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-9 Offshore Mooring Chain Pt 2, Annex 2-9

Table 1 Mechanical Properties of offshore mooring chain and accessories

Tensile test Impact test(1)

Grade Tensile Average


Yield strength Elongation(%) Reduction of area Test temp
strength absorbed
(Nmm  )(2) (   ) (%) (℃)
(Nmm  )(2) energy (J)

RSBCR 3 410 min. 690 min. 17 min. 50 min. -20(3) 40 min.(3)


RSBCR 3S 490 min. 770 min. 15 min. 50 min. -20(3) 45 min.(3)
RSBCR 4 580 min. 860 min. 12 min. 50 min. -20 50 min.
RSBCR 4S 700 min. 960 min. 12 min. 50 min. -20 56 min.
RSBCR 5 760 min. 1000 min. 12 min. 50 min. -20 58 min.
NOTES:
(1) When the absorbed energy of two or more test specimens among a set of test specimens is less in val-
ue than the specified average absorbed energy or when the absorbed energy of a single test specimen is
less in value than 70 % of the specified average absorbed energy, the test is considered to have failed.
(2) The yield ratio (the aim value of yield to tensile ratio) for grade R 3, R 3S, or R 4 is to be maximum
0.92.
(3) Impact test of grade R 3 and R 3S may be carried out at the temperature of 0℃ where approved by the
Society. In this case, minimum mean absorbed energy is to be not less than 60J for grade R 3 and
65J for grade R 3S.
(4) Reduction of area of cast steel is to be for Grades R 3 and R 3S : min. 40 %, for R 4, R 4S and R 5 :
min. 35 %.
(5) Aim maximum hardness for R 4S is HB330 and R 5 HB340.

(5) Selection of test sample


Bars of the same nominal diameter are to be presented for test in batches of 50 tonnes or frac-
tion thereof from the same heat. Test specimens are to be taken from material heat treated in
the same manner as intended for the finished chain.
(6) Test specimens
(A) For all grades, one tensile and three Charpy V-notch specimens are to be taken from each
sample selected.
(B) For grades R 3S , R 4, R 4S and R 5 in addition to the test specimen required by (A), two
tensile test specimens having a diameter of 20 mm in principle, are to be taken for the hy-
drogen embrittlement test. (Consideration will be given to a diameter of 14 mm with the
Society's approval.) In this case, test specimen is to be taken from the central region of
bar materials heat-treated in the same manner as (a) or (b).
(a) In case of continuous casting, test samples representing both the beginning and the end
of the charge(except the mixed zone of the charge) shall be taken.
(b) In case of ingot casting test samples representing two different ingots shall be taken.
(C) The test specimens are to be taken with their longitudinal axis parallel to the final direction
of rolling.
(D) The tensile and impact test specimens are to be taken from the test sample in the longi-
tudinal direction at a depth of 1/6 diameter from the surface or as close as possible to this
position. (See Fig 1)
(E) The longitudinal axis of the notch is to correspond approximately to the radial direction of
each test specimen.

92 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-9 Offshore Mooring Chain Pt 2, Annex 2-9

Fig 1 Location of test specimens

(7) Surface inspection, non-destructive inspection and verification of dimensions


(A) Non-destructive examination is to be performed in accordance with recognized standards sub-
ject to the approval by the Society. Non-destructive examination procedures, together with
rejection/acceptance criteria are to be submitted to the Classification Society.
(B) Non-destructive examination operators are to have the qualification given in Annex 2-7, 1
(4) (a) of this guidance in the method of non-destructive examination.
(C) Surface inspection for all grades is to be carried out and it is to be confirmed that there
are no harmful defects.
(D) 100 percent of material intended for either chain or fittings are subjected to ultrasonic ex-
amination at an appropriate stage of the manufacture and it is to be confirmed that there
are no harmful defects.
(E) For all grades, 100 percent of round bars for chains is to be examined by magnetic particle
or eddy current methods and it is to be confirmed by magnetic particle or eddy current
methods and it is to be confirmed that there are no harmful defects. Provided that their
depth is not greater than 1 % of the bar diameter longitudinal discontinuities may be re-
moved by grinding and blending to a smooth contour.
(F) Notwithstanding the requirements of (D) and (E), the frequency of non-destructive inspection
may be reduced where the quality control conditions of the manufacturer are satisfactorily
met.
(G) The diameter and roundness of all grades of chain bars are to be within the tolerances
specified in Table 2.

Table 2 Dimensional tolerance

Tolerance on roundness
Nominal Diameter (mm) Tolerance on diameter (mm) (d  - d  ) (mm) (1)

less than 25 -0, +1.0 0.6 max.


25 ~ 35 -0, +1.2 0.8 max.
36 ~ 50 -0, +1.6 1.1 max.
51 ~ 80 -0, +2.0 1.50 max.
81 ~ 100 -0, +2.6 1.95 max.
101 ~ 120 -0, +3.0 2.25 max.
121 ~ 160 -0, +4.0 3.00 max.
161 ~ 210 -0, +5.0 4.00 max.
NOTES:
(1) d  and d  mean the maximum and minimum diameter of a round bar.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 93
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-9 Offshore Mooring Chain Pt 2, Annex 2-9

(8) Marking
Each bar is to be stamped with the steel grade designation and the charge number 9 or a code
indicating the charge number) on one of the end surfaces. Other marking methods may be ac-
cepted with the Society's approval.
3. Forged steel
(1) Manufacture
(A) Forged steels used for the manufacture of accessories must be in compliance with approved
specifications and the submitted test reports by the Society.
(B) Steel is to be manufactured by basic oxygen, electric furnace or such other process as may
be specially approved.
(C) The austenitic grain size measured in accordance with KS D 0205 or other international rec-
ognised standards is to be 6 or finer.
(D) Steel for forgings intended for R 4S and R 5 chain is to be vacuum degassed.
(F) For steel intended for R 4S and R 5 accessories the following information is to be supplied
by the steel manufacturer to the mooring accessory manufacturer and the results included in
the accessory documentation :
(a) Each heat is to be examined for non-metallic inclusions. The level of micro inclusions
is to be quantified and assessed; to be sure inclusion levels are acceptable for the final
product.
(b) A sample from each heat is to be macro etched to be sure there is no injurious segre-
gation or porosity.
(c) Jominy hardenability data in accordance with KS D 0206 or other international recog-
nised standards is to be supplied with each heat.
(2) Steel manufacture
For forgings, the forging reduction ratio, used in the qualification tests, from cast ingot/slab to
gorged component is to be recorded. The forging reduction ratio used in production can be
higher, but should not be lower than that qualified.
(3) Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
(A) All steels are to be killed and fine grain treated. The chemical composition of ladle samples
of each heat is to be determined by the steel maker and is to comply with the approved
specification.
(B) The forge is to submit a specification of the chemical composition of the forged material,
which must be approved by the Society. For Grade R 4, R 4S and R 5 chain the steel should
contain a minimum of 0.20 % molybdenum.
(4) Heat treatment
Finished forgings are to be properly heat treated in compliance with specifications submitted and
approved.
(5) Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of each grade are to comply with the requirements given in Table 1.
(6) Test specimens
(A) For test sampling, forgings of similar dimensions(diameters do net differ by more than 25
mm) originating from the same heat treatment charge and the same heat of steel are to be
combined into one test unit.
(B) One tensile test specimen and one set (3 pieces) of impact test specimens are to be taken
from the test sample.
(C) The location of the test specimens is to comply with Fig 1.
(7) Surface and non-destructive inspection
(A) Surface inspection for all grades is to be carried out and it is to be confirmed that there
are no harmful defects.
(B) Non-destructive examination is to be performed in accordance with recognized standards sub-
ject to the approval by the Society. Non-destructive examination procedures, together with
rejection/acceptance criteria are to be submitted to the Classification Society.
(C) Non-destructive examination operators are to have the qualification given in Annex 2-7, 1
(4) (a) of this guidance in the method of non-destructive examination.
(D) Surface inspection for all grades is to be carried out and it is to be confirmed that there
are no harmful defects.
(8) Marking
Marking of forgings is to be in accordance with 2 (8).

94 Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012
Pt 2 Materials and Welding
Annex 2-9 Offshore Mooring Chain Pt 2, Annex 2-9

4. Steel castings for chains


(1) Manufacture
(A) Cast steels used for the manufacture of accessories must be in compliance with approved
specifications and the submitted test reports by the Society.
(B) Steel is to be manufactured by basic oxygen, electric furnace or such other process as may
be specially approved.
(C) The austenitic grain size measured in accordance with KS D 0205 or other international rec-
ognised standards is to be 6 or finer.
(D) Steel for castings intended for R 4S and R 5 chain is to be vacuum degassed.
(E) For steel intended for R 4S and R 5 accessories the following information is to be obtained
and the results included in the accessory documentation :
(a) Each heat is to be examined for non-metallic inclusions. The level of micro inclusions
is to be quantified and assessed; to be sure inclusion levels are acceptable for the final
product.
(b) A sample from each heat is to be macro etched to be sure there is no injurious segre-
gation or porosity.
(c) Jominy hardenability data in accordance with KS D 0206 or other international recog-
nised standards is to be supplied with each heat.
(2) Deoxidation practice and chemical composition
(A) All steels are to be killed and fine grain treated. The chemical composition of ladle samples
of each heat is to be determined by the steel maker and is to comply with the approved
specification.
(B) The foundries is to submit a specification of the chemical composition of the cast material,
which must be approved by the Society. For Grade R 4, R 4S and R 5 chain the steel should
contain a minimum of 0.20 % molybdenum.
(3) Heat treatment
All castings are to be properly heat treated in compliance with specifications submitted and ap-
proved by the Society.
(4) Mechanical properties
The mechanical properties of each grade are to comply with the requirements given in Table 1.
(5) Test specimens
(A) For test sampling, castings of similar dimensions originating from the same heat treatment
charge and the same heat of steel are to be combined into one test unit.
(B) One tensile test specimen and one set (3 pieces) of impact test specimens are to be taken
from the test sample.
(C) The location of the test specimens is to comply with Fig 1.
(6) Surface and non-destructive inspection
(A) Surface inspection for all grades is to be carried out and it is to be confirmed that there
are no harmful defects.
(B) Non-destructive examination is to be performed in accordance with recognized standards sub-
ject to the approval by the Society. Non-destructive examination procedures, together with
rejection/acceptance criteria are to be submitted to the Classification Society.
(C) Non-destructive examination operators are to have the qualification given in Annex 2-7, 1
(4) (a) of this guidance in the method of non-destructive examination.
(D) The castings are to be subjected to 100 percent ultrasonic examination in compliance with
the standard submitted and approved.
(7) Marking
Marking of forgings is to be in accordance with 2 (8).
5. Materials for studs
(1) Studs intended for stud link chain cable are to be made of steel corresponding to that of the
chain or in compliance with specifications submitted and approved.
(2) The carbon content should not exceed 0.25 percent if the studs are to be welded in place.

Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships 2012 95
Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships
Guidance Relating to the Rules for the Classification
of Steel Ships

PART 2 MATERIALS AND WELDING

Published by
KOREAN REGISTER OF SHIPPING
90 Gajeongbukro, 23-7 Jang-Dong, Yuseong-Gu,
DAEJEON, KOREA
TEL : +82 42 869 9114
FAX : +82 42 862 6011
Website : http://www.krs.co.kr

Copyright, ⓒ, 2012 by KOREAN REGISTER OF SHIPPING


Printed in Korea

CopyrightⒸ 2012, Korean Register of Shipping


Reproduction of this Rules and Guidance in whole or in
parts is prohibited without permission of the publisher.

You might also like